Quick Apps For SharePoint 6.4 User Guide Appsfor Share Point_6.9_User Point 6.9

User Manual: QuickAppsforSharePoint_6.9_UserGuide

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 420 [warning: Documents this large are best viewed by clicking the View PDF Link!]

QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
© 2018 AgreeYa Solutions, Inc.
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED.
This guide contains proprietary information protected by copyright. The software described in this guide is furnished under a
software license or nondisclosure agreement. This software may be used or copied only in accordance with the terms of the
applicable agreement. No part of this guide may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or
mechanical, including photocopying and recording for any purpose other than the purchaser’s personal use without the written
permission of AgreeYa Solutions, Inc.
The information in this document is provided in connection with AgreeYa products. No license, express or implied, by
estoppel or
otherwise,
to any
intellectual
property right is
granted
by this
document
or in
connection
with the sale of AgreeYa
products.
EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS AS SPECIFIED IN THE LICENSE AGREEMENT FOR THIS PRODUCT,
AGREEYA ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER AND DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY WARRANTY RELATING TO
ITS PRODUCTS INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE, OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL AGREEYA BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL,
PUNITIVE, SPECIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION OR LOSS OF INFORMATION) ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DOCUMENT, EVEN IF AGREEYA
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. AgreeYa makes no representations or warranties with respect to
the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this document and reserves the right to make changes to specifications and
product descriptions at any time without notice. AgreeYa does not make any commitment to update the information
contained in this document.
If you have any questions regarding your potential use of this material, contact:
AgreeYa Solutions, Inc.
605 Coolidge Dr.
Folsom, CA 95630
USA
Refer to our web site (www.agreeya.com) for regional and international office information.
Trademarks
AgreeYa, the AgreeYa logo are trademarks of AgreeYa Solutions, Inc. and/or its affiliates. Microsoft, Internet Explorer,
SharePoint, Windows, Windows Server, SQL Server are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in
the United States and/or other countries. Salesforce and Salesforce.com are trademarks of Salesforce.com. K2, K2BlackPearl
are registered trademarks of Sourcecode Technology Holdings Inc. in the United States and/or other countries. Domino is a
registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation. Telerik is a registered trademark of Telerik AD in the
United States and either a registered trademark or trademark of Telerik AD in other countries. Oracle and Java are registered
trademarks of Oracle and/or its affiliates. Nintex and its product logos are registered trademarks owned by Nintex USA LLC and
Nintex Pty Ltd. SAP is the trademark(s) or registered trademark(s) of SAP AG in Germany and in several other countries. Google
and Google Chrome is a trademark or registered trademark of Google Inc. Netscape Navigator is a registered trademark of AOL
Inc. Other trademarks and trade names may be used in this document to refer to either the entities claiming the marks and names
or their products. AgreeYa disclaims any proprietary interest in the marks and names of others.
QuickApps for SharePoint User Guide
Updated - October 2017
Software Version - 6.9
Legend
CAUTION: A CAUTION icon indicates potential damage to hardware or loss of data if instructions are not followed.
WARNING: A WARNING icon indicates a potential for property damage, personal injury, or death.
IMPORTANT NOTE, NOTE, TIP, MOBILE, or VIDEO: An information icon indicates supporting information.
Contents
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 3
Introducing QuickApps for SharePoint® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
About this Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
About QuickApps for SharePoint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Features of QuickApps for SharePoint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
qCalendarView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10
Configuration Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10
qCalendar Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
qCalendarView Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
qCaptionDisplay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
qCaptionDisplay Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
qCascadingMenu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
qCascadingMenu Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
qCascadingMenu Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Configuring qCascadingMenu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
qChartView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Configuration Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
qChartView Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
qChartView Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Configuring qChartView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 4
Formatting Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Setting Number Formatting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Setting Number Scaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
qDiscussionView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
qDiscussionView Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
qDiscussionView Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Configuring qDiscussionView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Sorting the qDiscussionView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Understanding the Complex Category Index List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Configuring qDiscussionView with the Complex Category Index List . . . . . . . . . . . .116
qDynamicLayout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
qDynamicLayout Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
qDynamicLayout Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Configuring qDynamicLayout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
qExcelViewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
qExcelViewer Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
qExcelViewer Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Configuring qExcelViewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
qHelpLink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
qHelpLink Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
qItemDisplay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
qItemDisplay Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 5
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
qListForm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Configuration Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
User Permissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
qListForm Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
qListForm Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Adding items to a list in SharePoint using qListForm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Creating and Editing Collapsible Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
qListView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
Configuration Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
qListView Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
qListView Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
Configuring a Basic ListView with Filters using ezEdit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
qManagement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
qManagement Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
qManagement Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Configuring qManagement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Exploring Web Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
Searching Web Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
Setting New Property Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
qMediaView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
qMediaView Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 6
qMultiSelector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
qMultiSelector Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
qPageRedirector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
qPageRedirector Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
qPanelMenu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
qPanelMenu Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
qPanelMenu Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Configuring qPanelMenu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
qSelector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
qSelector Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
qSIChartView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
qSIChartView Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
qSIChartView Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
Configuring qSIChartView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
Formatting Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
Setting Number Formatting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Setting Number Scaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
qSIListForm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
qSIListForm Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 7
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .340
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
qSIListView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
qSIListView Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375
qSISelector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
qSISelector Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Content Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Behavior Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385
Appearance Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385
Advanced Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
Custom Action Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Custom Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
ICustomActionEx Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
ICustomAction Interface (Deprecated) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
Debugging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
Using the Custom Action Class . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
Deploying Custom Action Class . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
ezLocalizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .400
Creating a New Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .400
Opening an Existing Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
Finding Values in a Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .401
My First App . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
Using My First App . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
Application Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .404
Installing the Application Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .404
Adding the CRM template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .404
Adding the Help Desk Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .405
Adding the Project Dashboard Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
Adding the Project Workspace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
Sample Charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .408
Contacting AgreeYa . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .419
Technical support resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .419
Third-party contributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .420
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 8
www.agreeya.com
1
Introducing QuickApps for SharePoint®
About this Guide
About QuickApps for SharePoint
Features of QuickApps for SharePoint
About this Guide
This guide describes how to use the web parts component of QuickApps for SharePoint. It contains the
information required to perform general tasks and is intended for network administrators, consultants,
analysts, and any other IT professionals using QuickApps for SharePoint.
Before using this guide, see the QuickApps for SharePoint - Quick Start Guide for installing and activating
QuickApps for SharePoint. The same document also introduces the basic operation of QuickApps for SharePoint,
using a simple configuration to externalize documents in a sample SharePoint environment.
About QuickApps for SharePoint
QuickApps for SharePoint enables you to build applications that can be easily supported, maintained, and
upgraded to ensure their long-term impact and return on investment. Because web parts automates simple or
mundane tasks, you can free up SharePoint development resources and satisfy business requirements without
costly custom coding.
Features of QuickApps for SharePoint
QuickApps for SharePoint is deployed as a SharePoint Solution. The benefit of the solution package deployment
is the ability to deploy web parts in selected Web Applications using the SharePoint Central Administration site.
It also provides the flexibility to turn on/off QuickApps for SharePoint as a site feature. When a new site or site
collection is created, the Admin or Site Designer can activate the QuickApps for SharePoint - Web Parts Library
to enable the web parts for newly added site collections.
This product allows you to:
use point-and-click configuration instead of custom code to customize SharePoint solutions up to 80
percent faster
meet your most complex business requirements, from interface enhancements to complete solutions,
without needing custom development training or experience
use My First App to configure compelling SharePoint list views and charts in a few simple mouse clicks
quickly build better SharePoint solutions with easy-to-use web parts featuring built-in video training and
tutorials. Discover best practices and tips and tricks from SharePoint peers and AgreeYa experts in the
collaborative QuickApps community at www.SharePointforAll.com.
maximize your SharePoint investment by accelerating SharePoint development cycles in order to save
resources, time and money on costly enhancements
empower end users to make their own customizations without risk to the environment, freeing expensive
development resources for more value-added projects
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 9
www.agreeya.com
accelerate SharePoint application development cycles using ready-made templates to deliver help desk,
project management and CRM applications that are easily supported, maintained, and extended
build applications that you can easily maintain and support with no custom coding
exceed user expectations and extend applications beyond what’s natively possible with features that
deliver tabular forms to save screen space, dynamically show and hide parts of a form, and establish
parent-child relationships to ensure reliable data entry
deliver sophisticated custom solutions that can be upgraded with ease from SharePoint version to version
bring data together from all of your enterprise application systems, such as Oracle®, SAP®, SQL Server®
and Salesforce.com®, without the hassle of copying the data manually into SharePoint
build dashboards and charts that provide full visibility of your K2® workflows (including real-time
workflow) status. Then build rich SharePoint forms that drive business processes, so users can take
action on K2 workflows from directly within the SharePoint form (for SharePoint 2010 only)
create custom actions with out-of-the-box and Nintex® workflows
use ribbons. For more information, see Ribbon Groups on page 9.
Ribbon Groups
A Ribbon group is delivered for each web part that supports the SharePoint and SharePoint Foundation Server
Ribbon UI.
The contextual group contains the “Commands” contextual tab for the web part on the page, which in turn,
contains different Ribbon groups. When you select a web part, you can access such functions as ezEdit and
Help.
When multiple web parts are added to the page, different Ribbon tabs are added in the order of the web part
appearance on the page. Each tab’s name defaults to the Title property of the web part.
The display name of the tab can be changed using the web part property, Ribbon Appearance. This property
allows you to customize the display name for the tab. If this property is filled out, it overrides the web part's
Title property. If both of these properties are empty, the default name, “Commands”, is used.
The web part’s ribbon may consists of one or more of the following groups:
NOTE: To hide the Ribbon, enable the corresponding property in the Configuration Editor.
Table 1. Ribbon Groups
Group Description
Manage Group Contains the buttons: “Save and Close”, “Edit Item”, “Edit Series”, and “Cancel”
depending on the context. For example, if you are working with a form of type
EditListItem, the group will contain the “Save and Close” button. If the form type
is DisplayListItem or DisplayDocument, and you are working with a Calendar list,
the button is “Edit Series”. The text for Save and Cancel buttons can be changed
by using the Toolbar Appearance tab.
Actions Group Contains a set of action buttons seen in the regular toolbar, The Ribbon organizes
the actions into different groups. In general, any button shown in the toolbar and
not in the “Manage” or “Custom Actions” groups is found in the “Actions” group.
This includes “Alert Me”, “Manage Permissions”, or “Manage Copies”.
Custom Actions
Group Contains a set of custom actions defined in the Custom Actions properties.
Setting & Help
Group Contains buttons from the web part context menu: “ezEdit”, “Help” and “About”.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
2
10
www.agreeya.com
qCalendarView
Overview
Configuration Wizard
qCalendar Pages
qCalendarView Procedure
Overview
The qCalendarView aggregates data from one or more SharePoint lists and displays it in calendar form.
The qCalendarView allows you to:
Aggregate data from multiple lists that reside in different SharePoint sites. The lists to be aggregated
are defined in the Viewed Lists property.
Ensure the referential integrity of the records in the dependent lists by preventing the deletion of the
parent record. The dependent lists are defined in the Viewed Lists property.
View your data by Month, Week, or Day.
Display non-recurring and recurring events from Calendar lists.
Customize the look and feel for each part of the calendar by using a skin.
Define a static filter using the CAML Filter expression or Complex Filter expression. The Complex Filter
expression supports time functions (for example, AddDays) and time expression (such as [TODAY]) to
filter out the data based on the moving time window. This feature is called Data Aging.
Access the most common functions on the data item, such as View Properties, Edit Properties, Alert Me,
Export to ICalendar, and Delete. The author can turn off the context menu by setting the Enable Context
Menu property to False.
Show or hide the calendar based on the site group and cross-site group membership of the currently
logged-in user by using the Show User Groups and Hide User Groups properties.
Enable the chart view to consume a filter from another web part that implements IWebPartRow or
IWebPartParameter interface.
Configuration Wizard
qCalendarView uses a configuration wizard to walk you through basic configuration tasks. For more information
on using the Configuration Wizard, see Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard on page 34.
TIP: To maintain the same look and feel across all web parts, save the web part as a template, and re-
import it into the SharePoint gallery to reuse it.
NOTE: The IWebPartParameter consumer implementation is labeled with Get Filter From in the web part
Connection menu. This interface cannot be connected with the obsolete IFilterProvider or IRowProvider
implementation. Do not connect this new interface with the old interface that is marked obsolete.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 11
www.agreeya.com
qCalendar Pages
You can configure this web part through its pages that are accessible through ezEdit. qCalendar contains the
following pages:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Optional Content
Search/Filter Panel
Filtering
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part, or accept the default. This field is
mandatory.
Viewed Lists See Viewed Lists on page 12.
ID HTTP Parameter Allows the qListForm and several other web parts to an HTTP Parameter called ID to
identify the item to be displayed or edited. This HTTP Parameter is usually generated
automatically by the viewer web part, such as qListForm or qCalendarView, when you
select an item to be displayed or edited.
NOTE: If qCalendar is placed on a web part page that is contained within a document
library, the page will generate an error if the value of the ID HTTP Parameter is bigger
than the number of pages within the document library. To prevent this error from
happening, rename the ID HTTP Parameter.
By default, the value of this property is "ID". You can change the value of this property
to something else, such as LID. In that case, when you select "View Properties" or "Edit
Properties" in the context menu, the URL of the display or edit form becomes:
http://mysite.com/EditFormURL.aspx?LID=xxx
NOTE: Set the same property in the qListForm to the same value.
Display Field Name Allows you to select the name of the field in the SharePoint list that contains the title
for the item. If you want to display the information from more than one fields, then
specify the format in the Display Format property.
For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 12
www.agreeya.com
Viewed Lists
The Viewed Lists section defines:
the lists whose data is aggregated in the calendar
the Dependent Lists for each list. If the Dependent Lists information is provided, the Calendar View
checks whether or not there are child records in the Dependent Lists when the user tries to delete an
item from the calendar. If there are, the Calendar View does not delete the selected item.
Viewed List contains the following list attributes:
Begin Date Field
Name Allows you to select the name of the field in the SharePoint list that contains the begin
date information. This drop down will only display date and time type of fields.
End Date Field Name Allows you to select the name of the field in the SharePoint list that contains the end
date information. This drop down will only display date and time type of fields.
Table 2. Viewed Lists
List Attributes Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Viewed Lists in XML format. For example:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="." ListName="wfpub" IncludeSubsites="false" IncludeThisSite="false"
IsRollUpList="false" RolledUpListName="Public Library"
UseUploadFormInLayoutsFolder="false">
<DependentLists />
</List>
</Lists>
Site URL The URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can be absolute
(http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
List Name The name of the SharePoint list that is edited or displayed by this Calendar View. The
list name is case sensitive. If the list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as
well.
To denote the current list, you can use a single dot (.) as the list name.
NOTE: This only works if the qCalendarView is contained in the AllItems.aspx. For
example, if you are replacing the Microsoft Calendar View in the AllItems.aspx of the
Tasks list and you use a single dot as the ListName attribute, the ListName attribute
of the qCalendarView ise set to Tasks. If you want to save the list as a template and
then use it somewhere else, the name of the new list might not be Tasks and using
this relative list name automatically picks up the new list name for the view.
Include Subsites If selected, the Calendar View searches all the subsites for a list whose name
specified in the ListName and aggregate the information from those list.
NOTE: If you have many subsites, the information may take a long time to aggregate.
Use this attribute if you have only a few subsites. You must test this feature in your
environment to see whether or not the response comes back in a reasonable amount
of time and the request does not time out.
Include This Site Used in conjunction of the IncludeSubsites attribute. If you set this property to true,
the list in the current site is not aggregated by the Calendar View. The current site is
the site whose URL is specified in the SiteUrl attribute.
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 13
www.agreeya.com
Is Rollup List Indicates whether or not the list specified by the SiteUrl and ListName attributes
contains the Site URLs of the lists to be aggregated instead of the data to be
aggregated. If you set this to true, the list specified by the SiteUrl and ListName must
have a field that contains the URL information. By default, the name of that field is
Site URL. If you use different field name, specify the name using the
SiteUrlFieldName attribute below.
Rolled Up List Name Used in conjunction with the Is Rollup List property, indicates the name of the lists to
be rolled up if you check the Is Rollup List check box.
If you want to aggregate more than one list from each site specified in the rollup list,
you can define more than one List elements with the same rollup list, but different
Rolled Up List Name. For example, if you want to aggregate Public Library and Private
Library document libraries from each site, you can specify the following:
Site URL Field Name Used in conjunction with the Is Rollup List property, indicates the field that contains
the Site URLs of the lists to be aggregated. This attribute is optional if the field name
is Site URL.
NOTE: The Site URL field must be a single line of text field.
Active Field Name Used in conjunction with the Is Rollup List property. The rollup list may contain a
Yes/No field to indicate whether or not a particular site should be included in the
rollup. This property is optional if the name of this field is Active.
NOTE: The Active field must be a Yes/No field.
Reset Session Names Resets (sets to NULL) the value of the session variables whose name is specified in this
attribute. You can specify multiple names by separating them with commas.
You can reset the session name if you have Multi Persistent Selectors in the target
page. Usually, you must reset all but the last persistent selector session values. This
ensures that the item that you want to pre-select in the last persistent selector is not
filtered out by the previous persistent selector.
Set Session Name Allows the calendar to store the selected item in the session under the name
specified in the attribute. The item is selected when the user clicks a hyperlink
created by using the Link To, Link To Target URL, or the Link To Source properties.
You can specify this attribute when you have a Persistent Selector web part in the
target page and you want that persistent selector to pre-select the item the user
chose in this calendar.
Target URL When the LinktoTargetUrl attribute of a specific column is selected (in the Primary
Content page), the data in that column becomes a hyperlink to the URL specified in
this attribute.
NOTE: The Target Url can use the <%field name%> field replacement expression. If
you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt; respectively.
NOTE: Use the LinktoTargetUrl attribute if you want each list to have a different URL;
for example, when you want to aggregate multiple lists from the same workspace and
connect a certain column to the display form of the list. In that case, the URL to the
display form of each list can be different.
New Form URL Indicates the URL where the form to create a new item in the list resides. The URL is
relative to the Site URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when
the New Item button in the toolbar is clicked. If not defined, the user is redirected to
the NewForm.aspx of the list (or Upload.aspx for the document library).
Table 2. Viewed Lists
List Attributes Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 14
www.agreeya.com
Optional Content
You can configure the following optional content:
Display Format
This attribute specifies how the field value is formatted when displayed.
The syntax for the Display Format string is as follow: {0:FormatString}. The following are the value of the
Display Format attribute grouped by the type of the value to be formatted.
Edit Form URL Indicates the URL where the form to edit an item in the list resides. The URL is
relative to the Site URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when
the user clicks Edit Properties in the Context Menu. If not defined, the user is
redirected to the EditForm.aspx of the list.
Redefining the Edit Form URL is useful if you have different ways of editing an item
depending on the current view. For example, in the view for external vendor, you may
want to give them an edit form that does not contain all the fields in the list.
NOTE: The ID and Source HTTP parameters are automatically appended to the Edit
Form URL during redirection.
This attribute is usually used in conjunction with the qListForm web part.
Display Form URL Indicates where the URL where the form to display an item in the list resides. The URL
is relative to the Site URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when
the user clicks View Properties in the Context Menu. If not defined, the user is
redirected to the DisplayForm.aspx of the list.
Redefining the Display Form URL is useful if you have different way of displaying an
item depending on the current view. For example, in the view for external vendor,
you may want to give them a display form that does not contain all the fields in the
list.
NOTE: The ID and Source HTTP parameters are automatically appended to the Display
Form URL during redirection.
This attribute is usually used in conjunction with the qListForm web part.
Table 3. Optional Content
Element Description
Recurrence Field Name Allows you to enter the name of the field in the SharePoint list that contains the
recurrence data. This property is optional. The default value is RecurrenceData,
the name of the field for the SharePoint calendar list that contains the recurrence
data. If the calendar displays data from another type of list, leave the value of
the properly blank. Only the event list can have recurrence data (SharePoint does
not allow you to add a new field to the list with Recurrence type).
Display Format Allows you to enter the format of the title. You can use the <%FieldName%> field
replacement expression to refer to a certain field. The FieldName is case
sensitive. This property takes precedence over the Display Field Name property.
NOTE: For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
Tooltip Field Name Allows you to select the name of the field in the SharePoint list that contains the
description for the item. The description for the item is displayed as a tooltip
when you hover your mouse over an item in the calendar.
If you want to display the information from more than one field, specify the
format in the Tooltip Format property.
Tooltip Format Allows you to enter the format of the tooltip. You can use the <%FieldName%>
field replacement expression to refer to a certain field. The FieldName is case
sensitive. This property takes precedence over the Tooltip Field Name property.
Table 2. Viewed Lists
List Attributes Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 15
www.agreeya.com
For custom number formatting, you can combine different specifiers. For example: {0:0,0%} will output
1,240,025%.
Table 4. Basic Numb e r Fo r matting
Format Type Output (if input is double
value 2.34)
Output (if input is integer value
12400)
{0:c} Currency $2.34 $12,400
{0:d} Decimal (whole
number) N/A 12400
{0:e} Scientific 2.340000e+000 1.240000e+004
{0:n} Number with
commas for
thousands
2.34 12,400
{0:x} Hexadecimal N/A cf90
Table 5. Custom Number Formatting
Specifier Note Example Output (if input is 12400.25)
0 Zero placeholder {0:00.00} 12400.250
# Digit placeholder {0:##.####} 12400.25
. Decimal point {0:0.0} 12400.3
, Thousands
separator {0:0,0} 12,400
%Percent (Multiplies
by 100 and add %
sign)
{0:0%} 1240025%
Table 6. Date Fo rmatting
Format Type Output (if input is November 14, 2007 10:34:23 PM)
{0:d} Short date 11/14/2007
{0:D} Long date November 14, 2007
{0:t} Short time 10:34 PM
{0:T} Long time 10:34:23 PM
{0:f} Full date and time November 14, 2007 10:34 PM
{0:F} Full date and time (long) November 14, 2007 10:34:23 PM
{0:g} Default date and time 11/14/2007 10:34 PM
{0:G} Default date and time
(long) 11/14/2007 10:34:23 PM
{0:M} Month and day November 14
{0:r} RFC1123 date string Wed, 14Nov2007 10:24:23 GMT
{0:s} Sortable date string 2007-14-11T22:34:23
{0:u} Universal sortable, local
time 2007-14-11 22:34:23 PM
{0:U} Universal GMT November 14, 2007 10:34:23 PM
{0:Y} Month and year November, 2007
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 16
www.agreeya.com
Search/Filter Panel
The Search/Filter Panel allows you to define the panels for search, filter, and replace in the web part.
The Search/Filter Panel contains the following elements:
Table 7. Custom Date Formatting
Specifier Note Example Output (if input is November
14, 2007 10:34:23 PM)
dd Day {0:00.0} 14
ddd Day name {0:##.####} Wed
ddd Full day name {0:0.0} Wednesday
f,ff,... Second fraction {0:fff} 230
gg Era {0:gg} A.D.
hh 2 digit hour {0:hh} 10
HH 2 digit hour in 24 hour
format {0:HH} 22
mm Minute 00-59 {0:mm} 34
MM Month 01-12 {0:MM} 11
MMM Month abbreviation {0:MMM} Nov
MMMM Full month name {0:MMMM} November
ss Seconds 00-59 {0:ss} 23
tt AM or PM {0:tt} PM
yy Year, 2 digits {0:yy} 07
yyyy Year {0:yyyy} 2007
zz Timezone offsets, 2
digits {0:zz} -05
zzz Full timezone offsets {0:zzz} -05:00
: Separator {0:hh:mm:ss} 10:34:23
/ Separator {0:dd/MM/yyyy 14/11/2007
Table 8. Search/Filt e r Pa nel
Element Description
Searched Fields See Searched Fields on page 17.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 17
www.agreeya.com
Searched Fields
This property defines what fields are displayed in the Filter panel. If defined, the calendar view displays the
Filter button in the toolbar. To disable the search feature in the calendar view, you can leave this property
blank. If defined, the calendar view displays Filter or Search menu items under the Actions button in the
toolbar. To disable the search feature in the calendar view, you can leave this property blank.
You will be able to perform a search by pressing Enter.
Specify the following field properties:
Show Search All Fields
Control in Search
Panel
Determines whether the Filter panel should display the control to search all fields in
the list. When set to true, the following control is shown in the Filter panel:
The Search All Fields Control allows you to do the following:
Combine the search all fields functionality with other search criteria that has
been entered for specific fields.
When the search all fields criteria is entered, the Filter panel will construct a
filter expression with the "Contain" operator for the following fields in the list:
Single line of text, Multiple lines of text, Choice, Lookup (only Lookup to a
Single Text field and Lookup to a Number field are supported), Person or Group
and Hyperlink or Picture. If the list contains a Lookup to Number field, Search
All Fields will not work for negative numbers for that field. The Filter panel will
use the entire keywords as the value to be searched. Therefore, if you enter
"High Priority" in the search all fields control and perform the search, it will
find the following sentence:
‘This is a high priority task’
However, it will not find the following sentence:
‘The priority is not always high’
Expand Filter panel
on Load Allows you to automatically open the Filter panel by default so that the user can
perform a search quickly. When set to true, the Filter panel opens when the web part
is loaded for the first time.
Panel Button Location Determines the location of the Go, Reset and Close buttons in the Filter panel. This
property also determines the location of the Go and Close buttons in the Replace
panel.
NOTE: Pressing Enter will not allow you to perform a search on such fields as external data, people picker,
managed metadata, and a drop-down list. Instead, the default behavior will occur.
NOTE: For the Number type field, the “Contain” operator is not supported for negative numbers, and is
not available for the following fields: Lookup to DateTime field, Lookup to Calculated field, and Lookup to
ID field.
Table 9. Searched Fields
Field Property Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Searched Fields in XML format.
Field Name Indicates the element you are editing.
Title Displays title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an encoded HTML
string.
Description Describes the field. This is useful if you want to give a short instruction or
explanation about the field.
Default Value Defines the default value for the field.
You can define a text, a number or a date. A date value must be specified in ISO
8601 format: YYYY-MM-DDThh:mm:ssZ, for example: midnight of February 14, 2002
is 2002-02-14T00:00:00Z.
Default Operator Defines the default operator for the field.
Table 8. Search/Filt e r Pa nel
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 18
www.agreeya.com
Fixed Operator Defines the operator for the field. If specified, the list to select the operator for
this field is turned off.
Use People Editor Enables you to enter any user information that is in your directory service.
If you set this to True and the field to be searched is a People and Group field, the
Filter panel shows the People Editor control for entering the search criteria.
Column Count Defines the number of columns for the options in a multi-choice field or in a choice-
and-lookup field if the Enable Multi Choice attribute is set to True. This is useful in
case your choice or lookup fields have too many choices and you want to break the
choices into several columns to minimize the vertical scrolling in your form.
Enable Multi Choice If set to True, allows you to select multiple options for the choice-and-lookup field.
Therefore, the user can specify a condition like "A or B". This attribute is ignored by
other field types.
To search a cross-site lookup field, you must specify one or more List elements
inside the Field element. The cross-site lookup field is displayed as two drop
downs.
Sort Field Defines the field that is used to sort the value in the list menu. The field name is
case sensitive.
Sort Order Allows you to sort the values in ascending or descending order.
AutoPostBack When set to true, this attribute causes the Filter panel to refresh when the user
changes the selection in a lookup field or cross-site lookup field.
You need to set AutoPostBack to true if this field is a lookup or a cross-site lookup
field and it is being used to filter another lookup or cross-site lookup field in the
Filter panel.
Parent Field Defines another lookup or cross-site lookup field that is used to filter this field.
Parent Filter Field Name Defines the field in the parent field that is used to filter this field. It is the primary
key in the list that is used in the lookup or cross-site lookup field.
Filter Field Name Defines the field in the list that is used by this lookup or cross-site lookup field that
is filtered by the parent filter field.
Display Field Name Shows the name of the field whose value is displayed in the list menu. The field
name is case sensitive. Use this attribute instead of the Display Format attribute if
you only want to display a single field in the list menu.
Display Format Indicates the format of the value that is displayed in the list menu. Define this
attribute instead of the Display Field Name attribute if you want to display multiple
fields in the list menu. You can use the field replacement expression <%Field%> to
refer to a field.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and
> characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in
the Searched Fields editor in the List View Editor, where the Editor encodes the
characters automatically.
NOTE: For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
Site URL Indicates the Site URL of the field. You can use an absolute or relative URL.
List Name Indicates the name of the List. The field name is case sensitive.
Site Name Indicates the name of the site specified in the Site URL. This is used in case you
have multiple lists. In this case, the first list menu to select the list displays as "List
Name in Site Name". You can use any name for the Site Name. It does not have to
match the real title of the Site.
Table 9. Searched Fields
Field Property Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 19
www.agreeya.com
Filtering
The Filtering page allows you to use CAML filters to dynamically filter records or use Complex Filters to define
static filter for the data.
The Filtering page contains the following:
CAML Filters
CAML Filter expressions help filter data by providing a way to link multiple conditions.
Turn Advanced Mode on if you want to edit CAML Filters in XML format.
The operators and field names in the CAML Filter are case sensitive. For the field name, use the internal name
of the field.
The Boolean operators <And> and <Or> are supported in CAML Filter. These operators are used to combine two
conditions. They must contain exactly two conditions. For example:
<And><Eq>...</Eq><Gt>...</Gt></And>
If you need to link more than two conditions, such as Condition1 And Condition 2 And Condition3, you must nest
these operators. For example:
<And><Eq>...</Eq><And><Gt>...</Gt><Lt>...</Lt></And></And>
You can specify conditions for CAML Filter in either of the following ways:
<IsNull><FieldRef Name="InternalFieldName"/></IsNull>
This returns all entries whose field specified by InternalFieldName does not contain any value.
<IsNotNull><FieldRef Name="InternalFieldName"/></IsNotNull>
This returns all entries whose field specified by InternalFieldName contains values (including empty
string value).
<Operator><FieldRef Name="InternalFieldName"/><Value Type="TypeName">
ValueToCompare</Value><Operator>
Where:
Table 10. Filtering
Element Description
CAML Filter Allows you to specify the CAML (Collaboration Application Markup Language) query
expression to filter your data. CAML is an XML-based query language. The CAML Filter will
only be applied to the data. The filter will not be applied to the responses.
For more information, see CAML Filters on page 19.
Complex Filter Allows you to use the Complex Filter expression to define a static filter for the data. The
complex filter is applied to the data after the CAML Filter is applied.
NOTE: The Complex Filter is provided here only for backward compatibility reason. In the
past, Complex filter was used to support date functions.
For more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
CAUTION: If the web part supports both CAML Filter and Complex Filter, use the CAML Filter. The
CAML Filter processes data in the SQL Server, so the data is transferred to the Web Server. The
Complex Filter processes data in the Web Server. If you specify both CAML Filter and Complex Filter,
the CAML Filter is processed first.The Complex Filter remains for backward compatibility reasons.
NOTE: This is different from the Complex Filter that uses the Display Name.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 20
www.agreeya.com
Using CAML Filters
CAML filters allow you set the following variables to validate text fields:
Variables work if you store either the user name, login name, user ID, or email address in a Single Line of Text
field. qListForm and qSIListForm use variables in the Fixed Value or Form Component Behavior sections.
For a field of type Single-line-of-Text or Multi-line Plain Text, the Operator drop-down menu contains the value,
Matches, as an operator for comparing the field value to a regular expression.
Examples of common regular expressions:
Value is
Operator One of the following:
Eq — equals to operator
Neq — not equals to operator
Gt — greater than operator
Geq — greater than or equals to operator
Lt — less than operator
Leq — less than or equals to operator
Contains — a string operator to check whether a string contains the specified
value
BeginsWith — a string operator to check whether a string begins with the
specified value
TypeName One of the following:
Text
Integer
Float
DateTime
NOTE: When you compare a DateTime value, only the date is being processed. The
time part is ignored by SharePoint
ValueTo
Compare One of the following:
String
Number
Date/Time value in the format — YYYY-MM-DDTHH:MM:SSZ
Date/Time value in the format :
- <Today OffsetDays="number"/> — today's date with optional number of days
to offset the today's date. You can use the OffsetDays attribute to do date
range filter. The OffsetDays attribute value must be a number (both positive
and negative numbers))
- <UserID/> — the current user. This value only works if the field is a user
lookup field)
Table 11. CAML Filter variables
Variable Description
<%Now%> Current time and date
%FilePath%> Complete path for a file in a document library
<%CurrentUserName%> Display name of the current user
<%CurrentLoginName%> Login name of the current user
<%CurrentUserID%> ID of the current user, for example: 1
<%CurrentUserEmail%> Email address of the current user
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 21
www.agreeya.com
Match beginning of a string: ^Test matches any string that starts with “Test”.
Match ending of a string: test$ matches any string that ends with “test”.
Telephone number: ^\d{3}-\d{3}-\d{4}$ matches any phone number in the format of 555-555-5555.
Using Dynamic Variables
The CAML Filter can also be used with dynamic variables. The Value element in the CAML Filter can come from
various sources such as an HTTP Parameter and Session.
Complex Filters
Complex Filter provides a powerful way to concatenate multiple conditions.
The date and time value must be enclosed in # and specified in ISO 8601 format: YYYY-MM-DDThh:mm:ssZ. For
example, midnight of February 14, 2002 is #2002-02-14T00:00:00Z#.
The operators and field names in the Complex Filter are case sensitive. For the field name, use the display
name of the field (include all spaces if there are any).
The following Boolean operators are supported in Complex Filter:
NOT This is used to negate a condition. For example, to get all employees whose name does not start
with M, they syntax is: NOT Employee Name LIKE 'M%'
AND and OR This is used to concatenate two conditions. The AND operator takes precedence over the
OR. Use parentheses to change the precedence of the operator.
For example, to get all employees in the Accounting or IT department and hired after 1/1/2004:
(Department='Accounting' OR Department='IT') AND Hired Date>#2004-01-01T00:00:00Z#
Specify conditions for Complex Filter is specified in one of following ways:
1 FieldName IS NULL
This will return all entries whose field specified by FieldName does not contain any value.
Some entries contain an empty string value ("") and their display is indistinguishable from the entries
with a NULL value. If you want to return such entries, use FieldName='' as the filter expression.
2 FieldName IS DBNULL
This will return all entries whose field specified by FieldName contains DBNull value. It is tricky to
determine whether a field is empty, contains null value or contains DBNull value. It all depends on the
field type and the type of back end system that you are dealing with. Therefore, try each one
("fieldName IS NULL", "fieldName IS DBNULL" or "fieldName=''") in order to identify which one is the
appropriate option for your needs.
NOTE: If you want to use Advanced Mode, you can extend the value element in the CAML filter. Some
examples are:
to enter the value in the Value element - <Value Type="Text">Some Text</Value>
to retrieve the value from an HTTP parameter - <Value Type="Text"
Source="HttpParameter" SourceName="NameOfHTTPParameter"/>
to retrieve the value from the Session variable - <Value Type="Text" Source="Session"
SessionName="SessionName" SourceName="NameOfHTTPParameter" SiteUrl="url"
ListName="ListName"/>
to compare values of two fields - <Value Type="FieldName"
Source="Field">Editor</Value>
CAUTION: If the web part supports both CAML Filter and Complex Filter, use the CAML Filter. The
CAML Filter processes data in the SQL Server, so the data is transferred to the Web Server. The
Complex Filter processes data in the Web Server. If you specify both CAML Filter and Complex Filter,
the CAML Filter is processed first. The Complex Filter remains for backward compatibility reasons.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 22
www.agreeya.com
3 FieldName IS NOT NULL
This will return all entries whose field specified by FieldName contains values (including empty string
value).
4 FieldName comparison-operator FieldExpression
Comparison operator is one of these: =, <> (not equal), <, >, <=, >=, LIKE
FieldExpression can be one of the following:
String A string is enclosed with single quote; for example 'Accounting'. A string can contain wild-
card character % or * when used in conjunction with the LIKE operator. For example: 'M%', 'M*'. A
wild-card character is not allowed in the middle of a string. Therefore, this expression is illegal:
'Te*xt'
Numbers Numbers are not enclosed. For example: 20, 20.5, 0.5. If you enclose a number with a
single quote, it is treated as string.
Dates For example: February 5, 2005 11:50 PM is #2005-02-05T23:50:00Z#.
[ME] This expression is replaced with the name of the currently logged-in user.
[TODAY] This expression is replaced with midnight of today's date.
[NOW] This expression is replaced with the current date and time.
Date function The following date functions are supported: AddSeconds, AddMinutes, AddHours,
AddDays, AddMonths and AddYears. Their syntax is DateFunction(dateValue, number). For
example: AddDays([TODAY], 7) adds 7 days to today's date
The following are some examples of the complex filter:
1 All my current task that are due within 7 days
PerformedBy=[ME] AND DueDate>=[TODAY] AND DueDate<=AddDays([TODAY], 7)
2 All unassigned tasks that are due within 3 days
PerformedBy IS NULL AND DueDate>=[TODAY] AND DueDate<=AddDays([TODAY], 3)
3 All overdue tasks
DueDate<[TODAY]
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Actions
Navigation
Views
Actions
The list form has some pre-defined actions, such as Save, Delete, Copy or Move. You can also write your own
custom action and hook it up with the list form.
The Actions page contain the following elements:
Table 12. Actions
Element Description
Custom Actions For more information, see Custom Actions on page 23.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 23
www.agreeya.com
Custom Actions
This property enables you to define additional buttons in the toolbar or context menu item in the context menu.
You can program that button or context menu item to do a series of actions. The List Form supports some built-
in actions. However, you can write your own custom action using one of the .NET languages, compile it, and call
it by the List Form. See Custom Action Help on page 389 to see how to write your own custom actions.
Here are some ways that you can use this functionality:
Add a custom toolbar button called "Assign All to Me" that will assign all of the selected tasks in the List
Form to me.
Add a custom toolbar called "Approve" that will change the status of all of the selected expense items to
Approved.
Create a custom context menu item called "Publish" that will move the right-clicked document into
another document library.
Create a custom context menu item or toolbar item to start a workflow.
With the ability to write your own custom action, you can virtually do anything to the data when you
click the custom button that you define.
NOTE: The toolbar button affects all the items that are selected in the List Form. The context menu item
affects only the item that is being right-clicked regardless of how many items are selected in your List
Form.
NOTE: The custom action in the List Form does not support the Save action.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 24
www.agreeya.com
Table 13. Custom Actions
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Custom Actions in XML format:
<CustomActions>
<Toolbar>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID" Position="0"
PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID” ImageUrl=”URL”
AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session" SourceName="fieldName"
SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</Toolbar>
<ContextMenu>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID" Position="0"
PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID” ImageUrl=”URL”
AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session" SourceName="fieldName"
SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</ContextMenu>
</CustomActions>
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 25
www.agreeya.com
IsSeparator Allows you to set the item as a separator.
ID Allows you to enter a unique ID that will identify the item. Use a descriptive identifier to
configure the action item with the editor. This field is mandatory.
Text Allows you to enter how the action item is displayed in the toolbar. This field is mandatory.
Text Resource
ID Allows you to define this property if you support a a multi-lingual site. This attribute defines
the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the Web Part. The
Text Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP
parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given
identifier and culture is not found, the value in the Text attribute is used.
Prompt Text Allows you to prompt the user to click the toolbar button or the context menu item.
Prompt Text
Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the
identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the Web Part. The
Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and
culture is not found, the default is used.
Access Key
(Toolbar Only) Allows you to define one character from the Text attribute that becomes the access key to
this toolbar button or context menu item. For example, if you define a letter T as the access
key, you can press ALT+T and the browser will put the focus on this button or context menu
item. If there are multiple elements on the page with the same access key, you can repeat
ALT+T repeatedly until you get the focus on this toolbar button or context menu item.
Position Allows you to set the position of the button in the toolbar. The index starts with 0.
Show User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the Web Part. Separate groups
with commas.
Hide User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part. Separate site
group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide User
Groups, the user cannot
Table 13. Custom Actions
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 26
www.agreeya.com
When you add an action, you can configure the following:
Element Description
Name A mandatory element which allows you to identify a given action in order to access it from
another action. You can refer to this action from the GoToURL action and from
ICustomActionEx Interface.
Type Allows you to determine the type of the action. Here are the options:
Delete — deletes the item.
GoToURL — redirects the user to a specific URL. You must specify the URL and where
you want the URL to open. You must select from one of the following source
parameters:
Input - the current user information as the value of the parameter
Session - the name of the session variable where the value comes from when
the source is set to Session
HttpRequest - the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the HTTP
parameters in the page URL. The name of the HTTP parameter is defined in
the SourceName attribute. As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName
attribute is ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter,
which is Hardware, is used as the value of the parameter.
ListItem - the value of the parameter is a list item or row
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the parameter for the GoToURL action can be
retrieved from the output of another action that comes first in the sequence
of actions defined in the ActionItem. There are two types of action that can
produce an output: an action with Type of ExecuteOperation, and an action
with Type of Custom that points to custom action implementation of
ICustomActionEx Interface. You do that by defining the SourceName
attribute of the action. This is the syntax of the SourceName attribute when
you use ResultFormAction source: <ActionName>.<ResultType>[.Name],
where ActionName refers to the Name attribute of the action that produces
the output, ResultType can be OutParameter (if the action result is returned
through one of the out or inout parameter) or RawData - (if the action result
is returned as an object). Name is optional. It further designates the object
we want to use for the parameter. You do not have to specify the Name when
the ResultType is RawData. However, if the ResultType is OutParameter, this
name specifies the name of the out or input key value pair.
ResultFromAction - the parameter for the GoToURL action can be retrieved
from the output of another action that comes first in the sequence of actions
defined in the ActionItem
You must define a source name (where in the source you want to get your
information from), name (the name of the parameter that is appended to the
URL you specified), and Session (the name of the session variable where the
value comes from when the source is set to Session)
GoToSource — redirects the user to the URL specified in the Source HTTP parameter.
The URL to the page must look like: http://...?Source=URL for this option to work.
StartWorkflow — starts the specified workflow in the Workflow Name drop-down
field. You must select a Workflow name.
ReturnToMasterChart — returns the user to the master chart page. You use this
action type if this web part is located in the drill down page.
Custom — implements your own custom action and call it with this action type.
Enter a Class name that implements the ICustomActionEx or ICustomAction
interface, or select a class from the drop-down list, if available.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 27
www.agreeya.com
Navigation
The Navigation page allows you to configure how and where the user will navigate in the web part. It contains
the following elements:
Views
The Views page allows you to set views so the user to view the data in a calendar.
The Views page contains the following element:
Table 14. Navigation
Element Description
LinkTo Allows you to turn the field into a hyperlinked column to the specified URL. The URL can be
an absolute or relative URL. The LinkTo can use the <%field name%> field replacement
expression.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively.
If you use a relative URL, the URL is appended to the site URL of the target site. For
example, specify "Lists/Calendar/EditForm.aspx?ID=&lt;%ID%&gt;" as the value of this
property. If the user clicks an event that comes from the Calendar list in Workspace A,
whose site URL is "http://mydomain/sites/mysite", the user is directed to
http://mydomain/sites/mysite/Lists/Calendar/EditForm.aspx?ID=23 (this assumes that the
user clicks the event with ID=23).
When the calendar view points to a document library, you can use a special field
replacement expression <%FilePath%> to get a complete path for the file.
LinkToTargetURL Allows you to make the field value a hyperlink to the URL specified in the TargetUrl
attribute in the Viewed Lists property.
Use the LinkToTarget URL when you aggregate lists with different name. In that case,
specify a different TargetUrl for each list in the Viewed Lists property and the calendar
view redirects the user to the correct URL depending on the list from where the clicked
item comes.
Link To Source Allows you to make the field value a hyperlink to the URL specified in the Source HTTP
parameter of the current request. For this option to work, the current page URL must look
like: http://.....?Source=....
When do you use this attribute as opposed to the Link To or the Link To Target URL
attributes? A typical case is when the URL for the hyperlink is dynamic. This could be
because it contains dynamic parameters or the URL is different depending on the referral
page.
Use the LinkToSource when you want to make the URL in the link dynamic. In that case, you
can pass in the URL for the link into the HTTP parameter of your page. For example, say
that we have a page where the user can select a particular contact from the Contacts list.
This page might be useful for several cases in your application and you cannot hard code
the URL because you may want the user to be redirected to different URL depending where
they are in the application. In that case, you can specify the URL for the hyperlink in the
URL of the page.
Table 15. Views
Element Description
Search Session Name The calendar will store the search criteria, last selected folder, sort criteria, and
other list view dynamic settings in the session variable with this name.
The calendar also use the Search Session Name to communicate those settings to
qExcelViewer and qChartView located in the page whose URL specified in the Excel
Viewer URL or Chart Viewer URL property, respectively. Therefore, the Search
Session Name in those web parts must be set to the same value as the session name
in this calendar.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 28
www.agreeya.com
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Toolbar
Legend
Calendar
Context Menu
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
To o l b a r
The Toolbar page allows you to configure the appearance of the toolbar. It contains the following:
Legend
The Legend page allows you to configure the appearance of the legend. It contains the following:
Table 16. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 17. Toolbar
Element Description
Toolbar Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the toolbar.
Show New Button Allows you to display the New button.
Show Connect To Outlook
Button Allows you to display the Connect to Outlook button.
Show Alert Me Button Allows you to show the Alert Me button in the toolbar.
Table 18. Legend
Element Description
Legend Title Allows you to enter a title of the legend.
Legend Color Appearance Allows you to select the list title and color and font color for a list that your
selected in Viewed Lists.
Show Legend Allows you to show the legend.
Legend Show Mode Allows you to select where to position the legend.
Legend Show User Groups Allows you to select the SharePoint members who can view the legend.
Legend Hide User Groups Allows you to select the SharePoint members who cannot view the legend.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 29
www.agreeya.com
Calendar
The Calendar page contains the following:
Table 19. Calendar
Element Description
Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the calendar view.
Calendar Width Allows you to enter the width of the calendar view in pixels. The default is 700.
Calendar Width Unit Allows you to enter unit of measure for the calendar width.
Calendar Height Allows you to enter the height of the calendar view in pixels. The default is 500.
Row Height Allows you to specify the row height for each day/week view and the appointment for
the month view in pixels.
Month View Visible
Appointments Per
Day
Allows you to enter the number of appointments visible per day when in the month
view. The default is 3.
Overflow Behavior Allows you to o scroll or expand the page when the calendar view is not large enough to
display all the data.
Default Calendar
View Allows you to set the default view for the Calendar web part. This can be either Day,
Week or Month.
Enable Day View Allows you to switch to view one day at a time in the Calendar web part
Enable Week View Allows you to switch to view one week at a time in the Calendar web part.
Enable Month View Allows you to switch to view one month at a time in the Calendar web part.
First Day of Week Allows you to determine the first day that is displayed in the week view and month
view. The default value is Sunday.
Last Day of Week Allows you to determine the last day that is displayed in the week view and month view.
The default value is Saturday.
Allow Delete Allows you to determine whether or not the delete button should be shown on every
appointment in the calendar. The delete button appears when you hover your mouse
over the appointment. If you set this property to false, the delete button is not shown
during the mouse over. By default, Allow Delete is set to true.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 30
www.agreeya.com
Context Menu
The Context Menu page contains the following:
Appearance Field
Name Allows you to determine the name of the field whose values is used to determine the
color of the appointment. This allows appointments to be displayed in different colors
based on the value in this predefined field. For example, to display all appointments in
conference room 5 with red and all appointments in conference room 6 with blue, the
Appearance Field Name would be "Location".
There are 2 additional fields that you can use as Appearance Field Name. These fields
are not part of the list but used internally by the Calendar View:
Workspace URL — this is the URL of the site that contains the containing list.
When using the Workspace URL in the Appearance Field Name, you need to
specify the absolute URL of the site in the FieldValue attribute in the Color
Appearance property, for example: http://www.mysite.com/site1
List Name — this is the name of the list that contains the appointment. When
using the List Name in the Appearance Field Name, you need to specify the
name of the list in the FieldValue attribute in the Color Appearance property,
for example: Project Calendar
Color Appearance Allows you to determine the color of the appointment for a certain value in the field
specified by the Appearance Field Name. Turn on Advanced Mode if you want to edit
Color Appearance in XML:
<Appearance>
<AppointmentAppearance FieldValue="fieldValue" BackgroundColor="color"
FontColor="color" />
<AppointmentAppearance FieldValueRange="number-number"
BackgroundColor="color" FontColor="color" />
</Appearance>
For example:
<Appearance>
<AppointmentAppearance FieldValue="Conference Room 5" BackgroundColor="Red"
FontColor="Black" />
<AppointmentAppearance FieldValue="Conference Room 6" BackgroundColor="Blue"
FontColor="Orange" />
</Appearance>
The following are the attributes of the Color Appearance property:
FieldValue — specifies the value for the field.
BackgroundColor — is optional and it specifies the background color of the
appointment for the specified value in the FieldValue attribute. The color can
be specified as a well-known color such as white, black, cyan, lightGray, as a
RGB value such as 255, 255,255, or you can specify it as #FFFFFF, #CCDDEE.
FontColor — is optional and it specifies the font color of the appointment for the
specified value in the FieldValue attribute. The color can be specified as a well-
known color such as white, black, cyan, lightGray, as a RGB value such as 255,
255,255, or you can specify it as #FFFFFF, #CCDDEE. The FontColor attribute is
ignored if you specify a URL in the Link To property or set the Link To Source or
Link To Target URL properties to true.
FieldValueRange — Instead of using the FieldValue attribute, you can also use
this attribute to determine a range of value, such as 0-100, 101-200.
FieldValueRange can only be used if you specify the name of a Number or
Currency field in the Appearance Field Name property.
Table 19. Calendar
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 31
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 20. Context Menu
Element Description
Enable Context Menu Allows you to show the context menu.
Context Menu Skin Name Allows you to set he skin name for the context menu.
Show View Properties Allows you to show the View Properties menu item in the context menu.
Show Edit Properties Allows you to show the Edit Properties menu item in the context menu.
Show Manage Permissions Allows you to show the Manage Permissions menu item in the context menu.
Show Alert Me Allows you to show the Alert Me menu item in the context menu.
Show Workflows Allows you to show the Workflows Properties menu item in the context
menu.
Table 21. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 22. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 32
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 23. Security
Element Description
Show User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the Web Part. Separate groups
with commas.
Hide User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part. Separate site
group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide User
Groups, the user cannot
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 22. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 33
www.agreeya.com
qCalendarView Procedure
You can perform the following procedure using qCalendarView:
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard
Table 24. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
View Properties Context
Menu Text Resource ID Allows you to set the text for the View Properties context menu.
Edit Properties Context
Menu Text Resource ID Allows you to set the text for the Edit Properties context menu.
Manage Permissions
Context Menu Text
Resource ID
Allows you to set the text for the Manage Permissions context menu.
Alert Me Context Menu
Text Resource ID Allows you to set the text for the Alert Me context menu.
Workflows Context
Menu Text Resource ID Allows you to set the text for the Workflows context menu.
New Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the New button.
Connect to Outlook
Button Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Connect to Outlook button.
Alert Me Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Alert Me button.
Filter Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Filter button.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 34
www.agreeya.com
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration
Wizard
To configure basic settings
1 Add qCalendarView to your page.
2 Select the ezWizard menu item from the qCalendarView Web Part Menu or Ribbon.
3 Select one or more lists, from the current site, whose data you want to view, and click Next.
4 Define calendar configurations, and click Next.
If you want to change your selections, select Previous.
5Click Finish.
NOTE: Once a Web Part is configured, the ezWizard item will not appear on the Web Part Menu or the Web Part
Ribbon.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
3
35
www.agreeya.com
qCaptionDisplay
Overview
qCaptionDisplay Pages
Overview
The qCaptionDisplay is a web part that displays a message from a SharePoint list. The text for the message is
identified with a Caption ID.
Storing the message in a list, as opposed to hard coding it in a page, increases the site maintainability. This is
useful if the site is replicated. If you need to make a change to the message, you only have to do it in one place;
just change the list. The list usually resides outside of the replicated site.
You can localize the title and the messages displayed by the caption display. You can define different Title for
different cultures using the Resource List and the Title Resource ID properties. The culture for the page can be
defined by appending the Culture HTTP parameter to the page URL. For example:
http://hostname/sites/sitename/default.aspx?Culture=en-US
To use the caption display, you must first define a source list for the captions. The SharePoint list for the caption
display should contain these fields:
Caption ID This field is mandatory. It is a single-line text field that contains the identifier for the
caption.
Caption This field is mandatory. This is a multiple-line text field that contains the message.
Culture This field is optional. You must have this field if you want to have different messages for a
different culture. You can define different captions with the same Caption ID, but different Culture. You
must leave the value for the default culture blank. For example:
If your list uses different name for the fields, define the name in the Caption ID Field Name, Caption Field Name
and Culture Field Name properties.
You can create the source by selecting AgreeYa Caption Display List (under Custom Lists in SharePoint). This
automatically creates a list that contains all of the above fields.
Define a convention for the Caption ID value that makes it easy for you to identify where the message is used.
For example, use the URL of the page, remove the host name from the URL and replace all / with . (period).
Therefore, if the page URL is http://hostname/sites/mysite/default.aspx, the Caption ID is
sites.mysite.default.aspx.
Table 1. Culture
Caption ID Culture Caption
sites.mysite.default.aspx Welcome to my site
sites.mysite.default.aspx id-ID Selamat datang ke situs saya
NOTE: Make sure that the Allow rich HTML text in the Caption field is set to No.
NOTE: The Caption field can contain plain text or a piece HTML.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 36
www.agreeya.com
qCaptionDisplay Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qCaptionDisplay contains
the following tabs:
Content Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Table 2. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part. This field is mandatory.
Site URL Allows you to enter the URL to the site that contains the list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is mandatory.
List Name Allows you to enter a list name. The name is case sensitive. If the name of the list
contains spaces, include the spaces in the List Name.
Caption ID Allows you to enter the identifier that locates the message in the list.
Caption ID Field Name Allows you to enter the name of the field containing the caption ID. The default
value is User Caption ID.
Caption Field Name Allows you to enter the name of the field containing the message. The default value
is Caption.
Culture Field Name Allows you to enter the name of the field containing the Culture. The default value is
User Culture.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 37
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 3. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 4. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 5. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the Web
Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 38
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 6. Security
Element Description
Show User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the Web Part. Separate groups
with commas.
Hide User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part. Separate site
group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide User
Groups, the user cannot
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 5. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 39
www.agreeya.com
Table 7. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
4
40
www.agreeya.com
qCascadingMenu
Overview
qCascadingMenu Pages
qCascadingMenu Procedures
Overview
The qCascadingMenu lets you create complex menus that occupy minimum screen real estate.
qCascadingMenu offers the ability to:
display items from multiple SharePoint lists. Each list can contain multiple top-level items.
define a static FilterExpression using a Complex Filter expression. The ability to filter enables you to
define the items to be displayed in your menu.
show or hide the top-level items that come from a certain list based on the site group membership of the
currently logged-in user.
hide menu items whose target URLs are not accessible by the current user.
define an icon for each menu item, and define the target frame for the target page.
localize the title and the menu item text. You can define different Title for different cultures using the
Resource List and the Title Resource ID properties. Your can define the culture appending the Culture
HTTP parameter to the page URL. For example:
http://hostname/sites/sitename/default.aspx?Culture=en-US
To configure this web part, we recommend that you use the AgreeYa Menu List custom list template. Use the
template to define a source list for the menu items on a SharePoint site. For information on how to create the
source list, see Configuring qCascadingMenu on page 46. This automatically creates a list which contains the
following columns by default:
Table 1. List Columns
Column Description
Text Provide the text for the menu item.
Menu ID Provides the ID for the menu item.
Parent Menu ID Provides the ID of the menu item that is the parent of this menu item.
Target Url Provides the target URL for the menu item.
NOTE: This is not a Hyperlink field because Hyperlink field does not let you use a relative
URL.
Target Indicates where to open the target page. Specify _blank to open the page in a new window.
Leave the target column empty to redirect the current window to the target URL.
Icon Url Provides the URL to the icon for the menu item.
Access Key Indicates the shortcut key to activate the menu item. You can activate the menu item by
pressing ALT+Access Key Character.
Culture Indicates the culture for this menu item
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 41
www.agreeya.com
You must map these columns in the source list to the corresponding field names in the Configuration section in
the Web Part. For more information on the Configuration section, see Configuration on page 41. For more
information on how to configure the qCascadingMenu Web Part, see Configuring qCascadingMenu on page 46.
qCascadingMenu Pages
You can configure this Web Part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qCascadingMenu contains
the following tabs:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Configuration
This property defines the source list and behavior of the cascading menu. The Configuration element can
contain one or more Menu elements. Each menu element can read a different source.
You can define the following in the Configuration section:
Table 2. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part, or accept the default. This field is
mandatory.
Configuration See Configuration on page 41.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 42
www.agreeya.com
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior Page contains the following:
Navigation
Table 3. Configuration
Field Description
Advanced Mode Turn on Advanced Mode if you want to edit Configuration in XML format:
<Configuration>
<Menu SiteUrl="url" ListName="listName" FilterExpression="filterExpression"
TextFieldName="Text" MenuIdFieldName="Menu Id" TargetUrlFieldName="Target Url"
TargetFieldName="Target" IconUrlFieldName="Icon Url" AccessKeyFieldName="Access
Key" CultureFieldName="Culture" ShowUserGroups="Group1, Group2"
HideUserGroups="Group1, Group2" CheckUserAccess="true/false"/>
</Configuration>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can
be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
List Name Allows you to enter the name of the list. The name is case sensitive. If the name of the
list contains spaces, include the spaces in the List Name.
Filter Expression Allows you to filter the data. The Complex Filter Expression to filter the data. For
more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
Text Field Name Allows you to set the field that contains the text for the menu item.
Menu ID Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the menu ID for the menu item.
Parent Menu ID Field
Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the parent ID for the menu item.
Target URL Field
Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the indicator of where to open
the target URL.
Target Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the indicator of where to open
the target page.
Icon URL Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the icon URL for the menu item.
Culture Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the culture for the menu item.
Access Key Field
Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the access key for the menu item.
Show User Groups Allows you to show groups where the user is a member of one of the SharePoint groups
listed. Separate site group names with commas.
Hide User Groups Allows you to hide groups where the user is member of one of the SharePoint groups
listed. Separate site group names with commas.
Check User Access Allows you to show only the menu items that point to the workspace which the current
can access.
NOTE: Performance can be affected when checking the access for each menu item,
especially for large menus. Also, make sure that every menu item points to a page in a
SharePoint site that is reachable from the current site (as opposed to any external site
such as MSN, Google)
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 43
www.agreeya.com
Navigation
The Navigation page allows you to configure how and where the user will navigate in the web part. It contains
the following elements:
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Menu
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Menu
The Menu page allows you to configure the appearance of the menu. It contains the following:
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Table 4. Navigation
Element Description
Target URL Relative to
Master Page URL Allows you to append the value of the target URL to the URL of the master page. By
default, this property is set to true to maintain backward compatibility with the
existing applications who assumed that the relative URL is appended to the relative
URL of the master page.
Table 5. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 6. Menu
Element Description
Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the menu.
Menu Flow Allows you to select if you want the menu flow horizontal or vertical.
Vertical Flow Width Allows you to set the width if your menu flow is vertical.
Table 7. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 44
www.agreeya.com
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 8. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 7. Layout
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 45
www.agreeya.com
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Table 9. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 10. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 46
www.agreeya.com
qCascadingMenu Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qCascadingMenu:
Configuring qCascadingMenu
Configuring qCascadingMenu
To configure qCascadingMenu
1 Create a source list from AgreeYa Menu List in SharePoint. The source list for the cascading menu will
contain the following fields:
Text - This field is mandatory. This is a single line of text field that provides the text for the menu
item.
Menu Id - This field is mandatory. This is a single line of text field that provides the ID for the
menu item.
Parent Menu Id - This field is mandatory. This is a single line of text field that provides the parent
ID for the menu item.
Target Url - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field that provides the target URL for
the menu item. Please note that this is not a Hyperlink field because Hyperlink field does not let
you use a relative URL.
Target - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field that indicates where to open the
target page.
Icon Url - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field that provides the URL to the icon
for the menu item.
Access Key - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field (one character) that indicates
the shortcut key to activate the menu item. You can activate the menu item by pressing
ALT+Access Key Character.
Culture - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field that indicates the culture for this
menu item.
2 Create a top-level menu. Click New Item to add information to your source list.
3 Create an entry in the list with blank Parent Menu Id, for example:
Table 11. Example of cascading menu list that contains two different cultures and invariants
Text Menu Id Parent
Menu Id Target Url Target Icon Url Access
Key Culture
Public Web
Sites 01 P
Web Sites
untuk Publik 01 W id-ID
Microsoft®01.01 01 http://www.microsoft.
com _blank search.gif M
Microsoft 01.01 01 http://www.microsoft.
com _blank search.gif M id-ID
Google®01.02 01 http://www.google.com _blank search.gif G
Google 01.02 01 http://www.google.com _blank search.gif G id-ID
Other Places 01.03 01 O
Situs Lain 01.03 01 S id-ID
CNN 01.03.01 01.03 http://www.cnn.com C
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 47
www.agreeya.com
The cascading menu can also read any type of list that contains at least the first four fields: Text, Menu
Id, Parent Menu Id and Target Url.
4 Add qCascadingMenu to your site collection page.
5Open ezEdit.
The Primary Content page opens by default.
6 From the Configuration section, select the source list created in SharePoint, and click OK.
7 Click Edit next to the list name.
8 For each field name, select the corresponding column name (from the source list created in SharePoint).
For example, for Text Field Name, select Text; for Menu Id Field Name, select Menu Id. Click OK.
9 If needed, configure the elements in the other tabs.
10 When done configuring each tab, click OK.
CNN 01.03.01 01.03 http://www.cnn.com C id-ID
ABC News 01.03.02 01.03 http://www.abcnews.
com A
ABC News 01.03.02 01.03 http://www.abcnews.
com Aid-ID
NOTE: If the name of the fields is not specified, you must define the field name mapping in the
Configuration property.
Table 11. Example of cascading menu list that contains two different cultures and invariants
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
5
48
www.agreeya.com
qChartView
Overview
Configuration Wizard
qChartView Pages
qChartView Procedures
Overview
qChartView aggregates data from one or more SharePoint lists and displays it in different chart types.
qChartView has the following features:
Different chart types including multi series chart, combination chart, 2D and 3D charts.
Ability to display data from multiple lists, even when the lists are in different sites, site collections or
web applications (as long as they are in the same configuration database).
Ability to customize the look of the chart
Ability to display one or more trend lines in the chart
Dual Y Axis support, making your charts more readable when the minimum and maximum values in your
data series are very different
Ability to generate multiple data series based on dynamic data
Ability to generate a preview at the time of configuring a chart
Ability to export a chart and its data in various formats
Ability to create drill down charts.
Dynamic language switching and Flash and JavaScript (HTML5) support
Configuration Wizard
qChartView uses a configuration wizard to walk you through basic configuration tasks. For more information on
using the Configuration Wizard, see Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard on page 88.
qChartView Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qChartView contains the
following tabs:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 49
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
Content Page
When you open ezEdit in qChartView, the Content page opens by default. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Filtering
Search/Filter Panel
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Viewed Lists
This property defines the lists whose data is aggregated in the Chart View.
The following are the elements for the Viewed Lists attribute.
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to add a title for the web part.
Viewed Lists See Viewed Lists on page 49 for more information
Chart Type Allows you to select the type of chart used to display the data. For examples of each chart
type, see Sample Charts on page 408.
When you select one of the Multi Series, Scroll or Stacked chart type, you must define
multiple data series in the Configuration property. Otherwise you will get a blank chart.
Configuration See Configuration on page 50 for more information.
Table 2. Viewed Lists
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Viewed Lists in XML format:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" ListName="listName" [optional attributes] />
</Lists>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can
be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
List Name Allows you to set the name of the SharePoint list. The list name is case sensitive. If the
list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as well.
To denote the current list, you can use a single dot (.) as the list name.
Include Subsites Allows you to search all subsites for a list whose name specified in the ListName, and
aggregate the information from those list.
NOTE: If you have many subsites, the information may take a long time to aggregate.
Use this attribute if you have only a small amount of subsites. You must test this
feature in your environment to see whether or not the response comes back in a
reasonable amount of time and the request does not time out.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 50
www.agreeya.com
Configuration
This property defines how the data should be grouped in the X Axis and the data series for the chart.
The Configuration element should contain only one X-Axis and one Series element. Each Series element may
contain one or more Items element.
The Configuration section contains the following:
Include This Site Used in conjunction of the IncludeSubsites attribute. If you set this property to true,
the list in the current site is aggregated by the Chart View. The current site is the site
whose URL is specified in the SiteUrl attribute.
Is Rollup List Indicates whether or not the list specified by the SiteUrl and ListName attributes
contains the Site URLs of the lists to be aggregated instead of the data to be
aggregated. If you set this to true, the list specified by the SiteUrl and ListName must
have a field that contains the URL information. By default, the name of that field is
Site URL. If you use different field name, specify the name using the SiteUrlFieldName
attribute below.
Rolled Up List Name Used in conjunction with the IsRollupList property, indicates the name of the lists to be
rolled up if you set the IsRollupList to true.
If you want to aggregate more than one list from each site specified in the rollup list,
you can define more than one List elements with the same rollup list, but different
RolledUpListName.
Site URL Field Name Used in conjunction with the IsRollupList property, indicates the field that contains the
Site URLs of the lists to be aggregated. This attribute is optional if the field name is
Site URL.
NOTE: The Site URL field must be a single line of text field.
Active Field Name Used in conjunction with the IsRollupList property. The rollup list may contain a
Yes/No field to indicate whether or not a particular site should be included in the
rollup. This property is optional if the name of this field is Active.
NOTE: The Active field must be a Yes/No field.
Table 2. Viewed Lists
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 51
www.agreeya.com
If you want to add a data series, configure the following:
Table 3. Configuration
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Configuration in XML format:
<Configuration LookupThresholdControlSetting=”On”>
<XAxis FieldName="FieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<Series>
<Items FieldName="FieldName"
AggregateFunction="Count|Avg|Sum|Min|Max|StdDev|Var" [optional
attributes]/>
<Items FieldName="FieldName"
AggregateFunction="Count|Avg|Sum|Min|Max|StdDev|Var" [optional
attributes]/>
</Series>
</Configuration>
Query All Fields Controls how Web Parts behave in relation to the Chart View Lookup Threshold in
SharePoint Resource Throttling. The options are:
Default — uses the level set in the Configuration Editor. If you have
selected Query All Fields check box in the Configuration Editor, the Web
Part will query only those fields that are not included in the Chart View
Lookup Threshold. If the Query All Fields check box is cleared, the Web
Part will query all fields.
On — If the Web Part level is On, the Web Part queries all fields in lists,
except Lookup fields.
Off — If the Web Part level is Off, the Web Part queries all fields in lists,
including Lookup fields.
Explicit — If the Web Part level is Explicit, the Web Part queries only those
fields selected in the Display Fields. This option renders the best
performance for your Web Part.
Field Name Specifies the name of the field that corresponds to the x axis data. This attribute
is mandatory. The field name is case sensitive.
Case Sensitive Calculations Allows you to perform case-sensitive calculations (sum, count, avg) on lists. The
calculations are performed as case insensitive if this property is not selected.
Display Only Those X-Axis
Values That Contain Data Select this check box if you want to display only X-axis values that contain data.
If this check box is not selected, all X-axis values are displayed on the chart.
NOTE: This is applicable only if you have selected Choice (menu to choose from)
as the Column type for your Field Name property.
Sort By Allows you to select how you want to group the data on the chart, either by field
name or data series number. The value of this property does not have to be the
same as the value in the Field Name attribute.
Sort Order Specifies how the values in the column specified by the Sort By should be
ordered, either ascending or descending.
Table 4. Data Series
Element Description
Field Name (for Data
Series) Specifies the field whose values are aggregated and plotted against the values in
the X- Axis.
NOTE: Only Number or Currency field can be used in the FieldName. The field
name is case-sensitive.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 52
www.agreeya.com
Examples of Configuration Property
The following is an example of the Configuration property if you want to display data from your Sales list. Your
Sales list contains the sales amount for every month in the year. There are 3 fields in the list: Year, Month, and
Amount. For example, say you want to display the month in the X axis. You also wants to create the data series
dynamically based on the year field.
If you are using Advanced Mode, here is the XML:
<Configuration>
<Series>
<Items FieldName="Amount" AggregateFunction="Sum" ChartSeriesType="COLUMN" FilterFieldName="Year" />
</Series>
<XAxis FieldName="Month" SortFieldName="Month" />
</Configuration>
The following shows the resulting chart
Aggregate Function Specifies the aggregation function to be performed on the field specified in the
FieldName attribute. The following aggregation functions are supported: Count,
Avg, Sum, StdDev, Var, Min, or Max.
Series Name Allows the series name to be displayed in the legend as the title in case of
multiple data series.
Chart Series Type Defines the chart type for this series when you use one of the combination chart
in the Chart Type property. The choices are: COLUMN, AREA or LINE. This
attribute is ignored for any non-combination chart type.
Filter Expression Defines the filter that is applied for the data in this series. The filter is defined
using the Complex Filter. For more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
Filter Field Name Determines the field name whose data is used to generate a dynamic data series.
The chart view will analyze the data in this field and generate the filter
expression for each data series automatically, one per unique value in the field.
This attribute is useful if the data that you should use as the filter expression for
the data series is dynamic.
Drill Down Chart URL Determines the URL of the page that contains the drill down chart for this data
series.
Show Values Allows you to determine whether to show the values for this dataset.
NOTE: This attributes is only applicable for a multi-series chart.
Include in Legend Allows you to determine whether to include the series name of this dataset in the
legend.
NOTE: This attribute is only applicable for a multi series chart.
Parent Y Axis Allows you to set the parent axis of the dataset - P (primary) or S (secondary).
Primary datasets are drawn as on the left y-axis and secondary on the right y-axis.
In 3D Column (or stacked Column) + Line Combination Charts, the columns draw
against primary y-axis and the lines against secondary y-axis. In 2D dual Y
combination charts, you can choose what dataset to render against which y-axis.
NOTE: This attribute is only applicable for a chart with a dual y axis.
Hide Allows you to sort a data series that will not be displayed on the chart.
NOTE: This option is only valid for multi-series charts only.
Table 4. Data Series
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 53
www.agreeya.com
Figure 1. Example of Configuration Property chart
Filtering
The Filtering page allows you to use CAML filters to dynamically filter records or use Complex Filters to define
static filter for the data.
The Filtering page contains the following:
Search/Filter Panel
The Search/Filter Panel allows you to define the panels for search, filter, and replace in the web part.
Table 5. Filtering
Element Description
CAML Filter Allows you to specify the CAML (Collaboration Application Markup Language) query
expression to filter your data. CAML is an XML-based query language. The CAML Filter will
only be applied to the data. The filter will not be applied to the responses.
NOTE: If you are using an external list created from SQL, CAML Filter is not supported for
the following SQL data types and corresponding operators:
Int/Tinyint/Smallint/float and 'Begins With' & 'Contains'
Bit (Boolean) and 'Contains'
Money and 'Contains'
For more information, see CAML Filters on page 19.
Complex Filter Allows you to use the Complex Filter expression to define a static filter for the data. The
complex filter is applied to the data after the CAML Filter is applied.
NOTE: The Complex Filter is provided here only for backward compatibility reason. In the
past, Complex filter was used to support date functions.
For more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 54
www.agreeya.com
The Search/Filter Panel contains the following elements:
Searched Fields
This property defines what fields are displayed in the Search Filter panel.
You will be able to perform a search by pressing Enter.
You can further edit fields using the following elements:
Table 6. Search/Filt e r Pa nel
Element Description
Searched Fields See Searched Fields on page 54.
Turn On List View Link
Mode Allows you to link this chart view with qListView. When selected, the chart view will
display the same data that is displayed in the listview, with the same filters and sort
condition applied. The filters and the sort conditions are being passed by the List View
using Session variable. Therefore, you must set the Search Session Name property to
the same value as the Search Session Name property in the listview.
NOTE: The chart view does not have Search/Filter panel available in this mode.
Turn On List Searcher
Mode Allows you to perform a search before the chart view displays any data.
Show Search All Fields
Control in Search
Panel
Determines whether the Filter panel should display the control to search all fields in
the list. When set to true, the following control is shown in the Filter panel:
The Search All Fields Control allows you to do the following:
Combine the search all fields functionality with other search criteria that has
been entered for specific fields.
When the search all fields criteria is entered, the Filter panel will construct a
filter expression with the "Contain" operator for the following fields in the list:
Single line of text, Multiple lines of text, Choice, Lookup (only Lookup to a
Single Text field and Lookup to a Number field are supported), Person or Group
and Hyperlink or Picture. If the list contains a Lookup to Number field, Search
All Fields will not work for negative numbers for that field. The Filter panel will
use the entire keywords as the value to be searched. Therefore, if you enter
"High Priority" in the search all fields control and perform the search, it will
find the following sentence:
‘This is a high priority task’
However, it will not find the following sentence:
‘The priority is not always high’
Expand Filter panel
on Load Allows you to automatically open the Filter panel by default so that the user can
perform a search quickly. When set to true, the Filter panel opens when the web part
is loaded for the first time.
Panel Button Location Determines the location of the Go, Reset and Close buttons in the Filter panel. This
property also determines the location of the Go and Close buttons in the Replace
panel.
NOTE: Pressing Enter will not allow you to perform a search on such fields as external data, people picker,
managed metadata, and a drop-down list. Instead, the default behavior will occur.
NOTE: For the Number type field, the “Contain” operator is not supported for negative numbers, and is
not available for the following fields: Lookup to DateTime field, Lookup to Calculated field, and Lookup to
ID field.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 55
www.agreeya.com
Table 7. Searched Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Searched Fields in XML format:
<Fields>
<Field Name="fieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<!-- To search a cross site lookup field, use one of the following two formats -->
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFieldName="fieldName" SortField="fieldName" [optional
attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFormat="fieldName" SortField="fieldName" [optional
attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
</Fields>
Field Name Indicates the element you are editing.
Title Displays title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an encoded HTML string.
Description Describes the field. This is useful if you want to give a short instruction or explanation about
the field.
Default Value Defines the default value for the field.
You can define a text, a number or a date. A date value must be specified in ISO
8601 format: YYYY-MM-DDThh:mm:ssZ, for example: midnight of February 14, 2002 is 2002-
02-14T00:00:00Z.
Default
Operator Defines the default operator for the field.
Fixed Operator Defines the operator for the field. If specified, the list to select the operator for this field is
turned off.
Use People
Editor Enables you to enter any user information that is in your directory service.
If you set this to True and the field to be searched is a People and Group field, the Filter
panel will show the People Editor control for entering the search criteria.
Column Count Defines the number of columns for the options in a multi-choice field or in a choice-and-
lookup field if the Enable Multi Choice attribute is set to True. This is useful in case your
choice or lookup fields have too many choices and you want to break the choices into
several columns to minimize the vertical scrolling in your form.
Enable Multi
Choice If selected, allows you to select multiple options for the choice-and-lookup field. Therefore,
the user can specify a condition like "A or B". This attribute is ignored by other field types.
To search a cross-site lookup field, you must specify one or more List elements inside the
Field element. The cross-site lookup field is displayed as two drop downs.
Sort Field Defines the field that is used to sort the value in the list. The field name is case sensitive.
Sort Order Allows you to sort the values in ascending or descending order.
AutoPostBack When selected, causes the Filter panel to refresh when the user changes the selection in a
lookup field or cross-site lookup field.
You need to set AutoPostBack to true if this field is a lookup or a cross-site lookup field and
it is being used to filter another lookup or cross-site lookup field in the Filter panel.
Parent Field Defines another lookup or cross-site lookup field that is used to filter this field. The parent
field must be listed before this field in the XML property.
Parent Filter
Field Name Defines the field in the parent field that is used to filter this field. It is the primary key in
the list that is used in the lookup or cross-site lookup field.
Filter Field
Name Defines the field in the list that is used by this lookup or cross-site lookup field that is
filtered by the parent filter field.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 56
www.agreeya.com
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Views
Views
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Chart
Toolbar
Layout
Other
Display Field
Name Shows the name of the field whose value is displayed in the list. The field name is case
sensitive. Use this attribute instead of the Display Format attribute if you only want to
display a single field in the list.
Display Format Indicates the format of the value that is displayed in the list. Define this attribute instead of
the Display Field Name attribute if you want to display multiple fields in the drop-down
menu. You can use the field replacement expression <%Field%> to refer to a field.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in the
Searched Fields editor in the List View Editor, where the Editor will encode the characters
automatically for you.
NOTE: For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
Site URL Indicates the Site URL of the field. You can use an absolute or relative URL.
List Name Indicates the name of the List. The field name is case sensitive.
Site Name Indicates the name of the site specified in the Site URL. This is used in case you have
multiple lists. In this case, the first drop-down menu to select the list will display as "List
Name in Site Name". You can use any name for the Site Name. It does not have to match the
real title of the Site.
Table 8. Views
Element Description
Search Session Name If Turn On List View Link Mode is selected, the Chart View will retrieve the Viewed Lists
and filter criteria from the session under this name. This value must match with the
Search Session Name property that you specify in the qListView. If the Turn On List View
Link Mode is not selected, the Chart View uses this search session name to store the
search criteria specified in the Search/Filter panel.
Table 7. Searched Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 57
www.agreeya.com
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Chart
The Chart Page allows you to define characteristics of your charts.
Chart Appearance contains the following elements
Chart Attributes
Advanced Mode
Turn on Advanced Mode if you want to edit Chart Attributes in XML format.
Title and Axis Name
The Chart View allows you to add a caption, sub-caption, x-axis title, and y-axis title for your charts. You can
configure the font properties for each of them individually or collectively. You can also apply styles and
animation effects to them.
Border and Background
Background refers to the entire background of the chart.
You can also have a border around the chart. By default, the border is on in 2D charts and off in 3D Charts.
Table 9. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 10. Chart Appearance
Element Description
Chart Width Allows you to specify the width of the chart in pixels.
Chart Height Allows you to specify the height of the chart in pixels.
Chart Attributes For more information, see Chart Attributes on page 57.
Trend Lines For more information, see Trend Lines on page 76.
Style For more information, see Styles on page 77.
Series Appearance For more information, see Series Appearance on page 83.
Table 11. Title and Axis
Element Description
Caption Allows you to add a title.
Sub-caption Allows you to add a subtitle to your chart.
X-Axis Name Allows you to set the x-axis name.
Y-Axis Name Allows you to seta y-axis name.
Rotate Y Axis Name Allows you to set rotate the name of the y-axis. The y-axis name is rotated by default
on the chart. If you're using UTF-8 characters, those characters would not appear in
rotated mode, as the qChartView uses embedded characters for rotation. In that
case, you can opt to show y-axis name in horizontal form by setting this attribute to
false.
Y Axis Name Width Allows you to set the maximum width that the non-rotated y-axis title can assume.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 58
www.agreeya.com
Shown below is a chart with a border around the chart.
Figure 2. Border around chart
Chart Canvas
Canvas refers to the area in which the chart is plotted.
Table 12. Border and Background
Element Description
Show Border Allows you to show a border around the chart. By default, it is set to true in 2D
charts and false in 3D charts.
Border Color Allows you to set the border color of the chart. Use hex color code. To use the color
picker, click on the color swatch square.
Border Thickness Allows you to set the border thickness of the chart (in pixels).
Border Alpha Allows you to set the border alpha (transparency) of the chart. The range is from 0-
100.
Background Color Allows you to fill the background as gradient. If you need to define two (or more)
colors, separate them by a comma.
Background Alpha Allows you to specify a respective alpha (transparency) for each color code that
you've specified in the Background Color attribute, Separate the alphas by comma.
The range is from 0-100
Background Ratio Allows you to set the ratio of each color in the gradient on a scale of 100. The total
ratios specified as this attribute should sum up to 100. For example, if you want to
plot a equidistant gradient for 2 colors, specify Background Ratio as "0,100".
Background Angle Allows you to set the angle of the gradient fill.
Background Image or
SWF URL Allows you to specify an external image (GIF,JPEG, or PNG only) or a SWF file as the
background of the chart. Specify the URL (with relative path) of the background
image or SWF File. Make sure that the image and the chart SWF file are in the same
sub-domain.
If you specify an absolute URL, the background image will not be shown.
Background Image or
SWF Alpha Allows you to configure the alpha of the background (loaded) image using this
property.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 59
www.agreeya.com
Figure 3. Canvas
Data Plot
Plot refers to the column, lines in a column, line chart respectively.
For all the charts, you can specify custom color for each data plot using the color attribute of <set /> element.
The color must be in hex code format (RRGGBB) without #.
<chart ....>
<set label='Jan' value='420000' color='FF0000'/>
<set label='Feb' value='910000' color='00FF00'/>
<set label='Mar' value='720000' color='0000FF'/>
....
</chart>
Table 13. Canvas
Element Description
Canvas Border Color Allows you set the border color for the Canvas. Use hex color code. To use the
color picker, click on the color swatch square.
Canvas Border Thickness Allows you set thickness of canvas border (in pixels)
Canvas Border Alpha Allows you set alpha for canvas border.
Canvas Background Color Allows you set the background color for the Canvas. Use hex color code. To use a
gradient fill, specify all the colors of the gradient separated by commas.
Canvas Background Alpha Allows you to specify a respective alpha (transparency) for each color code that
you've specified in Canvas Background Color attribute. Separate the alphas by
comma.
Canvas Background Ratio Allows you to set the ratio of each color in the gradient on a scale of 100. The
total ratios specified as this attribute should sum up to 100. For example, if you
want to plot a equidistant gradient for 2 colors, specify canvasbgRatio as "0,100".
Canvas Background Angle Allows you to set the angle of the gradient fill (in degrees - 0-360).
Show Canvas Background Allows you to set the canvas background for a 3D chart (and canvas).
Show Canvas Base Allows you to set the canvas base for a 3D chart (and canvas).
Canvas Background Depth Allows you to set the depth of canvas background for a 3D chart (and canvas).
Canvas Base Depth Allows you to set the height of canvas base (in pixels) for a 3D chart (and
canvas).
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 60
www.agreeya.com
Figure 4. Data Plot
By default, most charts have FFFFFF as the plot gradient color. If you wish to use solid fills for the column (or
area), use the Plot Gradient Color attribute without any color defined for it, that is, plotGradientColor=''
<chart plotGradientColor='' ....>
<set label='Jan' value='420000' color='FF0000'/>
<set label='Feb' value='910000' color='00FF00'/>
<set label='Mar' value='720000' color='0000FF'/>
....
</chart>
Figure 5. Data Plot with solid fills
Table 14. Data Plot
Element Description
Plot Gradient Color Allows you to globally add a gradient color to the entire plot (column, area) of chart
by specifying a color as its attribute.
Plot Fill Angle Allows you set the fill angle for gradient if you've opted to fill the plot (column, area)
as gradient. The range is from 0 - 360.
Plot Fill Ratio Allows you set the ration for gradient if you've opted to fill the plot (column, area) as
gradient. The range is from 0 - 100.
Plot Fill Alpha Allows you set the fill alpha for gradient if you've opted to fill the plot (column, area)
as gradient.
Show Plot Border Allows you to show or hide the plot border. By default, each data plot (column, area,
pie) shows a border.
Plot Border Dashed Allows you to make the plot border dashed by setting this attribute to true.
Plot Border Dash
Length Allows you to set the length of each dash.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 61
www.agreeya.com
Data Labels
Data labels refer to the names for the data points that appear on the x-axis.
Figure 6. Data Labels
In the chart shown above, the dates are the data labels for the chart. By default, they get wrapped when there
is not enough space on the chart.
Plot Border Dash Gap Allows you to set the gap between each dash.
Use Round Edges Allows you to plot columns/bars with rounded edges and glass effect gradients in
charts that support 2D Columns or Bars (like column charts, bar charts, 2D
combination charts).
NOTE: In this mode, the following features do not work:
When you plot the columns with rounded edges, shadow is applied to them by
default and show Shadow attribute no longer works. If you want to remove
shadow from this mode, override the shadow with a new shadow style (applied
to DATAPLOT) with alpha as 0.
Plot fill properties like gradient color, angle. no longer work as the colors for
gradient are now calculated by the chart itself.
Plot border properties no longer work in this mode. Also, you cannot render
the border as dash in this mode.
Table 15. Data Labels
Element Description
Show Labels Allows you to show the data labels.
Label Display Allows you to display the data labels can be displayed on the charts in the following ways:
Wrap — By default, all the labels are shown in wrap mode, which enables you to wrap
your long x-axis labels in multiple lines.
Rotate — allows you to rotate or slant the x-axis labels.
Stagger — distributes labels into multiple lines (by default 2).
NOTE: Rotate mode does not work if you have non-English characters in your x-axis labels as
the charts use embedded fonts to render rotated labels.
Slant Labels Allows you to slant the labels at 45 degrees if you are using the Rotate mode for the Label
Display.
Stagger Lines Allows you to choose the number of lines to stagger the labels if you are using the Stagger
mode for the Label Display.
Label Step Allows you to show every n-th label instead of all labels if your X Axis labels represent a
continuous quantity like time and date.
Table 14. Data Plot
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 62
www.agreeya.com
Data Values
Data values refer to the plot values such as line, column, and bar displayed beside it.
Figure 7. Data Values
In the chart shown above, the dollar values appearing above the column are the data values.
External Logo
You can load external logos at run-time to be displayed over the chart. The logos can be GIF/JPEG/PNG or SWF
files that reside on the same sub-domain as the chart SWF.
Table 16. Data Values
Element Description
Show Values Allows you to show data values. By default, the data values are shown. To hide them, set
this attribute to false.
Rotate Values Allows you to rotate the values. By default, the chart will show the data values
horizontally.
Place Values
Inside Allows you to place the data values inside the columns.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 63
www.agreeya.com
Figure 8. External Logo
Font Properties
You can specify generic font properties for all the text on the chart using the attributes given below.
Table 17. External Logo
Element Description
Logo URL Allows you to specify the URL of the logo. You may use relative or absolute URL as long as
the image and the chart SWF file are in the same sub-domain.
Logo Position Allows you to set the position of the logo can be configured using this attribute.
Logo Alpha Allows you to set the opacity of the logo once it has loaded.
Logo Scale Allows you to set the scale of the logo, once it has loaded. The scale of 100 will display the
logo in its original size. The scale of less than 100 will shrink the logo. The scale of more
than 100 will enlarge the logo.
Logo Link Allows you to link the logo to an external URL. This link can open in same window, new
window, pop-up windows or frames. For information on how to format the link, see Trend
Lines on page 76.
Table 18. Font Properties
Element Description
Base Font Name Allows you set the font face (family) of all the text (data labels, values) on chart. If
you specify Outside Canvas Base Font Name attribute also, then this attribute
controls only the font face of text within the chart canvas bounds.
Base Font Size Allows you to set the base font size of the chart, that is, all the values and the names
in the chart that lie on the canvas are displayed using the font size provided here.
The range is from 0 - 72.
Base Font Color Allows you to set the base font color of the chart, that is, all the values and the
names in the chart that lie on the canvas are displayed using the font color provided
here. Use hex color code. To use the color picker, click on the color swatch square.
Outside Canvas Base
Font Name Allows you classify all the text in the chart into 2: the text inside the canvas which
consists of only the tool tip and the data values and all the text outside the canvas.
You can define a base font group for all the text outside the canvas as well.
This attribute sets the base font family of the chart font which lies outside the
canvas, that is, all the values and the names in the chart that lie outside the canvas
are displayed using the font name provided here.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 64
www.agreeya.com
Chart Palettes
qChartView offers 5 palettes. The palette theme configures colors of the following:
Background and border
Canvas border and background
Fonts
4Div lines
Toolti p
Anchors
Legend
The internal palette does not cover the color of the data items. To change the color of the data items, use the
Palette Colors attribute or Series Appearance property.
Y Axis
Chart limits are the minimum and maximum y-axis values. qChartView automatically calculates the best chart
limits when you do not specify them explicitly.
.
Outside Canvas Base
Font Size Allows you to set the base font size of the chart, that is, all the values and the names
in the chart that lie outside the canvas are displayed using the font size provided
here. The range is from 0 - 72
Outside Canvas Base
Font Color Allows you to set the base font color of the chart, that is, all the values and the
names in the chart that lie outside the canvas are displayed using the font color
provided here.
Table 19. Chart Palettes
Element Description
Palette Allows you to select the palette number.
Palette Colors Allows you to specify your own palette for data items by providing a list of hex
colors.
Table 20. Y Axix
Element Description
Y Axis Min Value Allows you to set the chart limits explicitly.
Y Axis Max Value Allows you to set the chart limits explicitly.
NOTE: The Y Axis Max Value must be bigger than any of the values in the data
series. Otherwise, the value will not be honored by the chart view.
Set Adaptive Y Min Allows you to set whether the y-axis lower limit would be 0 (in case of all positive
values on chart) or should the y-axis lower limit adapt itself to a different figure
based on values provided to the chart.
Primary Y Axis Min Value Allows you to explicitly set the lower limit of the primary y-axis. If you do not
specify this value, it is automatically calculated by qChartView based on the data
provided by you.
Primary Y Axis Max Value Allows you to explicitly set the upper limit of the primary y-axis. If you do not
specify this value, it is automatically calculated by qChartView based on the data
provided by you.
Secondary Y Axis Min
Value Allows you to explicitly set the lower limit of the secondary y-axis. If you do not
specify this value, it is automatically calculated by qChartView based on the data
provided by you.
Table 18. Font Properties
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 65
www.agreeya.com
Division Lines
Divisional lines are horizontal lines running through the canvas. They break up the y axis into smaller units
helping in better visual data interpretation.
Figure 9. Division Lines
Secondary Y Axis Max
Value Allows you to explicitly set the upper limit of the secondary y-axis. If you do not
specify this value, it is automatically calculated by qChartView based on the data
provided by you.
Primary Y Axis Name Allows you to set the primary y-axis title.
Secondary Y Axis Name Allows you to set the secondary y-axis title.
Set Adaptive Secondary
Y Min Allows you to set whether the secondary y-axis lower limit would be 0 (in case of all
positive values on chart) or should the y-axis lower limit adapt itself to a different
figure based on values provided to the chart.
Primary Y Axis Name
Width Allows you to set choose a maximum width (in pixels) that is applied to primary y-
axis name, if you do not rotate y-axis name.
Secondary Y Axis Name
Width If you opt to not rotate y-axis name, you can choose a maximum width (in pixels)
that is applied to secondary y-axis name.
Table 21. Division Lines
Element Description
Adjust Division Lines Allows you to explicitly specify the y-axis upper and lower limit values, and also
the number of divisional lines. In those cases, you need to automatic adjustment
of divisional lines by setting this attribute to false. Then you can specify the y-
axis upper and lower limits using the Y Axis Max Value and Y Axis Min Value
attributes respectively.
Number of Division Lines Allows you to set the number of divisional lines.
Div Line Effect Allows you to enable to apply an effect, for example, EMBOSS, or BEVEL to the
divisional lines. This attribute is applicable to MultiSeriesCombination3D chart
type only.
Show Y Axis Values Allows you to show all the y-axis values.
Y Axis Values Step Allows you to skip every nth Y Axis value.
Division Lines Allows you to set the color for divisional lines.
Division Lines Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of divisional lines. The range is from 1 - 5.
Table 20. Y Axix
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 66
www.agreeya.com
Zero Plane
Zero plane is a plane which separates the positive and negative numbers on a chart having both of them.
Figure 10. Zero Plane
Division Lines Alpha Allows you to set the alpha of divisional lines. The range is from 0 - 100.
Is Dashed Allows you to set the divisional line to be dashed.
Division Lines Dash Length Allows you to set the length of each dash.
Division Lines Dash Gap Allows you to set the gap between each dash.
Show Alternate H Grid
Color Allows you to set the horizontal grid bands alternately between the divisional
lines for all 2D charts. They can be hidden by setting this attribute to false.
Alternate H Grid Color Allows you to set the color of the horizontal grid bands.
Alternate H Grid Alpha Allows you to set the alpha of the horizontal grid bands. The range is from 0 -
100.
Vertical Div Lines Allows you to set the vertical divisional lines running through the canvas in a
line/area chart. They help in relating the data to its respective label, when there
is a large amount of data.
Number of Vertical Div
Lines Allows you to set the number of vertical div lines.
Vertical Div Lines Color Allows you to set the color of the vertical axis division lines.
Vertical Div Lines Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of the vertical axis division lines in pixels.
Vertical Div Lines Alpha Allows you to set the alpha of vertical axis division lines. The range is from 0 -
100.
Is Dashed Allows you to set the vertical axis division lines as dashed.
Vertical Div Lines Dash
Length Allows you to set the length of each dash.
Vertical Div Lines Dash Gap Allows you to set the gap between each dash..
Show Alternate V Grid
Color Allows you to set the vertical grid bands alternately between the vertical
divisional lines.
Alternate V Grid Color Allows you to set the color of the alternate vertical grid bands.
Alternate V Grid Alpha Allows you to set the alpha (transparency) of the alternate vertical grid bands.
Show V Line Label Border Allows you to set the borders for all labels for vLines in the chart. If you want to
show label border for just a particular vLine, you can override this value by
specifying border configuration for that specific vLine.
Table 21. Division Lines
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 67
www.agreeya.com
Anchors
Each data point in a line or area chart is represented by an anchor. The anchors help identify the data point
better in the chart. They also show a tool tip showing the data point details when the mouse is hovered over
them, and can be linked to other pages as well.
Figure 11. Anchors
Table 22. Zero Plane
element description
Show Zero Plane Allows you set the zero plane in the column, line, and the area chart. It can be
removed in the line chart but not in the column or the area chart because they use
this as their base to draw. It can be removed in the line chart by setting this
attribute to false.
Zero Plane Color Allows you set the color of the zero plane.
Zero Plane Alpha Allows you set the alpha (transparency) of the zero plane. The range is from 0 -
100.
Zero Plane Thickness Allows you set the thickness of the zero plane in pixels.
Zero Plane Show Border Allows you set the whether to show border of zero plane for a 3D chart.
Zero Plane Border Color Allows you set the border color of zero plane for a 3D chart.
Zero Plane Mesh Allows you set the whether to draw the zero plane as a wireframe mesh or as a
filled plane. If set to true, a mesh on the zero plane of the chart is drawn. This
attribute is applicable to MultiSeriesCombination3D chart type only.
Table 23. Anchors
Element Description
Draw Anchors Allows you show the anchors. The anchors are displayed by default. To hide them, set
this attribute to false. Once the anchors are hidden, the tool tips for the data points will
not be displayed and the links will not work.
Anchor Alpha Allows you set the alpha of entire anchors. The range is from 0 - 100. If you need to hide
the anchors but still have tool tip and link, set Anchor Alpha to ‘0’
Anchor Sides Allows you to set the number of sides the anchor will have. For example, an anchor with
3 sides would represent a triangle, with 4 it would be a square. The range is from 3 - 20.
Anchor Radius Allows you to set the radius (in pixels) of the anchor. The greater the radius, the bigger
the anchor size.
Anchor Border Color Allows you to set the border color of anchors.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 68
www.agreeya.com
Tool Tip
A tool tip is shown when the mouse is hovered over a particular data point. It shows the following information:
Single series chart (except pie & doughnut): Name & value
Pie & Doughnut: Name & value/percentage
Multi-series & combination chart: Series Name, Category Name, Data Value
Figure 12. Tool Tip
Paddings and Margins
qChartView lets you define various paddings and margins using pixels. These attributes are listed one-by-one
below.
By default, qChartView provides some padding between the chart border and the canvas. This is called the
chart margin and each margin can be set individually.
Anchor Border
Thickness Allows you to set the border thickness (in pixels) of the anchors.
Anchor Background
Color Allows you to set the background color of anchors.
Anchor Background
Alpha Allows you to set the alpha of anchor background. The range is from 0 - 100.
Table 24. Tool Tip
Element Description
Show Tool Tip Allows you to set the tool tip.
Show Tool Tip Shadow Allows you to show the tool tip shadow.
Tool Tip Border Color Allows you to customize the border color of the tool tip.
Tool Tip Background Color Allows you to customize the background color of the tool tip.
Tool Tip Separator Character Allows you to specify a character to separate the name and value displayed in
tool tip.
Series Name in Tool Tip Allows you to control whether series name will appear in the tool tip. For multi-
series and combination charts, qChartView shows the following information in
tool tip (unless tool text is explicitly defined): "Series Name, Category Name,
Data Value".
Show Percent In Tool Tip Allows you to show percentage values in Tool Tip for Pie or Doughnut chart. By
default, the Pie or Doughnut chart shows percentage values in Tool Tip.
Table 23. Anchors
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 69
www.agreeya.com
Figure 13. Paddings and Margins
Table 25. Paddings and Margins
Element Description
Left Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the left side of your chart. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Right Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the right side of your chart. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Top Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space ton the top of your chart. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Bottom Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the bottom of your chart. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Canvas Left Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the left side of the canvas. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Canvas Right Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the right side of the canvas. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Canvas Top Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space t on the top of the canvas. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Canvas Bottom
Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the bottom of the canvas. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Caption Padding Allows you to set the amount of space between the caption of the chart and the top of
the chart canvas. If you have a sub-caption defined in the chart, it controls the space
between the sub-caption and the top of the chart canvas.
X Label Gap Allows you to set the vertical space between the labels and canvas wall edge. If you
want more space between the canvas and the x-axis labels, you can use this attribute to
control it.
Y Label Gap Allows you set the horizontal space between the canvas wall edge and the y-axis values
or trend line values (on left/right side). This is particularly useful, when you want more
space between your canvas and y-axis values.
X Axis Name Padding Allows you to set the distance between the top of x-axis title and the bottom of data
labels (or canvas, if data labels are not shown).
Y Axis Name Padding Allows you to set the padding between the y-axis name and values.
Y Axis Values Padding Allows you to set the padding between the left end of the chart canvas and the y-axis
values.
Label Padding Allows you to set the vertical space between the canvas bottom edge and the data
labels.
Value Padding Allows you to control the space between your columns/anchors and the value
textboxes.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 70
www.agreeya.com
Smart Labels and Lines
Smart labels are the labels for the pie/doughnut chart. The smart labels prevent overlapping of labels even
when large number of labels are placed in close vicinity.
Figure 14. Smart Labels and Lines
Canvas Padding For a line/area chart, allows you to set the padding between the canvas border and the
position where the line/area chart begins to draw is called canvas padding.
Plot Space Percent On a column chart, allows you to set the spacing between two columns. By default, the
spacing is set to 20% of canvas width. For example, if you wanted all columns to stick to
each other without any space in between, you can set plotSpacePercent to 0. Similarly,
if you want very thin columns, you can set plotSpacePercent to its max value of 80.
Table 26. Smart Labels and Lines
Element Description
Enable Smart Labels Allows you to enable the smart labels (if required to save chart space or when there
are few pie segments). When the smart labels are switched off, the pie labels would
be displayed without the smart label lines. But if they number of labels increases and
smart labels are not being used, then the labels might overlap.
Smart Line Color Allows you to set the color of smart label connector lines.
Smart Line Thickness Allows you to set the thickness (in pixels) of smart label connector lines.
Smart Line Alpha Allows you to set the alpha (transparency) of smart label connector lines. The range is
0 - 100.
Is Smart Line Slanted Allows you to set the smart lines (smart label connector lines) in two ways: Slanted or
Straight.
Label Distance Allows you to set the distance of the label/value text boxes from the pie/doughnut
edge in pixels. You must set Enable Smart Labels to false for this attribute to take
effect.
Smart Label Clearance Allows you to set the clearance distance of a label (for sliced-in pies) from adjacent
sliced out pies in pixels.
Skip Overlap Labels Allows you to skip the overlapping labels if you have too many labels in your pie chart
(which is difficult to adjust even using smart labels). In that case, you have the option
to set this attribute to true. The labels of the least significant pies would be removed.
Show Percent Values Allows you to set the actual value of the pie segment to be displayed in the label or
the percentage value. By default, the actual values are displayed. When you want to
display their percentages, set this attribute to true.
Table 25. Paddings and Margins
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 71
www.agreeya.com
Legend
In multi-series/combination charts, the series name of each dataset shows up in the legend of the chart. This
helps you relate a data plot to its series name using its color. A dynamically generated series will be prefixed in
the legend with the series name if a series name has been configured. The legend does not appear for single-
series charts because there is only one series in the chart.
Figure 15. Legend
The legend below the chart helps identify the series name.
Table 27. Legend
Element Description
Show Legend Allows you to show the legend.
Interactive Legend Allows you to make the legend interactive. Interactive Legend only works for a
combination chart. In the combination chart, you can click the legend to show/hide
the values of the data items. If you set Interactive Legend to false, then legend will
not be interactive.
Legend Caption Allows you to add a caption for the entire legend by setting the same here.
Legend Marker Circle Allows you to use square legend keys or circular ones.
Reverse Legend Allows you to reverse the order of items in legend.
Legend Position Allows you to place the legend in 2 positions: RIGHT and BOTTOM. It gets placed
below the canvas by default. To place it to the right of the chart canvas, set Legend
Position = 'RIGHT'.
Allow Drag Allows you to make the legend dragable. End viewers of the chart can drag the
legend around on the chart.
Legend Background
Color Allows you to set the background color for the legend.
Legend Background
Alpha Allows you to set the background alpha (transparency) for the legend. The range is 0
- 100.
Legend Border Color Allows you to set the border color for the legend.
Legend Border
Thickness Allows you to set the border thickness, in pixels, for the legend.
Legend Border Alpha Allows you to set the border alpha for the legend. The range is 0 - 100.
Legend Shadow Allows you to set a shadow for legend.
Legend Scroll
Background Color Allows you to set the background color of the scroll bar. If you've too many items on
the legend, a scroll bar appears.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 72
www.agreeya.com
Number Formatting
qChartView offers you a lot of options to format your numbers on the chart from number prefixes and suffixes
to controlling the decimal places to scaling your numbers based on a pre-defined scale.
.
3D Chart Attributes
The 3D Combination chart is a true 3D chart which offers features such as viewing from a specific camera angle,
definition of light source, use of dynamic lighting, and rotation.
The various elements of a 3D Combination chart are shown below:
Legend Scroll Bar Color Allows you to set the bar color of the scroll bar. If you've too many items on the
legend, a scroll bar shows up on the same.
Legend Scroll Button
Color Allows you to set the color of buttons on the scroll bar. If you've too many items on
the legend, a scroll bar shows up on the same.If you've too many items on the
legend, a scroll bar shows up on the same.
Table 28. Number Formatting
Element Description
Format Number Allows you to determine whether the numbers displayed on the chart are formatted
using commas, for example, 40,000 if Format Number is true and 40000 if Format
Number is false.
Format Number Scale Allows you to determine whether to add K (thousands) and M (millions) to a number
after truncating and rounding it - for example, if Format Number Scale is set true,
1043 would become 1.04K (with decimals set to 2 places). Same with numbers in
millions - a M will added at the end.
Default Number Scale Allows you to set the default unit of the numbers that you are providing to the chart.
Number Scale Unit Allows you to set the unit of each block of the scale.
Number Scale Value Allows you to set the range of the various blocks that constitute the scale.
Number Prefix Allows you to add a prefix to all the numbers visible on the graph. For example, to
represent all dollars figure on the chart, you could specify this attribute to ' $' to
show like $40000, $50000.
Number Suffix Allows you to add a suffix to all the numbers visible on the graph. For example, to
represent all figure quantified as per annum on the chart, you could specify this
attribute to ' /a' to show like 40000/a, 50000/a.
Decimal Separator Allows you to specify the character to be used as the decimal separator in a number.
Thousand Separator Allows you to specify the character to be used as the thousands separator in a
number.
In Decimal Separator Allows you to input the decimal separator.
In Thousand Separator Allows you to input the thousand separator.
Decimals Allows you to set the number of decimal places to which all numbers on the chart
would be rounded. The range is from 0 - 10.
Force Decimals Allows you to add 0 padding at the end of decimal numbers. For example, if you set
decimals as 2 and a number is 23.4. If force Decimals is set to 1, qChartView will
convert the number to 23.40 (note the extra 0 at the end).
Y Axis Value Decimals Allows you to specify the div line values decimal precision. The range is from 0 - 10.
Table 27. Legend
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 73
www.agreeya.com
Figure 16. 3D Charts
Table 29. 3D Charts
Element Description
Is 2D Allows you to decide whether initially to draw a 2D view of the chart.
Chart Order Allows you to set the order by which different types of charts will appear. The value
can be any combination of 'column', 'line' or 'area', each separated by a comma. By
default, the order is: line, column, area. You can change to any order you like, for
example, 'column, area, line' or 'line, area'.
Chart On Top Allows you to decide whether or not the chart canvas is placed over the extra chart
elements (caption, subcaption, legend). This feature is visible when the chart canvas
is zoomed/scaled. +
Auto Scaling Allows you to decide whether or not the chart is allowed to best fit automatically
after a user interaction, for example, rotation.
Allow Scaling Allows you to set whether to allow zoom-in/zoom-out.
NOTE: Scaling or use of mouse is compatible only with Windows® Operating System.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 74
www.agreeya.com
Animate 3D Allows you to show the initial plot animation. By default, the 3D chart is rendered with
a default animation.
To globally set off all animation set Animation to false. This would not only set off 3D
animations, but also disable all animations applied using <styles>. The additional use
of Animate 3D can override this value. Hence, a combination of Animation = false and
Animate 3D = true would disable all animations applied using <styles> but, enable
animation of the 3D canvas.
Exe Time Allows you to set the time that the chart takes to animate. This attribute also sets the
time taken by the chart canvas to animate when the chart is transformed to any view
(View3D, View 2D, Reset View).
Camera Angle
X/Camera Angle Y Allows you to define the camera angle.
Camera Angle X lets you specify the camera angle (for view around the chart
vertically) from which the chart is viewed initially in no animation mode (when
animate3D='0) . If not specified, the default value is 30. The range is from 0 to
360 and 0 to -360.
Camera Angle Y lets you specify the camera angle (for view around the chart
horizontally) from which the chart is viewed initially in no animation mode
(when animate3D='0). If not specified, the default value is -45. The range is
from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360.
Since this is a true 3D chart, it's rendered as a 3D model that is viewed from a specific
camera angle. The camera can simply be defined as the eye of a real viewer. When
you have set Animate 3D to 0, you can define the camera angle using two attributes -
Camera Angle X and Camera Angle Y.
When you use animation, you can also set up the starting camera view from which the
camera view starts animating, and the final camera view to which the chart would
finally be rotated. For this, you need to use Start Angle X, Start Angle Y, End Angle X
and End Angle Y attributes.
Start Angle X/End
Angle X Start Angle X — Allows you to specify the view angle (for view around the chart
vertically) at which rotation of the chart starts (when the chart is initialized). The
rotation stops at endAngX. If not specified, the default values for both the attributes
are 30. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360. This is for animated charts (when
animate3D='1').
End Angle X — Allows you to specify the view angle (for view around the chart
vertically) at which rotation of the chart ends (when the chart is initialized). The
rotation starts at startAngX. If not specified, the default values for both the attributes
are 30. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360. This is for animated charts (when
animate3D='1').
Start Angle Y/End
Angle Y Start Angle Y — Allows you to specify the view angle (for view around the chart
horizontally) from which rotation of the chart starts (when the chart is initialized).
The rotation stops at endAngY. If not specified, the default values for both the
attributes are -45. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360. This is for animated charts
(when animate3D='1').
End Angle Y — Allows you to specify the view angle (for view around the chart
horizontally) at which rotation of the chart ends (when the chart is initialized). The
rotation starts at startAngY. If not specified, the default values for both the attributes
are -45. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360. This is for animated charts (when
animate3D='1').
Light Angle X/Light
Angle Y Light Angle X — Allows you to specify the angular position of the light source (for X-
axis) w.r.t the chart world coordinate system. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360.
Light Angle Y — Allows you to specify the angular position of the light source (for Y-
axis) w.r.t the chart world coordinate system. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360.
Table 29. 3D Charts
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 75
www.agreeya.com
Custom About Menu Item
You can change the default "About QuickApps for SharePoint" context menu item to show your label and link it
to your own URL using the below attributes.
Intensity Allows you to control the intensity of the light that falls on the chart elements. The
range of this attribute lies between 0 to 10. 10 would provide light with maximum
intensity, and you will get the brightest view of the chart. If you set the value to 0,
light is provided with least intensity. However, the chart will never appear in full
darkness even you set intensity to 0. A faint light is always made available. By default,
the value is set to 2.5.
Dynamic Shading Allows you to set the chart in dynamic shading/non-world mode. If set to false, the
chart is in world mode.
For example, you can have a Combination 3D Chart that has two different lighting
systems to light up the chart elements. The light source may be fixed outside the
chart. This causes only those sides of the chart to get the light which face the light
source. Thus, when the chart is manually rotated, dynamic shades are created on the
chart surfaces. This system of lighting is called dynamic shading.
World lighting is where the light source is fixed with the chart. In this case, the light
source rotates with the rotation of the chart. Hence, the surface facing the light
source gets lightened and continues to be in the bright side despite any manual
rotation of the chart being made, whereas the surface not facing the light keeps
remaining in darkness with every chart rotation.
Bright 2D Allows you to set maximum brightness to the chart while being rendered in 2D mode.
This is applicable only when you've set Dynamic Shading to true. However, once you
set this attribute to true, you cannot use Light Angle X and Light Angle Y attributes.
Rather, it automatically sets up the light sources to give the brightest view of the
chart in 2D mode.
Allow Rotation Allows you to decide whether to stop any user interactive rotation of the chart or not.
If it is set to false, the interactive rotation is barred.
Constrain Vertical
Rotation Allows you to rotate up to 90 degrees (top or bottom) from 0 degree position. You can
also specify these limits using Minimum Vertical Rotation Angle and Maximum Vertical
Rotation Angle attributes. This is only applicable to user's mouse interactively with the
chart.
Minimum Vertical
Rotation Angle Allows you to set the minimum allowed angle up to which a user can rotate the chart
vertically. This is only applicable to user's mouse interactively with the chart.
Maximum Horizontal
Rotation Angle Allows you to set the maximum allowed angle up to which a user can rotate the chart
horizontally. This is only applicable to user's mouse interactively with the chart.
Z Depth Allows you to set the depth (3D thickness) of each DATAPLOT object using zDepth
attribute.
Z Gap Plot Allows you to specify a gap between all dataplots in a 3D combination chart, as more
than one DATAPLOT types can exist due to different datasets.
A Z Gap Plot set to 0 will show no gap between dataplots.
YZ Wall Depth Allows you to set the depth of the YZ wall of 3D chart.
ZX Wall Depth Allows you to set the depth of the ZX wall of 3D chart.
XY Wall Depth Allows you to set the depth of the XYwall of 3D chart.
Clustered Allows you to set a Combination 3D chart in clustered mode. In a Combination 3D
chart, you can plot multiple number of datasets which can be rendered as Column.
Table 29. 3D Charts
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 76
www.agreeya.com
Functional
These attributes let you control a variety of functional elements on the chart.
Trend Lines
Trend Lines allow you to specify the horizontal/vertical lines spanning the chart canvas which aid in
interpretation of data with respect to some pre-determined value.
Trend Lines contain the following:
Table 30. Custom About Menu
Element Description
Show About Menu
Item Allows you to set up a custom context menu in the chart, which can show your
text and can be linked to your URL. For example, you can set the context menu
of the chart to include "About your company name" and then link to your
company home page. By default, the chart shows "About QuickApps for
SharePoint" when right-clicked.
About Menu Item
Label Allows you to set a menu item label for the custom context menu item.
About Menu Item Link Allows you to provide a link for the custom context menu item. You can specify
the link in qChartView link format to be able to open the same in new window,
pop-ups, frames or as JavaScript links.
Table 31. Functional
Element Description
Animation Allows you to control animation in your charts. If you do not want to animate any part of the
chart, set this to false. This would also disable all animations applied using <styles>. Animate 3D
can override this value. By default, animation is set to true.
Click URL Allows you to set a URL as a hotspot for a chart. For more information, see Formatting Links.
Table 32. Trend Lines
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Trend Lines in XML format.
Start Value Allows you to set the start value for the trend line
End Value Allows you to set the ending y-axis value for the trend line
Display Value Allows you to display a string caption for the trend line by its side
Color Allows you to set the color of the trend line and its text
Is Trend Zone Allows you to set the trend as a zone rather than a line
Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of the trend line
Alpha Allows you to set the alpha transparency of the trend line
Dashed Allows you to set the trend line as a dashed line
Dash Length Allows you to set the length of each dash in pixels
Dash Gap Allows you to set the gap length between each dash
Value on Right Allows you to show if the trend line is on the right or left side of the chart
Tool Text Allows you to show tool text when hovered over a trend line
Parent Y Axis Allows to you set whether the trend line should be plotted against a primary or secondary Y
axis (If you use a dual Y Axis chart). If you do not use a dual Y axis chart, the trend line is
plotted against the primary Y axis.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 77
www.agreeya.com
Styles
Styles help you apply font, effects and animations to various objects of the chart. Styles lends a simple
mechanism using which you can easily control the visual layout of charts.
Styles allows you to:
Define your own style attributes using the Style Editor.
Associate them with defined Objects of the chart from within the Style Editor.
Have better control over chart look & feel.
Group together in one element in the XML document, thereby separating data from visual formatting.
Store the entire style definition in a central location in your application, so that all charts within
application can utilize it.
Re-use style definitions. Each style can be applied to multiple chart objects or vice versa.
Each object on the chart has been assigned a unique name, for direct association with style definitions. For
example, the background of the chart is termed as BACKGROUND. Similarly, the plot (columns, lines, areas) on
the chart is named as DATAPLOT. This enables you to associate each style to multiple chart objects or associate
multiple chart objects to a particular style.
You can find the list of objects for each chart in individual Chart XML Sheet.
You can define one or more styles for a chart from the Styles Editor. To add a style, click Add. To see more
attributes for a particular style, click Edit for the style. To delete a style, select the check box of the style and
click Delete.
Styles contains the following:
Table 33. Styles
Element Description
Advanced
Mode Turn on if you want to edit Styles in XML format:
<styles>
<definition>
<style name='MyFirstFontStyle' type='font' face='Verdana' size='12' color='FF0000' bold='1'
bgColor='FFFFDD' />
<style name='MyFirstAnimationStyle' type='animation' param='_xScale' start='0'
duration='2' />
<style name='MyFirstShadow' type='Shadow' color='CCCCCC' />
</definition>
<application>
<apply toObject='Caption' styles='MyFirstFontStyle,MyFirstShadow' />
<apply toObject='Canvas' styles='MyFirstAnimationStyle' />
<apply toObject='DataPlot' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
</application>
</styles>
Name Allows you to assign your custom name for the style definition. Style name can only include
alphabets and numbers. Punctuation marks (including underscore) should not be used. Style
name must be unique, that is, two style definitions cannot have the same name.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 78
www.agreeya.com
Type Allows you to set the following types:
Font — allows you to control text properties for all the text on the chart. You can set:
Font — allows you to set the font type
Size — allows you to set the font size
Color — allows you to set the font color
Bold — allows you to set the font weigh
Underline — allows you to assign underline character
Background Color — allows you to set the background color
Border Color — allows you to set the border color
Is HTML — allows you to render the text as HTML
Left Margin — allows you to set the left margin of the text
Letter Spacing — allows you to set the space between the letters in the text
Animation — Allows you to define your custom animations for different elements of the
chart. By default, qChartView animates the data plot (columns, lines, area) only.
However, you can define your custom animations for other chart objects (like captions,
titles, values) in the XML. Each chart object can have multiple animation properties
(like x, y, xscale, yscale, alpha) and each sequence can have its own duration.
Param — Allows you to you specify the property of chart object which you want to
animate, such a _x (animate the x position), _y (animate the y position), _xScale
(animate the x-scale), _yScale (animate the y-scale), alpha (helps the alpha transition
animation effect), _rotation (animate pies and doughnuts in circles)
Start — allows you to set the start value of the animation
Duration — allows you to control the duration of animation in seconds
Easing — allows you to specify the pattern of animation easing.
Table 33. Styles
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 79
www.agreeya.com
Type Shadow — Allows you to apply shadow effect to any object on the chart.
Distance — allows you to set the offset distance of the shadow
Angle — allows you to set the angle of the shadow
Color — allows you to set the color of the shadow
Alpha — allows you to set the alpha transparency of the shadow
BlurX — allows you set the amount of horizontal blur on the shadow. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
BlurY — allows you to set the amount of vertical blur on the shadow. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
Strength — allows you to set the strength of the imprint or spread. The higher the
value, the more color is imprinted and the stronger the contrast between the shadow
and the background.
Quality — allows you to set the number of times to apply the shadow effect. Valid
values are 0 to 15. The default value is 1, which is equivalent to low quality. A value of
2 is medium quality, and a value of 3 is high quality. Shadow with lower values are
rendered quicker
Glow — lets you apply glow effects to objects on the chart.
Color — allows you to set the color of the glow
Alpha — allows you to set the alpha transparency of the glow
BlurX — allows you set the amount of horizontal blur on the glow. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
BlurY — allows you to set the amount of vertical blur on the glow. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
Strength — allows you to set the strength of the imprint or spread. The higher the
value, the more color is imprinted and the stronger the contrast between the shadow
and the background.
Quality — allows you to set the number of times to apply the glow effect. Valid values
are 0 to 15. The default value is 1, which is equivalent to low quality. A value of 2 is
medium quality, and a value of 3 is high quality. Shadow with lower values are rendered
quicker.
Table 33. Styles
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 80
www.agreeya.com
Custom defined styles to chart objects
To apply your defined styles to chart objects, make sure that you have the list of chart objects present in each
chart.
For example, the following chart objects are for 2D Single Series Column Chart:
Bevel — Allows you to apply bevel effect for any of the chart objects.
Angle — allows you to set the angle of the bevel
Distance — allows you to set the offset distance of the bevel
Shadow Color — allows you to set the shadow color of the bevel
Shadow Alpha — allows you to set the alpha transparency value of the shadow color
Highlight Color — allows you to set the highlight color of the bevel
Highlight Alpha — allows you to set the alpha transparency value of the highlight color
BlurX — allows you set the amount of horizontal blur on the bevel. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
BlurY — allows you to set the amount of vertical blur on the bevel. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
Strength — allows you to set the strength of the imprint or spread. The higher the
value, the more color is imprinted and the stronger the contrast between the shadow
and the background.
Quality — allows you to set the number of times to apply the bevel. Valid values are 0
to 15. The default value is 1, which is equivalent to low quality. A value of 2 is medium
quality, and a value of 3 is high quality. Shadow with lower values are rendered quicker.
Blur — Allows you to create a blur effect for any object on the chart.
BlurX — allows you set the amount of horizontal blur. Values that are a power of 2 (such
as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other values.
BlurY — allows you to set the amount of vertical blur. Values that are a power of 2 (such
as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other values.
Quality — allows you to set the number of times to apply the filter. Valid values are 0 to
15. The default value is 1, which is equivalent to low quality. A value of 2 is medium
quality, and a value of 3 is high quality. Shadow with lower values are rendered quicker.
Table 34. Chart Objects for 2D Series Column Chart
Object Name Description Features Supported Animation Parameters Supported
BACKGROUND entire background of the chart Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
_xScale
_yScale
CANVAS T the area in which the actual
chart is plotted. It is represented
by a bounded rectangle. In 3D
charts, it refers to the 3D base on
which the columns are built.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
_xScale
_yScale
Table 33. Styles
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 81
www.agreeya.com
CAPTION The heading of the chart Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
DATALABELS The x-axis labels of the data Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
DATAPLOT The actual plot of the chart. For
example, in Column 2D chart,
columns are referred to as
DATAPLOT.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
_xScale
_yScale
DATAVALUES The plot values that is, value of
each data (line, column, bar, pie),
which is displayed beside the data
plot.
Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
DIVLINES The horizontal or vertical lines
running through the canvas. Each
divisional line signifies a smaller
unit of the entire axis thus aiding
the users in interpreting the
chart.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_y
_yScale
HGRID Alternate color bands between
two successive horizontal
divisional lines
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_y
_xScale
_yScale
SUBCAPTION The sub-heading of the chart Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
TOOLTIP The tool tip shown when mouse is
hovered over the data plots Font (only
Font, Size
and Color
attributes are
supported)
Table 34. Chart Objects for 2D Series Column Chart
Object Name Description Features Supported Animation Parameters Supported
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 82
www.agreeya.com
The following XML does the work of applying styles to different chart objects:
<application>
<apply toObject='Caption' styles='MyFirstFontStyle,MyFirstShadow' />
<apply toObject='Canvas' styles='MyFirstAnimationStyle' />
<apply toObject='DataPlot' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
</application>
Each <apply> element helps to apply multiple styles to one chart object; for example, in our code, we first
apply the MyFirstFontStyle font style to Caption of the chart and then apply the shadow style MyFirstShadow to
the same object.
If you are using multiple styles, ensure:
TRENDLINES Horizontal/vertical lines spanning
the chart canvas which aid in
interpretation of data with
respect to some pre-determined
value.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_y
_xScale
_yScale
TRENDVALUES The display values of trend-lines
(if any) Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
VLINES Vertical separator lines that help
you separate blocks of data.
These lines run through the height
of the chart, thereby segregating
data into different blocks. In case
of bar charts, they are horizontal
and run through the width of
chart.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_y
_xScale
_yScale
XAXISNAME The x-axis title of the chart Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
YAXISNAME The y-axis title of the chart Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
YAXISVALUES The limit values or divisional line
values, which are displayed along
the y-axis of the chart
Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
_rotation
Table 34. Chart Objects for 2D Series Column Chart
Object Name Description Features Supported Animation Parameters Supported
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 83
www.agreeya.com
you separate the style names using comma
for example, <apply toObject='Caption' styles='MyFirstFontStyle,MyFirstShadow' />
when you apply a single style to multiple objects, define <apply> element for each object and then
assign the style for it.
for example,
<apply toObject='Caption' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
<apply toObject='DataPlot' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
You CANNOT separate the object list by comma and then assign a single style to it - the following is
INVALID:
<apply toObject='Caption,DataPlot' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
The style name specified during application has been defined earlier in style definition and the spelling
are correct, else, qChartView will ignore it and log the error in Debug Window.
Series Appearance
This property enables you to specify the appearance of the data series and data items in the series.
The Appearance element can contain one or more Series Appearance elements. Each Series Appearance
element controls the appearance of the data series in the chart. Therefore, the first Series Appearance element
controls the appearance of the first data series, the second one contains the second data series, and so on. See
the Configuration property on how to define multiple data series in the chart.
The Series Appearance contains the following:
Table 35. Series Appearance
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Series Appearance in XML format:
<Appearance>
<SeriesAppearance [optional attributes]>
<ItemAppearance [optional attributes] />
<ItemAppearance [optional attributes] />
</SeriesAppearances>
<SeriesAppearance [optional attributes]>
<ItemAppearance [optional attributes] />
<ItemAppearance [optional attributes]/>
</SeriesAppearances>
</Appearance>
Color Allows you to set the color using which columns, lines, area of that dataset would be drawn.
Alpha Allows you to set the alpha (transparency) of the entire dataset at the Series Appearance
level. The range is from 0 - 100.
Ratio Allows you to control the ratio of each color using a comma separated list of ratios, if you
are showing columns as gradients,
Dashed Allows you to set whether this dataset would appear as dashed.
Show Plot
Border Allows you to set whether to show the border of this dataset.
Plot Border
Color Allows you to set the color of the plot border.
Plot Border
Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of the plot border lines.
Plot Border
Alpha Allows you to set the alpha transparency of the plot border lines
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 84
www.agreeya.com
The Series Appearance element can contain zero or more Item Appearance elements. If you do specify any Item
Appearance element, every item in the series is displayed according to the settings in the Series Appearance
element. The Item Appearance is applied as follows:
If you specify the Item Value in the Item Appearance, the settings are applied based on the X axis value
of the item. For example, if the X axis shows the value of the Priority field in the Tasks list, you can make
all the High priority items displayed in red.
If you specify Y Axis Value Range in the Item Appearance, the settings are applied based on the Y axis
value of the item. For example, you can highlight any data items that falls within a certain range with a
certain color (low sales number with red, high sales number with blue).
If neither is specified, the settings are applied in the order they are listed. This means the first Item
Appearance controls the appearance of the first data item in the series, the second one controls the
second data item in the series, and so on. In this case, if the data series has more items to display than
the number of Item Appearance, the remaining items are displayed with the settings specified by the
Series Appearance. Having said this, it is better to define more Item Appearance elements when you
have a variable number of items to display in the chart.
Item Appearance contains the following:
Line Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of the lines for the particular dataset in pixels.
Line Dash
Length Allows you to define the length of the dash, if the lines are to be shown as dash for the
particular dataset.
Line Dash Gap Allows you to define the length of the gap between dashes, if the lines are to be shown as
dash for the particular dataset.
Draw Anchors Allows you set whether to draw anchors for the particular dataset. If the anchors are not
shown, then the tool tip and links will not work for the dataset.
Anchor Sides Allows you set the number of sides that the anchors of the particular dataset will have. For
example, an anchor with 3 sides would represent a triangle, with 4 it would be a square and
so on. The range is from 3 - 20.
Anchor Radius Allows you to set the radius (in pixels) of the anchors of the particular dataset. Greater the
radius, bigger would be the anchor size.
Anchor Border
Color Allows you set the border color of anchors of the particular dataset. Use hex code of colors.
To use the color picker, click on the color swatch square.
Anchor Border
Thickness Allows you set border thickness of anchors of the particular dataset in pixels.
Anchor
Background
Color
Allows you set the background color of anchors of the particular dataset. Use hex code of
colors. To use the color picker, click on the color swatch square.
Anchor Alpha Allows you set the alpha of entire anchors of the particular dataset. If you need to hide the
anchors for the dataset but still enable tool tips, set this as 0.
Anchor
Background
Alpha
Allows you set the alpha (transparency) of anchor background of the particular dataset. The
range is from 0 - 100.
Table 36. Item Appearance
Element Description
Item Value Allows you to specify the settings in the Item Appearance element that are applied to the
data items whose X axis value match with the specified value.
Y Axis Value
Range Allows you to apply the color is applied based on the Y axis value of the item, if you specify
Y Axis Value Range,
Table 35. Series Appearance
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 85
www.agreeya.com
To o l b a r
The Toolbar Appearance Tab contains the following:
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Color Allows you to define the color of data series at the Series Appearance level for multi-series
and combination charts. However, if you wish to highlight a particular data item, you can
specify its color at Item Appearance level.
Display Value Allows you to display a custom string value if instead of the numerical value of this data.
Tooltext Allows you to display more information for the data item as tool tip. By default, qChartView
shows the series Name, Category Name and value as tool tip text for that data item.
Alpha Allows you to define the alpha of datasets at the Series Appearance level for multi-series and
combination charts, However, if you wish to highlight a particular data item, you can specify
its alpha at Item Appearance level using this attribute. The range is from 0 - 100.
Dashed Allows you to set whether the border of this data item should appear as dashed.
Anchor Sides Lets you specify item specific sides of the anchor in a line/area chart. The range is from 3 -
20.
Anchor Radius Lets you specify item specific radius (in pixels) of the anchor in a line/area chart.
Anchor Border
Color Lets you specify item specific border color of the anchor. Use hex code of colors. To use the
color picker, click on the color swatch square
Anchor Border
Thickness Lets you specify item specific border thickness in pixels) of the anchor in a line/area chart.
Anchor
Background
Color
Lets you specify item specific background color of the anchor in a line/area chart.
Anchor Alpha Lets you specify item specific alpha (transparency) of the anchor in a line/area chart. The
range is from 0 - 100.
Anchor
Background
Alpha
Lets you specify item specific alpha (transparency) of the anchor background in a line/area
chart. The range is from 0 - 100.
Table 37. Toolbar Appearance
Element Description
Toolbar Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the toolbar.
Show Return to Master Chart
Button If selected, displays the Return To Master Chart Button. This button will
appear only if the Source parameter exists in the URL of the current page.
When the user clicks this button, the user is returned back to the URL
specified in the Source HTTP parameter.
Show Export Button When selected, displays options that enable export of rendered chart in
various formats: JPG, PNG, SVG, PDF, and XLS (as an Excel spreadsheet).
Table 38. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Table 36. Item Appearance
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 86
www.agreeya.com
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 39. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 38. Layout
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 87
www.agreeya.com
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Table 40. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information, see
ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 41. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 88
www.agreeya.com
qChartView Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qChartView:
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard
Configuring qChartView
Formatting Links
Setting Number Formatting
Setting Number Scaling
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration
Wizard
To configure basic settings
1 Add qChartView to your page.
2 Select the ezWizard menu item from the qChartView Web Part Menu or Ribbon.
3 Select one or more lists, from the current site, whose data you want to aggregate, and click Next.
4 Define chart configurations, and click Next.
If you want to change your selections, select Previous.
5Click Finish.
NOTE: Once a Web Part is configured, the ezWizard item will not appear on the Web Part Menu or the Web Part
Ribbon.
Configuring qChartView
To configure qChartView
1 Add qChartView to your page.
2Open ezEdit.
Return to Master Chart
Button Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Return to Master Chart toolbar button is retrieved from
the resource file that is included in the product. If the resource file in the culture
that you want to use is not available, define the text for the Return to Master Chart
toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource ID and
the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and
culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Filter Button Text
Resource ID By default, the text for the Filter toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text
for the Filter toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This
Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP
parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the
given identifier and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource
file is used.
Table 41. Localization
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 89
www.agreeya.com
The Primary Content page opens by default.
3 Configure each element as needed and click OK.
4 If needed, configure the elements in the other tabs.
5 When done configuring each tab, click OK.
Formatting Links
You can perform the following procedures with links:
Defining Links for a Chart
Opening Links in a New Window
Linking to Frames
Setting Number Formatting
Defining Links for a Chart
To define a link for any data plot
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Functional.
3 In the Click URL field, define the link attribute as in the following example:
link='ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan'
With the above XML, the data plot (be it column, pie or line/area anchor), when clicked, will take to the
page ShowDetails.asp?Month=Jan, which might contain another chart to show detailed results for the
month of January.
The chart view expects all the links in URL Encoded format, if you have characters special characters
(such as ?,&) in your link. When the user clicks the link, the chart view decodes it and invokes
ShowDetails.asp?Month=Jan.
All the server-side scripting languages provide a generic function to URL Encode any string.
Opening Links in a New Window
You can open the link in a new window instead of the same window.
To open a link in a new window
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Functional.
3 In the Click URL field, add n- before any link, as in the following example:, link='n-
ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan'
The above link, when clicked, opens in a new window.
Opening Links in Pop-up Windows
The chart view also allows you to open your links in pop-up windows.
To open a link in pop-up window
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 90
www.agreeya.com
2Click Functional.
3 In the Click URL field, define the link as in the following example:
link="P-detailsWin,width=400,height=300,toolbar=no,scrollbars=no, resizable=no-
ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan"
Where:
P- denotes that the link is to be opened in a new pop-up window.
detailsWin specifies a name for the new window. If you want all the links to open in the same
pop-up, use the same window name across all links. However, if you want each link to open in a
new pop-up, specify a different window name for each link.
height specifies the height of the window in pixels.
width specifies the width of the window in pixels.
resizable when enabled, allows the user to manually resize the window by dragging its edges or
corners.
Linking to Frames
The chart view allows you to open links in specified frames too. To do so, you just specify the name of the frame
in the link itself.
To open link in a specified frame
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Functional.
3 In the Click URL field, set the link as in the following example: link='F-FrameName-
ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan'
Where:
F denotes the link opens in a frame
-FrameName denotes the name of the frame to be opened
-ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan denotes the actual link to be opened. The link needs to be URL
Encoded.
NOTE: You can include other attributes, such as:
menubar specifies whether or not to display a menu bar at the top of the window.
toolbar specifies whether or not to display the main toolbar (with the back,
forward, stop buttons).
location specifies whether or not to display the location bar (the Address Bar in
Internet Explorer®) - where URLs are typed and displayed.
directories specifies whether or not to display any additional toolbar (for example,
the Links Bar in Internet Explorer).
status specifies whether or not to display the status bar at the foot of the window.
left specifies the distance in pixels of the new window from the left edge of the
screen. (This applies to Internet Explorer. For Netscape Navigator® use screenX).
top specifies the distance in pixels of the new window from the top edge of the
screen. (This applies to Internet Explorer. For Netscape Navigator use screenY).
fullscreen when enabled causes the window to open in full-screen mode (Internet
Explorer only.)
scrollbars specify whether or not to display the horizontal and vertical scrollbars
that normally appear when the page content is larger tan the screen.
-ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan denotes the actual link to be invoked
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 91
www.agreeya.com
In this example, the main frameset is contained in FrameExample.html, which has two vertical frame pane- one
on top containing the chart (FramePages\FrameChart.html) and one on bottom to show the linked frame pages.
The bottom pane by default shows FramePages\LowerFrame.html which contains the message "Click on columns
above to view details".
The setup looks like the following:
Figure 17. Linking to Frames
Setting Number Formatting
You can perform the following procedures:
Controlling Decimal Precision
Automatic Number Formatting
Setting Custom Thousand and Decimal Separator Character
Adding Number Prefix and Suffix
Formatting Y-axis Values Decimal in Manual Div-Lines Mode
Controlling Decimal Precision
All the charts types in qChartView support the attribute decimals. This single attribute lets you control the
decimal precision of all the numbers on the chart. Using this attribute, you can globally set the number of
decimal places of ALL numbers of the chart.
To globally set the number of decimal places
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 Enter a value in the Decimal box.
4Click Save.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 92
www.agreeya.com
For example, if you have numbers on your chart as 12.432, 13.4 and 13 and you set Decimals='2' , the numbers
would be converted to 12.43, 13.4 and 13 respectively.
Figure 18. Controlling decimal precision
Similarly, if you had data as 0.12342, 0.134 and 0.13, and you set Decimals as 3, qChartView would output
0.124, 0.134 and 0.13 respectively.
Even though the Decimals is set to 3, qChartView does not add the 0 padding to 0.13 to form 0.130. However, if
you want your numbers on the chart to have trailing zeroes too, you can set Force Decimals=true and now the
numbers would show as 0.124, 0.134 and 0.130 respectively, as shown in these examples:
Figure 19. Force decimals
Automatic Number Formatting
qChartView automatically formats your numbers by adding K,M (Kilo, Million) and proper commas to the
numbers, as shown in this example:
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 93
www.agreeya.com
Figure 20. Automatic Number Formatting
The data for chart is 12500, 13400 and 13300. qChartView automatically formats the number scaling to convert
to K (Thousands) & M (Millions).
If you do not want to truncate numbers
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 From Format Number Scale, select False.
4Click Save.
When you now view the chart, you will see the following:
Figure 21. Not truncating numbers
In the example above, qChartView is showing full numbers on the chart. It has also added commas to the
numbers at the required places.
If you do not want to set commas
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 From Format Number, select False.
4 From Format Number Scale, select False.
5Click Save.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 94
www.agreeya.com
Figure 22. Not setting commas
The commas have been removed from numbers.
Setting Custom Thousand and Decimal Separator Character
By default, qChartView uses . (dot) as decimal separator and , (comma) as thousand separator character.
However, you can customize this character depending on your requirements. For example, you can swap the
separator characters.
To swap separator characters
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 In the In Decimal Separator, enter ,.
4 In the In Thousand Separator, enter ..
5Click Save.
Figure 23. Swap separator characters
Adding Number Prefix and Suffix
qChartView allows you to add a prefix or suffix to all numbers on the chart.
To add a number prefix or suffix
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 In the Number Prefix box, enter a character or value.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 95
www.agreeya.com
For example, to represent dollar figures, enter $.
4 In the Number Suffix box, enter a character or value.
For example, to represent figures quantified per annum, enter p.a.
5Click Save.
If you intend to use special characters for Number Prefix or Number Suffix, URL Encode them when using
dataXML method. For example, if you wish to have numberSuffix as % (for example, 30%):
numberSuffix='%25'
In dataURL method, you can directly specify the character.
Figure 24. Adding number prefixes and suffixes
Formatting Y-axis Values Decimal in Manual Div-Lines Mode
If you want to set the number of divisional lines on chart, you can control the decimals of y-axis values
separately. For example, consider the following attributes and chart:
Y Axis Min Value='115' Y Axis Max Value='140' Zero Plane=false Number of Division Lines='3'>
In this chart, the chart lower limit, upper limit, and number of divisional lines have been manually set.
qChartView will not automatically adjust divisional lines. In the chart, qChartView has truncated decimals from
y-axis values, as it cannot find any other decimal values on the chart.
You can, however, show decimals on y-axis values in this case (when Zero Plane is false) using Y Axis Value
Decimals attribute, for example Y Axis Min Value='115' Y Axis Max Value='140' Zero Plane=false Number of
Division Lines='3' Y Axis Value Decimals='2' Decimals='0' >.
When you now see the chart, 2 decimal places on y-axis values appear. But, the other numbers on chart would
still have 0 decimal places.
NOTE: Force Decimals does not work in this mode.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 96
www.agreeya.com
Figure 25. Formatting y-axis
Setting Number Scaling
Number scaling lets you define your own scales for numbers and then apply it to all numbers on the chart.
For example, if your numbers on the chart are greater than 1000, qChartView scales them to K (Thousands) or M
(Millions). For example, if you plot a chart with data as 12500, 13400 and 13300, you will see the following
chart:
Figure 26. Setting number scaling
qChartView has scaled the numbers down to K. By default, qChartView has the K,M (1000,1000) scaling defined
for each chart. You can, however, customize it.
You can perform the following procedures:
Adding Billions to Default Scaling
Putting Time in Scale
Adding Billions to Default Scaling
qChartView, by default, has 1000,1000 (K,M) scaling defined for all charts. It does not have the scaling for
billions defined. You can modify the number scaling to add billion so that the final scale looks like
1000,1000,1000 (K,M,B).
This scale would look something like:
1000 = 1 K
1000 K = 1 M
1000 M = 1 B
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 97
www.agreeya.com
To convert this scale into qChartView format
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 In the Number Scale Value box, enter 1000,1000,1000.
4 In the Number Scale Unit box, enter K,M,B.
5Click Save.
Whatever numeric figure was present on the left hand side of the table is put in Number Scale Value and
whatever unit was present on the right side of the scale table has been put under Number Scale Unit - all
separated by commas.
If you want to set the chart formatting flags
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 From Format Number, select True.
4 From Format Number Scale, select True.
5 In the Number Prefix box, enter $.
6Click Save.
When you now view a chart containing data in billions, you will see the following chart. Note that the
chart now contains figure both in millions and billions.
Figure 27. Setting chart formatting
Putting Time in Scale
If you want to plot time-related figures on the chart, you can set the time in each process to range from a few
seconds to few days. You can build a scale indicating time and then specify it to the chart:
60 seconds = 1 minute
60 minute = 1 hr
24 hrs = 1 day
7 days = 1 week
To convert this scale in qChartView
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 98
www.agreeya.com
3 In the Default Number Scale box, enter s.
The default number scale is now represented in seconds.
4 In the Number Scale Value box, enter 60,60,24,7.
5 In the Number Scale Unit box, enter min,hr,day,wk.
6Click Save.
Whatever numeric figure was present on the left hand side of the table is put in Number Scale Value and
whatever unit was present on the right side of the scale table has been put under Number Scale Unit - all
separated by commas.
If you want to set the chart formatting flags
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 From Format Number, select True.
4 From Format Number Scale, select True.
5Click Save.
When you now view the chart, you'll see that all the data has been automatically scaled to the best
value:
38 is converted to 38s
150 is converted to 2.50min
11050 is converted to 3.07hr
334345 is converted to 3.87 day
1334345 is converted to 2.21wk
Figure 28. Time scaling
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
6
99
www.agreeya.com
qDiscussionView
Overview
qDiscussionView Pages
qDiscussionView Procedures
Overview
qDiscussionView allows you to view multiple discussions lists at once. These discussion lists can reside in
another site, another site collection, or another web application as long as they are in the same configuration
database.
qDiscussionView Pages
You can configure this web part through its pages that are accessible through ezEdit. qDiscussionView contains
the following pages:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Filtering
Search/Filter Panel
Sorting
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 100
www.agreeya.com
Viewed Lists
The Viewed Lists section defines:
the discussion lists whose data is viewed in qDiscussionView and how it is aggregated. You can define the
lists to be aggregated one by one, in a Rolled-Up list, or from lists with a particular name from all the
subsites (recursive rollup)
the dependent lists for each list. If the Dependent Lists information is provided, qDiscussionView will
check whether or not there are child records in the Dependent Lists when you delete items from the
view. If there are any, qDiscussionView will not delete the selected items.
You will need the qListForm web part in order to establish a relationship between different lists.
The following are the elements for the Viewed List attribute:
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part, or accept the default. This field is
mandatory.
Viewed Lists See Viewed Lists on page 100.
Display Fields See Display Fields on page 103
ID HTTP Parameter
Name Allows the qDiscussionView and several other web parts to an HTTP Parameter called
ID to identify the item to be displayed or edited. This HTTP Parameter is usually
generated automatically by the viewer web part, when you select an item to be
displayed or edited.
NOTE: If qDiscussionView is placed on a web part page that is contained within a
document library, the page will generate an error if the value of the ID HTTP
Parameter is bigger than the number of pages within the document library. To prevent
this error from happening, rename the ID HTTP Parameter.
By default, the value of this property is "ID". You can change the value of this property
to something else, such as LID. In that case, when you select "View Properties" or "Edit
Properties" in the context menu, the URL of the display or edit form becomes:
http://mysite.com/EditFormURL.aspx?LID=xxx
NOTE: Set the same property in the qListForm to the same value.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 101
www.agreeya.com
Table 2. Viewed Lists
Element Description
Advanced
ModeTurn on if you want to edit Viewed Lists in XML format:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" ListName="listName" IncludeSubsites="true/false"
IncludeThisSite="true/false" IsRollupList="true/false" SiteUrlFieldName="fieldName"
RolledUpListName="listName" TargetUrl="targetUrl" SetSessionName="sessionName"
ResetSessionNames="name1, name2" NewFormUrl="URL" EditFormUrl="URL"
DisplayFormUrl="URL">
<!-- To define dependent lists, add a DependentLists element inside the List element -->
<DependentLists>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" ListName="listName" KeyFieldName="keyFieldName" />
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" ListName="listName" KeyFieldName="keyFieldName" />
</DependentLists>
</List>
<List ...></List>
<List ...></List>
</Lists>
Site URL The URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can be absolute (http://...)
or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a double
dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
List Name The name of the SharePoint list that is edited or displayed by this Discussion View. The list
name is case sensitive. If the list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as well.
To denote the current list, you can use a single dot (.) as the list name.
NOTE: This only works if the qDiscussionView is contained in the AllItems.aspx. For example,
if you are replacing the Microsoft® Discussion View in the AllItems.aspx of the Tasks list and
you use a single dot as the ListName attribute, the ListName attribute of the qDiscussionView
is set to Tasks. If you want to save the list as a template and then add it somewhere else, the
name of the new list might not be Tasks and using this relative list name will automatically
pick up the new list name for the view.
Include
Subsites If set to true, the Discussion View will search all the subsites for a list whose name specified in
the ListName and aggregate the information from those list.
NOTE: If you have many subsites, the information may take a long time to aggregate. Use this
attribute if you have only a small amount of subsites. You must test this feature in your
environment to see whether or not the response comes back in a reasonable amount of time
and the request does not time out.
Include This
Site Used in conjunction of the IncludeSubsites attribute. If you set this property to true, the list in
the current site will be aggregated by the Discussion View. The current site is the site whose
URL is specified in the SiteUrl attribute.
Is Rollup List Indicates whether or not the list specified by the SiteUrl and ListName attributes contains the
Site URLs of the lists to be aggregated instead of the data to be aggregated. If you set this to
true, the list specified by the SiteUrl and ListName must have a field that contains the URL
information. By default, the name of that field is Site URL. If you use different field name,
specify the name using the SiteUrlFieldName attribute.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 102
www.agreeya.com
Rolled Up List
Name Used in conjunction with the IsRollupList property, indicates the name of the lists to be rolled
up if you set the IsRollupList to true.
If you want to aggregate more than one list from each site specified in the rollup list, you can
define more than one List elements with the same rollup list, but different RolledUpListName.
For example, if you want to aggregate Public Library and Private Library document libraries
from each site, you can specify the following:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="." ListName="Project Sites" IsRollupList="true" SiteUrlFieldName="Project Site
URL" RolledUpListName="Public Library" />
<List SiteUrl="." ListName="Project Sites" IsRollupList="true" SiteUrlFieldName="Project Site
URL" RolledUpListName="Private Library" />
</Lists>
Site URL Field
Name Used in conjunction with the IsRollupList property, indicates the field that contains the Site
URLs of the lists to be aggregated. This attribute is optional if the field name is Site URL.
NOTE: The Site URL field must be a single line of text field.
Active Field
Name Used in conjunction with the IsRollupList property. The rollup list may contain a Yes/No field
to indicate whether or not a particular site should be included in the rollup. This property is
optional if the name of this field is Active.
NOTE: The Active field must be a Yes/No field.
Reset Session
Names Resets (sets to NULL) the value of the session variables whose name is specified in this
attribute. You can specify multiple names by separating them with commas; for example
TaskSession, IssueSession.
You can reset the session name if a discussion may have one or more tasks associated with it.
In addition to storing the selected discussion in the session, you may store the dependent task
information in the session as well. This means that every time you store a new discussion into
a session, you need to reset the dependent task information from the session as well.
Set Session
Name Defines the name of the session variable where the Discussion View will store the item whose
column is being clicked by the user. The user can click the item if one of the LinkTo,
LinkToTarget or the LinkToSource attributes in the Display Fields property is defined.
This attribute is usually used if you have another web part (such as the qListForm) that can
consume the stored values from the session.
You can set the session name when you want to consume the item from a session variable in a
qListForm later.
Target URL When the LinkToTarget attribute of a specific column is set to true (in the Display Fields
property), the data in that column becomes a hyperlink to the URL specified in this attribute.
NOTE: The TargetUrl can use the <%field name%> field replacement expression. If you are
using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and > characters, which are
&lt; and &gt; respectively.
Use the LinkToTargetUrl attribute if you want each list to have a different URL; for example,
when you want to aggregate multiple lists from the same workspace and connect a certain
column to the display form of the list. In that case, the URL to the display form of each list is
different.
New Form URL Indicates the URL where the form to create a new item resides. The URL is relative to the Site
URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when one of the New buttons in the
toolbar is clicked. If not defined, the user is redirected to the NewForm.aspx of the list (or
Upload.aspx for the document library).
Redefining the New Form URL is useful if you have different way of creating an item
depending on the current view. For example, in the view for external vendor, you may want to
give them a new form that does not contain all the fields in the list.
NOTE: The Source HTTP parameter is automatically appended to the New Form URL during
redirection.
This attribute is usually used in conjunction with qListForm.
Table 2. Viewed Lists
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 103
www.agreeya.com
Display Fields
This property defines the fields that should be displayed in the tree list panel of qDiscussionView.
The Display Field contains the following elements:
Reply Form
URL Indicates the URL where the form to create a new response resides. The URL is relative to the
Site URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when the Reply button in the
toolbar or in the preview panel or the Reply context menu item is clicked. If not defined, the
user is redirected to the URL specified in the NewFormUrl, if one is defined. Otherwise, the
user is redirected to the NewForm.aspx of the list.
Redefining the Reply Form URL is useful if you want to have a different form to create a reply
than the one that is used to create a new discussion. For example, in the form to create a
reply, you may want to use 2 qListForms. The first qListForm is used to display the detail of
the parent discussion and the second qListForm is used to create the response itself.
NOTE: The Source HTTP parameter is automatically appended to the Reply Form URL during
redirection.
This attribute is usually used in conjunction with qListForm.
Edit Form URL Indicates the URL where the form to edit an item in the list resides. The URL is relative to the
Site URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when the user clicks Edit
Properties in the Context Menu. If not defined, the user is redirected to the EditForm.aspx of
the list.
Redefining the Edit Form URL is useful if you have different ways of editing an item depending
on the current view. For example, in the view for external vendor, you may want to give them
an edit form that does not contain all the fields in the list.
NOTE: The ID and Source HTTP parameters are automatically appended to the Edit Form URL
during redirection.
This attribute is usually used in conjunction with qListForm.
Display Form
URL The URL where the form to display an item in the list resides. The URL is relative to the Site
URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when the user clicks View
Properties in the Context Menu. If not defined, the user is redirected to the DisplayForm.aspx
of the list.
Redefining the Display Form URL is useful if you have different way of displaying an item
depending on the current view. For example, in the view for external vendor, you may want to
give them a display form that does not contain all the fields in the list.
NOTE: The ID and Source HTTP parameters are automatically appended to the Display Form
URL during redirection.
This attribute is usually used in conjunction with qListForm.
Site URL The URL to the site that contains the dependent list.
List Name The name of the dependent list. The list name is case sensitive.
Key Field
Name The name of the field in the dependent list that contains the ID of the parent item. It is the
foreign key in the dependent list. The key field is usually a single line of text that contains the
parent item ID or a cross-site lookup field to the parent list. The name is case sensitive.
Table 2. Viewed Lists
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 104
www.agreeya.com
Table 3. Display Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Display Fields in XML format:
<Fields LookupThresholdControlSettings=”On”>
<Field Name="fieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<!-- Grouped field -->
<Field Name="fieldName" Grouped="true" SortDirection="asc|desc"
GroupExpanded="true|false" />
</Fields>
Query All Fields Controls how Web Parts behave in relation to the Discussion View Lookup Threshold in
SharePoint Resource Throttling. The options are:
Default — uses the level set in the Configuration Editor. If you have selected Query
All Fields check box in the Configuration Editor, the Web Part will query only those
fields that are not included in the Discussion View Lookup Threshold. If the Query
All Fields check box is cleared, the Web Part will query all fields.
On — If the Web Part level is On, the Web Part queries all fields in lists, except
Lookup fields.
Off — If the Web Part level is Off, the Web Part queries all fields in lists, including
Lookup fields.
Explicit — If the Web Part level is Explicit, the Web Part queries only those fields
selected in the Display Fields. This option renders the best performance for your
Web Part.
Title Indicates the title of the field. This is useful if the real field name is too long and you want
to abbreviate the title in the field header, or if you simply want to display a different title
in the field header. If this attribute is not specified, the value specified in the Name
attribute is used in the field header. For example:
<Field Name="Created By" Title="Author" />
Title Resource ID Indicates the identifier in the Resource List that is used as the title of the field. The
TitleResourceID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP
parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given
identifier is not found, the default Title is used.
Width Indicates the width of the field. You can specify the value in pixels (Width="20px") or
percentage (Width="20%").
We recommend leaving at least one field where you do not specify this property. That field
will take up the remaining width of the page. For example:
<Field Name="Subject" Width="100px" />
Align Indicates the horizontal alignment for the field. The values is one of the following: left,
right, or center. For example:
<Field Name="Created" Align="right" />
Item Style Indicates the style for the item. You can define the style as you would in a CSS class; for
example, color: red; font-weight: bold
Item CSS Class Indicates the distinct style for the column and you already have defined the style in an
external CSS file.
Display Field
Name If specified, indicates a cross-site lookup field. It contains the name of the field in the
cross-site list that contains the value to be displayed. The field name is case sensitive.
A cross-site lookup field enables you to lookup a list that resides in another site, another
site collection, or another web application as long as it is in the same configuration
database. You need the qListForm web part to create a cross-site lookup field.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 105
www.agreeya.com
Display Format If specified, indicates a cross-site lookup field. It contains the format of the value that is
displayed. Define this attribute if you want to display values from multiple fields. You can
use the field replacement expression <%Field%> to refer to a field.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in the
Display Fields editor in the Discussion View Editor, where the Editor will encode the
characters automatically for you.
NOTE: For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
Show User Groups Allows you to show groups where the user is a member of one of the SharePoint groups
listed. Separate site group names with commas.
Hide User Groups Allows you to hide groups where the user is a member of one of the SharePoint groups
listed. Separate site group names with commas.
Hyperlink Field
Target If this field is a SharePoint Hyperlink or Picture field, indicates the target window for the
hyperlink. For example, use "_blank" if you want to open the target URL in a new window.
If this attribute is left blank, the target URL will open in the current window.
This attribute will not affect the hyperlink column created with the LinkTo, LinkToSource
or LinkToTargetURL attributes.
Link To Indicates that the Discussion View will turn the field into a hyperlinked column to the
specified URL. The URL can be an absolute or relative URL. The LinkTo can use the <%field
name%> field replacement expression.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in the
Display Fields editor in the Discussion View Editor, where the Editor will encode the
characters automatically for you.
If you use a relative URL, the URL is appended to the site URL of the target site. For
example, specify "Lists/TeamDiscussion/EditForm.aspx?ID=&lt;%ID%&gt;" as the value of
this property. If you click a customer record that comes from the Customers list in
Workspace A, whose site URL is "http://mydomain/sites/mysite", you are directed to
http://mydomain/sites/mysite/Lists/TeamDiscussion/EditForm.aspx?ID=23 (assuming you
click the discussion with ID=23).
Here is an example on how to make the Subject field a hyperlink column to the edit form
of the Discussion list:
<Field Name="Subject"
LinkTo="Lists/TeamDiscussion/EditForm.aspx?ID=&lt;%ID%&gt;&Source=..
/../default.aspx" />
Link To Target If set to true, indicates the Discussion View will make the field value a hyperlink to the URL
specified in the TargetUrl attribute in the Viewed Lists property.
Use this element when you aggregate lists with different name. In that case, you specify a
different TargetUrl for each list in the Viewed Lists property and the Discussion View will
redirect the user to the correct URL depending on the list where the clicked item comes
from.
Link To Source The Discussion View will make the field value a hyperlink to the URL specified in the
Source HTTP parameter of the current request. For this option to work, the current page
URL must look like: http://.....?Source=....
Use this element when the URL for the hyperlink is dynamic. This could be because it
contains dynamic parameters or the URL is different depending on the referral page.
Also, when you want to make the URL in the link dynamic. In that case, you can pass in the
URL for the link into the HTTP parameter of your page.
Table 3. Display Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 106
www.agreeya.com
Filtering
The Filtering page allows you to use CAML filters to dynamically filter records.
The Filtering page contains the following:
Search/Filter Panel
The Search/Filter Panel allows you to define the panels for search, filter, and replace in the web part.
The Search/Filter Panel contains the following elements:
Is Complex
Category If selected, you can set the following:
Complex Category Index Site URL — By default, the complex category index list
resides in the same site as the discussion list itself. If this is not the case, then you
must specify the URL of the site that contains the index list here.
Complex Category Index List Name — By default, the complex category index list is
named "<Discussion list name> Categories". For example, if your discussion list
name is "Team Discussion", then its index list name is "Team Discussion Categories".
If this is not the case, then you must specify the name of the index list here.
Grouped Allows you to group data by:
Sort Direction — This attribute determines whether the values in the header of the
grouped field must be displayed in ascending or descending order. The options are
asc for ascending order or desc for descending order. The default value is asc.
Group Expanded — If set to true, the group is initially expanded. Otherwise, it is
collapsed. If not specified, the default value is false.
NOTE: Grouping is not supported on any field that has "Allow Multiple Values" enabled.
Table 4. Filtering
Element Description
CAML Filter Allows you to specify the CAML (Collaboration Application Markup Language) query
expression to filter your data. CAML is an XML-based query language. The CAML Filter
will only be applied to the data. The filter will not be applied to the responses.
For more information, see CAML Filters on page 19.
Table 5. Search/Filt e r Pa nel
Element Description
Searched Fields See Searched Fields on page 107.
Expand Filter panel
on Load Allows you to automatically open the Filter panel by default so that the user can
perform a search quickly. When set to true, the Filter panel opens when the web part
is loaded for the first time.
Panel Button Location Determines the location of the Go, Reset and Close buttons in the Filter panel. This
property also determines the location of the Go and Close buttons in the Replace
panel.
Show Apply On Top
Level Discussions Only
in search panel
Determines whether the check box, “Apply only on Top Level Discussions”, is shown in
the filter panel. If you check this check box when performing the search, the
qDiscussionView will filter only the top level discussion and the search results will be
shown in the structure they are supposed to be (under the correct grouping, etc). If
you clear this check box when performing the search, the search results will be
displayed in a flat structure.
Table 3. Display Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 107
www.agreeya.com
Searched Fields
This property defines which fields are displayed in the Filter panel. If defined, the discussion view displays
Filter or Search menu items under the Actions button in the toolbar. To disable the search feature in the
discussion view, you can leave this property blank.
You will be able to perform a search by pressing Enter.
You can further edit fields using the following elements:
Show Search All Fields
Control in Search
Panel
Determines whether the Filter panel should display the control to search all fields in
the list. When set to true, the following control is shown in the Filter panel:
The Search All Fields Control allows you to do the following:
Combine the search all fields functionality with other search criteria that has
been entered for specific fields.
When the search all fields criteria is entered, the Filter panel will construct a
filter expression with the "Contain" operator for the following fields in the list:
Single line of text, Multiple lines of text, Choice, Lookup (only Lookup to a
Single Text field and Lookup to a Number field are supported), Person or Group
and Hyperlink or Picture. If the list contains a Lookup to Number field, Search
All Fields will not work for negative numbers for that field. The Filter panel will
use the entire keywords as the value to be searched. Therefore, if you enter
"High Priority" in the search all fields control and perform the search, it will
find the following sentence:
‘This is a high priority task’
However, it will not find the following sentence:
‘The priority is not always high’
Turn On List Searcher
ModeAllows the user to perform a search before the listview display any data.
NOTE: Pressing Enter will not allow you to perform a search on such fields as external data, people picker,
managed metadata, and a drop-down list. Instead, the default behavior will occur.
NOTE: For the Number type field, the “Contain” operator is not supported for negative numbers, and is
not available for the following fields: Lookup to DateTime field, Lookup to Calculated field, and Lookup to
ID field.
Table 6. Searched Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Searched Fields in XML format:
<Fields>
<Field Name="fieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<!-- To search a cross site lookup field, use one of the following two formats -->
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFieldName="fieldName" SortField="fieldName" [optional
attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFormat="fieldName" SortField="fieldName" [optional
attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
</Fields>
Field Name Indicates the element you are editing.
Title Displays title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an encoded HTML string.
Description Describes the field. This is useful if you want to give a short instruction or explanation
about the field.
Table 5. Search/Filt e r Pa nel
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 108
www.agreeya.com
Default Value Defines the default value for the field.
You can define a text, a number or a date. A date value must be specified in ISO
8601 format: YYYY-MM-DDThh:mm:ssZ, for example: midnight of February 14, 2002 is 2002-
02-14T00:00:00Z.
Default Operator Defines the default operator for the field.
Fixed Operator Defines the operator for the field. If specified, the list to select the operator for this field is
turned off.
Use People
Editor Enables you to enter any user information that is in your directory service.
If you set this to True and the field to be searched is a People and Group field, the Filter
panel shows the People Editor control for entering the search criteria.
Column Count Defines the number of columns for the options in a multi-choice field or in a choice-and-
lookup field if the Enable Multi Choice attribute is set to True. This is useful in case your
choice or lookup fields have too many choices and you want to break the choices into
several columns to minimize the vertical scrolling in your form.
Enable Multi
Choice If set to True, allows you to select multiple options for the choice-and-lookup field.
Therefore, the user can specify a condition like "A or B". This attribute is ignored by other
field types.
To search a cross-site lookup field, you must specify one or more List elements inside the
Field element. The cross-site lookup field is displayed as two drop downs.
Sort Field Defines the field that is used to sort the value in the drop-down menu. The field name is
case sensitive.
Sort Order Allows you to sort the values in ascending or descending order.
AutoPostBack When set to true, this attribute causes the Filter panel to refresh when the user changes the
selection in a lookup field or cross-site lookup field.
You need to set AutoPostBack to true if this field is a lookup or a cross-site lookup field and
it is being used to filter another lookup or cross-site lookup field in the Filter panel.
Parent Field Defines another lookup or cross-site lookup field that is used to filter this field. The parent
field must be listed before this field in the XML property.
Parent Filter
Field Name Defines the field in the parent field that is used to filter this field. It is the primary key in
the list that is used in the lookup or cross-site lookup field.
Filter Field Name Defines the field in the list that is used by this lookup or cross-site lookup field that is
filtered by the parent filter field.
Display Field
Name Shows the name of the field whose value is displayed in the drop-down menu. The field
name is case sensitive. Use this attribute instead of the Display Format attribute if you only
want to display a single field in the drop-down menu.
Display Format Indicates the format of the value that is displayed in the drop-down menu. Define this
attribute instead of the Display Field Name attribute if you want to display multiple fields in
the drop-down menu. You can use the field replacement expression <%Field%> to refer to a
field.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in the
Searched Fields editor in the List View Editor, where the Editor will encode the characters
automatically for you.
NOTE: For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
Site URL Indicates the Site URL of the field. You can use an absolute or relative URL
List Name Indicates the name of the List. The field name is case sensitive.
Site Name Indicates the name of the site specified in the Site URL. This is used in case you have
multiple lists. In this case, the first drop-down menu to select the list will display as "List
Name in Site Name". You can use any name for the Site Name. It does not have to match the
real title of the Site.
Table 6. Searched Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 109
www.agreeya.com
Sorting
The Sorting page allows you to define the sorting criteria and paging type and size in the web part.
The Sorting page contains the following elements:
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Actions
Views
Actions
The Actions page contain the following elements:
Views
The Views page allows you to set views so the user to view the data.
The Views page contains the following elements:
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Table 7. Sorting
Element Description
Sort Fields Defines the initial sorting criterion for the data. This is the syntax for this
property:
FieldName1 [SortDirection], FieldName1 [SortDirection]
SortDirection is either ASC (ascending order) or DESC (descending order). The
FieldName and the SortDirection are case sensitive. If the SortDirection is not
specified, ascending order is assumed. For example:
First Name ASC, Last Name DESC, Company
Table 8. Actions
Element Description
Row Double Click
Action Allows you to select which action to perform when you double-click a row.
Table 9. Views
Element Description
Search Session Name The DiscussionView will store the search criteria, last selected folder, sort
criteria, and other DiscussionView dynamic settings in the session variable
with this name.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 110
www.agreeya.com
View
Toolbar
Context Menu
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
View
The View page allows you to set views so the user to view the data.
The View page contains the following elements:
Table 10. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 11. View
Element Description
Selection Column
Type Allows you to set the row selection type. The options are:
None: The user must click the row to select it.
MultiRowSelector: The discussion view will display a check box as the first
column. To select a row, the user checks the check box for that row. To select
multiple rows, the user checks the check box for each row to be selected.
Maximum Top Level
Discussions Per Page Allows you to set the maximum number of top level discussions to be displayed on one
page.
Expand To Level Allows you to determine how many levels should be expanded when the Discussion
View is loaded for the first time.
Show Preview Panel Allows you to display the preview panel.
Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the tree list panel in the Discussion View. The
skin name is associated with a folder under the following directory in the web server:
C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft
Shared\WebServerExtensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\DevExpress\9.3\
Themes
The skin folder will contain the CSS file and images needed to control the visual
appearance of the grid. If none of the provided skins satisfy your need, you can copy
one of the existing skins and modify it. You must follow the CSS class name convention
in the CSS file, which is class name followed by the skin name; for example,
dxtlControl_Office2003Blue.
Splitter Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the splitter in the Discussion View. The skin
folder will contain the CSS file and images needed to control the visual appearance of
the grid. If none of the provided skins satisfy your need, you can copy one of the
existing skins and modify it. You must follow the CSS class name convention in the CSS
file, which is class name followed by the skin name; for example, RadSplitter_Office.
Splitter Orientation Allows you to divide the treeview and the Preview panel either horizontally or
vertically using a splitter.
Tree View List Panel
Size Allows you to set the height (when the splitter orientation is Horizontal) or the width
(when the splitter orientation is Vertical) of the treeview list panel in pixels.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 111
www.agreeya.com
To o l b a r
The Toolbar page allows you to configure the appearance of the toolbar. It contains the following:
Context Menu
The Context Menu page contains the following:
Preview Panel Size Allows you to set the height (when the splitter orientation is Horizontal) or the width
(when the splitter orientation is Vertical) of the Preview panel in pixels.
Grid Lines Allows you to specify if the tree list can display no grid lines, horizontal grid line,
vertical grid lines or both depending on the Grid Lines property.
Table 12. Toolbar
Element Description
Toolbar Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the toolbar.
Show Filter Button at Top Allows you to show the Filter/Search button as a top level button. If not
selected, If set to false, the Filter/Search button is shown under the Actions
button.
Show New Item Button Allows you to display the New button.
Show Delete Button Allows you to display the Delete button
Show Connect To Outlook
Button Allows you to display the Connect to Outlook button.
Show Alert Me Button Allows you to show the Alert Me button in the toolbar.
Show Reply Button Allows you to display the Reply button.
Show Expand All Button Allows you to display the Expand All button.
Show Collapse All Button Allows you to display the Collapse All button.
Table 13. Context Menu
Element Description
Enable Context Menu Allows you to show the context menu.
Context Menu Skin Name Allows you to set he skin name for the context menu.
Show View Properties Allows you to show the View Properties menu item in the context menu.
Show Edit Properties Allows you to show the Edit Properties menu item in the context menu.
Show Reply Allows you to show the Reply menu item in the context menu.
Show Delete Item Allows you to show the Delete Item menu item in the context menu.
Show Manage Permissions Allows you to show the Manage Permissions menu item in the context menu.
Show Alert Me Allows you to show the Alert Me menu item in the context menu.
View Properties Context Menu
Text Allows you to set the text for the View Properties context menu.
Edit Properties Context Menu
Text Allows you to set the text for the Edit Properties context menu.
Reply Context Menu Text Allows you to set the text for the Reply context menu.
Delete Item Context Menu Text Allows you to set the text for the Delete Item context menu.
Manage Permissions Context
Menu Text Allows you to set the text for the Manage Permissions context menu.
Alert Me Context Menu Text Allows you to set the text for the Alert Me context menu.
Table 11. View
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 112
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Table 14. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 15. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 113
www.agreeya.com
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Table 16. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 17. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
View Properties Context
Menu Resource Text ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the View Properties context menu.
Edit Properties Context
Menu Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Edit Properties context menu.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 114
www.agreeya.com
qDiscussionView Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qDiscussionView:
Configuring qDiscussionView
Sorting the qDiscussionView
Configuring qDiscussionView with the Complex Category Index List
Configuring qDiscussionView
To configure qDiscussionView
1 Add qDiscussionView to your page.
2Open ezEdit.
The Primary Content page opens by default.
3 Configure each element as needed and click OK.
4 If needed, configure the elements in the other tabs.
5 When done configuring each tab, click OK.
Sorting the qDiscussionView
You can sort the entries in the qDiscussionView by clicking the column header. Clicking the column header again
will alternate between ascending and descending order.
Due to the hierarchical nature of the discussions and their responses, the sorting will sort the node against
another nodes in the same level. For example, if the following discussion structure exists:
* Discussion 1
- Response 1.1
- Response 1.1.1
- Response 1.1.2
- Response 1.2
- Response 1.2.1
Reply Context Menu
Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Reply context menu.
Delete Item Context
Menu Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Delete Item context menu.
Manage Permissions
Context Menu Resource
ID
Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Manage Permissions context menu.
Alert Me Context Menu
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Alert Me context menu.
Filter Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Filter button.
Table 17. Localization
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 115
www.agreeya.com
- Response 1.2.2
* Discussion 2
- Response 2.1
- Response 2.1.1
- Response 2.1.2
- Response 2.2
- Response 2.2.1
- Response 2.2.2
When you click the Subject column header:
Discussion 1 is sorted against Discussion 2
Response 1.1 is sorted against Response 1.2.
Response 2.1 is sorted against Response 2.2.
Response 1.1.1 is sorted against Response 1.1.2.
Response 1.2.1 is sorted against Response 1.2.2.
Response 2.1.1 is sorted against Response 2.1.2.
Response 2.2.1 is sorted against Response 2.2.2.
To clear the sorting for a certain column
Press Ctrl and click the column header.
To sort multiple columns
Press Shift and click other column headers.
The sort index depends on which column you click first. For example, if you click Created field and then
click Shift + Subject field, the entries are sorted based on the Created field first and then Subject field,
regardless the Subject field appeared first.
Understanding the Complex Category Index List
The Complex Category Index List allows qDiscussionView to function like the Lotus Notes response document
which contains a category attribute. qDiscussionView maintains the index list when one or more discussions are
deleted. You must mark the complex category field in your discussion list, so qDiscussionView will know that the
complex category field exists and the index list is updated.
To mark the complex category field in your discussion list
1 From the menu, select ezEdit.
2 From the Display Fields section, select Edit.
3 Select Edit for each field name you want displayed.
4 Select the Is Complex Category check box, and click OK.
The Complex Category Index List can contain multiple categories such as: Category1, Category2, Category3. In
this case, the discussion is displayed in each of the multiple categories in the treeview. For example, if
Discussion A contained ‘Category1, Category2, Category3’ in the Complex Category Index List, it would be
displayed in the treeview view as follows:
- Category1
- Discussion A
- Category2
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 116
www.agreeya.com
- Discussion A
- Category3
- Discussion A
The sorting is disabled when you use grouped complex category field.
The category field can contain nested categories, such as: Category1\Category2\Category3. In this case, the
discussion is displayed in the nested categories in the treeview. For example, if Discussion A contained
‘Category1\Category2\Category3’ in the complex category field, it would be displayed in the treeview as
follows:
- Category1
- Category2
- Category3
Discussion A
The category field can contain a mix of multiple and nested categories. For example, if Discussion A contained
‘Category1, Category2, Category3, Level1\Level2\Level3’ in the complex category field, it would be displayed in
the listview as follows:
-- Category1
- Discussion A
- Category2
- Discussion A
- Category3
- Discussion A
- Level1
- Level2
- Level3
Discussion A
In order to support complex categories while maintaining good performance, the Complex Category must be
indexed. Another SharePoint list is used to store the index. There are two ways to create the Complex Category
Index list.
To create the Complex Category Index List
1 From qDiscussionView, select Create Complex Category Index List.
2 Accept the default site URL or enter another site URL.
3 Enter the list name.
Once created, the index appears when you get lists from the Viewed List section of the web part.
For mass creation of the Complex Category Index list after discussion lists are migrated from Lotus Notes, use
the Complex Category Indexer tool. After the migration job, there are many unindexed discussion lists. This tool
creates the Complex Category Index list and populate it at the same time.
Configuring qDiscussionView with the Complex
Category Index List
If you have a Discussion list that you want to appear in different categories, you would configure the Complex
Category Index List. The Complex Category Index List allows qDiscussionView to function like the Lotus Notes
response document which contains a category attribute.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 117
www.agreeya.com
qDiscussionView maintains the index list when one or more discussions are deleted. You must mark the complex
category field in your discussion list, so qDiscussionView will know that the complex category field exists and
the index list is updated.
To configure qDiscussionView with Complex Category Index List
1 Create a discussion board list in SharePoint. For example, create a discussion board list called
"Discussion".
2 Create a column for Discussion. Enter the name "Category" and select Single Line of Text or Multiple
Lines of Text as the Type.
3 Create a SharePoint page, add a qDiscussionView web part, and open ezEdit. In Viewed Lists, select
Discussion.
4 From the qDiscussionView drop-down menu, select Create Complex Category Index List.
The New Category dialog box opens.
5 Enter a Complex Category Index Site URL and List Name.
The List Name defaults to discussion board list name plus Categories. For example, the default list name
is Discussion Categories.
6Open ezEdit of the qDiscussionView web part.
a From Display Fields, select Edit next to "Category" created in step 2.
bSelect Is Complex Category check box.
c Enter a Complex Category Index Site URL and Complex Category Index List Name. This name must
the same as the list name entered in Step 5 (in our example, Discussion Categories).
7 Replace SharePoint's out-of-the-box web parts on the NewItem, EditItem, and ViewItem pages with
qListForm web parts.
You must replace the out-of-the-box web part with the qListForm to use the Complex Category
Discussion feature in qListForm.
NOTE: Refer to the SharePoint documentation on how to create a column and discussion
board list.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 118
www.agreeya.com
a Hide out-of-the box web parts. From the web part drop-down, select Edit Web Part. From the
Layout section, select the Hidden check box.
b Add a qListForm web part. Open ezEdit.
c For Form Type, select NewListItem to replace Default New Form from the out-of-the-box web
part.
d Create two more qListForm web parts. Open ezEdit. For Form Type, select:
DisplayListItem to replace Default Display Form from the out-of-the-box web part
EditListItem to replace Default Edit Form from the out-of-the-box web part
8 In each qListForm web part:
aSelect Edit from Display Fields and select Edit next to Category (created in step 2).
bSelect Complex Category as the Field Type. Enter a Complex Category Index Site URL and List
Name. This name must the same as the list name entered in Step 5 (in our example, Discussion
Categories).
You can now use qListForm to view, edit, and update complex categories and view discussion
threads grouped by complex categories.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
7
119
www.agreeya.com
qDynamicLayout
Overview
qDynamicLayout Pages
qDynamicLayout Procedures
Overview
The qDynamicLayout Web Part allows you to create a customized layout by placing multiple Web Parts and HTML
elements on one page. This helps you manage page space more effectively.
qDynamicLayout Pages
You can configure this Web Part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qDynamicLayout contains
the following pages:
Content Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
When you open ezEdit in qDynamicLayout, the Primary Content page opens by default, and contains the
following editable sections:
Primary Content
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part, or accept the default. This field is
mandatory.
Layout See Layout on page 120.
View Settings See View Setting on page 120.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 120
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Tab Layout allows you to pick where to add the tabs and what the tabs should be named.
The following are elements found in the Layout section.
View Setting
The View Setting section allows you to select in what tabs the Web Parts should appear and in which order.
The following are elements found in the View Settings section.
Table 2. Layout
Element Description
Advanced Mode Allows you to edit Layout in XML format:
<FormLayout Type="Tab" Orientation="HorizontalTop">
<Container ID="Test" Label="DiscussionView" Description="" />
</FormLayout>
ID Allows you to give an ID to each tab
The IDs can contain letters ([A-Z, a-z]), digits ([0-9]), hyphens ("-"), and underscores
("_") only.
Label Allows you to name each tab
Description Allows you to add a description to each tab, if necessary
Show User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the web part. Separate
groups with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
Hide User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the web part.
Separate site group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If users are defined in Show User Groups and Hide User Groups, Hide Groups takes
precedence.
Default Allows you to define the default tab for qDynamicLayout. If this element is not
specified, the first tab listed in the Layout becomes the default tab. If the tab for the
specified element is hidden, then the first non-hidden tab becomes the default tab.
Table 3. View Setting
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit View Settings in XML format:
<ViewSetting>
<Content Type="WebPart" ContainerID="1">
<WebPart ID="g_59f7fda1_4405_45c8_bba0_f354db68bab8" Type="DiscussionView"
ClientId="MSOZoneCell_WebPartWPQ18" />
</Content>
</ViewSetting>
Web Part Title Indicates the name the Web Part to be added
Web Part Type Indicates the type of Web Part to be added
Container If you have more than one qDynamicLayout Web Part, the Container indicates if a Web
Part is already part of another qDynamicLayout Web Part and the name of that
qDynamicLayout Web Part. You cannot configure these Web Parts from another
qDynamicLayout Web Part. You can configure only those Web Parts that are contained in
the qDynamicLayout you are editing.
Tab ID Allows you to select the tab where to add the Web Part. The Tab ID appears when you
configure the IDs in the Layout section
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 121
www.agreeya.com
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Skin
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Skin
The Skin page allows you to configure the appearance of the web part.
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Table 4. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 5. Skin
Element Description
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the Web Part. If you have a custom skin, you can add it
to the following folder:
for SharePoint 2010: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins
for SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins
for SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install directory.
Table 6. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 122
www.agreeya.com
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Table 7. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 8. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 123
www.agreeya.com
qDynamicLayout Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qDynamicLayout:
Configuring qDynamicLayout
Configuring qDynamicLayout
If a Web Part is hidden or closed, you cannot add it to qDynamicLayout.
If you delete qDynamicLayout, only the qDynamicLayout container is deleted, the Web Parts contained within it
are not.
You cannot configure the View Settings section until you have added a Web Part to a tab in qDynamicLayout.
To configure qDynamicLayout
1 Add the qDynamicLayout Web Part to your page.
2Open ezEdit.
The Primary Content page opens by default.
3 Configure each element as needed and click OK.
4 If needed, configure the elements in the other tabs.
5 When done configuring each tab, click OK.
You do not have to add a Web Part to a tab right away. You can add one later or add more Web Parts to the same
tab.
To add a Web Part later or add more Web Parts to the same tab
1 From Site Actions, select Edit Page.
2Select Add a Web Part.
3 Select a Web Part and click Add.
4 From qDynamicLayout Web Part, select ezEdit.
5 From View Settings section, select Edit.
6 Select the Web Part you just added.
7 Select the Tab ID for the Web Part.
8Click OK.
To configure a Web Part within a qDynamicLayout Web Part
1 From Site Actions, select Edit Page.
2 From qDynamicLayout Web Part, select a tab.
3From the tab, select ezEdit.
4 Configure and save the Web Part.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
8
124
www.agreeya.com
qExcelViewer
Overview
qExcelViewer Pages
qExcelViewer Procedures
Overview
qExcelViewer lets you view data in Microsoft Excel. The Excel viewer works in conjunction with the qListView.
qExcelViewer Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qExcelViewer contains the
following tabs:
Content Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part, or accept the default. This field is
mandatory.
Session Name Allows you to enter the name of the Session variable where the Excel Viewer expects
to find all the information that has been set by a qListView. This name must match the
Search Session Name in qListView.
Show Header Allows you to show the column name in the first row.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 125
www.agreeya.com
Display Fields
This property defines the fields that should be displayed in the Excel spreadsheet.
This property is optional if the properties in the Custom Display section are specified. In that case, the default
display for the search results is turned off and the custom display is used. You can also combine a custom display
with the Display Fields; for example, if you want to display the data in the grid and to provide the summary of
the data or disclaimer using the custom display.
The Display Fields section contains the following:
Display Fields See Display Fields on page 125.
Child View Display
Fields Defines the fields that should be displayed in the view for the child record. For more
information, see Child View Display Fields on page 129.
Table 2. Display Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Display Fields in XML format:
<Fields LookupThresholdControlSetting=”On”>
<Field Name="fieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<Field Name="fieldName" [optional attributes]/>
</Fields>
Query All Fields Controls how Web Parts behave in relation to the Excel View Lookup Threshold in
SharePoint Resource Throttling. The options are:
Default — uses the level set in the Configuration Editor. If you have selected
Query All Fields check box in the Configuration Editor, the Web Part will query
only those fields that are not included in the Excel View Lookup Threshold. If
the Query All Fields check box is cleared, the Web Part will query all fields.
On — If the Web Part level is On, the Web Part queries all fields in lists, except
Lookup fields.
Off — If the Web Part level is Off, the Web Part queries all fields in lists,
including Lookup fields.
Explicit — If the Web Part level is Explicit, the Web Part queries only those
fields selected in the Display Fields. This option renders the best performance
for your Web Part.
Title Allows you to set the title for the field header. This is useful if the real field name is
too long and you want to abbreviate the title in the field header, or if you simply want
to display a different title in the field header. If this attribute is not specified, the
value specified in the Name attribute is used in the field header.
Align Allows you to set the alignment for the field.
Display Field
Name Allows you to specify the name of a field in the cross-site list. You only specify this if
the field that you are trying to display is a cross-site lookup field.
If you want to display multiple fields from the cross-site lookup field, use the Display
Format.
Display Format Allows you to set the format of the value that is displayed in a cross-site lookup field.
You use this attribute if you want to display values from multiple fields.
NOTE: You can use the field replacement expression <%Field%> to refer to a field. If
you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively, unless you use the Excel Viewer
Editor which will encode it automatically for you.
For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 126
www.agreeya.com
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 3. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 4. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 5. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 127
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the Web
Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 6. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 5. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 128
www.agreeya.com
qExcelViewer Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qExcelViewer:
Configuring qExcelViewer
Configuring qExcelViewer
To configure qExcelViewer
1 Create a new blank page and give it an .aspx extension. This name must appear in the Excel Viewer URL
property of qListView.
2 Add qExcelViewer to your page.
3Open ezEdit.
The Primary Content page opens by default.
4 Enter a session name. This session must be the same as the Search Session Name created in qListView.
5 Select some display fields.
6 When done configuring each tab, click OK.
Table 7. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
NOTE: If you are using Excel 2010, if you have more than 8 outline levels, some rows will be
hidden. To show all data, select all rows and right-click the rows. Select Unhide.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 129
www.agreeya.com
Child View Display Fields
This property defines the fields that should be displayed in the Excel spreadsheet. When you select the Edit
button, a dialog box opens with a list of field names based on the session name which you have saved in
qListView.
The Child View Display Fields section contains the following:
Table 8. Child View Display Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Display Fields in XML format:
<Fields LookupThresholdControlSetting="Default">
<Field Name="Title" InternalName="Title" />
</Fields>
Query All Fields Controls how Web Parts behave in relation to the Excel View Lookup Threshold in
SharePoint Resource Throttling. The options are:
Default — uses the level set in the Configuration Editor. If you have selected
Query All Fields check box in the Configuration Editor, the Web Part will query
only those fields that are not included in the Excel View Lookup Threshold. If
the Query All Fields check box is cleared, the Web Part will query all fields.
On — If the Web Part level is On, the Web Part queries all fields in lists, except
Lookup fields.
Off — If the Web Part level is Off, the Web Part queries all fields in lists,
including Lookup fields.
Explicit — If the Web Part level is Explicit, the Web Part queries only those
fields selected in the Display Fields. This option renders the best performance
for your Web Part.
Title Allows you to set the title for the field header. This is useful if the real field name is
too long and you want to abbreviate the title in the field header, or if you simply want
to display a different title in the field header. If this attribute is not specified, the
value specified in the Name attribute is used in the field header.
Align Indicates the horizontal alignment for the field. The values is one of the following:
left, right, or center. For example:
<Field Name="Created" Align="right" />
Display Field
Name Allows you to specify the name of a field in the cross-site list. You only specify this if
the field that you are trying to display is a cross-site lookup field.
If you want to display multiple fields from the cross-site lookup field, use the Display
Format.
Display Format Allows you to set the format of the value that is displayed in a cross-site lookup field.
You use this attribute if you want to display values from multiple fields.
NOTE: You can use the field replacement expression <%Field%> to refer to a field. If
you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively, unless you use the Excel Viewer
Editor which will encode it automatically for you.
For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
9
130
www.agreeya.com
qHelpLink
Overview
qHelpLink Pages
Overview
qHelpLink provides a context-sensitive help functionality. The help link enables each page to be connected to a
different help file or to no help file (in which case the help link will not be visible). This capability lets the site
administrator or author issue the help files in stages.
The help link information is stored in a SharePoint list. The SharePoint list for the help link should contain:
Context ID This field is mandatory. This is a single line of text that contains the identifier for the help
URL.
Help Url This field is mandatory. This is a single line of text that contains the URL for the help file.
Culture This field is optional. You must have this field if you want to have a different Help URL for
different culture. You can define different Help URLs with the same Caption ID but different Help URL.
You must leave the value for the default culture blank. For example:
If your list uses different names for the fields, you must define the name in the Context ID Field Name, Help Url
Field Name, and Culture Field Name properties.
The Help URL field may contain an absolute or a relative URL.
You can create the source list easily by using the “AgreeYa Help List” under Custom Lists in SharePoint. This will
automatically create a list that contains all of the above fields.
qHelpLink Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qHelpLink contains the
following tabs:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Table 1. Culture
Context ID Culture Help Url
sites.mysite.default.aspx defaultHelp.aspx
sites.mysite.default.aspx id-ID defaultHelp.id-ID.aspx
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 131
www.agreeya.com
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Custom Display
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Custom Display
The Custom Display page contains the following:
Table 2. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Site Url Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current
path, a double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the
root path.
List Name Allows you to set the name of the list. The name is case sensitive. If the name of
the list contains spaces, include the spaces in the List Name.
Context ID Allows you to set the identifier to locate the help URL in the list.
NOTE: Define a convention for the Context ID value that will make it easy for you
to identify where the help URL is used. For example, use the page URL, remove
the host name from the URL, and replace all / (slash) with . (dot). Therefore, if
the page URL is http://hostname/sites/mysite/default.aspx, the Context ID is
sites.mysite.default.aspx
Context ID Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field containing the context ID. The default
value is User Context ID.
Help Url Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field containing the message. The default
value is Help URL.
Culture Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field containing the Culture. The default value
is User Culture.
Help Text Allows you to set the text for the help link. The default value is Help. You can
replace this value with HTML such as <img border="0" title="Help"
src="imageURL"> to display an image instead of text.
Table 3. Custom Display
Element Description
CSS Style Allows you to set the CSS style for the help link. The default value is empty. You
can define this as you would define the styles in a CSS class.
CSS Class Allows you to set the CSS class name for the help link. The class name must be
defined in an external CSS file. If defined, this priority takes precedence over the
CSS Style class.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 132
www.agreeya.com
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Navigation
Navigation
The Navigation page allows you to configure how and where the user will navigate in the web part. It contains
the following elements:
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Table 4. Navigation
Element Description
Target Allows you to define how the help file should be displayed. The default value is
_blank, which means the help file opens in a new window. Another alternative
is the name of a frame or another window.
Table 5. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 6. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 133
www.agreeya.com
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Table 7. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 8. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 134
www.agreeya.com
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 9. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
10
135
www.agreeya.com
qItemDisplay
Overview
qItemDisplay Pages
Overview
qItemDisplay displays the item that was put into a session variable by another web part, such as qListView or
qListForm. If you want to select something from a large list, you can use a combination of qItemDisplay and
qListView. qListView is used to select the item and qItemDisplay is used to display the item after it is selected.
Because qItemDisplay is a row provider, you can use this web part to pass the selected item to qListForm to be
consumed or to a qListView to filter the data.
qItemDisplay supports multiple languages, and Dynamic language switching and Flash and JavaScript (HTML5).
You can define different a Title for different languages using the Resource List and the Title Resource ID
properties.
qItemDisplay Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qHelpLink contains the
following tabs:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Custom Display
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 136
www.agreeya.com
Custom Display
The Custom Display page contains the following:
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to add a title to the web part.
Session Name Allows you to set the name of the session variable where qItemDisplay retrieves
the selected item information. This name must be set to the same value as the
name specified in the:
Set Session Name attribute in the Viewed Lists property of the qListView if
you use the listview to select the item.
Set Session Name property of the qListForm if you use the List Form to put
the item into the session
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The
URL can be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This
attribute is mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current
path, a double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the
root path.
List Name Allows you to set the name of the SharePoint list. The list name is case sensitive.
If the list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as well.
To denote the current list, you can use a single dot (.) as the list name.
Display Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field that you want to display in the selector.
The field name is case sensitive.
If you want to display information from multiple fields, use the Display Format
properties. The Display Field Name property is ignored if the Display Format
property is defined.
Display Format Allows you to configure the format of the items that are displayed. This property
can contain a plain text value or a piece of HTML. You can use a field
replacement expression (<%field name %>) to refer to a field name. For example,
you can display Employee ID and Employee Name as follows:
<strong>Employee ID</strong>: <%Employee ID %><br>
<strong>Employee Name</strong>: <%Employee Name%>
The item is displayed as:
Employee ID: 1001
Employee Name: John Smith
For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
No Selected Item
Message Allows you to set the message that is displayed if the qItemDisplay does not find
the selected item information in the session variable. The default value is No
Item Selected.
Table 2. Custom Display
Element Description
Style Allows you to set the CSS style for the help link. The default value is empty. You
can define this as you would define the styles in a CSS class.
CSS Class Allows you to set the CSS class name for the help link. The class name must be
defined in an external CSS file. If defined, this priority takes precedence over the
CSS Style class.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 137
www.agreeya.com
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Navigation
Navigation
The Navigation page allows you to configure how and where the user will navigate in the web part. It contains
the following elements:
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Toolbar
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
To o l b a r
The Toolbar page allows you to configure the appearance of the toolbar. It contains the following:
Table 3. Navigation
Element Description
No Selected Item
Redirect URL If specified, the user will be redirected to this URL if the qItemDisplay does not
find the selected item information in the Session. The page specified by this
URL usually contains the Web Part to select the item.
Table 4. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 138
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 5. Toolbar
Element Description
Toolbar Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the toolbar.
Change Value Button Text Allows you to change the selected item that is displayed in qItemDisplay.
Because qItemDisplay is read-only, the user must go to another page to change
the value. That other page usually contains another web part, such as
qListView. The Selected Item Display provides a button in the toolbar to
redirect the user to the Change Value page. This property defines the text for
that button. The default value is Change Value. You may want to change this
value to something else, for example, Change Selected Project, or Change
Selected Customer.
Change Value Button Icon URL Allows you to define the URL for the icon for the Change Value button. This
property is optional if you do not want to have an icon on the button.
Change Value Button URL Allows you to define the URL for the change value page. If this property is not
defined, the Change Value button will not be displayed.
NOTE: NOTE: This value is usually the same as the value in the No Selected
Item Redirect URL.
Table 6. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 7. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 139
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 8. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 7. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 140
www.agreeya.com
Table 9. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
11
141
www.agreeya.com
qListForm
Overview
Configuration Wizard
qListForm Pages
qListForm Procedures
Overview
The qListForm replaces the Microsoft List Form web part. qListForm provides many features to create
relationships among lists. The only native SharePoint capability that creates relationships between two lists is
the lookup field. However, the lookup field can only see one field from a list that resides in the same
workspace. This limits your ability to create a sophisticated application across several workspaces.
With qListForm, you have the ability to:
support different content type in the list
support dynamic language switching and Flash and JavaScript (HTML5)
place the List Form in any page, including list-supporting forms, such as DispForm.aspx, EditForm.aspx,
NewForm.aspx, and Upload.aspx.
create, update, or display an item from lists in another site. The target list is defined using Site URL and
List Name properties.
define a custom toolbar button. You can associate the custom toolbar button with one or more actions.
The list form has some pre-defined actions, such as Save, Delete, Copy or Move. You can also write your
own custom action and hook it up with the list form.
use various form types: DisplayListItem, NewListItem, EditListItem, DisplayDocument, UploadDocument,
CreateDocument and EditDocument. This is defined in the Form Type property.
filter a lookup/cross-site lookup field with another lookup/cross-site lookup field using the master-detail
capability
insert an image, upload documents, and do a spell-check using the Rich Text Editor.
customize the Rich Text Editor’s toolbar using Rich Text Editor Toolbar Settings.
create collapsible sections in the Rich Text Editor. For more information, see Creating and Editing
Collapsible Sections on page 188.
show or hide user fields based on the SharePoint group membership of the user.
define whether to hide, show, enable, or disable a field, a group of fields or a tab/panel in the list form
based on the condition of the fields.
create a new document and define the metadata for the new document, and enter the metadata for
multiple file uploads.
redirect users after saving information: GoToNextPageUrl, GoToSource and TrySourceThenNextPageUrl.
define a different URL for the Save and Close button, Cancel button and the Edit Item button.
create a new record or update records in dependent lists.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 142
www.agreeya.com
add child list and create a relationship between parent and child list.
ensure the referential integrity of the records in the dependent lists by preventing the deletion of the
parent record.
manage attachments in the List Form if the target list is attachment-enabled.
add new lookup item
add user from people picker control
insert an image as an attachment to the list item using the Image Manager toolbar button.
define a mask for the input. Enforcing the format increases the consistency and data correctness.
create a description for each field in plain text or HTML.
define a new title for the field.
add rating for an item.
assign a fixed value to a field, and assign a formatted value to a field based on values in other fields.
fill the value of a field from a value stored in the Session variable.
create a cross-site lookup field. A cross-site lookup field is similar to the SharePoint lookup field, except
it can look up multiple lists in any workspaces that are accessible from the current site by the current
user.
sort entries in the cross-site lookup field.
auto-fill a field based on value of a field that belongs to a parent field. The parent field can be a lookup
field or a cross-site lookup field. This feature ensures data consistency and correctness when the value
from the parent field is replicated in the target field.
hide a field. A hidden field is processed during postback, but it will not be displayed.
create a read only field.
store the displayed, new, or updated items into the Session. This feature enables a List Form to
communicate with another web part, such as qSelector in another page.
display the options for multi-choice fields in multiple columns.
define a CAPTCHA field thereby enhancing the authenticity of entered data.
send an email while editing or creating an item using the List Form Emailer.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 143
www.agreeya.com
The List Form Emailer requires you to put the MailSettings configuration in the web.config file. You have
to do this because the List Form Emailer does not use the SharePoint email capability due to its
limitation of sending a maximum of 1000 characters.
Configuration Wizard
qListForm uses a configuration wizard to walk you through basic configuration tasks. For more information on
using the Configuration Wizard, see Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard on page 187.
User Permissions
In order for qListForm to work, the user must have a minimum set of permissions in their permission level.
NOTE: The List Form Emailer requires you to put the MailSettings configuration in the web.config
file. You have to do this because the List Form Emailer does not use the SharePoint email capability
due to its limitation of sending a maximum of 1000 characters. The MailSettings configuration looks
like the following (you only have to add the lines with bold font):
<configuration>
<configSections>
<sectionGroup name="QuestSoftware">
<section name="MailSettings" type="System.Configuration.SingleTagSectionHandler,
System, Version=1.0.5000.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089" />
</sectionGroup>
</configSections>
<QuestSoftware>
<MailSettings OutboundSmtpServer="Smtp server name or IP address"/>
</QuestSoftware>
</configuration>
use IRowConsumer and IWebPartRow interfaces to auto-fill a certain field based on field in a
consumed row.
NOTE: The IRowConsumer interface is obsolete. It is provided here only for backward compatibility
reason. When you establish the web part connection, this interface is labeled Consume Row From
(Obsolete) in the web part Connections menu. Use the IWebPartRow consumer implementation that
is labeled with Get Row From.
The IWebPartRow consumer implementation is labeled with Get Row From in the web part
Connection menu. This interface cannot be connected with the obsolete IRowProvider
implementation. Do not connect this new interface with the old interface that is marked obsolete.
use IRowProvider and IWebPartRow interfaces to provide a row to another web part, such as
qListForm or qSelector.
NOTE: The IWebPartRow implementation is labeled with Send Row To in the web part Connection
menu. This interface cannot be connected with the obsolete IRowConsumer or IFilterConsumer
implementation. Do not connect this new interface with the old interface that is marked obsolete.
The IRowProvider interface is obsolete. It is provided here only for backward compatibility reason.
When you establish the web part connection, this interface is labeled Consume Row From
(Obsolete) in the web part Connections menu. Use the IWebPartRow consumer implementation that
is labeled with Send Row To.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 144
www.agreeya.com
If you do not meet the above minimum requirements, you will see "Access is denied" message either when the
list form is loaded or when it is saved.
qListForm Pages
You can configure this web part through its pages that are accessible through ezEdit. qListForm contains the
following pages:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
System Integration
Optional Content
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Table 1. User Permissions
Form Type Minimum set of permissions
NewListItem Item, Edit Items, View Items, View Pages, Browse User Information, Open
UploadDocument Add Item, Edit Items, View Items, View Application Pages, View Pages, Browse User
Information, Open
EditListItem Items, View Items, View Pages, Browse User Information, Open
EditDocument Items, View Items, View Application Pages, View Pages, Browse User Information, Open
DisplayListItem View Items, View Pages, Open
DisplayDocument View Items, View Application Pages, View Pages, Open
CreateDocument Add Item, Edit Items, View Items, View Application Pages, View Pages, Browse User
Information, Open
Table 2. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part, or accept the default. This field is mandatory.
List Name Allows you to select a SharePoint list or document library that is edited or displayed by this List
Form. For more information, see List Name on page 189.
Child List Allows you to select child list. For more information, see Child List on page 189.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 145
www.agreeya.com
Form Type Allows you to choose one of the following:
DisplayListItem — The form is used to display a list item (all fields are read-only).
NewListItem — The form is used to create a new item in the list.
EditListItem — The form is used to edit a list item.
DisplayDocument — The form is used to display a document metadata.
UploadDocument — The form is used to upload a document into a document library.
EditDocument — The form is used to modify a document metadata.
CreateDocument — The form is used to create a new document in the document library in
a similar manner as the NewListItem except it will display the "File Name" field as the
first field in the form. When you click the Save and Close button, a document is created
and the metadata specified in the form is applied to the new document. After the
document is created, the qListForm will append EditDoc=1 HTTP parameter to the URL
where the user is redirected to. If the redirected page contains a qListForm, it will open
up the newly created document. The target folder of the new document is specified by
the RootFolder HTTP parameter in the URL. If the RootFolder is not specified, the
document is created in the root folder of the document library. The qListForm
determines which template is used to create the new document using one of the
following methods:
By using the document template specified in the content type. The content type is specified by
the ContentTypeId HTTP parameter in the URL. If the ContentTypeId is not specified, the default
content type is used by the list form.
The user can select a document template from a document library. The 2 properties of the list
form, Template List Site URL and Template List Name, specify the Site URL and List Name of the
doc library that contains the document template. When both are specified, the qListForm will
display a drop-down menu above the Field Name field that contains list of documents in that doc
library. The user can then select a document that will serve as a template for the new
document.
When this property is set to DisplayListItem, EditListItem, DisplayDocument, or EditDocument,
the URL of the current page must contain an ID HTTP parameter to indicate the identifier of the
item to be displayed or edited. The ID HTTP parameters are usually included by the List Form
when you click New Item in its toolbar or View Properties or Edit Properties in its context menu.
Form Layout For more information, see Form Layout on page 146.
Display
Fields For more information, see Display Fields on page 155.
NOTE: Use the Related Items check box if you want to display the child list along with parent
list.
Child List
Display
Fields
Defines the fields that should be displayed in the view for the child records. For more
information, see Child List Display Fields on page 190.
Table 2. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 146
www.agreeya.com
Form Layout
This property enables you to define the layout of the fields in the List Form. If this property is not defined, the
List Form will display the fields in two column format: the first column is the field title and the second column
is the control for the field.
This property is related to the Display Fields property. The Form Layout property defines the layout type and
the containers. In order to place a certain field in a specific container, you will use the Tab/Panel/Container ID
attribute of the Field element in the Display Fields property.
The Form Layout element can contain zero or more Container elements. You may not have to define any
container for a certain type of layout manager. Some custom layout manager may have a fixed set of containers
that do not need to be defined.
The Form Layout section contains the following:
Relationship
Mapping For more information, see Relationship Mapping on page 191.
ID HTTP
Parameter
Name
Allows the qListForm and several other web parts to an HTTP Parameter called ID to identify the
item to be displayed or edited. This HTTP Parameter is usually generated automatically by the
viewer web part, such as qListForm or qCalendarView, when you select an item to be displayed
or edited.
NOTE: If qListForm is placed on a web part page that is contained within a document library, the
page will generate an error if the value of the ID HTTP Parameter is bigger than the number of
pages within the document library. To prevent this error from happening, rename the ID HTTP
Parameter.
By default, the value of this property is "ID". You can change the value of this property to
something else, such as LID. In that case, when you select "View Properties" or "Edit Properties"
in the context menu, the URL of the display or edit form becomes:
http://mysite.com/EditFormURL.aspx?LID=xxx
Set the same property in the qListForm to the same value.
Table 2. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 147
www.agreeya.com
Table 3. Form Layout
Form Layout
type Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Form Layout in XML format:
<FormLayout Type="TabLayout">
<Container Type="containerType" ID="containerID1" Label="tabText1"
ShowUserGroups="group1,group2" HideUserGroups="group3,group4">
<Container Type="containerType" ID="containerID2" Label="tabText2"
ShowUserGroups="group3,group4" HideUserGroups="group1,group2">
</FormLayout>
Tab Layout Groups the fields in multiple tabs. You can add tabs to this layout by setting values for the
following:
ID — the identifier for the tab. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Label — the label for the container. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will
use the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the container is shown if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the container is hidden if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will
take precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in
the HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
Panel Layout Groups the fields in multiple panels. You can add panels to this layout by setting values for
the following:
ID — the identifier for the panel. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Label — the label for the container. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will
use the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the container is shown if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the container is hidden if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will
take precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in
the HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 148
www.agreeya.com
Custom Layout Uses the custom layout manager class specified in the LayoutManagerClassName attribute
to layout the fields. Using the custom layout, you can write your own custom Layout
Manager where you can layout the fields in any way you want it or even create your own
custom controls in the form. For more detail on how to write your own custom Layout
Manager class, see System Integration on page 164.
You can add containers to this layout by setting values for the following:
ID — the identifier for the tab. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Type — they type of container.
Label — the label for the container. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will
use the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the container is shown if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the container is hidden if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will
take precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in
the HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
MultiColumn
Layout Displays the data in multiple columns. You can select the number of columns, and select if
you want to render and control in a single row (displays the Label/Input control on the
same row. If not selected, the Label/Input control is on separate row. Being on the separate
row gives more screen real estate to render multiple columns. If this is selected, column
span and row span attributes are applied to grouped field.)
Table 3. Form Layout
Form Layout
type Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 149
www.agreeya.com
Custom Layout
The Custom Layout capability enables you to write your own Layout Manager for the qListForm or qSIListForm.
This document explains the programming interface for writing the custom Layout Manager and how to deploy
your custom Layout Manager into the server.
Layout Manager
A Layout Manager is a part of the list form that determines the layout of the controls on the form. The type of
the layout for your form is specified in the Form Layout property. Out of the box, the list form provides two
layout managers:
Tab and
MultiColumn
Layout
Groups the fields in multiple tabs and in multiple columns in each tab.
You can add tabs to this layout by setting values for the following:
ID — the identifier for the tab. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Label — the label for the tab. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will use
the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the tab is shown if the current user is a member of at least one
of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group names
here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the tab is hidden if the current user is a member of at least one
of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group names
here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will take
precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in the
HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
Render and Control in a single row — the tab displays the Label/Input control on the
same row. If not selected, the Label/Input control is on separate row. Being on the
separate row gives more screen real estate to render multiple columns. If this is
selected, column span and row span attributes are applied to grouped field.
Panel and
MultiColumn
Layout
Groups the fields in multiple panels and in multiple columns in each panel.
You can add panels to this layout by setting values for the following:
ID — the identifier for the panel. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Label — the label for the panel. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will use
the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the panel is shown if the current user is a member of at least one
of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group names
here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the panel is hidden if the current user is a member of at least one
of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group names
here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will take
precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in the
HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
Render and Control in a single row — the panel displays the Label/Input control on
the same row. If not selected, the Label/Input control is on separate row. Being on
the separate row gives more screen real estate to render multiple columns. If this is
selected, column span and row span attributes are applied to grouped field.
Table 3. Form Layout
Form Layout
type Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 150
www.agreeya.com
You can create your own Layout Manager:
When you want to layout the controls in a way that is not provided by the out of the box layout
managers. For example, grouping the controls in different sections and having multiple sections in the
same row.
When you want to create a custom control for one or more fields in the form. For example, in Figure 1,
the table at the bottom of the form is a custom control created by the custom layout manager. This table
contains the list of opening hours for a restaurant for every day during the week.
Figure 1. Creating a custom control
You can create your own custom Layout Manager class or use the sample custom Layout Manager class that is
shipped with QuickApps for SharePoint.
To open the sample code
1Select Start | All Programs | AgreeYa | QuickApps for SharePoint | Sample Code.
The Sample Code folder opens in Windows Explorer.
2Double-click SampleCode.sln.
This opens the solution in Microsoft Visual Studio. The sample custom Layout Manager class can be found
in SampleLayoutManager.cs file in the SampleCustomActionsAndCustomLayouts project.
Custom Layout Manager Class
If you want to write your own custom Layout Manager class, ensure the following:
A Class Library project is created using Microsoft Visual Studio
Table 4. Layout Manager
Layout manager Description
Default Layout Manger Is used if the Form Layout property of the list form is blank. The default layout
manager lays out the controls vertically in two columns: the first column is the
field title and the second column is the control for the field.
Tab Layout Manager Enables you to group your fields into multiple tabs. You can use the Tab layout
manager by specifying TabLayout in the Type attribute of the FormLayout
element in the Form Layout property.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 151
www.agreeya.com
Microsoft SharePoint Server is installed and running properly
QuickApps for SharePoint is installed and running properly in your SharePoint environment
You have a strong name key file to sign your assembly
Programming Interface
Your custom Layout Manager classes must be derived from WA.Core.LayoutManager.FormLayoutManager class.
This class is located in WA.Core.DLL that is installed in the Global Assembly Cache (GAC) when you install the
QuickApps for SharePoint.
Properties
The following are the properties of the WA.Core.LayoutManager.FormLayoutManager class:
Methods
The following are the methods of the WA.Core.LayoutManager.FormLayoutManager class.
Table 5. WA.Core.LayoutManager.FormLayoutManger class properties
Property Description
FormType indicates the type of list form that contains the layout manager class. The type of this
property is FormTypeEnum enumeration and the options are New, Edit or Display. This
property is useful when you create custom controls in your layout manager. For example,
when the FormType is Display, you may want to make your custom control read only.
WebPart references the parent web part, which is either a qListForm or a qSIListForm.
FormItem references the item that is being created, edited, or displayed in the form. The type of
this property is System.Object. The real type of the FormItem depends on whether the
Layout Manager is used in the qListForm or qSIListForm. The qListForm will assign a
Microsoft.SharePoint.SPListItem object to the FormItem property. The qSIListForm will
assign a System.Collections.Hashtable object to the FormItem property. The Hashtable
contains a key value pair of field name and field value. You can use the FormItem to get
the values of the fields to populate your custom controls and to save the value from your
custom controls back to the form.
FormLayout indicates an XML string that is entered in the Form Layout property of the qListForm or
qSIListForm. You can use this information to find out about the containers that are
specified for your layout manager.
ClientSide
ValidationError
Handler
indicates a read only property to get the name of the Javascript function that is called in
the validation error in the client side, such as a required field that is empty, number field
outside a specific range. You do this only if you need special handling such as showing the
control with the validation error. For example, the Tab layout manager groups fields in
different tabs. The field with the validation error maybe located in the tab that is not
currently shown. In that case, the Tab layout manager needs to show the tab that
contains the field with the validation error.
NOTE: Your layout manager class can override this property.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 152
www.agreeya.com
Table 6. WA.Core.LayoutManager.FormLayoutManager class methods
Method Description
public abstract void
AddControlToContainer(System.
Web.UI.Control control, string
containerID, string
fieldDisplayName, string
fieldInternalName, Guid fieldID,
string fieldDescription, bool
isFieldRequired, bool
isControlHidden)
Is called by the list form during initialization phase (in the OnInit method).
The list form will create controls for the fields specified in the Display
Fields property and then call this method to add the control to the layout
manager. Your layout manager class must override this method. The
following are the parameters for this method:
control – the control to be added
containerID – the ID of the container where this control should be
added. The containerID for the field is specified in the Display
Fields property of the list form. If not specified, the containerID is
NULL.
fieldDisplayName – the display name of the field that owns this
control. For qListForm, this means the display name for the
SharePoint field, which is usually different than the internal name
of the field.
fieldInternalName – the internal name of the field that owns this
control. For qListForm, this means the internal name for the
SharePoint field, which is usually different than the display name
of the field. For example, the internal name of the “Assigned To”
field may be “Assigned _x0020_To”. For qSIListForm, the
fieldDisplayName and the fieldInternalName are the same.
fieldID – the unique identifier for the field. This is a good candidate
to use as a unique key to keep track of your fields. For example,
when the list form needs to hide the controls for certain fields by
using the HideControl method, it will use the fieldID as parameter.
fieldDescription – the description for the field. This is the field
description that is specified by the user in the Display Fields
property of the list form. It’s up to you on how you want to display
it in your layout manager. One option is to display the description
underneath the control. If not specified, the fieldDescription is
NULL.
isFieldRequired – a boolean flag to indicate whether or not this is
required field. You may want to put some visual indicator for
required fields such as a ‘*’ in the field title.
isControlHidden – a boolean field to indicate whether or not the
control for the field should be hidden. The user can mark a certain
field as a hidden field in the Display Fields property. If a field is
hidden, you still have to add the control into the control hierarchy
but you need to hide it in a certain way. For example, you can set
the style’s Display attribute to None.
public abstract void
AddMessageToContainer(string
message, string containerID)
Is called if the list form needs to display a certain message on the form.
For example, if the Email Notification Section in the qListForm is enabled,
the qListForm will call this method to generate this message: "If you want
to send an email notification, please complete the following information.”
The email is sent if you enter one or more email addresses in the To field.
You need to display the message in the layout manager when this method
is called.
public abstract void
HideControl(Guid fieldID) Is called if the list form needs to hide a certain control. For example,
when the qListForm is editing a Calendar item, the Start Time and End
Time fields needs to be hidden when the user checks the All Day Event and
Recurrence fields. You must implement this method for your layout
manager to support the Form Component Behavior property of the list
form.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 153
www.agreeya.com
Debugging
In order to debug the code, generate the debug version of the DLL and copy the DLL and PDB file into the bin
folder under the root folder of your SharePoint application. If you cannot find the bin folder, you can create
one. Sign your assembly with a strong name key file.
Physical Path
To find the physical path of the root folder of your SharePoint application
1Select Start | Control Panel | Administrative Tools | Internet Information Services (IIS) Manager.
2 Expand the node with your computer name.
3 Expand the Web Sites folder.
public abstract void
ShowControl(Guid fieldID) Is called if the list form needs to show a certain control. For example,
when the qListForm is editing a Calendar item, the Start Time and End
Time fields needs to be shown when the user unchecks either the All Day
Event or Recurrence fields. You must implement this method for your
layout manager to support the Form Component Behavior property of the
list form.
public virtual void
EnableControl(Guid fieldID) Is called if the list form needs to enable a certain control. You must
implement this method for your layout manager to support the Form
Component Behavior property of the list form.
public virtual void
DisableControl(Guid fieldID) Is called if the list form needs to disable a certain control. You must
implement this method for your layout manager to support the Form
Component Behavior property of the list form.
public virtual void
ShowContainer(Guid fieldID) Is called if the list form needs to show a certain container in your layout
manager. You must implement this method for your layout manager to
fully support the Form Component Behavior property of the list form.
public virtual void
HideContainer(Guid fieldID) You layout manager class may override this method. The list form will call
this method if it needs to hide a certain container in your layout manager.
You must implement this method for your layout manager to fully support
the Form Component Behavior property of the list form.
public virtual void
EnableContainer(Guid fieldID) Is called if the list form needs to enable a certain container in your layout
manager. You must implement this method for your layout manager to
fully support the Form Component Behavior property of the list form.
public virtual void
DisableContainer(Guid fieldID) Is called if the list form needs to disable a certain container in your layout
manager. You must implement this method for your layout manager to
fully support the Form Component Behavior property of the list form.
public virtual void
PopulateFormControls() Overridden if this method creates custom controls for certain fields. You
must create the custom controls already in the OnInit method. The list
form will call this method during pre-render phase and you can use the
FormItem property to get the values for the fields and populate your
custom controls. You do not have to populate the controls that are
created by the list form and added by the AddControlToContainer method.
Those controls is populated by the list form.
public virtual void
SaveValuesToFormItem() Overridden if this method creates custom controls for certain fields. The
list form will call this method after the user clicks the save button in the
form. You must write back the value from your custom controls to the
FormItem so that the list form can save the value back to SharePoint or
your external system.
NOTE: You can set the output folder of your project to the bin folder of your SharePoint application.
Therefore, the DLL and PDB files are automatically updated every time you compile your application.
Table 6. WA.Core.LayoutManager.FormLayoutManager class methods
Method Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 154
www.agreeya.com
4 Find the node that represents your site. The SharePoint site should contain _layouts, _vti_bin and
_wpresources underneath it.
5 Right-click the node and select Properties.
6Select Home Directory tab.
The value in the Local path tells you the physical path of your root folder.
Trust Level
Once you generate the debug version, you should change the trust level for your web application to Full while
debugging the custom Layout Manager class. The trust level is specified in the web.config. Find the trust
element in your web.config and change the level to Full.
<trust level="Full" originUrl="" />
Using the Custom Layout Manager Class
In order to use your custom Layout Manager class, you should refer to it in the Form Layout property of the
qListForm or qSIListForm as follows:
<FormLayout Type="CustomLayout" LayoutManagerClassName="Fully qualified class name
of the custom Layout Manager" />
For example, in order to use the SampleLayoutManager class that comes in the sample code, specify the
following in the Form Layout property:
<FormLayout Type="CustomLayout"
LayoutManagerClassName="MyCompany.DevStudio.SampleLayoutManager,
MyCompany.DevStudio, Version=1.0.0.0, Culture=neutral,
PublicKeyToken=451cac61f7ec4225" />
Constructing the XML
To use the Form Layout property editor to construct the XML
1 Make sure that you have compiled your custom layout manager project and put the resulting DLL into the
bin folder of your SharePoint web application.
2 Create a qSIListForm.
3Select Web Part Menu | Configure from the SI List Form.
4Click Edit on the Form Layout property.
5Select CustomLayout in the Form Layout Type drop-down menu.
6 Select the class name in the drop-down menu under the Layout Manager Class Name.
7Click OK.
Debugging the Code
To debug the code in your custom Layout Manager class
1 Open the SharePoint page that contains the qListForm or qSIListForm that contains the custom Layout
Manager.
2 Open your project's solution using Visual Studio.
3Select Debug | Attach to Process.
4Select w3wp.exe in the process list.
If w3wp.exe is not listed, make sure that you check Show processes in all sessions. You may see more
than one w3wp.exe listed. If you do, select the one with your user name or try it one by one until you
find the process that contains the executable for your code.
NOTE: When you specify the class name in the LayoutManagerClassName attribute in the FormLayout
element, you must use a fully qualified class name.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 155
www.agreeya.com
5Click Attach.
6 Set some breakpoints in your custom action code.
7 Invoke your custom action by clicking the custom toolbar button or the custom context menu that you
configure in qListView or qListForm.
Deploying the Custom Layout Manager Class
When it is ready to deploy the solution, build your custom action project in release mode. Sign the assembly
with a strong name key file. This ensures the assembly created can be deployed into Global Assembly Cache
(GAC).You can deploy your assembly into the GAC by using the gacutil.exe that comes with the .NET Framework
SDK. Here is the command: gacutil /i <DLLName>.
Once the assembly is dropped into the GAC, your class is ready to use.
Display Fields
This property defines what fields should be displayed in the List Form and how the fields are populated.
CAPTCHA — This field contains the security image used for authenticating data that is input in the form
and works for the following form types: NewListItem, EditListItem, UploadDocument, CreateDocument
and EditDocument. If the list contains an existing field that has the name CAPTCHA then this field will
take precedence.
When you select the Edit button, a dialog box opens with a list of field names based on the list you have
selected. You can enter a title and description for each field name.
You can add more details to the field names.
NOTE: In addition to the fields in the list, the listform recognizes the following special field.
Table 7. Display Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Display fields in XML format. For example:
<DisplayFields>
<Fields ContentType="Task">
<Field Name="Title" ConsumeHTTPParameterName="InitTitle" />
</Fields>
</DisplayFields>
Field Name Displays the field name.
Title Allows you to change the displayed title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an
encoded HTML string. Change the displayed title, for example, when the title is too long or
to make the title more descriptive.
Title Resource ID If supporting a multi-lingual site, you may want to display a different Title for the field
depending on the current culture. This property defines the identifier in the Resource List
that is used as the title of the field. The TitleResourceID and the current cultural setting
(identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier is not found, the default Title is used.
Tooltip Allows you to set the text that is displayed in the tooltip when you hover your mouse over
the control for the field in the list form. If you do not specify this attribute, the display
name of the field is used as the tooltip text.
Tooltip Resource
ID If supporting a multi-lingual site, you may want to display a different tooltip for the field
depending on the current culture. This property defines the identifier in the Resource List
that is used as the title of the field. The Tooltip Resource ID and the current cultural setting
(identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier is not found, the default tooltip is used.
Description Allows you to set the field description. It can be a plain string or an encoded HTML string.
The Description is added below the field value.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 156
www.agreeya.com
Description
Resource ID If supporting a multi-lingual site, you may want to display a different description for the
field depending on the current culture. This property defines the identifier in the Resource
List that is used as the title of the field. The Description Resource ID and the current
cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the
string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier is not found, the default
description is used.
Width (in pixels) Allows you to set the width of the control in pixels.
Some controls, such as the Rich Text Editor, have minimum width and it will not honor the
specified width if it is smaller than its minimum width.
Column Span Allows you to set the span of the column.
Row Span Allows you to set the span of the row.
Hidden Allows you to hide the field.If the field is hidden, the List Form will not modify that field at
all. If you hide the field using the Hidden attribute, the field is processed according to the
way it is defined, but it will not be shown in the List Form.
Group Name Allows you to create dynamic behavior for a group of fields. The list form can be defined to
have dynamic behavior where certain fields or group of fields can be hidden, shown,
disabled, or enabled based on certain conditions. The value in the Group Name field is
referred to in the Form Component Behavior property.
Column Count Allows you to define the number of columns that the choices for the multi-choice field
should be broken into. This is useful if you have many choices in your multi-choice field to
minimize the vertical scrolling when entering the data into the list form. This attribute is
ignored if the field is not a multi-choice field.
Hide Select and
Unselect All Allows you to hide the Select All and Unselect All links in the multi-choice field control. If
not specified, the Select All and Unselect All links are shown by default. This attribute is
ignored if the field is not a multi-choice field.
Auto Post Back If selected, allows the control to refresh the form when its value changes. This attribute is
applicable for the following field types: Lookup field, Cross-site lookup field, Yes/No and
Choice. This attribute is ignored for other field types. This attribute should be set to true in
the following scenarios:
When a lookup field or cross site lookup field is defined as the Parent Field of
another field.
When a lookup field, cross site lookup field, Yes/No, or choice field is being used in
the conditions of the Form Component Behavior property.
Use People
Editor If selected, allows the qListForm to display the People Editor control for the People and
Group field. With the People Editor control, you can lookup any user in your directory
service. By default, the value is false. If set to false, the qListForm will display the users
from the site user list.
This attribute only effects the People and Group field. It is ignored for any other fields.
There is a known issue in the SharePoint People Editor control where it cannot persist its
value during AJAX operation. Therefore, you need to set Enable AJAX property to false
when you use the People Editor control and have an auto-postback lookup field in the form.
Use Current User
as Default Value If selected, allows the name of the current user to become the default value of the People
and Group field when the Form Type is set to New List Item or Upload Document. This
attribute is ignored if the Form Type property is set to another value or when the field is
not a People and Group field. By default, the value is false.
Do not Render as
Hyperlink This attribute affects the display of the Person or Group field, the lookup field or the cross-
site lookup field when the Form Type is set to Display List Item or Display Document. If set
to true, the value of those kinds of field is rendered as plain text instead of hyperlink.
Disable Resize This attribute determines whether or not the Rich Text Editor for the Rich Text Field can be
resized. To resize a Rich Text Editor, you can drag the resize handle in the lower right hand
corner of the editor. The resize handle is hidden when this attribute is set to true.
Table 7. Display Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 157
www.agreeya.com
Fixed Value
You can assign a fixed value to a field using the FixedValue attribute.
Expand Options
on Load Allows you to expand the list of users or options when selected.
Show User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the web part. Separate
groups with commas.
Hide User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the web part. Separate
site group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If users are defined in Show User Groups and Hide User Groups, Hide Groups takes
precedence.
Mask Allows you to define the format of the input for a single line of text field. This property is
ignored for another field type. The mask can contain characters and input-mask-flags such
as:
# — digit or space, optional. If this position is blank in the mask, it is rendered as a prompt
character.
L — uppercase letter, optional. Restricts input to the ASCII letters A-Z.
l (lower case L) — lowercase letter, optional. Restricts input to the ASCII letters a-z.
a — accepts any character
<n..m> — restricts the user input to the declared numeric range, for example: <0..255>.
The numeric range mask part must occupy multiple characters of the mask.
<option1|option2|option3> — restricts user input to one of the set options, for example:
<Sun|Mon|Tue|Wed|Thu|Fri|Sat>.
\ — escapes a mask character, turning it into a literal. "\\" is the escape sequence for a
backslash.
All other characters — all non mask elements will appear as themselves. Literals always
occupy a static position in the mask at run time, and cannot be moved or deleted by the
user.
Prompt
Character Allows you to define the character that is displayed and saved in place of the empty
characters when you specify a Mask. If not specified, "_" (underscore) is used as the default
prompt character. Specify only a single character in this attribute.
Parent Field Allows you to define another lookup or cross-site lookup field that is used to filter this
field. The parent field must be listed before this field in the XML property.
Parent Filter
Field Name Allows you to define the field in the parent field that is used to filter this field. In other
words, it is the primary key in the list that is used in the lookup or cross-site lookup field.
Filter Field Name Allows you to define the field in the list that is used by this lookup or cross-site lookup field
that is filtered by the parent filter field.
Field Type Allows you to select a field type. More options are available depending on the field type
selected. The default is regular field. See the following fields for more information:
Fixed Value
Consume Value from an HTTP Parameter
Calculated Format
Autofill with a lookup/cross-site lookup field
Consume value from a row provided by another web part
Consume value from a session
Lookup Field
Cross-site Lookup
System Integration
Complex Category
Table 7. Display Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 158
www.agreeya.com
For example, to assign Accounting to the Department field:
<Field Name="Department" FixedValue="Accounting"/>
Additionally, you can use special variables for the FixedValue attribute.
<CurrentUserID/> this value is replaced by the ID of the currently logged in user. If you want to assign
the current user to the People and Group field, use this variable. If you are using Advanced Mode and you
would like to assign a task to the currently logged in user, you can specify the following Field element:
<Field Name="Assigned To" FixedValue="&lt;CurrentUserID/&gt;" /> (If you are using Advanced Mode)
<CurrentUserName/> this value is replaced by the name of the currently logged in user.
<CurrentUserEmail/> this value is replaced by the email of the currently logged in user.
<CurrentLoginName/> this value is replaced by the login name of the currently logged in user. The login
name is usually in the form of domain\username.
<Today/> this value is replaced by today's date.
<Now/> this value is replaced by the current date and time.
You can edit the following:
NOTE: If you are using SharePoint Form-Based Authentication, the above variables will return the
following, for example:
CurrentUserName=testuser
CurrentLoginName=i:0#.f|<site>|testuser
CurrentUserID=6
CurrentUserEmail=testuser@company.com
Table 8. Fixed Va l u e
Element Description
Allow Edit Allows you to edit the fixed value field.The value that is retrieved from the Fixed Value
attribute will only be used to initialize the field. Afterwards, the user can modify the value
as they wish and save it.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 159
www.agreeya.com
Consume Value from an HTTP Parameter
The HTTP Parameter Consumer field gets its value from an HTTP parameter. This is the attribute to create an
HTTP Parameter Consumer field:
Calculated Format
You can format a value of a field using values from other fields by using the CalculatedFormat attribute. The
value of the another field can be referred to using the <%fieldName%> field replacement expression. If you are
using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and > characters, which are &lt; and &gt;,
respectively unless you type in the value in the Display Fields editor in the List Form Editor, where the Editor
will encode the characters automatically for you.
For example, if you want to format the Full Name field as Last Name, First Name, the Field element should be
specified as:
<Field Name="Full Name" CalculatedFormat="&lt;%Last Name%&gt;, &lt;%First Name%&gt;" />
Another example is to assign a ten-digit number to the AccountNumber field using the ID of the list item. If the
ID is less than 10 digits, it is padded with zeros.
<Field Name="AccountNumber" CalculatedFormat="&lt;%{0:0000000000}
ID%&gt;"/>
This attribute can also be used to make a field read-only. For example, to make the AccountNumber a read-only
field:
<Field Name="AccountNumber" CalculatedFormat="&lt;%AccountNumber%&gt;" />
Autofill with a lookup/cross-site lookup field
The Auto Fill field gets its value from the parent field. The parent field must be a lookup field or a cross-site
lookup field.
The following are the attributes to create an auto-fill field:
For example, a List Form is used to edit the Employee list. Manager is a field in the Employee list, and it is a
lookup field. Two other fields, ManagerFirstName and ManagerLastName, are filled based on the row selected in
the Manager field. The Fields element for the Manager, ManagerFirstName,and ManagerLastName will look like
the following:
Table 9. Consume Value from an HTTP Parameter
Element Description
Consume HTTP
Parameter Name Allows you to enter the name of the HTTP parameter whose value is to be consumed.
This field is mandatory.
Allow Edit Allows you to edit the fixed value field.The value that is retrieved from the Fixed Value
attribute will only be used to initialize the field. Afterwards, the user can modify the
value as they wish and save it.
Table 10. Autofill with a lookup/cross-site lookup field
Element Description
Parent Field Allows you to defines the name of the parent field. The parent field must be
specified before any of the child fields.
Auto Fill Display
Field Name Allows you to define the field in the parent field where the value comes from
Auto Fill Display
Format Allows you to define the string format for the values. This attribute takes
precedence over the Auto Fill Display Field Name attribute. The format of the
Auto Fill Display Format is the same as the format used in the Calculated Format
attribute.
Allow Edit Allows you to define if this field is editable. By default, the list form displays this
field type as a non-editable field. If this attribute is set to true, this field is
editable.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 160
www.agreeya.com
<DisplayFields>
<Fields ContentType="Employee">
<Field Name="Manager" AutoPostBack="true"/>
<Field Name="ManagerFirstName" ParentField="Manager" AutoFillDisplayFieldName="FirstName"/>
<Field Name="ManagerLastName" ParentField="Manager" AutoFillDisplayFieldName="LastName"/>
</Fields>
</DisplayFields>
Set the AutoPostBack attribute to true in the parent field. Otherwise, the ManagerFirstName and the
ManagerLastName fields will not be refreshed when the user selects another manager.
Consume value from a row provided by another web part
The row consumer field gets its value from the row that is consumed by this List Form. To create a row
consumer field, you must connect the List Form with another web part that implements the IRowProvider
interface (such as the qSelector or qMultiSelectors).
These are the attributes to create a row consumer field:
For example, a List Form is used to edit a Tasks list. The Tasks list contains a Project Name field, and this field
is configured as a row consumer field. The row is provided by a qSelector web part that displays the list of
projects from the Projects list and is connected to the List Form.
<DisplayFields>
<Fields ContentType="Task">
<Field Name="ProjectName" ConsumeRowDisplayFieldName="Name"/>
</Fields>
</DisplayFields>
Consume value from a session
Session consumer field gets its value from a row that is stored in the session object. The concept is similar to
Row Consumer Field Attributes. However, if you need to get values from multiple providers, you must use the
Session Consumer Field instead of Row Consumer Field because the List Form can only be connected to one row
provider.
To create a session consumer field, you must first declare a Sessions element. A Sessions element can contain
one or more Session elements. The Sessions element contains the information about the list where the row
stored in the session comes from. After the Sessions element is defined, you can use it in the Field element. The
XML for the session consumer field looks like the following:
<DisplayFields>
<Sessions>
<Session Name="sessionName" SiteUrl="siteUrl" ListName="listName"/>
</Sessions>
<Fields ContentType="contentType1">
<Field Name="field Name" ConsumeSessionName="sessionName"
ConsumeSessionDisplayFieldName="displayFieldName"/>
</Fields>
</DisplayFields>
Table 11. Consume value from a row provided by another web part
Element Description
Consume Row
Display Field Name Allows you to defines the field name in the row from where the value comes.
Consume Row
Display Format Allows you to define the string format for the values. This attribute takes
precedence over the Consume Row Display Field Name attribute. The format of the
Consume Row Display Format is the same as the format used in the Calculated
Format attribute.
Allow Edit Allows you to define if this field is editable. By default, the list form displays this
field type as a non-editable field. If this attribute is set to true, this field is
editable.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 161
www.agreeya.com
These are the attributes to create a row consumer field:
You can replace the Consume Session Display Field Name attribute with Consume Session Display Format if you
want to use multiple fields as the source of values for this field.
For example, a List Form is used to edit a Tasks list. The Tasks list contains a Project Name field, and this field
is configured as a session consumer field. The row is provided by a qSelector web part in another page that is
visited before this page is opened.
<DisplayFields>
<Sessions>
<Session Name="ProjectsSession" SiteUrl="../../.." ListName="Projects" />
</Sessions>
<Fields ContentType="Task">
<Field Name="ProjectName" ConsumeSessionName="ProjectsSession"
ConsumeSessionDisplayFieldName="Name"/>
</Fields>
</DisplayFields>
Lookup Field
You can sort and filter the entries for the Lookup fields by using the Sort Field and CAML Filter attributes,
respectively. These attributes are ignored if the field is not a lookup field.
For example, if you are using Advanced Mode and you want to sort the Related Task lookup field by its title and
only want to show high priority tasks, you can specify the following configuration:
<Field Name="Related Task" SortField="Title" CamlFilter="&lt;Eq&gt;&#xD;&#xA; &lt;FieldRef
Name=&quot;Priority&quot; /&gt;&#xD;&#xA; &lt;Value Type=&quot;Choice&quot;&gt;(1)
High&lt;/Value&gt;&#xD;&#xA;&lt;/Eq&gt;" />
Cross-site Lookup
Cross-site lookup is the capability of the List Form to refer to multiple lists in different sites.
To use this feature, create a single-line-of-text field, not a lookup field. Internally, the List Form will store the
field value in this format: siteUrl;#listName;#listItemId.
For example, add a Document Type field to the metadata of every document that you store in the document
library. One way of doing this is to make this field a choice field. However, if you need to change the options for
the Document Type, you have to go to every document library in every site to change it. The same problem
occurs if you make the Document Type field a SharePoint lookup field (because SharePoint can look up a list in
the same site). The solution is to make the Document Type field a cross-site lookup field. You can create a
Table 12. Consume value from a session
Element Description
Name Allows you to enter the name of the session you want to consume. This field is
mandatory.
Site URL Allows you to enter the URL of the list site.
List Name Allows you to enter the list name.
Consume Session
Display Field Name Allows you to defines the field name in the session from where the value comes.
Consume Session
Display Format Allows you to define the string format for the values. This attribute takes precedence
over the Consume Session Display Field Name attribute. The format of the Consume
Session Display Format is the same as the format used in the Calculated Format
attribute.
If you select New List Item type as Form type, leave this field blank unless it is in simple
text format.
Allow Edit Allows you to define if this field is editable. By default, the list form displays this field
type as a non-editable field. If this attribute is set to true, this field is editable.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 162
www.agreeya.com
Document Type list in a centralized place and create a DocumentType field (as single line of text field) in every
document library. Configure this field as:
<Field Name="DocumentType" DisplayFieldName="Type" SortField="Type" AutoPostBack="true">
<List SiteUrl="../../.." SiteName="Dashboard" ListName="DocumentType" />
</Field>
The Display Field Name attribute can be replaced with Display Format attribute if you want to display multiple
fields in the drop-down menu. The value of the Display Format attribute is in the same format as that of the
Calculated Format attribute.
The above configuration assumes the following conditions:
The DocumentType list resides three levels above the current page (indicated by ../../.. in the Site URL
attribute).
The Document Type list contains one field called Type that contains the text for the document type, such
as Budget, Proposal, Manual.
You want to display the document types sorted alphabetically using the Sort Field attribute. If you do not
specify the Sort Field, the document types are sorted in the order they appear in the list; sorted by list
item ID.
The Site Name attribute is a text description of the Site URL. It does not have to match with the real
name of the site pointed to by Site URL.
You want the form to be refreshed every time you select another item by specifying
AutoPostBack="true". This is necessary if this field is a parent field of other fields in the form and the
child fields are visible. Otherwise, it is optional.
You can specify more than one List element inside the Field element. If you do, the List Form will display two
dropdowns. The first drop-down menu selects the list and the second drop-down menu selects the items in the
list. This function makes the Site Name important because the first drop-down menu displays the list as List
Name in SiteName.
System Integration
System Integration (SI) field gets its values from a data column accessible through the System Integration
Framework the same mechanism used by SI Web Parts to connect to external data sources.
In order to use the SI Field, the qListForm should be added to a web part page which belongs to a SharePoint
site that has System Integration configuration defined. It also requires that the Catalog property be defined
prior to specifying the SI Field.
The required attributes for a field of this type:
Table 13. System Integration
Element Description
Entity Name Allows you to specify which entity to use from Catalog property.
Operation Name Allows you to specify which entity operation to use from Catalog property to retrieve
the options from the external system. The syntax for the operation is
EntityName.OperationName. Both the entity and the operation must already be defined
in the Catalog property.
Data Member/Data
Index Allows you to specify the data table name that contains the options in case the
operation returns multiple tables. If the external system returns multiple data tables
without names, you can use the DataIndex attribute to refer to the table. The index is a
number and it starts with 0 (not 1).
Data Text Field Allows you to specify the column in the data table whose value is displayed in the drop-
down menu.
Data Value Field Allows you to specify the column in the data table that contains the real value that
should be saved back to the external system.
Define the DataTextField/DataValueField to be the primary key column for your
external data and any other columns as the source for the secondary fields to ensure
data integrity; however, it is not required.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 163
www.agreeya.com
Complex Category
The Complex Category field allows the SharePoint discussion view webpart to function like the Lotus Notes
response document which contains a category attribute. Categories that allow multiple values are not
supported.
Secondary Field
Name Allows you to specify an additional column in the data table whose value is displayed in
the drop-down menu. This is an optional field. Secondary fields are elements under the
regular display field so you can specify one or more fields. These fields is read-only.
Data Value Field Allows you to specify the column in the data table from which the actual value is used
that is associated with the displayed Secondary Field.
Eliminate Duplicate
Values Allows you to specify whether you want to eliminate duplicate values in the drop-down
menu.
Use Item Picker Allows you to specify whether to use an entity item picker or a drop-down list to display
the System Integration column. The default is to use the drop-down list. If you select to
use the item picker, you may specify zero or more Finder Operations to be used by the
entity item picker. The Finder Operation references the entity.operation defined in the
System Integration Catalog property. You can define one or more entity/operation in
the Catalog to help filter the data returned from the external system. Select the Add
Operation button to add a Finder Operation:
Finder Operation — specifies a valid entity and operation defined in Catalog
property to be used in the LookupOperation.
Filter Field — the field name to be used for filtering. If the operator takes an
argument, the filtering happens in the back-end server. If not, the filtering
happens in the web server by using the data view filter. The filter field name is
also used to match the finder operation during the item picker search.
Data Member/Data Index — defines the data table name that contains the
options in case the operation returns multiple tables. If the external system
returns multiple data tables without names, you can use the DataIndex attribute
to refer to the table. The index is a number and it starts with 0 (not 1).
The Item Picker option provides the ability to filter a large amount of data before
bringing the filtered data into the list form. The default, drop-down list, option will
bring all the data over to SharePoint and display it all in a list. Make sure to take into
account the amount of data that is returned when deciding the best option to display SI
column data using drop-down menu or item picker.
Here is an example:
<DisplayFields>
<Sessions />
<Fields ContentType="Task">
<Field Name="Title" />
<Field Name="Priority" />
<Field Name="Status" />
<Field Name="AWEmployeeID" LookupOperation="Product.EmployeeList"
DataMember="row" DataTextField="LoginID" DataValueField="EmployeeID">
<SecondaryField Name="AWContactID" DataValueField="EmployeeID" />
<SecondaryField Name="AWLoginID" DataValueField="LoginID" />
</Field>
</Fields>
</DisplayFields>
Table 13. System Integration
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 164
www.agreeya.com
The attributes for a field of this type:
System Integration
This property defines the entity and the operations related to the entity.
Table 14. Complex Category
Element Description
Edit Mode Allows you to define how the treeview for the complex category control should be
displayed. There are two options:
Inline — the treeview control is displayed in the form itself which enable the user to
assign and edit the complex category values directly in the form
Popup — the treeview control will display the complex category value as a read only
field with and Edit link. When the user clicks the Edit link, it will display the
treeview in a popup dialog box. The Popup option is recommended if you have many
categories to be displayed in the treeview.
Complex
Category Index
Site URL
Allows you to index the Complex Category field. Another SharePoint list is used to store the
index. The Complex Category Index Site URL is the site URL of the index list. If not defined,
the Complex Category Index Site URL will default to the current site URL.
Complex
Category Index
List Name
Allows you to set the list name of the index list. If not defined, the Complex Category Index
List Name will default to the name of the discussion list plus Categories. For example, if
your discussion list name is Team Discussion, then the index list name is Team Discussion
Categories.
Height Allows you to define the height of the complex category control in pixels. If not specified,
it will always fit the whole categories in the form without a scrollbar
Expand to Level Allows you to define the number of category levels that can be expanded when the
complex category control is loaded for the first time.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 165
www.agreeya.com
Catalog
Entities contain the following elements:
You can add operations to your entities by configuring the following elements:
Table 15. Catalog
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit the Catalog in XML format. This property is an XML string in
this format:
<Catalog>
<Entity Name="entityName" System="systemName" Service="serviceName"
Default="true/false">
<Properties>
<Property Name="propertyName" Type="typeName" Value="propertyValue" />
<Property Name="propertyName" Type="typeName" Value="propertyValue" />
</Properties>
<Operation Name="operationName" Method="methodName" Default="True/False" >
<Parameter Source="sourceType" SessionName="sessionName"
SourceName="sourceName" Type="parameterType" Name="parameterName"
Usage="usageType" Value="value" />
<Parameter Source="sourceType" SessionName="sessionName"
SourceName="sourceName" Type="parameterType" Name="parameterName"
Usage="usageType" Value="value" />
</Operation>
</Entity>
<Entity>
..</Entity>
</Catalog>
System Allows you to specify the system name that is defined in the System Integration
configuration file. If the system name does not exist in the System Integration
configuration file, you will get an error.
Service Allows you to specify the service name that is defined in the System Integration
configuration file. The service name that you specify here must belong to system that
you specify in the System attribute. If the service name does not exist in the System
Integration configuration file, you will get an error.
Name Allows you to specify the name of the entity which must be unique within this Catalog.
The name does not have to match with any name in your external system. However, it is
recommended that you use a descriptive name for your entity. This field is mandatory.
Set Session Name Allows you to enter name of the session variable where the edited or newly created item
is stored when it is saved, or the item that is being displayed or edited is stored when it
is loaded.
Reset Session
Names Allows you to reset (set to NULL) the value of the session variable whose name is
specified in this attribute. Specify multiple names by separating them with commas.
Default Allows you to define this entity as the default for the list form. If this element is not
specified, the first entity that is listed in the catalog becomes the default entity. The
default operation of the default entity is the operation that is used to retrieve the data
when the list form is loaded for the first time in edit or display mode.
Table 16. Operations
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the operation. This name does not have to match with any
name in your external system. This name is used to refer to this operation in the Action property.
This field is mandatory.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 166
www.agreeya.com
You can define parameters for the operation by configuring the following elements:
You can define one or more Property elements.
Method Allows you to specify the real name of the operation in your external system. For example, it
may refer to the name of a web service method. Or it may refer to the name of a stored
procedure in your SQL Server database.
Default Allows you to define this operation as the default. The default operation is the first operation
that is called to retrieve the entity to be displayed or edited. If this attribute is not specified,
the first operation listed in the entity becomes the default operation.
Table 17. Parameters
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the parameter.
Source Allows you to define the source of this parameter. The source can be one of the following:
DefaultValue — the value of the parameter that is the default
NullValue — the value of the parameter is blank
FixedValue — the value of the parameter that is defined in the Value attribute
HttpRequest — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the HTTP parameters in
the page URL. The name of the HTTP parameter is defined in the SourceName attribute.
As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName attribute is
ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter, which is Hardware, is used
as the value of the parameter.
Input — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from one of the input fields in the
form. You specify the name of the input field in the SourceName attribute. Additionally,
you can retrieve the current user information as the value of the parameter. You can
specify one of the following name in the SourceName attribute to retrieve the current
user information:
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row
that is consumed from another web part. You specify the name of the field that is
consumed in the SourceName attribute.
Session — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row that is stored in the
session. You specify the name of the session in the SessionName attribute. You specify the
name of the field that is consumed in the SourceName attribute.
ComplexType — the value of the parameter is an object based on the Type attribute and
Member definition inside the Parameter. Array and nested complex types are supported.
Array — the value of the parameter is an array of values
XML — the value of the parameter that is dynamically built when the condition is execute
at runtime
Usage Allows you to define the direction for this parameter. The options are In, Out, InOut, or
ReturnValue.
Table 18. Properties
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the property. Refer to the documentation for the DAO Provider
to your external system will tell you the name of the property that you must define.
Type Allows you to specify type of value that is specified in the Value attribute. Example:
System.String.
Value Allows you to specify the value of the property.
Table 16. Operations
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 167
www.agreeya.com
Optional Content
You can configure the following optional content:
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Actions
Form
Navigation
Email Notification
Actions
The list form has some pre-defined actions, such as Save, Delete, Copy or Move. You can also write your own
custom action and hook it up with the list form.
The Actions page contain the following elements:
Table 19. Optional Content
Element Description
Display Attachment Field Allows Display Attachment field to be displayed on the form
Display Creation and
Modification Info Allows Display Creation and Modification Info field to be displayed on the form
Display Required Field
Message Allows Required Fields Messages to be displayed on the form
Enable Multiple File
Upload Allows Enable Multiple File Upload field to be displayed on the form
Check Overwrite Existing
File check box Allows Check Overwrite Existing File check box to be displayed on the form
Show Save As File Textbox Allows Show Save As File textbox to be displayed on the form
Hide Parent Folder Name Allows Hide Parent Folder Name to be displayed on the form
Allow Lookup Item
Addition Allows Add New Lookup Item link to be displayed in the form using which a user
can add new lookup item from the form itself. The link will be visible only in edit
mode of the form.
NOTE: This only works if you have edit permission for the list.
Show Validation Summary Allows Validation Summary to be displayed on top of the form.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 168
www.agreeya.com
Custom Actions
This property enables you to define additional buttons in the toolbar or context menu item in the context menu.
You can program that button or context menu item to do a series of actions. The List Form supports some built-
in actions. However, you can write your own custom action using one of the .NET languages, compile it, and call
it by the List Form. See Custom Action Help on page 389 to see how to write your own custom actions.
Here are some ways that you can use this functionality:
Add a custom toolbar button called "Assign All to Me" that will assign all of the selected tasks in the List
Form to me.
Add a custom toolbar called "Approve" that will change the status of all of the selected expense items to
Approved.
Create a custom context menu item called "Publish" that will move the right-clicked document into
another document library.
Create a custom context menu item or toolbar item to start a workflow.
With the ability to write your own custom action, you can virtually do anything to the data when you
click the custom button that you define.
The Custom Actions element contains one Toolbar element and one Context Menu element. These elements can
contain one or more Action Item elements. You can associate the Action Item with one or more Action elements.
The Action element define a certain operation that is carried out by the action item when it is clicked. When
you add an action item, you can configure the following:
Table 20. Actions
Element Description
Custom Actions For more information, see Custom Actions on page 168.
Custom Action Error
Display Allows you to set where the error message is displayed if the custom action throws an
exception. The options are:
Inline — the error message is displayed in the list form above the displayed
fields.
Popup — the error message is displayed in a popup dialog box.
InlineAndPopup — the error message is displayed in a popup dialog box and
inline above the displayed fields.
Popup is the default.
This property will only affect the error message that is returned by the ICustomAction
implementation. It will not affect the error that is generated internally by the List
Form.
NOTE: The toolbar button affects all the items that are selected in the List Form. The context menu item
affects only the item that is being right-clicked regardless of how many items are selected in your List
Form.
NOTE: The custom action in the List Form does not support the Save action.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 169
www.agreeya.com
Table 21. Custom Actions
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Custom Actions in XML format. Here are the schema of
this property:
<CustomActions>
<Toolbar>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID"
Position="0" PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID”
ImageUrl=”URL” AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder"
TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl" TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session"
SourceName="fieldName" SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</Toolbar>
<ContextMenu>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID"
Position="0" PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID”
ImageUrl=”URL” AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder"
TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl" TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session"
SourceName="fieldName" SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</ContextMenu>
</CustomActions>
IsSeparator Allows you to set the item as a separator.
ID Allows you to enter a unique ID that will identify the item. Use a descriptive
identifier to configure the action item with the editor. This field is mandatory.
Text Allows you to enter how the action item is displayed in the toolbar. This field is
mandatory.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 170
www.agreeya.com
Text Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a a multi-lingual site. This attribute
defines the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the
Web Part. The Text Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the
Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the
string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the value in the Text
attribute is used.
Prompt Text Allows you to prompt the user to click the toolbar button or the context menu item.
Prompt Text Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a multi-lingual site. The property
defines the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the
Web Part. The Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the
Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the
string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default is used.
Access Key (Toolbar
Only) Allows you to define one character from the Text attribute that becomes the access
key to this toolbar button or context menu item. For example, if you define a letter
T as the access key, you can press ALT+T and the browser will put the focus on this
button or context menu item. If there are multiple elements on the page with the
same access key, you can repeat ALT+T repeatedly until you get the focus on this
toolbar button or context menu item.
Position Allows you to set the position of the button in the toolbar. The index starts with 0.
Show User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the Web Part. Separate
groups with commas.
Hide User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part.
Separate site group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide
User Groups, the user cannot
Table 21. Custom Actions
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 171
www.agreeya.com
When you add an action, you can configure the following:
Element Description
Name A mandatory element which allows you to identify a given action in order to access it from another
action. You can refer to this action from the GoToURL action and from ICustomActionEx Interface.
Type Allows you to determine the type of the action. Here are the options:
Delete — deletes the item.
Move — allows you to move the item to a target. You must specify a Target Site URL, Target
List Name, and Target Folder. This action only works for document in a document library.
Copy — allows you to copy the item to a target. You must specify a Target Site URL, Target
List Name, and Target Folder.
GoToURL — redirects the user to a specific URL. You must specify the URL and where you
want the URL to open. You must specify the following parameters:
Input - the current user information as the value of the parameter
Session - the name of the session variable where the value comes from when the
source is set to Session
HttpRequest - the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the HTTP
parameters in the page URL. The name of the HTTP parameter is defined in the
SourceName attribute. As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName
attribute is ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter, which is
Hardware, is used as the value of the parameter.
ListItem - the value of the parameter is a list item or row
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the parameter for the GoToURL action can be retrieved
from the output of another action that comes first in the sequence of actions
defined in the ActionItem. There are two types of action that can produce an
output: an action with Type of ExecuteOperation, and an action with Type of Custom
that points to custom action implementation of ICustomActionEx Interface. You do
that by defining the SourceName attribute of the action. This is the syntax of the
SourceName attribute when you use ResultFormAction source:
<ActionName>.<ResultType>[.Name], where ActionName refers to the Name
attribute of the action that produces the output, ResultType can be OutParameter
(if the action result is returned through one of the out or inout parameter) or
RawData - (if the action result is returned as an object). Name is optional. It further
designates the object we want to use for the parameter. You do not have to specify
the Name when the ResultType is RawData. However, if the ResultType is
OutParameter, this name specifies the name of the out or input key value pair.
ResultFromAction - the parameter for the GoToURL action can be retrieved from the
output of another action that comes first in the sequence of actions defined in the
ActionItem
You must define a source name (where in the source you want to get your
information from), name (the name of the parameter that is appended to the URL
you specified), and Session (the name of the session variable where the value comes
from when the source is set to Session)
GoToSource — redirects the user to the URL specified in the Source HTTP parameter. The
URL to the page must look like: http://...?Source=URL for this option to work.
StartWorkflow — starts the specified workflow in the Workflow Name drop-down field. You
must select a Workflow name.
ReturnToMasterChart — returns the user to the master chart page. You use this action type
if this web part is located in the drill down page.
Custom — implements your own custom action and call it with this action type. Enter a
Class name that implements the ICustomActionEx or ICustomAction interface, or select a
class from the drop-down list, if available.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 172
www.agreeya.com
Form
The Form page contains the following elements:
Table 22. Form
Element Description
Form Initialization
Actions Allows the List Form to be automatically pre-populated when the Form Type
property is set to NewListItem, CreateDocument, or UploadDocument. The List
Form will call the defined custom actions that are specified in this property.
The fields that cannot be automatically pre-populated are:
Auto-fill field (fixed value, consume value from an HTTP parameter,
calculated format, consume value from a session, consume row from a row
provided by another web part, auto fill with a lookup or cross-site lookup
field)
BDC Column
SI Column
Complex category field
Cross site lookup field
See the Custom Action Help on page 389 chapter on how to write a custom action to
initialize the list form.
You can click Edit and turn on Advanced Mode to edit Form Initialization Actions in
XML:
<FormInitialization>
<Action Name=”initial 1” Type="Custom"
Class="MyCompany.DevStudio.SampleFormInitializationAction,
MyCompany.DevStudio, Version=1.0.0.0, Culture=neutral,
PublicKeyToken=451cac61f7ec4225" / >
<Action Name=”initial 2” Type="Custom"
Class="MyCompany.DevStudio.SampleFormInitializationAction2,
MyCompany.DevStudio, Version=1.0.0.0, Culture=neutral,
PublicKeyToken=451cac61f7ec4225" / >
</FormInitialization>
Form initialization is a way to auto fill the form. It should not be used in
conjunction with another auto fill method. If you do this, the result is
unpredictable (that is sometimes the value from form initialization will take
precedence, but sometimes the value from the other auto fill method will take
precedence).
Form Component
Behavior For more information, see Form Component Behavior on page 173.
Dependent Lists For more information, see Dependent Lists on page 176.
Template List Site URL Allows you to specify the site URL of the document library that contains the
document template that is used to create a new document when the Form Type is
“Create Document”.
Template List Name Allows you to specify the List Name of the document library that contains the
document template that is used to create a new document when the Form Type is
‘CreateDocument’.
When both the Template List Site URL and the Template List Name are specified,
the qListForm will display a drop-down menu above the Field Name field that
contains list of documents in that doc library. The user can then select a document
that will serve as a template for the new document.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 173
www.agreeya.com
Form Component Behavior
This property is used to control the conditional behavior of the different components in the form, such as a
field, a group of fields, or a tab. You can specify the following conditional behaviors: Show When, Hide When,
Enabled When, Disabled When, Valid When, Invalid When, Required When, and Default When. See Table 24 for
more information.
ValidWhen, InvalidWhen, and RequiredWhen are used with SharePoint List Item and Column validation. The
validation is processed by:
1 The Form Component Behavior is processed first. If it succeeds (meaning no condition is true for
InvalidWhen and no condition fails for ValidWhen and no condition is true for RequiredWhen), it goes on
to perform SharePoint Column and List Item Validation. If they succeed, then Save and Close procedures
follow.
2 The implementation of SharePoint List and Column validation applies to qListForm Save and Close action
only. If user defines a custom action that has "performValidation" flag set to true, it will only enforce
Form Component Behavior and will ignore List and Column Validation.
This property is an XML string in this format:
The Form Component Behavior element can contain one or more Component elements. Each Component
element controls the behavior of a specific component in the form like a field or tab/panel.
The Component element contains the following elements:
Table 23. Form Components
Element Description
Advanced Mode Allows you to edit Form Component Behavior in XML.
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Field/Group/Container" ID="ComponentID">
<ShowWhen>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</ShowWhen>
<HideWhen>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</HideWhen>
<EnabledWhen>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</EnabledWhen>
<DisabledWhen>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</DisabledWhen>
<InvalidWhen Message=”Custom Message when condition is true”>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</InvalidWhen>
<ValidWhen Message=”Custom Message when condition is true”>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</ValidWhen>
<RequiredWhen Message=”Custom Message when condition is true”>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</RequiredWhen>
</Component>
<Component ...>
<Component ...>
</FormComponentBehavior>
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 174
www.agreeya.com
The Component element may contain any or none of the following conditional behavior elements:
For fields of type text, numeric or date/time, regular expression matching can be used for validation. Use the
“Matching” operator in the conditional behavior element.
The following are some examples of how to use this property:
1 Show the Resolved Date and Resolved By fields when the Status field is changed to "Resolved". By
specifying both fields’ GroupName attribute in the Display Fields property to “ResolvedFieldsGroup”, it
is defined that both fields belong to the same group.
Type Defines the type of the component that is assigned to the dynamic behavior. The
choices are: Field, Group, or Container (that is, tab/panel).
NOTE: A field cannot be hidden or disabled if that field is a mandatory field and
the defined type of form component is either Field or Group. However, it can be
hidden or disabled if the form component type is Container.
ID Defines the ID or name of the component whose behavior is defined to be dynamic.
When the Type is set to Field, this ID refers to the Name of a field that is defined
in the Display Fields property. When the Type is set to Group, this ID refers to the
Group Name attribute of a field that is defined in the Display Fields property.
When the Type is set to Container, this ID refers to the ID of a container that is
defined in the Form Layout property.
Table 24. Conditional Behavior Components
Element Description
Show When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be shown.
Hide When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be hidden. This
conditional behavior takes precedence over the other conditional behavior.
Therefore, if Hide When and Show When are defined and both evaluate to
true, the component is hidden.
Enabled When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be enabled.
Disabled When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be disabled. This
conditional behavior takes precedence over the Enabled When conditional
behavior. Therefore, if Enabled When and Disabled When are defined and both
evaluate to true, the component is disabled.
Required When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be required. This
conditional behavior is for fields only. It has no effect on a field that has been
defined as required by SharePoint. A custom message can be specified. It is
displayed when the Required When condition is satisfied. The message is
displayed by default in red after the input control on the form. However you
can specify any text or HTML code as the Message attribute.
Valid When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be valid. This
conditional behavior is for fields only. A custom message can be specified. It is
displayed when the Valid When condition is satisfied. The message is displayed
by default in red after the input control on the form. However you can specify
any text or HTML code as the Message attribute.
Invalid When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be invalid. This
conditional behavior is for fields only. This conditional behavior takes
precedence over the Valid When conditional behavior. Therefore, if Valid
When and Invalid When are defined and both evaluate to true, the field is
invalid. A custom message can be specified. It is displayed when the Invalid
When condition is satisfied. The message is displayed by default in red after
the input control on the form. However you can specify any text or HTML code
as the Message attribute.
Default When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be set as default.
Table 23. Form Components
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 175
www.agreeya.com
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Group" ID="ResolvedFieldsGroup">
<ShowWhen>
<Eq><FieldRef Name="Status"/><Value Type="Choice">Resolved</Value></Eq>
</ShowWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
2 Enable the "Amount Paid" field when the Invoice Status field is changed to "Paid".
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Field" ID="Amount Paid">
<EnabledWhen>
<Eq><FieldRef Name="Invoice Status"/><Value Type="Choice">Paid</Value></Eq>
</EnabledWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
3 Hide the Reason field when the Project Status field is not "Behind"
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Field" ID="Reason">
<HideWhen>
<Neq><FieldRef Name="Project Status"/><Value Type="Choice">Behind</Value></Neq>
</HideWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
4 Show error message if field, Assigned To, is blank when Status is “In Process”
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Field" ID="Assigned To">
<InvalidWhen Message="Assigned To Must be filled if Status is In Process">
<And>
<IsNull>
<FieldRef Name="AssignedTo" />
</IsNull>
<Eq>
<FieldRef Name="Status" />
<Value Type="Choice">In Progress</Value>
</Eq>
</And>
</InvalidWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
5 Field % Complete must be between 0 and 100
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Field" ID="% Complete">
<ValidWhen Message="% Complete must be between 0 and 100">
<And>
<Geq>
<FieldRef Name="PercentComplete" />
<Value Type="Number">0</Value>
</Geq>
<Leq>
<FieldRef Name="PercentComplete" />
<Value Type="Number">1</Value>
</Leq>
</And>
</ValidWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 176
www.agreeya.com
6 Set the container to default when the Project Status field is "In-progress"
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Container" ID="Initiation">
<DefaultWhen>
<Neq><FieldRef Name="Project Status"/><Value Type="Choice">In-progress</Value></Neq>
</DefaultWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
Dependent Lists
This property identifies the child lists to be updated when the List Form saves the changes to the current list
item.
This property works in conjunction with the Form Type property. When the Form Type property is set to
EditListItem or EditDocument, the List Form will update the values in the child lists. When the Form Type
property is set to NewListItem or UploadDocument, the List Form will create a new record in the child lists. This
is useful when you have two lists with a one-to-one relationship.
This property also prevents the deletion of the current item if there are any child records in the specified lists.
The user can delete a record when the Form Type property is set to DisplayListItem or EditListItem.
The Lists element can contain multiple List elements. One List element represents one child list. These are the
attributes of the List element:
The List element can contain zero or more Field elements. One Field element represents a field in the child list
that needs to be updated. These are the attributes of the Tasks list:
Source The name of the field in the parent list where the value comes from. The name is case
sensitive.
Target The name of the field in the child list where the value is copied to when the parent record is
saved. The name is case sensitive.
The following diagram illustrates parent child relationship between two different lists
Table 25. Dependent Lists
Element Description
Advanced Mode Allows you to edit Dependent Lists in XML. The value of this property is an XML string in this
format:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="siteURL" ListName="listName" KeyFieldName="keyFieldName">
<Field SourceFieldName="sourceFieldName" TargetFieldName="targetFieldName"/>
</List>
</Lists>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL of the site that contains the child list.
List Name Allows you to set the name of the child list. The name is case sensitive
Key Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field in the child list that contains the ID of the parent
item. The key field is usually a single line of text that contains the parent item ID or a cross-
site lookup field to the parent list. The name is case sensitive.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 177
www.agreeya.com
Figure 2. Parent/Child Relationship between two lists
The Project Phases list is the parent list of the Tasks list. The ID field is the primary key in the Project Phases list
because the value of the ID field is guaranteed to be unique (every SharePoint list and library contains a field
called ID. This field cannot be modified and its value is uniquely auto-generated by SharePoint). The Phase List
Item ID is the foreign key in the Tasks list. We replicate the value of the Project List Item ID, Project Name and
Phase Name into the fields with the same name in the Tasks list.
For example, if the List Form is configured to edit an item in the Project Phases list, then every time we modify
the information in the Project Phase list we need to make sure the values that are replicated and the Tasks lists
are modified. The following is how the Dependent List property should be setup:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="." ListName="Tasks" KeyFieldName="Phase List Item ID">
<Field SourceFieldName="Project List Item ID"TargetFieldName="Project List Item ID"/>
<Field SourceFieldName="Project Name"TargetFieldName="Project Name"/>
<Field SourceFieldName="Phase Name"TargetFieldName="Phase Name"/>
</List>
</Lists>
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 178
www.agreeya.com
Navigation
The Navigation page allows you to configure how and where the user will navigate in the web part. It contains
the following elements:
Table 26. Navigation
Element Description
Save Button Click Action Determines what will happen when the user clicks the Save and Close button on the
toolbar. These are the choices for this property:
GoToNextPageUrl — Go to the page specified in the Next Page URL property.
You can use this option if you always want the user to go to the same URL
every time they save the form.
GoToSource — Go to the page specified in the Source HTTP parameter. For
this option to work, the URL of the current page must contain the Source
HTTP parameter (http://...?Source=...). This option will give you the same
behavior as the Microsoft List Form. If you open the form using qListView, the
listview automatically sets the Source HTTP parameter for you. If you use this
option and the Source HTTP is not in the URL, the list form will give you an
error.
TrySourceThenNextPageUrl — Go to the page specified in the Source http
parameter if one exists. If not, go to the page specified in the Next Page URL
property. This option is the most commonly used one. Most of the time, you
want to go the URL specified in the Source HTTP parameter. However, if that
parameter is not available (for example, the user may type in the URL
directly in the address bar), you want to have an alternative URL to go to.
Next Page URL Works in conjunction with the Save Button Click Action property. When this property
is set to GoToNextPageUrl or TrySourceThenNextPageUrl, allows you to set the page
to go to when the user clicks the Save and Close button on the toolbar if the Save
Button Click Action property is set to GoToNextPageUrl or
TrySourceThenNextPageUrl.
If this field is blank, you are redirected to the List's Web Address.
Cancel Button Click
Action Determines what will happen when the user clicks the Cancel button on the toolbar.
SameActionAsSaveAndClose — This is the default value. You may want to
select another option if you want the Cancel button to behave differently
than the Save and Close button. This option is useful if you want to guide the
user through a series of steps when doing data entry. For example, when user
is in Form1, clicking Save and Close will bring them to Form 2 while clicking
Cancel button will bring them back to the home page.
GoToGoBackUrl — Go to the page specified in the Go Back URL property. You
can use this option if you always want the user to go to the same URL every
time they save the form.
GoToSource — Go to the page specified in the Source HTTP parameter. For
this option to work, the URL of the current page must contain the Source
HTTP parameter (http://...?Source=...). This option will give you the same
behavior as the Microsoft List Form. If you open the form using qListView, the
listview automatically sets the Source HTTP parameter for you. If you use this
option and the Source HTTP is not in the URL, the list form gives you an error.
TrySourceThenGoBackUrl — Go to the page specified in the Source http
parameter if one exists. If not, go to the page specified in the Go Back URL
property. This option is the most commonly used one. Most of the time, you
want to go the URL specified in the Source HTTP parameter. However, if that
parameter is not available (for example, the user may type in the URL
directly in the address bar), you want to have an alternative URL to go to.
Go Back URL Allows you to set which page to go to after the user clicks the Cancel button on the
toolbar if the Cancel Button Click Action property is set to GoToGoBackUrl or
TrySourceThenGoBackUrl.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 179
www.agreeya.com
Email Notification
The Email Notification page allows you to configure the web part to be sent as an email. It contains the
following:
Show Edit Button Allows you to display the Edit Item button when the Form Type is set to
DisplayListItem or DisplayDocument.
Edit Form URL Allows you to set the page to go to after the Edit Item button is clicked. If not
defined, the user will redirected to the EditForm.aspx of the list.
The Edit Item button will show up when the Form Type is set to Display Item or
Display Document and the Show Edit Button property is set to true.
Show Version History
Button Allows you to display the Version History button.
Display Form URL Displays the history of changes in the Multiple Lines of Text field when the Append
Changes to Existing Text setting in the field is turned on. The user can click one of
the texts in the history list to view that version of the text. This property define the
URL of the Display Form to display previous version of the text. If this property is not
defined, the default Display Form of the list is used.
Table 27. Email Notification
Element Description
Display Email
Notification Section Allows you to determines whether or not the email notification section should be
displayed in the List Form. The email notification will enable the user to send an
email to one or more recipients when an item is added or modified.
Subject Allows you to specify the default subject that is displayed by the list item email.
Message Allows you to specify the default message that is displayed by the list item email.
Allow Custom Message Allows you to set the list item to allow the user to modify the message.
Include Link to List or
Library Allows you to allows the hyperlinks to the AllItems.aspx of the list or document
library.
Include Link to Item Allows you to determine whether the message will include the hyperlink to the
newly added or modified list item.
Include Document as
Attachment Allows you to allow the email to contain the selected document as attachments.
Table 26. Navigation
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 180
www.agreeya.com
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Toolbar
Control
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
To o l b a r
The Toolbar page allows you to configure the appearance of the toolbar. It contains the following:
User Selection Mode Allows you to select user from the parent site or address book.
Plain Text— If the plain text option is selected, a text box will be displayed
in which you can type email IDs. Also, a list of all parent site users will be
displayed from which the user can be selected.
People Picker — If the people picker is selected, address book will be
displayed from which you can add user.
User Selection Scope Allows you to choose the source from which the user will be selected. It can be
from All Web User or a specific SharePoint Group.
Advanced Mode: Turn on if you want to edit Web User in XML format. XML will look
like the following:
<Scopes>
<Scope Name="AllWebUsers" />
</Scopes>
Turn on if you want to edit SharePoint Group in XML format. XML will look like the
following:
<Scopes>
<Scope Name="SPGroup" [selected scope] GroupName="SPGroupName" [sharepoint
group name] GroupID=" GroupID " [sharepoint group ID]
GroupSiteUrl="groupSiteUrl" />
</Scopes>
Table 28. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 27. Email Notification
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 181
www.agreeya.com
Control
The Control page allows you to set the appearance of your user controls in a web part. It contains the following:
The Control page contains the following:
Table 29. Toolbar
Element Description
Toolbar Location Allows you to define where a toolbar for the list form should be displayed. The
choices are TopAndBottom, Top, Bottom or None. Select None if you do not
want to display the regular toolbar. Only the Ribbon buttons are displayed in
this case.
Toolbar Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the toolbar.
Show Save Button Allows you to display the Save and Close button.
Show Cancel Button Allows you to display the Cancel button.
Show Delete Button Allows you to show the Delete button in the toolbar.
Show Mark Private/Public
Button Allows you to display the Mark Private/Public toggle button. This button will
only be displayed for a new form or an edit/display form and the logged in user
is the creator of the item. If an item is marked as private, only the creator can
see it.
In New or Edit mode, if this property is changed for an item, the change takes
place when the Save button is clicked. In Display mode, if this property is
changed for an item, the change takes place immediately with the following
popup message:
“Are you sure you want to make this item private? This change will take place
immediately”
OR
“Are you sure you want to make this item public? This change will take place
immediately”
Show Manage Permissions
Button Allows you to display the Manage Permissions button.
Show Manage Copies Button Allows you to display the Manage Copies button.
Show Workflows Button Allows you to display the Workflows button.
Show Alert Me Button Allows you to show the Alert Me button in the toolbar. The Alert Me button
creates a list-level alert.
Save and Close Button Text Allows you to set the display text for Save and Close button.
Cancel Button Text Allows you to set the display text for the Cancel button.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 182
www.agreeya.com
Table 30. Control
Element Description
Rich Text Editor Skin
Name Allows you to select the skin name for the rich text editor. The rich text editor
appears in the form when the Type attribute of the Field element in the Display
Fields property is set to RichText. If you have a custom skin, you can add it to the
following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft
Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Clear your browser cache frequently while working with custom skins. In IE, CSS
cache can be cleared by clicking the Clear Cache button in the CSS tab of
Developer Tools, located under the Tools menu of the browser.
Rich Text Editor Toolbar
Settings Define the toolbar groups and the order in which they appear in the toolbar for
the text editor for rich text and enhanced rich text.
You can edit Rich Text Editor Toolbar Settings in XML by turning on Advanced
Mode.
Complex Category Tree
Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the Complex Category Tree in the list
form. If you have a custom skin, you can add it to the following folder for
SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Drop-Down Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the drop-down menu control for the choice
field. If you have a custom skin, you can add it to the following folder for
SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 183
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Tab/Panel Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the Tab/Panel layout. If you have a custom
skin, you can add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program
Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Grid Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the child list. If you have a custom skin,
you can add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program
Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Table 31. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 32. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections
to other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Table 30. Control
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 184
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Ajax
Session
Security
Resources
Ajax
The AJAX page allows you to configure AJAX in your web part.It contains the following:
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 33. AJAX
Element Description
Enable AJAX Allows you to enable AJAX for the List Form. AJAX enables the List Form to carry out some
operations within the grid without refreshing the whole page. For example, when you sort a
column by clicking its column header or change the page by clicking the pager, the List Form
only refreshes the data in the grid without causing the whole page to post back. However,
there are times when AJAX causes some issues. In this case, you must disable the AJAX
capability of the List Form.
The following are some known situations where you need to disable AJAX:
In Internet Explorer 6, the data grid will fail to carry out the AJAX operation. If your
user base reports this issue, you can disable the AJAX to fix it.
If you use javascript's document.write() method in the Results Body property of the
Custom Display, the text that is generated using document.write() will not be rendered
after the AJAX operation. This is true even if you do not call the document.write()
directly within the Results Body but rather through another javascript function that
calls document.write().
Table 32. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 185
www.agreeya.com
Session
The Session page allows you to set or reset the session variable in the web part. It contains the following:
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Table 34. Session
Element Description
Set Session
Name Defines the name of the session variable where:
The edited or newly created item is stored when it is saved.
The item that is being displayed or edited is stored when it is loaded.
Use the list form to display a Task and a listview underneath it to display Task Serial Notes.
The list form will filter the listview so that the listview will only show the serial notes for the
displayed task. When you click the New Item button to create a new task serial notes, you
want some of the fields in the task serial notes to be auto-filled with the fields from the
current task. In that case, you set the session name in the list form so that the current task is
stored in the session and you can consume it in the new form for the task serial notes.
Reset Session
Name Allows you to reset the List Form (set to NULL) the value of the session variable whose name is
specified in this attribute. You can specify multiple names by separating them with commas.
Table 35. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security group,
or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 186
www.agreeya.com
Table 36. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the
attributes for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
Save and Close Button
Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Save and Close button.
Cancel Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Cancel button.
Delete Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Delete button.
Edit Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Edit button.
Approve/Reject Item
Button Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Approve/Reject Item button.
Check In Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Check In button.
Check Out Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Check Out button.
Manage Permissions
Button Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Manage Permissions button.
Manage Copies Button
Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Manage Copies button.
Version History Button
Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Version History button.
Workflows Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Workflows button.
Alert Me Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Alert Me button.
Mark Private Button
Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Mark Private button.
Mark Public Button Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Mark Public button.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 187
www.agreeya.com
qListForm Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qListForm:
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard
Adding items to a list in SharePoint using qListForm
Creating and Editing Collapsible Sections
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration
Wizard
To configure basic settings
1 Add qListForm to your page.
2 Select the ezWizard menu item from the qListForm Web Part Menu or Ribbon.
3 Select a list, from the current site, whose data you want to view, and click Next.
4 Define form configurations (ID Http Parameter Name field is a mandatory field and only becomes
available if selected form type is DisplayListItem, EditListItem, DisplayDocument, or EditDocument.),
and click Next.
If you want to change your selections, select Previous.
5Click Finish.
NOTE: Once a Web Part is configured, the ezWizard item will not appear on the Web Part Menu or the Web Part
Ribbon.
Adding items to a list in SharePoint using qListForm
If you want to add items to a SharePoint list using qListForm, you must replace the out-of-box web part with
qListForm.
To replace out-of-box SharePoint ListForm with qListForm
1 Create a list in SharePoint, for example Document List.
2 From Modify Form Web Parts, select New Default List.
3 Add qListForm.
4Open ezEdit.
5 From Primary Content, enter a title, a site URL, and the name of the list you created in SharePoint.
6From Form Type, select NewListItem. Click OK.
Indicates Required Field
Button Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Indicates Required Field button.
Parent Folder Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Parent folder.
Destination Folder Text
Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Destination Folder.
Table 36. Localization
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 188
www.agreeya.com
7 Hide the out-of-the-box SharePoint List.
a From the SharePoint list, select Edit Web Part.
b From the Layout section, click Hidden.
Figure 3. Edit Web Part
8Click Stop Editing from the SharePoint ribbon.
You are returned to the list in SharePoint. When you click Add new item, the QuickApps qListForm
opens.
Creating and Editing Collapsible Sections
Collapsible Sections are useful for organizing documents that contain a lot of information since you can use
them to collapse one or more paragraphs into a single line. You can expand the paragraphs when necessary by
clicking the triangle that appears to the left of a collapsed section. In Lotus Notes, this capability already exists
and for users migrating from Notes to SharePoint, this feature allows for seamless migration of this type of text.
There are three editing modes in rich text editor:
Design allows you to turn a section of text to collapsible or expanded
HTML allows you to work directly with specified markup to turn text into a collapsible section
Preview allows you to click to expand or collapse a section of text that is marked up as collapsible
text.
To create a collapsible section
1 Select the text that you want to collapse.
2Click Apply Section.
The selected text becomes a collapsible section with a section header with a default title of “New
Section”. This title can be changed.
To remove a collapsible section
NOTE: Do not delete the Microsoft List Form. Doing so may render your list unusable.
NOTE: Collapsible text does not work in Internet Explorer 7.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 189
www.agreeya.com
1 Select the section header.
2Click Remove Section.
Nested sections can be created by allowing a section header and section repeated inside the parent
section. The section header can be aligned to the left (default), right, and center.
List Name
This property defines the following:
The list whose data is viewed in the listform.
The following are the elements for the List attribute.
Child List
This property defines the following:
The list whose data is viewed in the listform.
The following are the elements for the Child List attribute.
Table 37. List Name
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit List Name in XML format. XML will look like the following:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="." ListName="Employee List" />
</Lists>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can
be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
NOTE: If you want to connect the listform with another Web Part in Microsoft
SharePoint Designer, the SiteUrl property must contain an absolute URL. We
recommend that you keep all URLs in the Web Part configuration relative to ensure site
portability. If you must, use an absolute URL temporarily, make the connection, and
then change the URL to a relative one.
List Name Allows you to enter the name of the SharePoint list that is edited or displayed. The list
name is case sensitive. If the list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as
well.
NOTE: This only works if the qListForm is contained in the AllItems.aspx. For example,
if you are replacing the Microsoft List View in the AllItems.aspx of the Tasks list and
you use a single dot as the ListName attribute, the ListName attribute of the qListForm
is set to Tasks. If you want to save the list as a template and then add it somewhere
else, the name of the new list might not be Tasks and using this relative list name will
automatically pick up the new list name for the view.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 190
www.agreeya.com
Child List Display Fields
This property defines what fields should be displayed in the List Form and how the fields are populated. When
you select the Edit button, a dialog box opens with a list of field names based on the list you have selected.
You can add more details to the field names.
The following are the elements for the Child List Display Fields attribute.
Table 38. Child List
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Viewed Lists in XML format. XML will look like the following:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="." ListName="Employee List" />
</Lists>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can
be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
NOTE: If you want to connect the listform with another Web Part in Microsoft
SharePoint Designer, the SiteUrl property must contain an absolute URL. We
recommend that you keep all URLs in the Web Part configuration relative to ensure site
portability. If you must, use an absolute URL temporarily, make the connection, and
then change the URL to a relative one.
List Name Allows you to enter the name of the SharePoint list that is edited or displayed. The list
name is case sensitive. If the list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as
well.
To denote the current list, you can use a single dot (.) as the list name.
NOTE: This only works if the qListForm is contained in the AllItems.aspx. For example,
if you are replacing the Microsoft List View in the AllItems.aspx of the Tasks list and
you use a single dot as the ListName attribute, the ListName attribute of the qListForm
is set to Tasks. If you want to save the list as a template and then add it somewhere
else, the name of the new list might not be Tasks and using this relative list name will
automatically pick up the new list name for the view.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 191
www.agreeya.com
Relationship Mapping
Allows you to create a relationship between parent and child list. When you select the Edit button, a dialog box
opens with a list of parent and child key fields based on the list.
The following are the elements for the Relationship Mapping attribute.
Table 39. Child List Display Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Display Fields in XML format. XML will look like the
following:
<Fields LookupThresholdControlSetting="Default">
<Field Name="Title" InternalName="Title" />
</Fields>
Query All Fields Controls how Web Parts behave in relation to the List Form Lookup Threshold in
SharePoint Resource Throttling. The options are:
Default — uses the level set in the Configuration Editor. If you have selected
Query All Fields check box in the Configuration Editor, the Web Part will query
only those fields that are not included in the List View Lookup Threshold. If the
Query All Fields check box is cleared, the Web Part will query all fields.
On — If the Web Part level is On, the Web Part queries all fields in lists, except
Lookup fields.
Off — If the Web Part level is Off, the Web Part queries all fields in lists,
including Lookup fields.
NOTE: Explicit — If the Web Part level is Explicit, the Web Part queries only those fields
selected in the Display Fields. This option renders the best performance for your Web
Part.
Title Allows you to change the displayed for the field. The value can be a plain string or an
encoded HTML string. Change the displayed title, for example, when the title is too
long or to make the title more descriptive.
Width (in pixels) Allows you to set the width of the control in pixels.
Some controls, such as the Rich Text Editor, have minimum width and it will not honor
the specified width if it is smaller than its minimum width.
Align Indicates the horizontal alignment for the field. The values is one of the following:
left, right, or center. For example:
<Field Name="Created" Align="right" />
Table 40. Relationship Mapping
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Relationship Mapping in XML format. XML will look like the
following:
<Mappings>
<Mapping ParentListName="ListName" ParentSiteUrl="siteUrl"
ChildListName="ListName" ChildSiteUrl=" siteUrl " ParentFieldName="
parentKeyFieldName" Operator="EqualsTo" ChildFieldName=" childkeyFieldName" />
</Mappings>
Parent Key Field
Name Allows you to select Parent Key Field Name.
Child Key Field Name Allows you to select Child Key Field Name.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
12
192
www.agreeya.com
qListView
Overview
Configuration Wizard
qListView Pages
qListView Procedures
Overview
qListView aggregates data from one or more SharePoint lists and displays the information in a grid.
This Web Part has an intuitive user interface that allows you to:
Configure the most complex aspects of web parts. This user interface is accessed from the Configure
item on the web part menu at the upper right corner of the list display.
Aggregate data from multiple lists from various SharePoint sites. The lists to be aggregated are defined
in the Viewed Lists property. You can define the lists that you want to aggregate individually in the
property, define it in a centralized list or ask the listview to aggregate lists with a specific name from all
the subsites (recursive rollup).
Display hierarchical data. For example, you can display the information from the Customer list and Sales
list in the same view.
Display data from lists with multiple content types. The listview displays a New button for each content
type in the list so that the user can create items with different content types from the listview.
Ensure the referential integrity of the records in the dependent lists by preventing the deletion of the
parent record.
Divide the data into multiple pages to limit their size and render pages faster. This feature is called
Paging. There are two Paging Modes available: Numeric Pager and Next Previous. If the number of rows in
a table is more than the specified Page Size, the data is divided into multiple pages and a Pager is
displayed at the bottom of the listview to enable the user to navigate to different pages.
Define a static filter using CAML Filter expression or Complex Filter expression. Both types of filter
expression supports time functions and time expression (such as [TODAY]) to filter out data based on a
moving time window. This feature is called Data Aging.
Define the dynamic filter or search criteria using the Find panel. The web part author can define the
fields that are shown in this panel using the Searched Fields property.
Filter a lookup/cross-site lookup field with another lookup/cross-site lookup field.
Replace the value of a certain field in the list. The user can either mass-replace the value of the
selected item or define the condition for the items to be replaced.
Define the initial static sort expression using the Sort Fields property. The listview can sort the data
based on multiple fields.
Export child list to Microsoft Excel in conjunction with qExcelViewer.
Sort the data in the listview by clicking the grid headers.
Define multiple levels of grouping on the data using the Grouped attribute in the Display Fields property.
You can also display the sum or item counts in the group header.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 193
www.agreeya.com
Support the List Searcher mode in listview. If Turn On List Searcher Mode is set to True, the listview does
not display data until the user performs a search.
Turn off the individual buttons in the toolbar.
User can edit office documents in browser after installing Office Web App and configure with SharePoint.
Manage the folders from one or more lists/document libraries in the Folder Panel.
Display the value of a cross-site lookup field. A cross-site lookup field is similar to the SharePoint lookup
field, except that it can look up multiple lists in any workspaces that are accessible from the current site
by the current user. The cross-site lookup field is identified by the Display Field Name or Display Format
attributes in the Display Fields property. You can use qListForm to populate a cross-site lookup field.
Access the most common functions for data items, such as View Properties, Edit Properties and Send
Email. If enabled, you can access the context menu by right-clicking the entry in the listview.
Change the URL of the new form, edit form, and display form using the Viewed Lists property.
Show or hide the listview based on the site group membership of the currently logged in user.
Display the data in virtually any format that can be achieved with JavaScript and HTML. With this
feature, you can create many types of custom reports on the data.
Support dynamic language switching and Flash and JavaScript (HTML5)
Export data to Microsoft Excel in conjunction with qExcelViewer.
Provide data from the whole listview to another web part using IWebPartTable interface.
Consume a filter from another web part that implements IRowProvider or IFilterProvider interface.
The listview is a consumer for the IWebPartParameter interface. This capability enables the chart view
to consume a filter from another web part that implements IWebPartRow or IWebPartParameter
interface.
The IWebPartParameter consumer implementation is labeled with Get Filter From in the web part
Connection menu. This interface cannot be connected with the obsolete IFilterProvider or IRowProvider
implementation. Do not connect this new interface with the old interface that is marked obsolete
Configuration Wizard
qListView uses a configuration wizard to walk you through basic configuration tasks. For more information on
using the Configuration Wizard, see Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard on page 226.
qListView Pages
You can configure this web part through its pages that are accessible through ezEdit. qListView contains the
following pages:
Content Page
NOTE: The Send Email item in the context menu enables the user to send an email with a
custom message to one or more recipients. The email message may contain the link to the
item, the link to the list or library and in case of document library, the document as an
attachment. This feature requires you to put the MailSettings configuration in your
web.config file. You need to do this because the Send Email does not use the SharePoint
email capability due to its limitation of sending a maximum of 1000 characters.
NOTE: The IFilterConsumer interface is obsolete. It is provided here only for backward
compatibility reason. When you establish the web part connection, this interface is labeled
Consume Filter From (Obsolete) in the web part Connections menu. Use the
IWebPartParameter consumer implementation that is labeled with Get Filter From.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 194
www.agreeya.com
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page contains the following:
Primary Content
Filtering
Search/Filter/Replace Panel
Sorting/Paging
Custom Display
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Viewed Lists
This property defines the following:
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part, or accept the default. This field is
mandatory.
Viewed Lists See Viewed Lists on page 194 for more information.
Display Fields See Display Fields on page 198 for more information.
Child View Display
Fields Defines the fields that should be displayed in the view for the child records. See
Display Fields on page 198 for more information.
Expand Child View on
Load Determines if the child view is expanded or collapsed when the listview is loaded for
the first time. By default, this property is set to false which means the hierarchical
listview does not expand the child view. If set to true, the entire child view expands
when the listview is loaded for the first time.
Enable New Item Link
in Child View Allows you to display the New Item link in the child view.
ID HTTP Parameter
Name Allows the qListForm and several other web parts to an HTTP Parameter called ID to
identify the item to be displayed or edited. This HTTP Parameter is usually generated
automatically by the viewer web part, such as qListView or qCalendarView, when you
select an item to be displayed or edited.
NOTE: If qListForm is placed on a web part page that is contained within a document
library, the page will generate an error if the value of the ID HTTP Parameter is bigger
than the number of pages within the document library. To prevent this error from
happening, rename the ID HTTP Parameter.
By default, the value of this property is "ID". You can change the value of this property
to something else, such as LID. In that case, when you select "View Properties" or "Edit
Properties" in the context menu, the URL of the display or edit form becomes:
http://mysite.com/EditFormURL.aspx?LID=xxx
Set the same property in the qListForm to the same value.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 195
www.agreeya.com
The lists whose data is viewed in the listview and the manner it is aggregated. There are a few ways that
you can aggregate information from multiple lists in the listview. First, you can define the lists to be
aggregated one by one. Second, you can define the site URL for the aggregated lists in a Rolled-Up list.
Third, you can aggregate the information from lists with a particular name from all the subsites
(recursive rollup).
The parent list and the child list in the hierarchical listview. You can only define one child element per
list. The hierarchical listview does not work when you aggregate the information using the Rolled-Up list
and recursive rollup.
The Dependent Lists for each list. If the Dependent Lists information is provided, the listview checks
whether there are child records in the Dependent Lists when the user tries to delete items from the
listview. If there are any, the listview will not delete the selected items.
The Lists element can contain one or more List elements. The listview will aggregate the information from all of
the List elements that you specify. To define the hierarchical listview, each List element can contain one child
List element.
The following are the elements for the Viewed List attribute.
Table 2. Viewed List
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Viewed Lists in XML format. XML will look like the following:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" ListName="listName" IncludeSubsites="true/false"
IncludeThisSite="true/false" IsRollupList="true/false" SiteUrlFieldName="fieldName"
RolledUpListName="listName" TargetUrl="targetUrl" SetSessionName="sessionName"
ResetSessionNames="name1, name2" NewFormUrl="URL" EditFormUrl="URL"
DisplayFormUrl="URL">
<!-- To define a child list in a hierarchical listview, you can add List element in the
parent List element. You can only have one child list. -->
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" ListName="listName"
ParentKeyFieldName="parentKeyFieldName" ChildKeyFieldName="childkeyFieldName"
TargetUrl="targetUrl" SetSessionName="sessionName" ResetSessionNames="name1,
name2" NewFormUrl="URL" EditFormUrl="URL"
UseUploadFormInLayoutsFolder="true/false" DisplayFormUrl="URL">
<!-- To define dependent lists, add a DependentLists element inside the List element
-->
<DependentLists>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" ListName="listName" KeyFieldName="keyFieldName" />
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" ListName="listName" KeyFieldName="keyFieldName" />
</DependentLists>
</List>
<List ...></List>
<List ...></List>
</Lists>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can
be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
NOTE: If you want to connect the listview with another Web Part in Microsoft
SharePoint Designer, the SiteUrl property must contain an absolute URL. We
recommend that you keep all URLs in the Web Part configuration relative to ensure site
portability. If you must, use an absolute URL temporarily, make the connection, and
then change the URL to a relative one.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 196
www.agreeya.com
List Name Allows you to enter the name of the SharePoint list that is edited or displayed. The list
name is case sensitive. If the list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as
well.
To denote the current list, you can use a single dot (.) as the list name.
NOTE: This only works if the qListView is contained in the AllItems.aspx. For example,
if you are replacing the Microsoft List View in the AllItems.aspx of the Tasks list and
you use a single dot as the ListName attribute, the ListName attribute of the qListView
is set to Tasks. If you want to save the list as a template and then add it somewhere
else, the name of the new list might not be Tasks and using this relative list name will
automatically pick up the new list name for the view.
Include Subsites If set to true, the listview searches all the subsites for a list whose name specified in
the ListName and aggregate the information from those list.
NOTE: If you have many subsites, the information may take a long time to aggregate.
Use this attribute if you have only a small amount of subsites. You must test this
feature in your environment to see whether or not the response comes back in a
reasonable amount of time and the request does not time out.
Include This Site Used in conjunction of the IncludeSubsites attribute. If you set this property to true,
the list in the current site will not be aggregated by the listview. The current site is the
site whose URL is specified in the SiteUrl attribute.
Is Rollup List Indicates whether or not the list specified by the SiteUrl and ListName attributes
contains the Site URLs of the lists to be aggregated instead of the data to be
aggregated. If you set this to true, the list specified by the SiteUrl and ListName must
have a field that contains the URL information. By default, the name of that field is
Site URL. If you use different field name, specify the name using the SiteUrlFieldName
attribute.
Rolled Up List Name Used in conjunction with the IsRollupList property, indicates the name of the lists to be
rolled up if you set the IsRollupList to true.
If you want to aggregate more than one list from each site specified in the rollup list,
you can define more than one List elements with the same rollup list, but different
RolledUpListName.
Site URL Field Name Used in conjunction with the IsRollupList property, indicates the field that contains the
Site URLs of the lists to be aggregated. This attribute is optional if the field name is
Site URL.
NOTE: The Site URL field must be a single line of text field.
Active Field Name Used in conjunction with the v IsRollupList property. The rollup list may contain a
Yes/No field to indicate whether or not a particular site should be included in the
rollup. This property is optional if the name of this field is Active.
NOTE: The Active field must be a Yes/No field.
Reset Session Names Resets (sets to NULL) the value of the session variables whose name is specified in this
attribute. You can specify multiple names by separating them with commas; for
example TaskSession, IssueSession.
You can reset the session name if a list has one or more tasks associated with it. In
addition to storing the selected list in the session, you may store the dependent task
information in the session as well. This means that every time you store a new list into
a session, you need to reset the dependent task information from the session as well.
Set Session Name Defines the name of the session variable where the listview stores the item whose
column is being clicked by the user. The user can click the item if one of the LinkTo,
LinkToTarget or the LinkToSource attributes in the Display Fields property is defined.
This attribute is usually used if you have another Web Part (such as the qListForm) that
can consume the stored values from the session.
You can set the session name when you want to consume the item from a session
variable in a qListForm later.
Table 2. Viewed List
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 197
www.agreeya.com
Target URL When the LinkToTarget attribute of a specific column is set to true (in the Display
Fields property), the data in that column becomes a hyperlink to the URL specified in
this attribute.
NOTE: If you using Advanced Mode, the TargetUrl can use the <%field name%> field
replacement expression. But you must use the encoded form of the < and > characters,
which are &lt; and &gt; respectively.
Use the LinkToTargetUrl attribute if you want each list to have a different URL; for
example, when you want to aggregate multiple lists from the same workspace and
connect a certain column to the display form of the list. In that case, the URL to the
display form of each list is different.
Create Document
Form URL When specified, the New button (and all the buttons for specific content types
underneath it) will redirect the user to the URL specified by this attribute. Normally,
the page pointed to by CreateDocumentFormUrl will contain a qListForm to create the
new document. For more detail about this, see the Create Document section of the
qListForm chapter.
CreateDocumentFormUrl will affect all types of list, not just document library.
There is no difference between CreateDocumentFormUrl and NewFormUrl when the
list is not a document library. You can specify either to affect the target URL for the
New button. But if both are specified, the CreateDocumentFormUrl will take
precedence. When the list is a document library, CreateDocumentFormUrl will affect
the New button and the NewFormUrl will affect the Upload button.
New Form URL Indicates the URL where the form to create a new item resides. The URL is relative to
the Site URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when one of the
New buttons in the toolbar is clicked. If not defined, the user is redirected to the
NewForm.aspx of the list (or Upload.aspx for the document library).
Redefining the New Form URL is useful if you have different way of creating an item
depending on the current view. For example, in the view for external vendor, you may
want to give them a new form that does not contain all the fields in the list.
NOTE: The Source HTTP parameter is automatically appended to the New Form URL
during redirection.
This attribute is usually used in conjunction with the qListForm Web Part.
Edit Form URL Indicates the URL where the form to edit an item in the list resides. The URL is relative
to the Site URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when the user
clicks Edit Properties in the Context Menu. If not defined, the user is redirected to the
EditForm.aspx of the list.
Redefining the Edit Form URL is useful if you have different ways of editing an item
depending on the current view. For example, in the view for external vendor, you may
want to give them an edit form that does not contain all the fields in the list.
NOTE: The ID and Source HTTP parameters are automatically appended to the Edit
Form URL during redirection.
This attribute is usually used in conjunction with the qListForm Web Part.
Display Form URL The URL where the form to display an item in the list resides. The URL is relative to the
Site URL of the list. The user is redirected to the specified URL when the user clicks
View Properties in the Context Menu. If not defined, the user is redirected to the
DisplayForm.aspx of the list.
Redefining the Display Form URL is useful if you have different way of displaying an
item depending on the current view. For example, in the view for external vendor, you
may want to give them a display form that does not contain all the fields in the list.
NOTE: The ID and Source HTTP parameters are automatically appended to the Display
Form URL during redirection.
This attribute is usually used in conjunction with the qListForm Web Part.
Table 2. Viewed List
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 198
www.agreeya.com
The List element for the child list must contain these additional attributes:
The List element can contain only one DependentLists element. The DependentLists element can contain one or
more List element. The List element inside the DependentList can contain the following attribute:
Display Fields
This property defines the fields that should be displayed.
This property is optional if the properties in the Custom Display section is specified. In that case, the default
display is turned off and the custom display is used. You can also combine the custom display with the Display
Fields. A good example is when you want to display data in a grid and provide a summary of the data or a
disclaimer using a custom display.
The Display Field contains the following elements:
Item Location — The format of the Item Location value is ListName in SiteUrl. This field is useful when
you aggregate multiple values into the listview to tell you where a particular item comes from.
Workspace URL — This field contains the URL of the site that contains the containing list.
List Name — This field contains the name of the containing list.
Folder — The server relative URL of the folder that contains this item.
Launch Form In Defines how the form pages (NewForm, EditForm, DisplayForm) associated with a
SharePoint list are launched. There are 3 different options: Dialog, New Window, and
Current Window. This property defaults to <Empty> in which case the form dialog
obeys the settings under List Settings/Advanced Settings.
NOTE: If you select Dialog, you can configure the dialog width and height.
Use Upload Form in
Layouts Folder Allows you to link to the Upload.aspx page in the _Layouts folder instead of the
Upload.aspx page in the Forms folder of the document library.
NOTE: This option was useful with SharePoint 2007. It is still available for legacy
purposes, but you no longer need to enable it.
Table 3. List element for child list
Element Description
Parent Key Field
Name Allows you to enter a name in the field in the parent list that will act as the filter for
the child records. In other words, this is the primary key field in the parent list.
Child Key Field Name Allows you to enter a name in the field in the child list that is filtered by the value
from the parent key field. In other words, this is the foreign key field in the child list.
Table 4. List element inside Dependent Lists
Element Description
Site URL Allows you to enter the URL to the site that contains the dependent list.
List Name Allows you to enter the name of the dependent list. The list name is case sensitive.
This property along with the SiteUrl defines the dependent list.
Key Field Name Allows you to enter the name of the field in the dependent list that contains the ID of
the parent item. In another word, the KeyFieldName is the foreign key in the
dependent list. The key field is usually a single line of text that contains the parent
item ID or a cross-site lookup field to the parent list. The name is case sensitive
NOTE: In addition to the fields in the list, the listview recognizes several special fields. You can display
the following fields, group the fields or use it as a field replacement expression in the CalculatedValue
attribute.
Table 2. Viewed List
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 199
www.agreeya.com
File Path — The complete URL for a file in the document library. This variable is only available for
document library.
Table 5. Display Field
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Display Fields or Child View Display Fields in XML format. In
XML, Displayed Fields look like:
<Fields LookupThresholdControlSettings=”On”>
<Field Name="fieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<!-- For a grouped field, you can specify one or more aggregated values -->
<Field Name="fieldName" Grouped="true" SortDirection="asc|desc"
GroupExpanded="true|false">
<Aggregate Function="aggregateFunction" FieldName="fieldName" Text="text"/>
<Aggregate Function="aggregateFunction" FieldName="fieldName" Text="text"/>
</Field>
</Fields>
Query All Fields Controls how Web Parts behave in relation to the List View Lookup Threshold in
SharePoint Resource Throttling. The options are:
Default — uses the level set in the Configuration Editor. If you have selected Query
All Fields check box in the Configuration Editor, the Web Part will query only those
fields that are not included in the List View Lookup Threshold. If the Query All
Fields check box is cleared, the Web Part will query all fields.
On — If the Web Part level is On, the Web Part queries all fields in lists, except
Lookup fields.
Off — If the Web Part level is Off, the Web Part queries all fields in lists, including
Lookup fields.
Explicit — If the Web Part level is Explicit, the Web Part queries only those fields
selected in the Display Fields. This option renders the best performance for your
Web Part.
Add Field Allows you to add custom fields to be displayed in the web part.
NOTE: If you are using a CalculatedValue or FixedValue attribute, you must first add and
configure at least one custom field.
Field Name Indicates the name of the field selected. If you select Custom, you can change the field
name.
NOTE: If you configure Calculated Value, Fixed Value, Display Field Name, and Display
Format, ensure the custom field name does not contain spaces. If the name contains
spaces, an error message is returned.
Title Indicates the title of the field. This is useful if the real field name is too long and you
want to abbreviate the title in the field header, or if you simply want to display a
different title in the field header. If this attribute is not specified, the value specified in
the Name attribute is used in the field header. For example:
<Field Name="Created By" Title="Author" />
Title Resource ID Indicates the identifier in the Resource List that is used as the title of the field. The
TitleResourceID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP
parameter) is used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given
identifier is not found, the default Title is used.
Width Indicates the width of the field. You can specify the value in pixels (Width="20px") or
percentage (Width="20%").
We recommend leaving at least one field where you do not specify this property. That
field will take up the remaining width of the page. For example:
<Field Name="Subject" Width="100px" />
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 200
www.agreeya.com
Align Indicates the horizontal alignment for the field. The values is one of the following: left,
right, or center. For example:
<Field Name="Created" Align="right" />
Item Style Indicates the style for the item in the row. You can define the style as you would in a CSS
class; for example, color: red; font-weight: bold
Item CSS Class Indicates the distinct style for the column and you already have defined the style in an
external CSS file.
Fixed Value Fixed Value appears if you have selected Custom as a Display Field. This allows you to
display text as a value for this field. This is useful when you want static text such as Edit
displayed in a field. You can then make this text a hyperlink using either the Link To, Link
To Target or Link To Source attributes.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you can configured Fixed Value as in the following
example:
<Field Name="EditColumn" FixedValue="Edit"
LinkTo="Lists/ListName/EditForm.aspx?ID=&lt;%ID%&gt;" />
To display an icon instead of a text, you can do the following (it assumes that you have
pencil.gif in the images folder in your site:
<Field Name="EditColumn" FixedValue="&lt;img src=&quot;images/edit.gif&quot;
border=0&gt;" LinkTo="Lists/ListName/EditForm.aspx?ID=&lt;%ID%&gt;" />
Table 5. Display Field
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 201
www.agreeya.com
Calculated Value Calculated Value appears if you have selected Custom as a Display Field.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, this attribute recognizes the field replacement
expression <%Field%> to refer to a field. The listview will replace the field replacement
expression with the value of the field for each row of data. You must use the encoded
form of the < and > characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively, unless you type in
the value in the Display Fields editor in the List View Editor, where the Editor will encode
the characters automatically for you.
You can use this attribute to:
Display the values from multiple fields in one grid column. For example, to display
a full name, you can concatenate the first name and last name as follows:
<Field Name="CalculatedFullName" Title="Full Name" CalculatedValue="&lt;%First
Name%&gt; &lt;%Last Name%&gt;" />
Reformat the values of another field, using the Display Format on page 14. You can
specify the Display Format in the Field replacement expression as follow:
<%{DisplayFormat}FieldName%>
For example, if you have a Date Time Field called "Start Date" and you want to
display it in a short date format, you can use the following field replacement
expression: <%{0:d}Start Date%>. To see the available display format, see Display
Format on page 14.
Format the display of a certain column in the grid. For example, you can display
the Status of your project with different colors depending on its value. In order to
do this, you can write a JavaScript function and then call that JavaScript function
using this attribute.
<Field Name="CalculatedProjectStatus" Title="Status"
CalculatedValue="&lt;script&gt;FormatProjectStatus('&lt;%Status%&gt;');&lt;/scri
pt&gt;" />
The above example assumes you have a JavaScript method called
DisplayProjectStatus defined on your page or in a JavaScript file that is included in
your page. That JavaScript method looks like:
<script language="javascript">
function FormatProjectStatus(status)
{
var displayedStatus = status;
if (status = 'Behind')
{
displayedStatus = '<font color="red">' + status + '</font>';
}
return displayedStatus;
}
</script>
You can format the value of the field in virtually any way you want..
NOTE: You can only call one JavaScript function in the CalculatedValue attribute and the
JavaScript function must return a string.
Display Field Name If specified, indicates a cross-site lookup field. It contains the name of the field in the
cross-site list that contains the value to be displayed. The field name is case sensitive.
A cross-site lookup field enables you to lookup a list that resides in another site, another
site collection, or another web application as long as it is in the same configuration
database. You need the qListForm Web Part to create a cross-site lookup field.
Table 5. Display Field
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 202
www.agreeya.com
Display Format If specified, indicates a cross-site lookup field. It contains the format of the value that is
displayed. Define this attribute if you want to display values from multiple fields.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you can use the field replacement expression
<%Field%> to refer to a field. You must use the encoded form of the < and > characters,
which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in the Display Fields
editor in the List View Editor, where the Editor will encode the characters automatically
for you.
NOTE: For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
Show User Groups Allows you to show groups where the user is a member of one of the SharePoint groups
listed. Separate site group names with commas.
Hide User Groups Allows you to hide groups where the user is a member of one of the SharePoint groups
listed. Separate site group names with commas.
Hyperlink Field
Target If this field is a SharePoint Hyperlink or Picture field, indicates the target window for the
hyperlink. For example, use "_blank" if you want to open the target URL in a new window.
If this attribute is left blank, the target URL will open in the current window.
This attribute will not affect the hyperlink column created with the LinkTo, LinkToSource
or LinkToTargetURL attributes.
Link To Indicates that the list view turns the field into a hyperlinked column to the specified URL.
The URL can be an absolute or relative URL.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, the LinkTo can use the <%field name%> field
replacement expression. You must use the encoded form of the < and > characters, which
are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in the Display Fields editor in
the List View Editor, where the Editor will encode the characters automatically for you. If
you use a relative URL, the URL is appended to the site URL of the target site. For
example, specify "Lists/TeamDiscussion/EditForm.aspx?ID=&lt;%ID%&gt;" as the value of
this property. If you click a customer record that comes from the Customers list in
Workspace A, whose site URL is "http://mydomain/sites/mysite", you are directed to
http://mydomain/sites/mysite/Lists/TeamDiscussion/EditForm.aspx?ID=23 (assuming you
click the discussion with ID=23).
Link To Target Allows the list view to make the field value a hyperlink to the URL specified in the Target
Url attribute in the Viewed Lists property.
The LinkToTarget URL is used when you aggregate lists with different names. You can
specify a different TargetUrl for each list in the Viewed Lists property and the list view
will redirect the user to the correct URL depending on the list from where the clicked
item comes.
Link To Source The list view will make the field value a hyperlink to the URL specified in the Source
HTTP parameter of the current request. For this option to work, the current page URL
must look like: http://.....?Source=....
Use this element when the URL for the hyperlink is dynamic. This could be because it
contains dynamic parameters or the URL is different depending on the referral page.
Also, when you want to make the URL in the link dynamic. In that case, you can pass in
the URL for the link into the HTTP parameter of your page.
Open Link In Allows you to define how the Link To Field opens. There are 3 different options: Dialog,
NewWindow, and CurrentWindow.
NOTE: If you select Dialog, you can configure the dialog width and height.
NOTE: If you are using Internet Explorer 9, the "NewWindow" option requires the user to
set the following: Internet Options | General |Tabs| Settings| When a pop-up is
encountered | 'Always open pop-ups in a new window'.
HTML Encode If selected, the value in the field is encoded first prior to being displayed. You need to set
this to true if this field contains values that are surrounded by < and >, such as <abc>.
Without the encoding, the value will not be displayed properly.
Table 5. Display Field
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 203
www.agreeya.com
The Field element can contain one or more Aggregate elements if its Grouped attribute is set to true. The
following are the attributes of the Aggregate element:
Filtering
The Filtering page allows you to use CAML filters to dynamically filter records or use Complex Filters to define
static filter for the data.
The Filtering page contains the following:
Do Not Render as
Hyperlink If selected, the value of fields is rendered as plain text instead of hyperlink.
Grouped Allows you to group data by:
Sort Direction — This attribute determines whether the values in the header of the
grouped field must be displayed in ascending or descending order. The options are
asc for ascending order or desc for descending order. The default value is asc.
Group Expanded — If set to true, the group is initially expanded. Otherwise, it is
collapsed. If not specified, the default value is false.
NOTE: Grouping is not supported on any field that has "Allow Multiple Values" enabled.
Table 6. Aggregate element attributes
Element Description
Text Allows you to enter the text that will precede the aggregated value when displayed.
Aggregate Function Allows you to select a function.
Field Name Allows you to enter a field name where the aggregation is performed.
Table 7. Filtering
Element Description
CAML Filter Allows you to specify the CAML (Collaboration Application Markup Language) query
expression to filter your data. CAML is an XML-based query language. The CAML Filter
will only be applied to the data. The filter will not be applied to the responses.
For more information, see CAML Filters on page 19.
CAML Filter for
Folders Allows you to filter the folders that are displayed in the folder panel. This is useful if
you maintain the metadata on your folders and want to display folders with specific
properties.
For more information, see CAML Filters on page 19.
Apply CAML Filter on
First Level Folder
Only
Allows you to apply the CAML Filter for folders only on the first level folder. By
default, the value is false. If set to true, the listview applies the CAML Filter for
folders on the first level folder (that is, folders located directly under the root folder)
but will not apply the CAML Filter on the subsequent level.
Complex Filter Allows you to use the Complex Filter expression to define a static filter for the data.
The complex filter is applied to the data after the CAML Filter is applied.
NOTE: The Complex Filter is provided here only for backward compatibility reason. In
the past, Complex filter was used to support date functions.
For more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
Table 5. Display Field
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 204
www.agreeya.com
Search/Filter/Replace Panel
The Search/Filter/Replace Panel allows you to define the panels for search, filter, and replace in the web part.
You will be able to perform a search by pressing Enter.
The Search/Filter/Replace Panel contains the following elements:
NOTE: Pressing Enter will not allow you to perform a search on such fields as external data, people picker,
managed metadata, and a drop-down list. Instead, the default behavior will occur.
Table 8. Search/Filter/Replace Panel
Element Description
Searched Fields See Searched Fields on page 205.
Fields Excluded from
Replace Panel Defines which fields from the list must be excluded from the Field Name drop-down
menu in the Replace panel.
The Fields element can contain one or more Field elements. The Field element can
contain one attribute, which is the Name attribute. The Name attribute is the display
name of the field to be excluded from the Replace panel.
NOTE: Turn Advanced Mode on if you want to edit this field in XM L format. This
property is an XML in this format:
<Fields>
<Field Name="Field1"/>
<Field Name="Field2"/>
</Fields>
Show Include Sub
Folders Check Box In
Search Panel
Determines whether the Include Sub Folders check box is displayed in the Filter
panel. When you select this property and the Show Folders Button property in the
Toolbar Appearance page, the Include Sub Folders check box will appear as the first
row in the search/Filter panel.
NOTE: Select this element when the folder panel is enabled and the view and the
search are limited only on the currently selected folder. The Include Sub Folders
check box is useful if you want to include the subfolders of the current folder in the
search.
Show Search All Fields
Control in Search
Panel
Determines whether the Filter panel should display the control to search all fields in
the list. When set to true, the following control is shown in the Filter panel:
The Search All Fields Control allows you to do the following:
Combine the search all fields functionality with other search criteria that has
been entered for specific fields.
When the search all fields criteria is entered, the Filter panel will construct a
filter expression with the "Contain" operator for the following fields in the list:
Single line of text, Multiple lines of text, Choice, Lookup (only Lookup to a
Single Text field and Lookup to a Number field are supported), Person or Group
and Hyperlink or Picture. If the list contains a Lookup to Number field, Search
All Fields will not work for negative numbers for that field. The Filter panel
will use the entire keywords as the value to be searched. Therefore, if you
enter "High Priority" in the search all fields control and perform the search, it
will find the following sentence:
‘This is a high priority task’
However, it will not find the following sentence:
‘The priority is not always high’
Expand Filter panel
on Load Allows you to automatically open the Filter panel by default so that the user can
perform a search quickly. When set to true, the Filter panel opens when the web part
is loaded for the first time.
Panel Button Location Determines the location of the Go, Reset and Close buttons in the Filter panel. This
property also determines the location of the Go and Close buttons in the Replace
panel.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 205
www.agreeya.com
Searched Fields
This property defines which fields are displayed in the Filter panel. If defined, the listview displays Filter or
Search menu items under the Actions button in the toolbar.
To disable the search feature in the listview, leave this property blank.
The Searched Fields element can contain multiple Field elements:
Turn On List Searcher
Mode Allows the user to perform a search before the listview display any data.
Show Filter On Fields Allows you to display a filter control on the listview column headers. When this
element is set to true, the filter control appears next to each column header.
However, you can only use this element when the Turn On list Searcher Mode element
is set to False.
NOTE: This filter does not support SharePoint List fields such as Lookup, Choice
(check box type), Person or Group, Multiple lines of text, Managed metadata (with
multiple values), Hyperlink or Picture, Calculated (calculation based on other
columns), and External data. The filter also does not support fields provided by the
web part such as Edit, Type, Item Location, and Add Field (Custom field that supports
fixed and calculated values). However, the filter control supports, SharePoint List
fields such as Single line of text, Choice (radio buttons and drop-down list), Number
(1, 10, 100), Currency ($, ¥, €), Date and Time, Yes/No (check box), Managed
metadata (which accepts single value), and Task Outcome. The filter also supports
the following fields provided by the web part such as List Name, Workspace URL,
Folder, and Site Name. Also, the maximum number of options available in the filter
checklist will only be the first 500 items that are displayed in the List View. You can
filter items beyond this 500 items limit directly using the search options provided in
the filter control.
NOTE: If the item count in the list exceeds the List View Threshold in SharePoint (see,
http://office.microsoft.com/en-us/sharepoint-foundation-help/manage-lists-and-libraries-with-many-
items-HA010377496.aspx), the search will fail. Set the filter settings to lessen the item count, and set the
search fields in the index. If the returned items, based on the search, return too many results, the search
will still fail.
NOTE: For the Number type field, the “Contain” operator is not supported for negative numbers, and is
not available for the following fields: Lookup to DateTime field, Lookup to Calculated field, and Lookup to
ID field.
Table 9. Searched Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Searched Lists in XML format. This property is an XML
string in the following format:
<Fields>
<Field Name="fieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<!-- To search a cross site lookup field, use one of the following two formats -->
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFieldName="fieldName" SortField="fieldName"
[optional attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFormat="fieldName" SortField="fieldName"
[optional attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
</Fields>
Field Name Indicates the element you are editing.
Table 8. Search/Filter/Replace Panel
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 206
www.agreeya.com
Title Displays title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an encoded HTML
string.
Description Describes the field. This is useful if you want to give a short instruction or
explanation about the field.
Default Value Defines the default value for the field.
You can define a text, a number or a date. A date value must be specified in ISO
8601 format: YYYY-MM-DDThh:mm:ssZ, for example: midnight of February 14, 2002
is 2002-02-14T00:00:00Z.
Default Operator Defines the default operator for the field.
Fixed Operator Defines the operator for the field. If specified, the drop-down menu to select the
operator for this field is turned off.
Use People Editor Enables you to enter any user information that is in your directory service.
If you set this to True and the field to be searched is a People and Group field, the
Filter panel will show the People Editor control for entering the search criteria.
Column Count Defines the number of columns for the options in a multi-choice field or in a choice-
and-lookup field if the Enable Multi Choice attribute is set to True. This is useful in
case your choice or lookup fields have too many choices and you want to break the
choices into several columns to minimize the vertical scrolling in your form.
Enable Multi Choice Allows you to select multiple options for the choice-and-lookup field. Therefore,
the user can specify a condition like "A or B". This attribute is ignored by other field
types.
To search a cross-site lookup field, you must specify one or more List elements
inside the Field element. The cross-site lookup field is displayed as two drop downs.
Sort Field Defines the field that is used to sort the value in the drop-down menu. The field
name is case sensitive.
Sort Order Allows you to sort the values in ascending or descending order.
AutoPostBack Use the Filter panel to refresh when the user changes the selection in a lookup field
or cross-site lookup field.
You need to set AutoPostBack to true if this field is a lookup or a cross-site lookup
field and it is being used to filter another lookup or cross-site lookup field in the
Filter panel.
Parent Field Defines another lookup or cross-site lookup field that is used to filter this field. The
parent field must be listed before this field in the XML property.
Parent Filter Field Name Defines the field in the parent field that is used to filter this field. It is the primary
key in the list that is used in the lookup or cross-site lookup field.
Filter Field Name Defines the field in the list that is used by this lookup or cross-site lookup field that
is filtered by the parent filter field.
Display Field Name Shows the name of the field whose value is displayed in the drop-down menu. The
field name is case sensitive. Use this attribute instead of the Display Format
attribute if you only want to display a single field in the drop-down menu.
Display Format Indicates the format of the value that is displayed in the drop-down menu. Define
this attribute instead of the Display Field Name attribute if you want to display
multiple fields in the drop-down menu. You can use the field replacement
expression <%Field%> to refer to a field.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and
> characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in
the Searched Fields editor in the List View Editor, where the Editor will encode the
characters automatically for you.
Site URL Indicates the Site URL of the field. You can use an absolute or relative URL.
Table 9. Searched Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 207
www.agreeya.com
Sorting/Paging
The Sorting/Paging page allows you to define the sorting criteria and paging type and size in the web part.
The Sorting/Paging page contains the following elements:
Custom Display
The custom display properties lets the page designer customize the display of the data using HTML and
JavaScript. The custom display appears after the default display (if the Display Fields property is defined).
Three properties define the custom display. The example in each property illustrates how to display the
FullName field of the search results in an HTML table.
List Name Indicates the name of the List. The field name is case sensitive.
Site Name Indicates the name of the site specified in the Site URL. This is used in case you
have multiple lists. In this case, the first drop-down menu to select the list will
display as "List Name in Site Name". You can use any name for the Site Name. It
does not have to match the real title of the Site.
Table 10. Sorting/Paging
Element Description
Sort Fields Allows you to define the initial sorting criterion for the data. This is the syntax for this
property:
FieldName1 [SortDirection], FieldName1 [SortDirection]
SortDirection is either ASC (ascending order) or DESC (descending order). The
FieldName and the SortDirection are case sensitive. If the SortDirection is not
specified, ascending order is assumed. For example:
First Name ASC, Last Name DESC, Company
NOTE: You cannot define criteria to sort custom fields. To sort custom fields, click the
column in qListView. You can sort custom fields under the following circumstances
only:
the custom field search data total count is less than MaxQueryRowCount's value
(by default, this value is 2000)
the custom field is only a calculated value
the custom field’s calculated value is not written in JavaScript code
Child View Sort Fields Defines the initial sorting criterion for the data in the view for the child records. This
property has the same syntax as that of the Sort Fields property.
Disable Multi Column
Sorting Allows you to sort the listview one column at a time. This means that if the user clicks
a column header to sort the data by that column, any previous sort with another
column is cancelled.
The default value of this property is false, which means the user can sort using
multiple columns.
Paging Mode Allows you to select the type of pager that is displayed at the bottom of the listview if
the items must be divided into multiple pages.
Page Size Allows you to set the maximum number of rows that is displayed in one page. If the
number of rows is larger than the Page Size, the data is divided into several pages. You
can navigate the pages using the Pager displayed at the bottom of the listview.
Table 9. Searched Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 208
www.agreeya.com
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Actions
Views
Email Notification
Actions
This property enables you to define additional buttons in the toolbar or context menu item in the context menu.
You can program that button or context menu item to do a series of actions. The listview supports some built-in
actions. However, you can write your own custom action using one of the .NET languages, compile it, and call it
by the listview. See Custom Action Help on page 389 to see how to write your own custom actions.
Here are some ways that you can use this functionality:
Add a custom toolbar button called "Assign All to Me" that will assign all of the selected tasks in the
listview to me.
Add a custom toolbar called "Approve" that will change the status of all of the selected expense items to
Approved.
Create a custom context menu item called "Publish" that will move the right-clicked document into
another document library.
Create a custom context menu item or toolbar item to start a workflow.
With the ability to write your own custom action, you can virtually do anything to the data when you
click the custom button that you define.
The Actions page contain the following elements:
Table 11. Custom Display
Element Description
Results Header Allows you to set the value of this property that is rendered once before the Results
Body. This property is a good place to include any JavaScript file, defining any
JavaScript function, or define any HTML elements for the header.
Example: These are the customers that match your search
criteria.<br><table><tr><th>Full Name</th></tr>
Results Body Allows you to set the value of this property that is repeated once for every row in the
search results. You can use the <%field name%> field replacement expression to refer
to the value of a certain field.
Example: <tr><td><%FullName%></td>
Results Footer Allows you to set the value of this property that is rendered once after the Results
Body.
Example: </table>
NOTE: The toolbar button affects all the items that are selected in the listview. The context menu item
affects only the item that is being right-clicked regardless of how many items are selected in your
listview.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 209
www.agreeya.com
Custom Actions
The Custom Actions element contains one Toolbar element and one Context Menu element. These elements can
contain one or more Action Item elements. You can associate the Action Item with one or more Action elements.
The Action element define a certain operation that is carried out by the action item when it is clicked.When you
add an action item, you can configure the following:
Table 12. Actions
Element Description
Custom Actions For more information, see Custom Actions on page 209.
NOTE: The custom action in the listview does not support the Save action.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 210
www.agreeya.com
Table 13. Custom Actions
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Custom Actions in XML format. Here are the schema of
this property:
<CustomActions>
<Toolbar>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID"
Position="0" PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID”
ImageUrl=”URL” AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder"
TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl" TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session"
SourceName="fieldName" SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</Toolbar>
<ContextMenu>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID"
Position="0" PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID”
ImageUrl=”URL” AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder"
TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl" TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session"
SourceName="fieldName" SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</ContextMenu>
</CustomActions>
IsSeparator Allows you to set the item as a separator.
ID Allows you to enter a unique ID that will identify the item. Use a descriptive
identifier to configure the action item with the editor. This field is mandatory.
Text Allows you to enter how the action item is displayed in the toolbar. This field is
mandatory.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 211
www.agreeya.com
Text Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a a multi-lingual site. This attribute
defines the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the
Web Part. The Text Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the
Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the
string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the value in the Text
attribute is used.
Prompt Text Allows you to prompt the user to click the toolbar button or the context menu item.
Prompt Text Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a multi-lingual site. The property
defines the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the
Web Part. The Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the
Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the
string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default is used.
Access Key (Toolbar
Only) Allows you to define one character from the Text attribute that becomes the access
key to this toolbar button or context menu item. For example, if you define a letter
T as the access key, you can press ALT+T and the browser will put the focus on this
button or context menu item. If there are multiple elements on the page with the
same access key, you can repeat ALT+T repeatedly until you get the focus on this
toolbar button or context menu item.
Position Allows you to set the position of the button in the toolbar. The index starts with 0.
Show User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the Web Part. Separate
groups with commas.
Hide User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part.
Separate site group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide
User Groups, the user cannot
Table 13. Custom Actions
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 212
www.agreeya.com
When you add an action, you can configure the following:
Table 14. Action
Element Description
Name A mandatory element which allows you to identify a given action in order to access it from
another action. You can refer to this action from the GoToURL action and from ICustomActionEx
Interface.
Type Allows you to determine the type of the action. Here are the options:
Delete — deletes the item.
Move — allows you to move the item to a target. You must specify a Target Site URL, Target
List Name, and Target Folder. This action only works for document in a document library.
Copy — allows you to copy the item to a target. You must specify a Target Site URL, Target
List Name, and Target Folder.
GoToURL — redirects the user to a specific URL. You must specify the URL and where you
want the URL to open. If you select to open the URL in a dialog, you can configure the
dialog width and height. You must specify the following parameters:
Input - the current user information as the value of the parameter
Session - the name of the session variable where the value comes from when the
source is set to Session
HttpRequest - the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the HTTP
parameters in the page URL. The name of the HTTP parameter is defined in the
SourceName attribute. As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName
attribute is ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter, which is
Hardware, is used as the value of the parameter.
ListItem - the value of the parameter is a list item or row
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the parameter for the GoToURL action can be retrieved
from the output of another action that comes first in the sequence of actions
defined in the ActionItem. There are two types of action that can produce an
output: an action with Type of ExecuteOperation, and an action with Type of
Custom that points to custom action implementation of ICustomActionEx Interface.
You do that by defining the SourceName attribute of the action. This is the syntax
of the SourceName attribute when you use ResultFormAction source:
<ActionName>.<ResultType>[.Name], where ActionName refers to the Name
attribute of the action that produces the output, ResultType can be OutParameter
(if the action result is returned through one of the out or inout parameter) or
RawData - (if the action result is returned as an object). Name is optional. It
further designates the object we want to use for the parameter. You do not have to
specify the Name when the ResultType is RawData. However, if the ResultType is
OutParameter, this name specifies the name of the out or input key value pair.
ResultFromAction - the parameter for the GoToURL action can be retrieved from
the output of another action that comes first in the sequence of actions defined in
the ActionItem. You must define a source name (where in the source you want to
get your information from), name (the name of the parameter that is appended to
the URL you specified), and Session (the name of the session variable where the
value comes from when the source is set to Session)
GoToSource — redirects the user to the URL specified in the Source HTTP parameter. The
URL to the page must look like: http://...?Source=URL for this option to work.
StartWorkflow — starts the specified workflow in the Workflow Name drop-down field. You
must select a Workflow name.
ReturnToMasterChart — returns the user to the master chart page. You use this action type
if this web part is located in the drill down page.
Custom — implements your own custom action and call it with this action type. Enter a
Class name that implements the ICustomActionEx or ICustomAction interface, or select a
class from the drop-down list, if available.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 213
www.agreeya.com
Views
The Views page allows you to set views so the user to view the data in Excel or a chart.
The Views page contains the following elements:
Email Notification
The Email Notification page allows you to configure the web part to be sent as an email.
The Email Notification page contains the following:
Table 15. Views
Element Description
Search Session Name The listview will store the search criteria, last selected folder, sort criteria, and
other listview dynamic settings in the session variable with this name.
The listview also use the Search Session Name to communicate those settings to
qExcelViewer and qChartView located in the page whose URL specified in the Excel
Viewer URL or Chart Viewer URL property, respectively. Therefore, the Search
Session Name in those web parts must be set to the same value as the session name
in this listview.
Excel Viewer URL Allows you to set the URL of the page that contains qExcelViewer. If this property is
specified, the Export to Excel button is displayed in the toolbar. The target page
specified by the URL must contain qExcelViewer. The Search Session Name property
of qExcelViewer must be set to the same value as the Search Session Name property
of this qListView.
Chart Viewer URL Allows you to set the URL of the page that contains qChartView. If this property is
specified, the View in Chart button is displayed in the toolbar. The target page
specified by the URL must contain qChartView. The Search Session Name property
of qChartView must be set to the same value as the Search Session Name property
of this qListView.
Table 16. Email Notification
Element Description
Subject Allows you to specify the default subject that is displayed by the list item email.
Message Allows you to specify the default message that is displayed by the list item email.
Allow Custom Message Allows you to set the list item to allow the user to modify the message.
Include Link to List or
Library Allows you to allows the hyperlinks to the AllItems.aspx of the list or document
library.
Send Email Context Menu
Text Allows you to display the text for the "Send Email" item of the right-click context
menu. The default value for this text is "Send Email". An example of another value
that is commonly used is "Forward".
Include Document as
Attachment Allows you to allow the email to contain the selected document as attachments.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 214
www.agreeya.com
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Grid
Toolbar
Context Menu
Folder Tree
Email Notification Editor
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Grid
The Grid page allows you set the appearance of the grid in the web part.
The Grid contains the following:
Table 17. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 18. Grid
Element Description
Selection Column Type Allows you to set a column type:
None: Use None if you want to click the row to select it or press Ctrl or
Shift and click the row to select multiple rows.
MultiRowSelector: Use this option if want the listview to display a check
box as the first column. To select a row, select the check box for that
row. To select multiple rows, select the check box for each row to be
selected.
SingleRowSelector: Use this option if want the listview to display a check
box as the first column. To select a row, select the check box for that
row.
Hide Expand\Collapse Image
When No Child Item Allows you to hide the +/- sign next to a list item if the item contains 0 child
items.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 215
www.agreeya.com
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the grid in the listview. If you have a
custom skin, you can add it to the following folder for SharePoint
2010:C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
or for SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web
Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the
install directory.
Header Style Allows you to enter the style for the header. You can define the style as you
would in a CSS class.
Example: font-family: verdana; color: black; background-color: #FFCC99;
height: 20px;
Header CSS Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the grid's header. If this property is
specified, it will override the style defined in the Header Style property. You
must define the class specified here in an external CSS file.
Pager Style Allows you to enter the style for the pager. You can define the style as you
would in a CSS class; for example, font-family: verdana; color: black;
background-color: #FFCC99; height: 20px;
Pager CSS Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the pager. If this property is
specified, it will override the style defined in the Pager Style property. You
must define the class specified here in an external CSS file.
Item Style Allows you to enter the style for the item. You can define the style as you would
in a CSS class; for example, color: red; font-weight: bold
Item CSS Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the item in the odd-numbered row
(1, 3, 5, and so on.). If this property is specified, it will override the style
defined in the Item Style property. You must define the class specified here in
an external CSS file.
Alternating Item Style Allows you to enter the style for the item in the even-numbered row (2, 4, 6,
and so on). You can define the style as you would in a CSS class; for example,
font-family: verdana; color: yellow; font-weight: bold;
Alternating Item CSS Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the item in the even number row (2,
4, 6, and so on). If this property is specified, it will override the style defined in
the Alternating Item Style property. You must define the class specified here in
an external CSS file.
Selected Item Style Allows you to enter the style for the selected item in the grid. You can define
the style as you would in a CSS class; for example, backgroundcolor: orange
!important; color: blue !important;
You can add "!important" after the color name so that this color will override
the selected item style provided by the skin.
Selected Item CSS Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the selected item in grid. If this
property is specified, it overrides the style defined in the Selected Item Style
property. You must define the class specified here in an external CSS file.
Main View Appearance Field
Name Allows you to define the name of the field whose values determine the color of
the row in the main view. The value of this field is compared against the
FieldValue and FieldValueRange in the Color Appearance property.
Table 18. Grid
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 216
www.agreeya.com
Child View Appearance Field
Name Allows you to define the name of the field whose values determine the color of
the row in the child view. The value of this field is compared against the
FieldValue and FieldValueRange in the Color Appearance property.
Color Appearance Allows you to define the color of the rows in the main view, child view, and
group header.
Turn Advanced Mode on if you want to edit Color Appearance in XML format:
<Appearance>
<MainViewAppearance>
<RowAppearance FieldValue="value1"
BackgroundColor="color1" FontColor="color2" />
<RowAppearance FieldValueRange="number - number"
BackgroundColor="color3" FontColor="color4" />
</MainViewAppearance>
<ChildViewAppearance>
<RowAppearance FieldValue="value1"
BackgroundColor="color1" FontColor="color2" />
<RowAppearance FieldValueRange="number - number"
BackgroundColor="color3" FontColor="color4" />
</ChildViewAppearance>
<GroupeHeaderAppearance>
<RowAppearance FieldValue="value1"
BackgroundColor="color1" FontColor="color2" />
<RowAppearance FieldValueRange="number - number"
BackgroundColor="color3" FontColor="color4" />
</GroupHeaderAppearance>
</Appearance>
You must specify those elements in that sequence. For example, if you specify
ChildViewAppearance before the MainViewAppearance you will get an error
that the XML is not valid.
To add color for the group header, you must enable grouping for displayed fields
before specifying field value, background color and font color.
Select the Edit button, then click Add Row Appearance to enter values in the
following:
Field Value — value for the field
Field Value Range — a range of values for the field, including negative
values
Background Color — the background color of the row for the specified
value in the Field Value attribute. The color can be specified as a well-
known color such as white, black, cyan, lightGray, as a RGB value such as
255, 255,255, or you can specify it as #FFFFFF, #CCDDEE.
Font Color — the font color of the row for the specified value in the Field
Value attribute. The color can be specified as a well-known color such as
white, black, cyan, light gray, as a RGB value such as 255, 255,255, or
you can specify it as #FFFFFF, #CCDDEE. The Font Color attribute is
ignored if you specify a URL in the LinkTo attribute or set the
LinkToSource or LinkToTargetURL attributes to true.
Table 18. Grid
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 217
www.agreeya.com
To o l b a r
The Toolbar page allows you to configure the appearance of the toolbar. It contains the following:
Context Menu
The Context Menu page allows you to set the look and feel of the context menu. It contains the following:
Table 19. Toolbar Appearance
Element Description
Toolbar Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the toolbar.
Show Filter Button at Top Allows you to show the Filter/Search button as a top level button. If not
selected, If set to false, the Filter/Search button is shown under the
Actions button.
Show New Item Button Allows you to show the New Item button in the toolbar.
Show Upload Button Allows you to show the Upload button in the toolbar.
Show Upload Button Type When the Show Upload Button property is selected, the Show Upload
Button Type property will determine which upload button will be displayed
in the toolbar. This property has three options: SingleFileUploadOnly,
MultipleFileUploadOnly, or SingleFileAndMultipleFileUpload.
NOTE: The Show Upload Button Type is available in SharePoint 2010 only.
Show Folders Button Allows you to show the Folders button in the toolbar.
Show Delete Button Allows you to show the Delete button in the toolbar.
Show Replace Button Allows you to show the Replace button in the toolbar.
Show Copy/Move Button Allows you to show the Copy/Move button in the toolbar.
Show Open with Windows Explorer
Button Allows you to show the Open with Windows Explorer button in the toolbar.
Show Connect to Outlook Button Allows you to show the Connect to Outlook button in the toolbar. The
Connect To Outlook button lets users view their SharePoint lists in their
Microsoft Outlook Calendar. The Connect To Outlook button will work only
if you have Microsoft Outlook installed in you computer and it only works
for the SharePoint list.
Show Alert Me Button Allows you to show the Alert Me button in the toolbar. The Alert Me button
creates a list-level alert.
Show Export Button Allows you to show the Export button in the toolbar.
Show Print Button Allows you to show the Print button in the toolbar.
Table 20. Context Menu Appearance
Element Description
Enable Context Menu Allows you to show the context menu.
Context Menu Method Allows you to define how the context menu is shown if the Enable Context Menu
property is set to True. There are three options in this property:
RightClick — The user can open the context menu by right clicking the row
in the listview. This is the default option.
ShowContextMenuColumn — The listview will show the context menu
column. The context menu column shows a drop-down arrow image which
will open the context menu when clicked.
RightClickAndShowContextMenuColumn — The user can open the context
menu either by right clicking the row or by using the context menu column.
Show View Properties Allows you to show the View Properties menu item in the context menu.
Show Edit Properties Allows you to show the Edit Properties menu item in the context menu.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 218
www.agreeya.com
Folder Tree
The Folder Tree page allows you set the appearance of the Folder panel. It contains the following:
Email Notification Editor
The Email Notification Editor allows you to set the appearance of rich text editor in the Send Email panel. It
contains the following:
Show Delete Item Allows you to show the Delete Item menu item in the context menu.
Show Manage Permissions Allows you to show the Manage Permissions menu item in the context menu.
Show Alert Me Allows you to show the Alert Me menu item in the context menu.
Show Version History Allows you to show the Show Version History menu item in the context menu.
Show Workflows Allows you to show the Show Workflows menu item in the context menu.
Show Check Out Allows you to show the Show Check Out menu item in the context menu.
Show Check In Allows you to show the Show Check In menu item in the context menu.
Show Discard Check Out Allows you to show the Show Discard Check Out menu item in the context menu.
Show Edit Document Allows you to show the Show Edit Document menu item in the context menu.
Show Edit in Browser Allows you to show the Show Edit in Browser menu item in the context menu.
Show Download a Copy Allows you to show the Show Download a Copy menu item in the context menu.
Show Create Document
Workspace Allows you to show the Show Create Document Workspace menu item in the
context menu.
Show Send Mail Allows you to show the Send Mail menu item in the context menu.
Show Publish/Unpublish
Major Version Allows you to show the Show Publish/Unpublish Major Version menu item in the
context menu.
Table 21. Folder Tree
Element Description
Folder Tree Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name.
The folder tree is enabled if you select the Show Folders Button check box
in the Toolbar Appearance tab.
Show Folder Tree on Page Load If this check box and the Show Folders Button property are selected, the
folder panel is initially expanded. This is convenient for your user if they
use folders a lot in the lists or library.
Folder Tree Height Allows you to set the height of the folder panel in pixels. The default is
300.
Table 20. Context Menu Appearance
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 219
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 22. Email Notification
Element Description
Rich Text Editor Skin
Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the rich text editor in the Send Email panel.
If you have a custom skin, you can add it to the following folder for SharePoint
2010:C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
or for SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Table 23. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 24. Other
Element Description
New Item Panel Style Defines the style of the new item panel. The new item panel is displayed when you click the New
button in the toolbar and there are multiple lists being aggregated in the view. The new item panel
lets the user select which list the new item should be created into. There are two options for the
style:
Elaborate — the new item panel displays the list of possible content types for
the list, the location and the description for the list. This is the default value.
Compact — the new item panel displays the list of possible content types for
the list but it does not display the location and the description for the list.
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to other
web parts
Allow Editing in
Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 220
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Ajax
Query Settings
Security
Resources
Ajax
The AJAX page allows you to configure AJAX in your web part.It contains the following:
Query Settings
The Query Settings page allows you to set a query in the web part. It contains the following:
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip when
you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about the web
part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part, either in a
separate window which you must close before returning to the Web Page (Mode), in a
separate window that you do not need to close before returning to the Web Page
(Modeless), or in the current browser window (Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image
URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as the web
part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in the web
part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing the web
part
Table 25. AJAX
Element Description
Enable AJAX Allows you to enable AJAX for the listview. AJAX enables the listview to carry out some
operations within the grid without refreshing the whole page. For example, when you sort a
column by clicking its column header or change the page by clicking the pager, the listview
only refreshes the data in the grid without causing the whole page to post back. However,
there are times when AJAX causes some issues. In this case, you must disable the AJAX
capability of the listview.
The following are some known situations where you need to disable AJAX:
In Internet Explorer 6, the data grid will fail to carry out the AJAX operation. If your
user base reports this issue, you can disable the AJAX to fix it.
If you use javascript's document.write() method in the Results Body property of the
Custom Display, the text that is generated using document.write() will not be
rendered after the AJAX operation. This is true even if you do not call the
document.write() directly within the Results Body but rather through another
javascript function that calls document.write().
Table 24. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 221
www.agreeya.com
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization elements in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Table 26.
Element Description
Maximum Row
Count Determines the maximum number of rows that are retrieved from the list. As an example of
when you may need to do this, when you want to show the last 5 documents that were
modified recently. In this case, you will set the Maximum Row Count property to 5.
Most of the time when you use this property, turn off the paging feature and show all of the
rows in one page. In this case, you need to set the Page Size property (in the Grid Appearance
page) to a bigger number than in the Maximum Row Count property.
Table 27. Security
Element Description
Show User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the web part. Separate groups
with commas.
Hide User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part. Separate site
group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide User
Groups, the user cannot view the Web Part.
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 222
www.agreeya.com
Table 28. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some settings,
such as the Web Part , whose value can change depending on the current culture setting.
The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string values for different
cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can have
multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default culture, leave
the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes for
the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the string
in the Resource List that is used as the text of the Web Part. The Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve
the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not
found, the default is used.
View Properties
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the View Properties context menu is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the
View Properties context menu item in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This
Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter)
are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Edit Properties
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Edit Properties context menu is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the
Edit Properties context menu item in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This
Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter)
are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Delete Item
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Delete Item context menu is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the
Delete Item context menu item in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This
Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter)
are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Manage
Permissions
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Manage Permissions context menu is retrieved from the
resource file that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the
text for the Manage Permissions context menu item in the Resource List and specify its
Resource ID. This Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture
HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the
given identifier and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is
used.
Alert Me Context
Menu Text
Resource ID
By default, the text for the Alert Me context menu is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the Alert Me
context menu item in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve
the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not
found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 223
www.agreeya.com
Version History
Context Menu
Resource ID
By default, the text for the Version History context menu is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the
Version History context menu item in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This
Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter)
are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Workflows
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Workflows context menu is retrieved from the resource file that
is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the
Workflows context menu item in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource
ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is
not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Check Out
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Check Out context menu is retrieved from the resource file that
is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the Check
Out context menu item in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is
not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Check In Context
Menu Text
Resource ID
By default, the text for the Check In context menu is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the Check In
context menu item in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve
the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not
found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Undo Check Out
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Undo Check Out context menu is retrieved from the resource
file that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for
the Undo Check Out Context Menu in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This
Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter)
are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Edit Document
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Edit Document context menu is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the
Edit Document context menu in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource
ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is
not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Edit in Browser
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Edit in Browser context menu is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the
Edit in Browser context menu in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource
ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is
not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Download Copy
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Download Copy context menu is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. If the resource file in the culture that you want to use is not
available, define the text for the Download Copy in the Resource List and specify its
Resource ID. This Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture
HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the
given identifier and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is
used.
Table 28. Localization
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 224
www.agreeya.com
Create
Document
Workspace
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Create Document Workspace context menu is retrieved from the
resource file that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the
text for the Create Document Workspace context menu in the Resource List and specify its
Resource ID. This Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture
HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the
given identifier and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is
used.
Send Email
Context Menu
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Send Email context menu is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the
Send Email context menu in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is
not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Action Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Action toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture that you
want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Action toolbar button in the
Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the current cultural
setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default
text from the invariant resource file is used.
Filter Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Filter toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture that you
want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Filter toolbar button in the
Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the current cultural
setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default
text from the invariant resource file is used.
New Button Text
Resource ID By default, the text for the New toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture that you
want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the New toolbar button in the
Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the current cultural
setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default
text from the invariant resource file is used.
Upload Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Upload toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture that you
want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the View in Chart toolbar
button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve
the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not
found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Upload
Document
Button Text
Resource ID
By default, the text for the Upload Documents toolbar button is retrieved from the resource
file that is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the
culture that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Upload
Documents toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This
Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter)
are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Upload Multiple
Documents
Button Text
Resource ID
By default, the text for the Upload Multiple Documents toolbar button is retrieved from the
resource file that is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in
the culture that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Upload
Multiple Documents toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here.
This Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP
parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given
identifier and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Table 28. Localization
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 225
www.agreeya.com
Delete Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Delete toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture that you
want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Delete toolbar button in the
Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the current cultural
setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default
text from the invariant resource file is used.
Show Folders
Button Text
Resource ID
By default, the text for the Show Folders toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture
that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Show Folders
toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and
the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is
not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Replace Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Replace toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture that you
want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Replace toolbar button in
the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the current cultural
setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default
text from the invariant resource file is used.
Copy Move
Button Text
Resource ID
By default, the text for the Copy Move toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture
that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Copy Move toolbar
button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve
the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not
found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Open with
Windows
Explorer Button
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Open with Windows Explorer toolbar button is retrieved from
the resource file that is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource
file in the culture that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the
Open with Windows Explorer toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID
here. This Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP
parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given
identifier and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Connect to
Outlook Button
Text Resource ID
By default, the text for the Connect to Outlook toolbar button is retrieved from the
resource file that is included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the
text for the Connect to Outlook toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource
ID. This Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP
parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given
identifier and culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Alert Me Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Alert Me toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that
is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture that
you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Alert Me toolbar button
in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the current
cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string
in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the
default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Export Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Export toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture that you
want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Export toolbar button in the
Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the current cultural
setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default
text from the invariant resource file is used.
Table 28. Localization
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 226
www.agreeya.com
qListView Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qListView:
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration Wizard
Configuring a Basic ListView with Filters using ezEdit
Configuring Basic Settings using the Configuration
Wizard
To configure basic settings
1 Add qListView to your page.
2 Select the ezWizard menu item from the qListView Web Part Menu or Ribbon.
3 Select one or more lists, from the current site, whose data you want to view, and click Next.
4 Select the fields you want displayed and the order you want them displayed. Click Next.
If you want to change your selections, select Previous.
5Click Finish.
NOTE: Once a Web Part is configured, the ezWizard item will not appear on the Web Part Menu or the Web Part
Ribbon.
Configuring a Basic ListView with Filters using ezEdit
To configure basic List View with filters
Print Button Text
Resource ID By default, the text for the Print toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture that you
want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Print toolbar button in the
Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the current cultural
setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default
text from the invariant resource file is used.
View in Excel
Button Text
Resource ID
By default, the text for the View in Excel toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture
that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the View in Excel
toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and
the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is
not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
View in Chart
Button Text
Resource ID
By default, the text for the View in Chart toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture
that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the View in Chart
toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and
the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is
not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Table 28. Localization
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 227
www.agreeya.com
1Open ezEdit.
2 From the Content page, select Primary Content.
3 Replace the default title with a new one.
4Select Edit from the Viewed List section.
This section is populated with lists selected when you configured basic settings.
5If
6 From the Display Fields section, click Edit.
a Select the Field Names that you wish to display.
b If you want, click Edit to edit any of the fields.
cClick Save.
7 Select the Search/Filter/Replace page.
8 Click Edit in Searched Fields, and select some field names on which you want to filter your web part.
Click OK.
9Click OK again.
A basic List View displays. Click Actions | Filter to filter the web part based on the fields selected in
step 8.
you want to then
Add a list Click Add List to find a list.
1 Enter the Site URL or if using a relative URL, you can use a
single dot (.) to denote the current path, a double dot (..)
to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the
root path.
2Select Search Subsites check box.
3Click Get Lists.
4 Select the lists that you want to use and click OK.
5Click Save.
Edit a list that is already
displayed Click Edit next to the name of a list.
If you want to include a child list, select Add Child List.
If you want to include a dependent list, select Add Dependent
List.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
13
228
www.agreeya.com
qManagement
Overview
qManagement Pages
qManagement Procedures
Overview
qManagement allows you to view and manage your web parts in one location. From qManagement, you can:
easily view and explore the hierarchy of the site where qManagement is located and its subsites
search for one or more web parts by type or by property
replace a property value with another one to one or more web parts
display your search and replace results in a table view
open ezEdit in the table view
In order to see all sites and subsites in qManagement, you must have administrator permissions. If you do not
have administrator permissions, some sites and subsites may not be displayed.
qManagement Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qManagement contains the
following tabs:
Content Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
When you open ezEdit in qManagement, the Content Page opens by default, and contains the following:
Primary Content
Paging
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
NOTE: When you perform a search and replace, you will not see the ezEdit icon in the table view if you do
not have proper permissions.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 229
www.agreeya.com
Primary Content contains the following:
Paging
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Grid
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Grid
The Grid page allows you set the appearance of the grid in the web part.
The Grid contains the following:
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the web part.
Site
Collection Allows you to select the site. The default value of this drop-down is the site where this
particular qManagement web part has been added within your site collection.
Table 2. Pa g i n g
Element Description
Paging Allows you to set:
Paging Mode - the type of pager that is displayed at the bottom of qManagement if the
items must be divided into multiple pages.
Page Size - the maximum number of rows that is displayed in one page. If the number of rows
is larger than the Page Size, the data is divided into several pages. You can navigate the pages
using the Pager displayed at the bottom of qManagement.
Table 3. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 230
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 4. Grid
Element Description
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the grid in the listview. If you have a custom skin, you
can add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common
Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for SharePoint
2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for SharePoint
2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install directory.
Table 5. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 6. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 231
www.agreeya.com
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 6. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 232
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Ajax
Security
Ajax
The AJAX page allows you to configure AJAX in your web part.It contains the following:
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Table 7. AJAX
Element Description
Enable AJAX Allows you to enable AJAX for the List Form. AJAX enables the List Form to carry out
some operations within the grid without refreshing the whole page. For example, when
you sort a column by clicking its column header or change the page by clicking the pager,
the List Form only refreshes the data in the grid without causing the whole page to post
back. However, there are times when AJAX causes some issues. In this case, you must
disable the AJAX capability of the List Form.
The following are some known situations where you need to disable AJAX:
In Internet Explorer 6, the data grid will fail to carry out the AJAX operation. If
your user base reports this issue, you can disable the AJAX to fix it.
If you use javascript's document.write() method in the Results Body property of
the Custom Display, the text that is generated using document.write() will not be
rendered after the AJAX operation. This is true even if you do not call the
document.write() directly within the Results Body but rather through another
javascript function that calls document.write().
Table 8. Security
Element Description
Show User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the web part. Separate groups
with commas.
Hide User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the web part. Separate site
group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
NOTE: If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide User
Groups, the user cannot view the web part.
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 233
www.agreeya.com
qManagement Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qManagement:
Configuring qManagement
Exploring Web Parts
Searching Web Parts
Setting New Property Values
Configuring qManagement
To configure qManagement
1 Add qManagement to your page.
2Open ezEdit.
The Primary Content page opens by default.
3 Select the following:
if you want to enable AJAX
if you want to wait a specified amount of time for the result of an AJAX asynchronous postback
operation
the skin name
if you want to display the web part to certain user groups
if you want to hide the web part from certain user groups
4Click OK.
Table 9. Display
Element Description
Enable AJAX When checked, allows you to enable AJAX for qManagement to carry out some
operations within the web part without refreshing the whole page. For example,
when you sort a column by clicking its column header or change the page by
clicking the pager, qManagement only refreshes the data in the grid without
causing the whole page to post back.
AJAX must be disabled in Internet Explorer 6, the data grid will fail to carry out the
AJAX operation. If a user reports this issue, you can disable the AJAX to fix it.
NOTE: You must enable AJAX to set an AJAX timeout value.
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the web part. If you have a custom skin, you
can add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common
Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 234
www.agreeya.com
Exploring Web Parts
Once qManagement is configured, the Explorer View opens by default. The Explorer View shows the site where
qManagement is located as the root node, and all its subsites as child nodes. From the Explorer View, you can:
open a SharePoint web part page
open ezEdit
delete a web part
get more details about the web part, such as web part type, web part product, and version number.
Searching Web Parts
You can search a list of specific web parts by selecting web part names only or selecting web part names and
entering property values.
To search Web Parts
1 Open qManagement, and click Search.
2 Select a web part type.
Click the ... button to select a single web part type or multiple web part types.
3 Select a web part property.
The web part properties displayed depend on the web part type selected. If you have selected multiple
web part types, then the common web part properties are displayed.
4 Select a search condition, and enter a property value.
These steps are optional.
5Click Go.
The results is displayed in a table showing the following:
Web Part title
Web Part type
the path where the web part is located
an Edit icon which opens ezEdit for the found web part. You will not see the ezEdit icon if you do
not have proper permissions.
Setting New Property Values
NOTE: The actions available in the treeview depend on your SharePoint permissions.
NOTE: Setting new property values in your web parts using qManagement may take a long time. If it times
out, you can increase the time-out value in the Web.Config file by setting the executionTimeout
attribute.
NOTE: This new time-out value is automatically applied to any web part that is on the same page as
qManagement, and has an AJAX operation enabled.
TIP: Because it can take a long time, set new property values during off-peak hours. If you want to see
which web parts are affected by setting new values, perform a search first. You can search and replace
properties in Web Parts only.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 235
www.agreeya.com
To set new property values
1 Open qManagement, and click Replace.
2 Select a web part type.
Click the ... button to open a dialog that allows you to select a single web part type or multiple web part
types.
3 Select a web part property.
The web part properties displayed depend on the web part type selected. If you have selected multiple
web part types, the common web part properties are displayed.
4 Select a search condition, and enter a property value.
These steps are optional.
5 Enter a new property value.
For example, if you enter the following:
Web Part Type = qListView
Web Part Property = Title
Search Condition = Contains
Property Value = Financial Department Web Part
Set Property Value to = Human Resources
The new value is Human Resources, not Human Resources Web Part.
6Click Go.
The results is displayed in a table showing the following:
the total number of results, including the number that have succeeded and/or failed
Web Part title
Web Part type
the path where the Web Part is located
an Edit icon which opens ezEdit for the found Web Part. You will not see the ezEdit icon if you do
not have proper permissions.
a status showing if setting the new property value succeeded or failed. If you see a Failed status,
you can click Failed to see an error message of why the action failed.
NOTE: Ensure you enter the applicable value you want set to a new value.
NOTE: If you enter invalid values in the Web Parts property, that Web Part may become
inoperable. If you leave this value blank, the old property value is replaced with a blank
value.
NOTE: When you set a new property value, it cannot be undone.
TIP: If you want to print your results, export the results to an Excel spreadsheet first.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
14
236
www.agreeya.com
qMediaView
Overview
qMediaView Pages
Overview
qMediaView provides support for the SharePoint Picture and Asset Libraries. The Picture Library provides the
ability to upload and share pictures in SharePoint. The Asset Library provides the same ability but with all your
digital assets such as images, audio, video, and other content from many applications.
qMediaView allows you to:
provides the ability to manage multiple media type resources in SharePoint
aggregate media from multiple picture libraries and asset libraries from various SharePoint sites
select one or more audio or video files and play them consecutively in a playlist fashion
view the media in several different ways: List, Metadata, Slide Show, Image Gallery
navigate the folder structures using breadcrumb navigation. The breadcrumb is displayed in between the
ribbon button and the picture library view. The breadcrumb navigation bar is displayed as All >>
Site/Picture Library Name >> Folder Name >> Subfolder Name. When there are multiple libraries defined
in Viewed List property, the Root node "All" is displayed allowing you to navigate to the aggregated view
of the all picture libraries' root folder structure.
divide the data into multiple pages to limit their size and render pages faster, known as Paging
define the dynamic filter or search criteria using the Filter panel, and supports the List Searcher mode in
the Media View
qMediaView Pages
You can configure this web part through its pages that are accessible through ezEdit. qMediaView contains the
following pages:
Content Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
VIDEO: Playing audio and video files requires Microsoft Silverlight. To download, go to
http://www.microsoft.com/getsilverlight/Get-Started/Install/Default.aspx. Make sure the status
of Microsoft Silverlight is enabled in Internet Explorer’s Add-ons Manager.
To enable Silverlight in Internet Explorer Add-ons Manager
1Click Tools | Manage Add-ons.
2 Select All add-ons.
3 Select Enabled for Microsoft Silverlight in the Add-on list.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 237
www.agreeya.com
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Search/Filter Panel
Paging
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Viewed Lists
The Viewed Lists section defines the lists whose data is viewed in the Media View. To aggregate information
from multiple lists, define the lists one by one using this property.
The following are the elements for the Viewed List attribute.
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to add a title to the web part.
Viewed Lists For more information, see Viewed Lists on page 237.
Display Fields For more information, see Display Fields on page 238..
Enable AJAX Allows you to enable AJAX. AJAX enables the Media View to carry out some operations
within the frame without refreshing the whole page. For example, when you change
the page by clicking the pager, the Media View only refreshes the data in the grid
without causing the whole page to post back. However, there are times when AJAX
causes some issues. In this case, you must disable the AJAX capability of the Media
View.
The following are some known situations where you need to disable AJAX:
In Internet Explorer 6, the data frame will fail to carry out the AJAX operation.
If your user base reports this issue, you can disable the AJAX to fix it.
If you use javascript's document.write() method in the Results Body property of
the Custom Display, the text that is generated using document.write() will not
be rendered after the AJAX operation.This is true even if you do not call the
document.write() directly within the Results Body but rather through another
javascript function that calls document.write().
Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the frame in the Media View. The skin name is
associated with a folder under the following directory in the web server:
C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web
ServerExtensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\DevExpress\9.3\Themes
The skin folder will contain the CSS file and images needed to control the visual
appearance of the grid. If none of the provided skins satisfy your need, you can copy
one of the existing skins and modify it. You must follow the CSS class name convention
in the CSS file, which is class name followed by the skin name; for example,
dxtlControl_Office2003Blue.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 238
www.agreeya.com
Display Fields
This property defines the fields that should be displayed in the Media View.
The Display Field contains the following elements:
Table 2. Viewed Lists
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Viewed Lists in XML format. For example:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="." ListName="MyPicLib" />
<List SiteUrl="./TeamBlog" ListName="Photos" />
</Lists>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can
be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
List Name Allows you to set the name of the SharePoint list that is edited or displayed. The list
name is case sensitive. If the list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as
well.
To denote the current list, you can use a single dot (.) as the list name.
NOTE: This only works if the qMediaView is contained in the AllItems.aspx. For
example, if you are replacing the Microsoft Media View in the AllItems.aspx of the
Tasks list and you use a single dot as the ListName attribute, the ListName attribute of
the qMediaView is set to Tasks. If you want to save the list as a template and then add
it somewhere else, the name of the new list might not be Tasks and using this relative
list name will automatically pick up the new list name for the view.
Table 3. Display Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Display Fields in XML format:
<Fields>
<Field Name="Name" InternalName="FileLeafRef" />
<Field Name="Type" InternalName="DocIcon" />
<Field Name="Copy Source" InternalName="_CopySource" />
<Field Name="File Size" InternalName="FileSizeDisplay" />
<Field Name="Preview" InternalName="PreviewOnForm" />
<Field Name="Picture Width" InternalName="ImageWidth" />
<Field Name="Description" InternalName="Description" />
</Fields>
Field Name If specified, indicates a cross-site lookup field. It contains the name of the field in the
cross-site list that contains the value to be displayed. The field name is case sensitive.
A cross-site lookup field enables you to lookup a list that resides in another site, another
site collection, or another web application as long as it is in the same configuration
database. You need the qListForm web part to create a cross-site lookup field.
Title Indicates the title of the field. This is useful if the real field name is too long and you want
to abbreviate the title in the field header, or if you simply want to display a different title
in the field header. If this attribute is not specified, the value specified in the Name
attribute is used in the field header. For example:
<Field Name="Created By" Title="Author" />
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 239
www.agreeya.com
Search/Filter Panel
The Search/Filter Panel allows you to define the panels for search, filter, and replace in the web part.
The Search/Filter Panel contains the following elements:
Searched Fields
This property defines which fields is displayed in the Filter panel. If defined, the Media View displays the Filter
menu items under the Actions tab. To disable the Filter feature, leave this property blank.
Width Indicates the width of the field. You can specify the value in pixels (Width="20px") or
percentage (Width="20%").
We recommend leaving at least one field where you do not specify this property. That field
will take up the remaining width of the page. For example:
<Field Name="Subject" Width="100px" />
Align Indicates the horizontal alignment for the field. The values is one of the following: left,
right, or center. For example:
<Field Name="Created" Align="right" />
Table 4. Search/Filt e r Pa nel
Element Description
Searched Fields See Searched Fields on page 239.
Expand Filter panel
on Load Allows you to automatically open the Filter panel by default so that the user can
perform a search quickly. When set to true, the Filter panel opens when the web part
is loaded for the first time.
Turn on Media Search
Mode Allows you to perform a search before the Media View displays any data.
Show Search All Fields
Control in Search
Panel
Determines whether the Filter panel should display the control to search all fields in
the list. When set to true, the following control is shown in the Filter panel:
The Search All Fields Control allows you to do the following:
Combine the search all fields functionality with other search criteria that has
been entered for specific fields.
When the search all fields criteria is entered, the Filter panel will construct a
filter expression with the "Contain" operator for the following fields in the list:
Single line of text, Multiple lines of text, Choice, Lookup (only Lookup to a
Single Text field and Lookup to a Number field are supported), Person or Group
and Hyperlink or Picture. If the list contains a Lookup to Number field, Search
All Fields will not work for negative numbers for that field. The Filter panel will
use the entire keywords as the value to be searched. Therefore, if you enter
"High Priority" in the search all fields control and perform the search, it will
find the following sentence:
‘This is a high priority task’
However, it will not find the following sentence:
‘The priority is not always high’
Panel Button Location Determines the location of the Go, Reset and Close buttons in the Filter panel. This
property also determines the location of the Go and Close buttons in the Replace
panel.
Table 3. Display Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 240
www.agreeya.com
You will be able to perform a search by pressing Enter.
The Fields element can contain multiple Field elements.The following are the elements for the Searched Fields.
Paging
Paging allows you to set the following:
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
View
Slide Show Appearance
Layout
NOTE: Pressing Enter will not allow you to perform a search on such fields as external data, people picker,
managed metadata, and a drop-down list. Instead, the default behavior will occur.
NOTE: For the Number type field, the “Contain” operator is not supported for negative numbers, and is
not available for the following fields: Lookup to DateTime field, Lookup to Calculated field, and Lookup to
ID field.
Table 5. Searched Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Searched Fields in XML format.
<Fields> <Field Name="Name" InternalName="FileLeafRef" />
<Field Name="Title" InternalName="Title" />
<Field Name="File Type" InternalName="FileType" />
<Field Name="Site Name" InternalName="Site Name" />
</Fields>
Name Specifies the name of the field. The field name is case sensitive. If the field name
contains spaces, include the spaces in the name as well.
Title Allows you to set the displayed title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an
encoded HTML string.
Width Allows you to set description that is displayed under the field value. This is useful if
you want to give a short instruction or explanation about the field.
Table 6. Pa g i n g
Element Description
Page Size Allows you to set the maximum number of items that are displayed in one page. If
the number of items is larger than the Page Size, the data is divided into several
pages. The user can navigate the pages using the Pager displayed at the bottom of
the page.
Paging Mode Allows you to set the type of pager that is displayed at the bottom of the page if
the items must be divided into multiple pages. A numeric pager is more user-
friendly because you are not bound to only next or previous pages. However, the
numeric pager consumes a lot more resources to generate, especially when the
list contains a large number of items. The next previous pager is more efficient
when the following conditions are fulfilled:
When the Display Fields property does not contain grouped fields.
When the Viewed Lists property only contain one list.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 241
www.agreeya.com
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
View
The View page contains the following:
Slide Show Appearance
The Slide Show Appearance Tab contains the following:
Table 7. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 8. View
Element Description
Media View Type The media can be viewed in several different ways. For a picture library: List,
Metadata, Slide Show, or Image Gallery. For an asset library: All Assets and
Thumbnails. The mode that is used by the web part when the page is first
loaded can be set using this property. The user can change the viewing mode
on the fly as well using the View tab of the qMediaView Web Part.
Skin Name The skin name for the frame in the Media View. The skin name is associated
with a folder under the following directory in the web server:
C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q22011\Skins
The following skins are available out of the box: Black, Default, Forest, Hay,
Office2007, Outlook, Simple, Sitefinity, Sunset, Vista, Web20, WebBlue,
Windows7.
The skin folder will contain the CSS file and images needed to control the
visual appearance of the grid. If none of the provided skins satisfy your need,
you can define your own skin. The easiest way to do so is by copying one of the
existing skins and modify it. Please note that you must follow the CSS class
name convention in the CSS file, which is class name followed by the skin
name; e.g., .RadListView_Default.
Show Toolbar Allows you show or hide the toolbar. This element is checked by default. Once
the toolbar displays on a page, you can expand or collapse it as required.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 242
www.agreeya.com
Table 9. Slide Show Appearance
Element Description
Slide Show Style Allows you to specify the different styles for the slide show. You can
change the style on the fly as well using the View tab of qMediaView. The
options are as follows:
AutomaticAdvance — Media items are scrolled automatically at the
specified speed.
ButtonsOver — Media items are scrolled by hovering over the
control buttons for each scroll direction.
Buttons — Media items are scrolled by clicking the control buttons
for each scroll direction.
SlideShow — Media items are automatically advanced with an
optional transition effect (for example fade) instead of scrolling.
SlideShowButtons — Media items are displayed by clicking the
control buttons for each sliding direction.
Carousel — Media items are automatically displayed in carousel
style.
CarouselButtons — Media items are displayed in carousel style by
clicking the control buttons for each scroll direction.
CoverFlow — Media items are automatically displayed in cover flow
style.
CoverFlowButtons — Media items are automatically displayed in
cover flow style by clicking the control buttons for each flow
direction.
Scroll Duration (milliseconds) Allows you to specify, in milliseconds, the speed for the scrolling frames.
The default is 500.
Frame Duration
(milliseconds) Allows you to specify, in milliseconds, the speed each frame will display.
The default is 500. This property is ignored in the Buttons and
SlideShowButtons modes.
Wrap Frames Allows you to set the frame to scroll from the beginning again once it
reaches the last frame.
Slide Animation Type Allows you to specify the skin name for the grid in the listview. Specifies
the type of the animation. The options are Fade, Pulse and CrossFade.
Slide Animation Duration
(milliseconds) Allows you to specify the slide show animation duration in milliseconds.
The default is 3000.This property is only applicable when the Slide Show
Style is set to 'SlideShow' or 'SlideShowButtons'.
Item Width (px) Allows you to specify the rotator item's width in pixels. The default is 550.
This property is only applicable when the Slide Show Style is set to
'SlideShow' or 'SlideShowButtons'.
Item Height (px) Allows you to specify the rotator item's height in pixels. The default is
410. This property is only applicable when the Slide Show Style is set to
'SlideShow' or 'SlideShowButtons'.
Rotator Width (px) Allows you to specify the rotator width in pixels. The default is 550. This
property is only applicable when the Slide Show Style is set to 'SlideShow'
or 'SlideShowButtons'.
Rotator Height (px) Allows you to specify the rotator height in pixels. The default is 410. This
property is only applicable when the Slide Show Style is set to 'SlideShow'
or 'SlideShowButtons'.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 243
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Enable Ribbon Bar Allows you to specify if the Ribbon Bar is visible or hidden. The default is
Visible. This property is only applicable when the Slide Show Style is set to
'SlideShow' or 'SlideShowButtons'.
Scroll Duration Allows you to specify possible directions for the scrolling frames. The
options are Horizontal and Vertical. This property is only applicable when
the Slide Show Style is set to a 'Button' type style.
Table 10. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 11. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Table 9. Slide Show Appearance
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 244
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Ajax
Security
Ajax
The AJAX page allows you to configure AJAX in your web part.It contains the following:
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 12. Ajax
Element Description
Enable Ajax Allows you to enable AJAX for the List Form. AJAX enables the List Form to carry out some
operations within the grid without refreshing the whole page. For example, when you sort a
column by clicking its column header or change the page by clicking the pager, the List Form
only refreshes the data in the grid without causing the whole page to post back. However,
there are times when AJAX causes some issues. In this case, you must disable the AJAX
capability of the List Form.
The following are some known situations where you need to disable AJAX:
In Internet Explorer 6, the data grid will fail to carry out the AJAX operation. If your
user base reports this issue, you can disable the AJAX to fix it.
If you use javascript's document.write() method in the Results Body property of the
Custom Display, the text that is generated using document.write() will not be rendered
after the AJAX operation. This is true even if you do not call the document.write()
directly within the Results Body but rather through another javascript function that
calls document.write().
Table 13. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
Table 11. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
15
245
www.agreeya.com
qMultiSelector
Overview
qMultiSelector Pages
Overview
qMultiSelector contains one or more qSelector web parts. When multiple selectors are displayed, one selector
will filter the next one. For example, when if you have two lists called Projects and Phases, the first selector
displays the data from the Projects list, while the second selector displays the data from the Phases list. Only
phases that belong to the project selected in the first selector are displayed.
qMultiSelector supports multiple languages. You can define a different title for different languages using the
Resource List and the Title Resource ID properties. The culture for the page can be defined by appending the
Culture HTTP parameter to the page URL. For example:
http://hostname/sites/sitename/default.aspx?Culture=en-US
qMultiSelector implements the row provider interface. It can provide a row to another Row Consumer web part
or a filter to another Filter Consumer web part.
The List Form implements IRowProvider interface. It can provide a row to another Row Consumer web part or a
filter to another Filter Consumer web part.
The List Form also implements IWebPartRow interface, and it can provide a row to another web part, such as
qListView.
qMultiSelector Pages
You can configure this web part through its pages that are accessible through ezEdit. qMultiSelector contains
the following pages:
Content Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
NOTE: IRowProvider is obsolete. It is provided here only for backward compatibility reason. When you
establish the web part connection, this interface is labeled Provide Row To (Obsolete) in the web part
Connections menu. Use the IWebPartRow implementation that is labeled with Send Row To.
NOTE: IWebPartRow is labeled with Send Row To in the web part Connection menu. This interface cannot
be connected with the obsolete IRowConsumer or IFilterConsumer implementation. Do not connect this
new interface with the old interface that is marked obsolete.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 246
www.agreeya.com
Primary Content
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Configuration
This property defines the configuration for each selector.
The top-level element is called Configuration. This element contains one or more PersistentSelector elements.
Each PersistentSelector element represents one qSelector selector. Most attributes in the PersistentSelector
element are the same properties as those defined for qSelector without spaces in its name. For example, the
Show Empty Selection property in the qSelector becomes the ShowEmptySelection attribute in the
PersistentSelector element.
The Configuration section contains the following:
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the web part.
Selector Direction Allows you to control the positioning of the selectors. If LeftToRight is selected, the
selectors are positioned side by side. If TopToBottom is selected, the selectors are
stacked on top of one another.
Configuration See Configuration on page 246.
Table 2. Configuration
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Configuration in XML format.
<Configuration>
<PersistentSelector Title="Select a Project" SessionName="ProjectSession" SiteUrl="."
ListName="Projects" DisplayFieldName="Project Name"
DisplayFields="&lt;Fields&gt;&lt;Field Name=&quot;Project ID&quot;/&gt;&lt;Field
Name=&quot;Project Name&quot;/&gt;&lt;/Fields&gt;" />
<PersistentSelector Title="The select a Phase" ParentFilterFieldName="ID"
FilterFieldName="Project List Item ID" SessionName="PhaseName" SiteUrl="."
ListName="Phases" DisplayFieldName="Phase Name" />
</Configuration>
Title Allows you to enter a title that is displayed above the selector. This field is mandatory.
List Name Allows you to select a list. This field is mandatory. For more information, see List
Name on page 247.
Session Name Allows you to define the search session variable name where the qSelector stores the
last selected item. If you want to associate several selectors, you must define the
same Search Session Name property for all of them. This field is mandatory.
Hidden Allows you hide the field to prevent other users from changing the selection.
Parent Filter Field
Name Allows you to enter the field name from the previous selector that is used to filter the
information in this selector.
Filter Field Name Allows you to enter the field name in the selector that filters the information.
Display Field Name Allows to select the name of the field that you want to display in the selector.If you
want to display information from multiple fields, use the Display Format properties.
The Display Field Name property is ignored if the Display Format property is defined.
This field is mandatory.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 247
www.agreeya.com
List Name
This property defines the following:
The list whose data is viewed in the selector.
Display Format Allows you to define the format of the items that are displayed in the selector. You can
use field replacement expression (<%field name %>) to refer to a field name. For more
information, see Display Format on page 14.
Display Fields Allows you to define the fields that are displayed in the drop-down menu of the web
part. You can enter values for the following:
Site URL - Indicates the Site URL of the field. You can use an absolute or
relative URL
List Name - Indicates the name of the List. The field name is case sensitive.
Parent Filter Field Name - Defines the field in the parent field that is used to
filter this field. It is the primary key in the list that is used in the lookup or
cross-site lookup field.
Filter Field Name - Defines the field in the list that is used by this lookup or
cross-site lookup field that is filtered by the parent filter field.
Eliminate Duplicate
Values Allows you to define whether or not you want to eliminate duplicate values in the
drop-down menu. This is useful in case you want to use the selector as a filter to
another Web Part.
CAML Filter
Expression Allows you to enter a CAML (Collaboration Application Markup Language) query
expression to filter your data. CAML is an XML based query language. For more
information, see CAML Filters on page 19.
Complex Filter Allows you enter Complex Filter expression to define a static filter for the data. The
complex filter is applied to the data after the CAML Filter is applied. For more
information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
Sort Field Allows you to enter a value that is used to sort the entries in the qSelector. This
property accepts a single field name.
Sort Ascending Allows you to sort the entries in the ascending order. Deselect this check boxif you
want the entries in descending order. This field is ignored if the Sort Field property is
not defined.
Show Empty Selection Allows you to display the value of Empty Selection Item Name property as the first
item.
You should check this property if you want the user to be able to select nothing.
Selecting nothing returns the entire unfiltered list. Another case is when the qSelector
acts as a filter to another web part and you want the ability to pass an empty filter.
This means the other web part will display all its data unfiltered.
Empty Selection Item
Name Allows you to display a specified value as the first item in the Selector when the Show
Empty Selection is checked. The default is - Select One -.
Empty Drop Down
Item Name Allows you to display specified text that is displayed in the drop-down menu when it
contains no list items. The default is <Empty>.
Persistent Width
Selector Allows you to set the width of the input part for the persistent selector.
Drop Down Width Allows you to set the width of the drop-down for the selector in pixels. If you specify
the width for each field in the Display Fields property in pixels, the value of this
property is usually the total width of all fields.
Drop Down Height Allows you to set the height of the drop-down menu.
Refresh Page When
Selection Changed Allows you to determine whether the page should be refreshed when you select
another item in the selector. By default, the value is false, which means that the page
is only posted back.
Table 2. Configuration
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 248
www.agreeya.com
The following are the elements for the List attribute.
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Selector
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Selector
The Selector page allows you to configure the appearance of the selector. It contains the following:
Table 3. List Name
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit List Name in XML format. XML will look like the following:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="." ListName="Employee List" />
</Lists>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can
be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
List Name Allows you to enter the name of the SharePoint list that is displayed. The list name is
case sensitive. If the list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as well.
Table 4. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 249
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 5. Toolbar
Element Description
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the grid in the listview. If you have a custom skin, you
can add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common
Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for SharePoint
2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web
ServerExtensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web
ServerExtensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install directory.
Table 6. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 7. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to other
web parts
Allow Editing in
Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip when
you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about the web
part.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 250
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part, either in
a separate window which you must close before returning to the Web Page (Mode),
in a separate window that you do not need to close before returning to the Web Page
(Modeless), or in the current browser window (Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as the web
part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in the web
part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing the web
part
Table 8. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 7. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 251
www.agreeya.com
Table 9. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some settings,
such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current culture setting.
The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string values for different
cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can have
multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value is
different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default culture,
leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes for
the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the string
in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve
the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not
found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
16
252
www.agreeya.com
qPageRedirector
Overview
qPageRedirector Pages
Overview
qPageRedirector sends users to a designated URL. To accomplish this, you could create a "My Home" hyperlink on
your page that redirects the user to the MyHomeRedirect.aspx page. In the MyHomeRedirect.aspx page, you
would put a Page Redirector web part.
qPageRedirector reads a list that contains two columns: User Name and URL. It will search the list for the entry
with User Name equals to the current logged on user. If it finds it, it will redirect the user to the URL mapped to
that user in the list.
The SharePoint list for the Page Redirector must contain these two fields:
User Name a user lookup field that defines the user.
URL a text field. It can contain relative or absolute URL
If your list uses different names for the fields, you must define the names in the User Name Field Name and the
URL Field Name property of the Page Redirector.
Here is the sample list:
When jsmith logs in, it will redirect him to home/jsmith.aspx.
You can localize the title of the Page Redirector. You can define different Titles for different cultures using the
Resource List and the Title Resource ID properties. You can use the Culture Selector web part to set the culture
for the site. The Culture Selector web part will define the culture using the Culture HTTP parameter as shown in
the following example:
http://hostname/sites/sitename/default.aspx?Culture=en-US
Table 1. Sample Lis t
User Name URL
Questdev\jsmith home/jsmith.aspx
Questdev\kbrown home/kbrown.aspx
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 253
www.agreeya.com
qPageRedirector Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qPageRedirector contains
the following tabs:
Content Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Menu
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Table 2. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part. This field is mandatory.
Site URL Allows you to enter the URL to the site that contains the list. The URL can be absolute
(http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is mandatory.
List Name Allows you to enter a list name. The name is case sensitive. If the name of the list
contains spaces, include the spaces in the List Name.
User Name Field
Name Allows you to enter the name of the field containing the user name. The default value
is User Name.
URL Field Name Allows you to enter the name of the field containing the URL. The default value is URL.
Table 3. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 254
www.agreeya.com
Menu
The Menu page allows you to configure the menu items in the web part. It contains the following:
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 4. Toolbar
Element Description
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the grid. If you have a custom skin, you can add it to
the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft
Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for SharePoint
2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web
ServerExtensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web
ServerExtensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install directory.
Menu Width Allows you to enter the width of the menu (in pixels).
Menu Height Allows you to enter the height of the menu (in pixels).
Table 5. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 6. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 255
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 7. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 6. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 256
www.agreeya.com
Table 8. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
17
257
www.agreeya.com
qPanelMenu
Overview
qPanelMenu Pages
qPanelMenu Procedures
Overview
qPanelMenu groups navigation items into multiple panels. The panel menu is similar to that on the left side of
Microsoft Outlook.
qPanelMenu has the ability to:
display items from different SharePoint lists. Each SharePoint list can contain the definition for multiple
panels. The source lists for the menu are defined in the Configuration property.
define a static FilterExpression using Complex Filters so you can define the items to be displayed in your
menu.
show or hide the top-level items that come from a certain list based on the site group membership of the
currently logged-in user.
hide menu items whose target URLs are not accessible by the current user
define an icon for each menu item, and define the target frame for the target page.
define different Title for different cultures using the Resource List and the Title Resource ID properties.
Your can define the culture appending the Culture HTTP parameter to the page URL. For example:
http://hostname/sites/sitename/default.aspx?Culture=en-US
To configure this web part, we recommend that you use the AgreeYa Menu List custom list template. Use the
template to define a source list for the menu items on a SharePoint site. For information on how to create the
source list, see Configuring qPanelMenu on page 263. This automatically creates a list which contains the
following columns by default:
Table 1. Menu List Custom List Template
Column description
Text Provide the text for the menu item.
Menu ID Provides the ID for the menu item.
Parent Menu ID Provides the ID of the menu item that is the parent of this menu item.
Target Url Provides the target URL for the menu item.
NOTE: This is not a Hyperlink field because Hyperlink field does not let you use a relative URL.
Target Indicates where to open the target page. Specify _blank to open the page in a new window.
Leave the target column empty to redirect the current window to the target URL.
Icon Url Provides the URL to the icon for the menu item.
Access Key Indicates the shortcut key to activate the menu item. You can activate the menu item by
pressing ALT+Access Key Character.
Culture Indicates the culture for this menu item
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 258
www.agreeya.com
You must map these columns in the source list to the corresponding field names in the Configuration section in
the Web Part. For more information on the Configuration section, see Configuration on page 258. For more
information on how to configure the qPanelMenu Web Part, see Configuring qPanelMenu on page 263.
qPanelMenu Pages
You can configure this Web Part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qPanelMenu contains the
following pages:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Optional Content
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Configuration
This property defines the source list and behavior of the Panel Menu. The Configuration element can contain
one or more Menu elements. Each menu element can read a different source.
The following are the elements for the Configuration section:
Table 2. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the web part.
Configuration See Configuration on page 258.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 259
www.agreeya.com
Table 3. Configuration
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Configuration in XML format.
<Configuration>
<Menu SiteUrl="url" ListName="listName" FilterExpression="filterExpression"
TextFieldName="Text" MenuIdFieldName="Menu Id" TargetUrlFieldName="Target Url"
TargetFieldName="Target" IconUrlFieldName="Icon Url" AccessKeyFieldName="Access
Key" CultureFieldName="Culture" ShowUserGroups="Group1, Group2"
HideUserGroups="Group1, Group2" CheckUserAccess="true/false"/>
</Configuration>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can
be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
List Name Allows you to enter the name of the list. The name is case sensitive. If the name of
the list contains spaces, include the spaces in the List Name.
Filter Expression Allows you to filter the data. The Complex Filter Expression to filter the data. For
more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
Menu ID Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the text for the menu item. This
attribute is optional if the field name is Text.
Parent Menu ID Field
Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the parent ID for the menu item.
This attribute is optional if the field name is Parent Menu ID.
Target URL Field
Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the indicator of where to open
the target URL. This attribute is optional if the field name is Target Url.
Target Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the indicator of where to open
the target page. This attribute is optional if the field name is Target.
Icon URL Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the icon URL for the menu item.
This attribute is optional if the field name is Icon Url.
Culture Field Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the culture for the menu item.
This attribute is optional if the field name is Culture.
Access Key Field
Name Allows you to set the name of the field that contains the access key for the menu
item. This attribute is optional if the field name is Access Key.
Show User Groups Allows you to show groups where the user is a member of one of the SharePoint groups
listed. Separate site group names with commas.
Hide User Groups Allows you to hide groups where the user is a member of one of the SharePoint groups
listed. Separate site group names with commas.
Check User Access Allows you to show only the menu items that point to the workspace which the current
can access.
NOTE: Performance can be affected when checking the access for each menu item,
especially for large menus. Also, make sure that every menu item points to a page in a
SharePoint site that is reachable from the current site (as opposed to any external
site, such as Google®)
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 260
www.agreeya.com
Optional Content
The Optional Content page contains the following:
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Navigation
Navigation
The Navigation page allows you to configure how and where the user will navigate in the web part. It contains
the following elements:
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Menu
Layout
Other
Table 4. Optional Content
Element Description
Expand Effect Allows you to set the visual effect that is applied when the panel items are expanded
or collapsed. The default expand effect is Linear.
Expand Group Indices Allows you to set the indices of the groups that are expanded initially when the page
is loaded. The index starts with 0. For example, if you want to expand the first and
the third groups, specify: 0, 2
Expand All Parent Menu
Items on Load Allows you to expand all parent menu items when the page is loaded. Parent menu
items are all menu items that contain sub menu items underneath it. If you set this to
true, you do not have to define the Expanded Group Indices property since it will
automatically expand the top level menu items as well.
Expand Mode Allows you to set the behavior of the panels when one is expanded or collapsed. The
default expand mode is MultipleExpandedItems. This expand mode enables you to
expand multiple panels at the same time.
Table 5. Navigation
Element Description
Target URL Relative to
Master URL Allows you to append the value of the target URL to the URL of the master page. By
default, this property is set to true to maintain backward compatibility with the
existing applications who assumed that the relative URL is appended to the relative
URL of the master page.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 261
www.agreeya.com
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Menu
The Menu page allows you to configure the menu items in the web part. It contains the following:
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 6. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 7. Toolbar
Element Description
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the grid in the listview. If you have a custom skin, you
can add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common
Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for SharePoint
2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for SharePoint
2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install directory.
Menu Width Allows you to enter the width of the menu (in pixels).
Menu Height Allows you to enter the height of the menu (in pixels).
Table 8. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 9. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 262
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 10. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
Table 9. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 263
www.agreeya.com
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
qPanelMenu Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qPanelMenu:
Configuring qPanelMenu
Configuring qPanelMenu
To configure qPanelMenu
1 Create a source list from AgreeYa Menu List in SharePoint. The list will contain the following fields:
Text - This field is mandatory. This is a single line of text field that provides the text for the menu
item.
Menu Id - This field is mandatory. This is a single line of text field that provides the ID for the
menu item.
Parent Menu Id - This field is mandatory. This is a single line of text field that provides the parent
ID for the menu item.
Target Url - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field that provides the target URL for
the menu item. Please note that this is not a Hyperlink field because Hyperlink field does not let
you use a relative URL.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 11. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some settings,
such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current culture setting.
The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string values for different
cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can have
multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default culture,
leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes for
the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the string
in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve
the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not
found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 264
www.agreeya.com
Target - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field that indicates where to open the
target page.
Icon Url - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field that provides the URL to the icon
for the menu item.
Access Key - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field (one character) that indicates
the shortcut key to activate the menu item. You can activate the menu item by pressing
ALT+Access Key Character.
Culture - This field is optional. This is a single line of text field that indicates the culture for this
menu item.
2 Create a top-level menu. Click New Item to add information to your source list.
3 Create an entry in the list with blank Parent Menu Id, for example:
The Panel Menu can also read any type of list that contains at least the first four fields: Text, Menu Id,
Parent Menu Id, and Target Url.
4 Add qPanelMenu to your site collection page.
5Open ezEdit.
The Primary Content page opens by default.
6 From the Configuration section, select the source list created in SharePoint, and click OK.
7Click Edit next to the list name.
8 For each field name, select the corresponding column name (from the source list created in SharePoint).
For example, for Text Field Name, select Text; for Menu Id Field Name, select Menu Id. Click OK.
9 If needed, configure the elements in the other tabs.
10 When done configuring each tab, click OK.
Table 12. Example of Panel Menu List
Text Menu
ID
Parent
Menu ID Ta r get URL Target Icon URL Access
Key Culture
Projects 01 P
Project 01 Pid-ID
Project One 01.01 01 Project1 O
Project Status 01.01 01 Project1 Sid-ID
Multi Projects 01.02 01 MultiProjects M
Bank Project 01.02 01 MultiProjects Bid-ID
NOTE: If the name of the fields is not specified, you must define the field name mapping in
the Configuration property.
IMPORTANT: You must build the parent menu before building child menu. If a child menu list item
references a menu ID of another list item, this list item must have been used to construct a menu.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
18
265
www.agreeya.com
qSelector
Overview
qSelector Pages
Overview
qSelector displays data from a SharePoint list in a drop-down control. qSelector remembers the last item
selected, even after you leave the page.
Using qSelector, you can:
keep the context of your work. For example, you can manage multiple projects in one workspace easily
by using qSelector. You can place a selector that displays the project information on every page in your
application and use that selector to filter the data in the qListView or any other view on the page.
Because the selector remembers the last item selected even as you move from page to page, you only
see the data for the same project until you switch to another project.
place a selector above a qListForm to select a certain item and then feed that item to the list form
because the qSelector is a row provider.
support dynamic language switching and Flash and JavaScript (HTML5)
qSelector supports multiple languages. You can define a different Title for different languages using the
Resource List and the Title Resource ID properties. The culture for the page can be defined by appending the
Culture HTTP parameter to the page URL. For example:
http://hostname/sites/sitename/default.aspx?Culture=en-US
qSelector implements the following web part connection interfaces:
IRowProvider interface, which provides a row to another Row Consumer web part or a filter to another
Filter Consumer web part.
IWebPartRow interface, which provides a row to another web part, such as qListView.
IFilterConsumer interface, which consumes a filter from another web part that implements IRowProvider
or IFilterProvider interface.
NOTE: The IRowProvider interface is obsolete. It is provided here only for backward
compatibility reason. When you establish the web part connection, this interface is labeled
Provide Row To (Obsolete) in the web part Connections menu. Use the IWebPartRow
implementation that is labeled with Send Row To.
NOTE: The IWebPartRow implementation is labeled with Send Row To in the web part
Connection menu. This interface cannot be connected with the obsolete IRowConsumer or
IFilterConsumer implementation. Do not connect this new interface with the old interface
that is marked obsolete.
NOTE: The IFilterConsumer interface is obsolete. It is provided here only for backward
compatibility reason. When you establish the web part connection, this interface is labeled
Consume Filter From (Obsolete) in the web part Connections menu. Use the
IWebPartParameter consumer implementation that is labeled with Get Filter From.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 266
www.agreeya.com
IWebPartParameter interface, which enables the selector to consume a filter from another web part that
implements IWebPartRow or IWebPartParameter interface.
qSelector Pages
You can configure this web part through its pages that are accessible through ezEdit. qMultiSelector contains
the following pages:
Content Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Filtering
Sorting
Selection
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
NOTE: The IWebPartParameter consumer implementation is labeled with Get Filter From in
the web part Connection menu. This interface cannot be connected with the obsolete
IFilterProvider or IRowProvider implementation. Do not connect this new interface with the
old interface that is marked obsolete.
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the web part.
Search Session
Name Allows you to define the search session variable name where the qSelector stores the last
selected item. If you want to associate several selectors, you must define the same Search
Session Name property for all of them.
List Name Allows you to select a list. For more information, see List Name on page 267.
Display Field
Name Allows to select the name of the field that you want to display in the selector.If you want
to display information from multiple fields, use the Display Format properties. The Display
Field Name property is ignored if the Display Format property is defined.
Display Format Allows you to define the format of the items that are displayed in the selector. You can
use field replacement expression (<%field name %>) to refer to a field name. For more
information, see Display Format on page 14.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 267
www.agreeya.com
List Name
This property defines the following:
The list whose data is viewed in the selector.
The following are the elements for the List attribute.
Filtering
The Filtering page allows you to use CAML filters to dynamically filter records or use Complex Filters to define
static filter for the data.
The Filtering page contains the following:
Display Fields Allows you to define the fields that are displayed in the drop-down menu of the web part.
If defined, the choices in the drop-down menu are displayed in a grid.
This property is an XML string in this format:
<Fields>
<Field Name="fieldName" Width="width" />
<Field Name="fieldName" Width="width" />
</Fields>
The <Fields> element may contain one or more <Field> elements.
Name - The name of the field. The field name is case-sensitive.
Width - The display width of the field. The value can be in pixel (for example:
200px) or percent (for example: 30%).
Eliminate
Duplicate Values Allows you to define whether or not you want to eliminate duplicate values in the drop-
down menu. This is useful in case you want to use the selector as a filter to another Web
Part.
Table 2. List Name
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit List Name in XML format. XML will look like the following:
<Lists>
<List SiteUrl="." ListName="Employee List" />
</Lists>
Site URL Allows you to set the URL to the site that contains the list to be searched. The URL can
be absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
When using a relative URL, you can use a single dot (.) to denote the current path, a
double dot (..) to denote the previous path, and a slash (/) to denote the root path.
List Name Allows you to enter the name of the SharePoint list that is displayed. The list name is
case sensitive. If the list name contains spaces, include the spaces here as well.
Table 3. Filtering
Element Description
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 268
www.agreeya.com
Sorting
The Sorting page allows you to define the sorting criteria.
The Sorting page contains the following elements:
Selection
The Selection page allows you to configure what do with empty selections. This page contains the following:
CAML Filter Allows you to specify the CAML (Collaboration Application Markup Language) query
expression to filter your data. CAML is an XML-based query language. The CAML Filter will
only be applied to the data. The filter will not be applied to the responses.
For more information, see CAML Filters on page 19.
Complex Filter Allows you to use the Complex Filter expression to define a static filter for the data. The
complex filter is applied to the data after the CAML Filter is applied.
NOTE: The Complex Filter is provided here only for backward compatibility reason. In the
past, Complex filter was used to support date functions.
For more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
Table 4. Sorting/Paging
Element Description
Sort Fields Allows you to enter a value that is used to sort the entries. This property accepts a
single field name.
Sort in Ascending
Order Allows you to sort the entries in the ascending order. Deselect this check box if you
want the entries in descending order. This field is ignored if the Sort Field property is
not defined.
Table 5. Selection
Element Description
Show Empty Selection Allows you to display the value of Empty Selection Item Name property as the first
item.
You should check this property if you want the user to be able to select nothing.
Selecting nothing returns the entire unfiltered list. Another case is when the
qSelector acts as a filter to another web part and you want the ability to pass an
empty filter. This means the other web part will display all its data unfiltered.allow
customer to select the behavior of the empty selection. And this option is only valid
for the "Get Filter From" connection type.
Turn Off Filtering When
Empty Selection is
Chosen
Allows you to turn filtering on or off if Show Empty Selection is selected. This option
is only valid for the "Get Filter From" connection type.
Empty Selection Item
Name Allows you to display a specified value as the first item in the Selector when the
Show Empty Selection is checked. The default is - Select One -.
Empty Drop-Down Item
Name Allows you to display specified text that is displayed in the drop-down menu when it
contains no list items. The default is <Empty>.
Refresh Page When
Selection Changed Allows you to determine whether the page should be refreshed when you select
another item in the selector. By default, the value is false, which means that the
page is only posted back.
Table 3. Filtering
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 269
www.agreeya.com
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Selector
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Selector
The Selector page allows you to configure the appearance of the selector. It contains the following:
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Table 6. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 7. Toolbar
Element Description
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the grid. If you have a custom skin, you can
add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common
Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Persistent Selector Width Allows you to specify the width of the input part for the selector.
Drop Down Width Allows you to specify the width of the drop-down menu for the selector in pixels. If
you specify the width for each field in the Display Fields property in pixels, the
value of this property is usually the total width of all fields.
Drop Down Height Allows you to specify the height of the drop-down menu for the selector.
Table 8. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 270
www.agreeya.com
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 9. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 8. Layout
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 271
www.agreeya.com
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Table 10. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 11. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
19
272
www.agreeya.com
qSIChartView
Overview
qSIChartView Pages
qSIChartView Procedures
Overview
The qSIChartView aggregates data from your external system and displays it in different chart types.
qSIChartView allows you to:
produce 34 different chart types
display data from multiple lists, even when the lists are in different sites, site collections, or web
applications (as long as they are in the same configuration database).
customize the look of the chart, including adding animation to your chart, and rendering your charts in
Flash and Javascript
view your web parts in SharePoint on PC, Mac, various browsers and iPad, iPhone mobile devices where
Flash is not available
display one or more trend lines in the chart
Some charts support dual Y Axis, make your charts more readable with dual Y axis support
filter your data, and generate multiple data series based on dynamic data
Ability to generate a preview at the time of configuring a chart
Ability to export a chart and its data in various formats
create drill down charts
display, create, and edit data in your external systems. Out of the box, this Web Part supports the DAO
Provider for:
Web Services
SQL Server
Oracle
Domino Server using XML over HTTP
Salesforce
K2Server (for SharePoint 2010 only)
qSIChartView Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qSIChartView contains the
following tabs:
TIP: To better understand SI web parts, read the System Integration Developer Guide.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 273
www.agreeya.com
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
When you open ezEdit in qSIChartView, the Content page opens by default. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Filtering
Search/Filter Panel
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Catalog
This property defines the entity and the operations related to the entity.
The Catalog section contains one or more entities. An entity identifies which system and service you have
defined in the Configuration Editor. An entity contains one or more operations that can be executed on the
entity, and consists of the following attributes:
Table 1. Display
Element Description
Title Allows you to add a title for the web part.
Catalog See Catalog on page 273 for more information.
Chart Type Allows you to select the type of chart used to display the data. For examples of each chart
type, see Sample Charts on page 408.
When you select one of the Multi Series, Scroll or Stacked chart type, you must define multiple
data series in the Configuration property. Otherwise you will get a blank chart.
Configuration See Configuration on page 277 for more information.
NOTE: If you are using a Salesforce system, the parameters that are available depend on the
method selected. See the System Integration Developer Guide for the methods and parameters.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 274
www.agreeya.com
Operations
An operation contains the following properties.
Table 2. Catalog
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit the Catalog in XML format:
<Catalog>
<Entity Name="entityName" System="systemName" Service="serviceName"
Default="true/false" SetSessionName="sessionName" ResetSessionNames="sessionName">
<Properties>
<Property Name="propertyName" Type="typeName" Value="propertyValue" />
<Property Name="propertyName" Type="typeName" Value="propertyValue" />
</Properties>
<Operation Name="operationName" Method="methodName" Default="True/False" >
<Parameter Source="sourceType" SessionName="sessionName"
SourceName="sourceName" Type="parameterType" Name="parameterName"
Usage="usageType" Value="value" />
<Parameter Source="sourceType" SessionName="sessionName"
SourceName="sourceName" Type="parameterType" Name="parameterName"
Usage="usageType" Value="value" />
</Operation>
</Entity>
<Entity>...</Entity>
</Catalog>
System Allows you to specify the system name that is defined in the System Integration configuration
file. If the system name does not exist in the System Integration configuration file, you will
get an error.
Service Allows you to specify the service name that is defined in the System Integration
configuration file. The service name that you specify here must belong to system that you
specify in the System attribute. If the service name does not exist in the System Integration
configuration file, you will get an error.
Name Allows you to specify the name of the entity which must be unique within this Catalog. The
name does not have to match with any name in your external system. However, it is
recommended that you use a descriptive name for your entity. This field is mandatory.
Set Session
Name Allows you to enter name of the session variable where the edited or newly created item is
stored when it is saved, or the item that is being displayed or edited is stored when it is
loaded.
Reset Session
Names Allows you to reset (set to NULL) the value of the session variable whose name is specified in
this attribute. Specify multiple names by separating them with commas.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 275
www.agreeya.com
Operation Parameters
You can click Edit to add parameters to your operation. You can define the following:
Table 3. Operations
Element Description
Name Allows you to define the name of the operation. This name does not have to match with any
name in your external system. This field is mandatory.
Method Type There are three supported types:
TableDirect — select this type to return all the data in a table. Specify the schema and
table name in the Method field below.
Stored Procedure — select this type to use a stored procedure to update or return data.
Specify the schema and stored procedure in the Method field below. Once a stored
procedure is selected, the Editor updates with the parameters that are defined for the
stored procedure. It is recommended that you do not add or remove these parameters
or change the “Name”, “Source”, or “Usage” fields.
Text — select this type to use free form PL/SQL string to query or update the database.
If your SQL string requires parameters, you will need to add them manually by clicking
the Add Parameter button.
NOTE: This attribute is only applicable for Oracle systems.
Method Allows you to set the real name of the operation in your external system. For example, it may
refer to the name of a web service method. Or it may refer to the name of a stored procedure
in your SQL Server database.
Default Allows you to select this operation as the default for the entity. The default operation is the
first operation that is called to retrieve the entity to be displayed. If this attribute is not
specified, the first operation listed in the entity becomes the default operation.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 276
www.agreeya.com
You can define one or more Property elements.
Table 4. Operation Parameters
Parameter Description
Name Allows you to set the parameter name that is used when calling the operation in your external
system.
Source Allows you to define the source of this parameter, which can be one of the following:
Default Value — the default value of the parameter type or default instance of the
parameter type. You must specify a type and usage (the direction for the parameter).
For example, if the parameter type is Boolean, the Default Value for the parameter is
false; if the parameter type is String, the default value is null. If a simple class or
structure is involved, an instance of the object is created and used as the parameter
value.
NullValue — the value of the parameter is null. You must specify a type and usage.
FixedValue — the value of the parameter. You must specify a value, type, and usage.
HttpRequest — the value of the parameter is retrieved from the HTTP parameters in
the page URL. You must specify a Source Name (the source name where the value is
retrieved) and usage. As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName attribute
is ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter, which is Hardware, is
used as the value of the parameter.
Input — you can link a field on the form to an operation parameter. You must specify a
Source Name, type, and usage.
You can also use this source type to retrieve the current user information as the value
of the parameter. You can retrieve the following information:
CurrentUserName - display name of the current user
CurrentLoginName - login name of the current user
CurrentUserID - ID of the current user
CurreUserEmail - email address of the current user
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row
that is consumed from another web part. You must specify a Source Name and type.
Session — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row that is stored in
the session. You specify Session Name (define the name of the session where the row of
information is retrieved), Source Name, type, and usage.
ComplexType — the value of the parameter is an object based on the Type attribute
and Member definition inside the Parameter. Array and nested complex types are
supported. You must specify type and usage.
Array — the value of the parameter is an array of values. You must specify type and
usage.
XML — the value of the parameter that is dynamically built when the condition is
execute at runtime. You must specify type and usage.
NOTE: For sources related to Salesforce, see the System Integration Developer Guide.
Table 5. Properties
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the property. Refer to the documentation for the DAO Provider
to your external system will tell you the name of the property that you must define.
Type Allows you to specify type of value that is specified in the Value attribute. Example: System.String.
Value Allows you to specify the value of the property.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 277
www.agreeya.com
Configuration
This property defines how the data should be grouped in the X Axis and the data series for the chart.
The Configuration element should contain only one X Axis and one Series element. Each Series element may
contain one or more Items element.
Configuration Properties
The Configuration section contains the following properties:
Data Series
You can define a data series for the chart by configuring the following properties:
Table 6. Configuration Properties
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Configuration in XML format.
<Configuration>
<XAxis FieldName="FieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<Series>
<Items FieldName="FieldName"
AggregateFunction="Count|Avg|Sum|Min|Max|StdDev|Var" [optional attributes]/
<Items FieldName="FieldName"
AggregateFunction="Count|Avg|Sum|Min|Max|StdDev|Var" [optional attributes]/
</Series>
/Configruration>
Data Index/Data
Member Allows you to define the data table name that contains the options in case the
operation returns multiple tables. If the external system returns multiple data tables
without names, you can use the Data Index attribute to refer to the table. The index is
a number and it starts with 0 (not 1).
NOTE: These are optional.
Field Name Specifies the name of the field that corresponds to the x axis data. This attribute is
mandatory. The field name is case sensitive.
Display Format Allows you to specify how the X axis values are formatted when displayed. For more
detail about the syntax of the Display Format attribute, see Display Format on page 14.
Sort By Allows you to select how you want to group the data on the chart, either by field name
or data series number. The value of this property does not have to be the same as the
value in the Field Name attribute.
Sort Order Specifies how the values in the column specified by the Sort By should be ordered,
either ascending or descending.
Table 7. Data Series
property description
Field Name Allows you to specify the field whose values are aggregated and plotted against
the values in the Y Axis.
NOTE: Only Number or Currency field can be used in the Field Name. The field
name is case sensitive.
Aggregate Function Allows you to specify the aggregation function to be performed on the field
specified in the Field Name attribute. The following aggregation functions are
supported: Count, Avg, Sum, StdDev, Var, Min, or Max.
Series Name Allows you to display a series name in the legend as title of the series.
NOTE: This applies to multiple data series charts.
Chart Series Type Allows you to define the chart type for this series when you use one of the
combination chart in the Chart Type property. The choices are: COLUMN, AREA or
LINE. This attribute is ignored for any non-combination chart type
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 278
www.agreeya.com
Examples of Configuration Property
The following is an example of the Configuration property if you want to display data from your Sales list. Your
Sales list contains the sales amount for every month in the year. There are 3 fields in the list: Year, Month and
Amount. For example, say you want to display the month in the X axis. You also wants to create the data series
dynamically based on the year field.
If you are using Advanced Mode, here is the XML:
<Configuration>
<Series>
<Items FieldName="Amount" AggregateFunction="Sum" ChartSeriesType="COLUMN" FilterFieldName="Year" />
</Series>
<XAxis FieldName="Month" SortFieldName="Month" />
</Configuration>
The following shows the resulting chart:
Filter Expression Allows you to define the filter that is applied for the data in this series. The filter
is defined using the Complex Filter expression. For more information, see
Complex Filters on page 21.
Filter Field Name Allows you to determine the field name whose data is used to generate a dynamic
data series. The chart view will analyze the data in this field and generate the
filter expression for each data series automatically, one per unique value in the
field. This attribute is useful if the data that you should use as the filter
expression for the data series is dynamic.
Drill Down Chart URL Allows you to determine the URL of the page that contains the drill down chart
for this data series. A drill down is the capability to click a chart item to display
more detailed information about the chart item.
Show Values Allows you to show the values for this dataset.
NOTE: This attribute is only applicable for a multi series chart.
Include in Legend Allows you to determine if you want to include the series name of this dataset in
the legend. This can be particularly useful when you're using combination charts
and you've used the area/line chart to plot a trend, and you do not want the
series name of that trend to appear in legend.
NOTE: This attribute is only applicable for a multi series chart.
Parent Y Axis Allows you to set the parent axis of the dataset - P (primary) or S (secondary).
Primary datasets are drawn as on the left y-axis and secondary on the right y-
axis. In 3D Column (or stacked Column) + Line Combination Charts, the columns
draw against primary y-axis and the linesagainst secondary y-axis. In 2D dual Y
combination charts, you can choose which dataset to render against which y-axis.
NOTE: This attribute is only applicable for a chart with a dual y axis.
Hide Allows you to sort a data series that will not be displayed on the chart.
NOTE: This option is only valid for multi-series charts only.
Table 7. Data Series
property description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 279
www.agreeya.com
Figure 1. Configuration property chart
Filtering
The Filtering page allows you to use Complex Filters to define static filter for the data.
The Filtering page contains the following:
Search/Filter Panel
The Search/Filter Panel allows you to define the panels for search, filter, and replace in the web part.
The Search/Filter Panel contains the following elements:
Table 8. Filtering
Element Description
Complex Filter Allows you to use the Complex Filter expression to define a static filter for the data. The
complex filter is applied to the data after the CAML Filter is applied.
NOTE: The Complex Filter is provided here only for backward compatibility reason. In the
past, Complex filter was used to support date functions.
For more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
Table 9. Search/Filt e r Pa nel
Element Description
Searched Fields See Searched Fields on page 280.
Turn On List Searcher
Mode Allows you to perform a search before the chart view displays any data.
Expand Filter panel
on Load Allows you to automatically open the Filter panel by default so that the user can
perform a search quickly. When set to true, the Filter panel opens when the web part
is loaded for the first time.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 280
www.agreeya.com
Searched Fields
This property defines what fields are displayed in the Search Filter panel.
You will be able to perform a search by pressing Enter.
You can further edit fields using the following elements:
Filter Usage Criteria Allow you to pass the filter criteria to the DAO provider layer. There are three options
in this property:
PassToDAOProvider — The filter criteria is passed to the DAO Provider. When
you select this, the filter criteria will not be used to filter the data that is
returned by the external system (because the SI List View assumes that the
data has been filtered by the external system).
FilterData — The filter criteria is used to filter the data that is returned by the
external system.
PassToDAOProviderAndFilterData — The filter criteria is passed to the DAO
Provider and is used to filter the data that is being returned by the external
system.
When you select PassToDAOProvider or PassToDAOProviderAndFilterData, you can use
the filter criteria as parameter values in the operations in the Catalog property. In
order to do so, you specify the parameter source as Input and the source name as:
FieldName.Value — allows you to retrieve the value that is entered by the user
in the Filter panel for a specific field.
FieldName.MaxValue — allows you to retrieve the maximum value that is
entered by the user in the Filter panel for the field that has Between operator,
such as DateTime field.
FieldName.Operator - allows you to retrieve the operator that is specified by
the user for a specific field.
There is a possibility that your back-end only handles "Equals" operator. In that case,
you can use the FixedOperator="Equals" attribute in the Searched Fields property so
that the user can only use the
Panel Button Location Determines the location of the Go, Reset and Close buttons in the Filter panel. This
property also determines the location of the Go and Close buttons in the Replace
panel.
NOTE: Pressing Enter will not allow you to perform a search on such fields as external data, people picker,
managed metadata, and a drop-down list. Instead, the default behavior will occur.
Table 10. Searched Fields
Element Description
Advanced
Mode Turn on if you want to edit Searched Fields in XML format.
<Fields>
<Field Name="fieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<!-- To search a cross site lookup field, use one of the following two formats -->
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFieldName="fieldName" SortField="fieldName" [optional
attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFormat="fieldName" SortField="fieldName" [optional
attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
</Fields>
Field Name Indicates the element you are editing.
Title Displays title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an encoded HTML string.
Table 9. Search/Filt e r Pa nel
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 281
www.agreeya.com
Description Describes the field. This is useful if you want to give a short instruction or explanation about
the field.
Default
Value Defines the default value for the field.
You can define a text, a number or a date. A date value must be specified in ISO 8601 format:
YYYY-MM-DDThh:mm:ssZ, for example: midnight of February 14, 2002 is 2002-02-14T00:00:00Z.
Default
Operator Defines the default operator for the field.
Fixed
Operator Defines the operator for the field. If specified, the list to select the operator for this field is
turned off.
Use People
Editor Enables you to enter any user information that is in your directory service.
If you set this to True and the field to be searched is a People and Group field, the Filter panel
will show the People Editor control for entering the search criteria.
Column
Count Defines the number of columns for the options in a multi-choice field or in a choice-and-lookup
field if the Enable Multi Choice attribute is set to True. This is useful in case your choice or
lookup fields have too many choices and you want to break the choices into several columns to
minimize the vertical scrolling in your form.
Enable Multi
Choice If selected, allows you to select multiple options for the choice-and-lookup field. Therefore,
the user can specify a condition like "A or B". This attribute is ignored by other field types.
To search a cross-site lookup field, you must specify one or more List elements inside the Field
element. The cross-site lookup field is displayed as two drop downs.
Sort Field Defines the field that is used to sort the value in the list. The field name is case sensitive.
Sort Order Allows you to sort the values in ascending or descending order.
AutoPostBac
kWhen selected, causes the Filter panel to refresh when the user changes the selection in a
lookup field or cross-site lookup field.
You need to set AutoPostBack to true if this field is a lookup or a cross-site lookup field and it is
being used to filter another lookup or cross-site lookup field in the Filter panel.
Parent Field Defines another lookup or cross-site lookup field that is used to filter this field. The parent field
must be listed before this field in the XML property.
Parent Filter
Field Name Defines the field in the parent field that is used to filter this field. It is the primary key in the
list that is used in the lookup or cross-site lookup field.
Filter Field
Name Defines the field in the list that is used by this lookup or cross-site lookup field that is filtered
by the parent filter field.
Display Field
Name Shows the name of the field whose value is displayed in the list. The field name is case
sensitive. Use this attribute instead of the Display Format attribute if you only want to display a
single field in the list.
Display
Format Indicates the format of the value that is displayed in the list. Define this attribute instead of
the Display Field Name attribute if you want to display multiple fields in the drop-down menu.
You can use the field replacement expression <%Field%> to refer to a field.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in the Searched
Fields editor in the List View Editor, where the Editor will encode the characters automatically
for you.
NOTE: For more information, see Display Format on page 14.
Site URL Indicates the Site URL of the field. You can use an absolute or relative URL.
List Name Indicates the name of the List. The field name is case sensitive.
Site Name Indicates the name of the site specified in the Site URL. This is used in case you have multiple
lists. In this case, the first drop-down menu to select the list will display as "List Name in Site
Name". You can use any name for the Site Name. It does not have to match the real title of the
Site.
Table 10. Searched Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 282
www.agreeya.com
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Actions
Views
Actions
The list form has some pre-defined actions, such as Save, Delete, Copy or Move. You can also write your own
custom action and hook it up with the list form.
The Actions page contain the following elements:
Custom Actions
This property enables you to define additional buttons in the toolbar or context menu item in the context menu.
You can program that button or context menu item to do a series of actions. The List Form supports some built-
in actions. However, you can write your own custom action using one of the .NET languages, compile it, and call
it by the List Form. See Custom Action Help on page 389 to see how to write your own custom actions.
Here are some ways that you can use this functionality:
Add a custom toolbar button called "Assign All to Me" that will assign all of the selected tasks in the List
Form to me.
Add a custom toolbar called "Approve" that will change the status of all of the selected expense items to
Approved.
Create a custom context menu item called "Publish" that will move the right-clicked document into
another document library.
Create a custom context menu item or toolbar item to start a workflow.
With the ability to write your own custom action, you can virtually do anything to the data when you
click the custom button that you define.
The Custom Actions element contains one Toolbar element and one Context Menu element. These elements can
contain one or more Action Item elements. You can associate the Action Item with one or more Action elements.
The Action element define a certain operation that is carried out by the action item when it is clicked. When
you add an action item, you can configure the following:
Table 11. Actions
Element Description
Custom Actions For more information, see Custom Actions on page 282.
NOTE: The toolbar button affects all the items that are selected in the List Form. The context menu item
affects only the item that is being right-clicked regardless of how many items are selected in your List
Form.
NOTE: The custom action in the List Form does not support the Save action.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 283
www.agreeya.com
Table 12. Custom Actions
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Searched Fields in XML format.
<CustomActions>
<Toolbar>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID" Position="0"
PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID”
ImageUrl=”URL” AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" /
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session" SourceName="fieldName"
SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</Toolbar>
<ContextMenu>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID" Position="0"
PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID”
ImageUrl=”URL” AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session" SourceName="fieldName"
SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</ContextMenu>
</CustomActions>
IsSeparator Allows you to set the item as a separator.
ID Allows you to enter a unique ID that will identify the item. Use a descriptive
identifier to configure the action item with the editor. This field is mandatory.
Text Allows you to enter how the action item is displayed in the toolbar. This field is
mandatory.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 284
www.agreeya.com
Text Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a a multi-lingual site. This
attribute defines the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the
title of the Web Part. The Text Resource ID and the current cultural setting
(identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the
value in the Text attribute is used.
Prompt Text Allows you to prompt the user to click the toolbar button or the context menu item.
Prompt Text Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a multi-lingual site. The property
defines the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the
Web Part. The Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the
Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the
string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default is used.
Access Key (Toolbar
Only) Allows you to define one character from the Text attribute that becomes the access
key to this toolbar button or context menu item. For example, if you define a letter
T as the access key, you can press ALT+T and the browser will put the focus on this
button or context menu item. If there are multiple elements on the page with the
same access key, you can repeat ALT+T repeatedly until you get the focus on this
toolbar button or context menu item.
Position Allows you to set the position of the button in the toolbar. The index starts with 0.
Show User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the Web Part.
Separate groups with commas.
Hide User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part.
Separate site group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide
User Groups, the user cannot
Table 12. Custom Actions
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 285
www.agreeya.com
When you add an action, you can configure the following:
Element Description
Name A mandatory element which allows you to identify a given action in order to access it from
another action. You can refer to this action from the GoToURL action and from
ICustomActionEx Interface.
Type Allows you to determine the type of the action. Here are the options:
Delete — deletes the item.
GoToURL — redirects the user to a specific URL. You must specify the URL and where
you want the URL to open. You must specify the following parameters:
Input - the current user information as the value of the parameter
Session - the name of the session variable where the value comes from when
the source is set to Session
HttpRequest - the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the HTTP
parameters in the page URL. The name of the HTTP parameter is defined in
the SourceName attribute. As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName
attribute is ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter,
which is Hardware, is used as the value of the parameter.
ListItem - the value of the parameter is a list item or row
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the parameter for the GoToURL action can be
retrieved from the output of another action that comes first in the sequence
of actions defined in the ActionItem. There are two types of action that can
produce an output: an action with Type of ExecuteOperation, and an action
with Type of Custom that points to custom action implementation of
ICustomActionEx Interface. You do that by defining the SourceName attribute
of the action. This is the syntax of the SourceName attribute when you use
ResultFormAction source: <ActionName>.<ResultType>[.Name], where
ActionName refers to the Name attribute of the action that produces the
output, ResultType can be OutParameter (if the action result is returned
through one of the out or inout parameter) or RawData - (if the action result
is returned as an object). Name is optional. It further designates the object
we want to use for the parameter. You do not have to specify the Name when
the ResultType is RawData. However, if the ResultType is OutParameter, this
name specifies the name of the out or input key value pair.
ResultFromAction - the parameter for the GoToURL action can be retrieved
from the output of another action that comes first in the sequence of actions
defined in the ActionItem
You must define a source name (where in the source you want to get your
information from), name (the name of the parameter that is appended to the
URL you specified), and Session (the name of the session variable where the
value comes from when the source is set to Session)
GoToSource — redirects the user to the URL specified in the Source HTTP parameter.
The URL to the page must look like: http://...?Source=URL for this option to work.
StartWorkflow — starts the specified workflow in the Workflow Name drop-down
field. You must select a Workflow name.
ReturnToMasterChart — returns the user to the master chart page. You use this
action type if this web part is located in the drill down page.
Custom — implements your own custom action and call it with this action type.
Enter a Class name that implements the ICustomActionEx or ICustomAction
interface, or select a class from the drop-down list, if available.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 286
www.agreeya.com
Views
Custom Message Display
Allows you to specify a custom message based on certain conditions.
We currently do not support mapping for the messages that the Display Messages From DAO Provider property
enables.
If you want to edit Custom Message Display in XML format, turn on Advanced Mode.
CustomMessageDisplay contains the following properties:
Display When — allows you to set the conditions to display a custom error message. When defining the
Display When condition, the following operators are supported: Eq (Equal) Neq (Not Equal) Null, Is Not
Null, Begins With, Contains and Matches (for regular expression).
Custom Message — The error message that you want displayed when the Display When condition is set.
If a Display When condition is set during runtime but a custom message is not specified, the original message is
displayed. If you want to hide the original message, use a blank string or any html code that renders no visible
cues, such as <div>&nbsp;</div>, for the CustomMessage attribute.
When multiple Custom Message elements are defined for this property, the first Custom Message, whose Display
When condition is set, is used.
If no conditions are met, an error message from the selected external system is displayed.
Table 13. Views
Element Description
Search Session Name If Turn On List View Link Mode is selected, the SIChartView will retrieve the Viewed Lists
and filter criteria from the session under this name. This value must match with the
Search Session Name property that you specify in the qListView. If the Turn On List View
Link Mode is not selected, the SIChartView uses this search session name to store the
search criteria specified in the Search/Filter page.
Display Message
from DAO Provider Allows you to display messages, such as informational messages or warnings at the top
of a web part. For more information on DAO providers, see System Integration
Developer Guide.
Custom Message
Display See Custom Message Display.
Allows you to specify a custom message based on certain conditions.
We currently do not support mapping for the messages that the Display Messages From
DAO Provider property enables.
If you want to edit Custom Message Display in XML format, turn on Advanced Mode.
CustomMessageDisplay contains the following properties:
Display When — allows you to set the conditions to display a custom error
message. When defining the Display When condition, the following operators are
supported: Eq (Equal) Neq (Not Equal) Null, Is Not Null, Begins With, Contains
and Matches (for regular expression).
Custom Message — The error message that you want displayed when the Display
When condition is set.
If a Display When condition is set during runtime but a custom message is not specified,
the original message is displayed. If you want to hide the original message, use a blank
string or any html code that renders no visible cues, such as <div>&nbsp;</div>, for the
CustomMessage attribute.
When multiple Custom Message elements are defined for this property, the first Custom
Message, whose Display When condition is set, is used.
If no conditions are met, an error message from the selected external system is
displayed.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 287
www.agreeya.com
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Chart
Toolbar
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Chart
The Chart Page allows you to define characteristics of your charts.
Chart Appearance contains the following elements
Chart Attributes
Advanced Mode
Turn on Advanced Mode if you want to edit Chart Attributes in XML format.
Title and Axis Name
The Chart View allows you to add a caption, sub-caption, x-axis title, and y-axis title for your charts. You can
configure the font properties for each of them individually or collectively. You can also apply styles and
animation effects to them.
Table 14. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 15. Chart Appearance
Element Description
Chart Width Allows you to specify the width of the chart in pixels.
Chart Height Allows you to specify the height of the chart in pixels.
Chart Attributes For more information, see Chart Attributes on page 287.
Trend Lines For more information, see Trend Lines on page 306.
Style For more information, see Styles on page 307.
Series Appearance For more information, see Series Appearance on page 313.
Table 16. Title and Axis
Element Description
Caption Allows you to add a title.
Sub-caption Allows you to add a subtitle to your chart.
X-Axis Name Allows you to set the x-axis name.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 288
www.agreeya.com
Border and Background
Background refers to the entire background of the chart.
You can also have a border around the chart. By default, the border is on in 2D charts and off in 3D Charts.
Shown below is a chart with a border around the chart.
Figure 2. Border around chart
Y-Axis Name Allows you to seta y-axis name.
Rotate Y Axis Name Allows you to set rotate the name of the y-axis. The y-axis name is rotated by default
on the chart. If you're using UTF-8 characters, those characters would not appear in
rotated mode, as the qSIChartView uses embedded characters for rotation. In that
case, you can opt to show y-axis name in horizontal form by setting this attribute to
false.
Y Axis Name Width Allows you to set the maximum width that the non-rotated y-axis title can assume.
Table 17. Border and Background
Element Description
Show Border Allows you to show a border around the chart. By default, it is set to true in 2D
charts and false in 3D charts.
Border Color Allows you to set the border color of the chart. Use hex color code. To use the color
picker, click on the color swatch square.
Border Thickness Allows you to set the border thickness of the chart (in pixels).
Border Alpha Allows you to set the border alpha (transparency) of the chart. The range is from 0-
100.
Background Color Allows you to fill the background as gradient. If you need to define two (or more)
colors, separate them by a comma.
Background Alpha Allows you to specify a respective alpha (transparency) for each color code that
you've specified in the Background Color attribute, Separate the alphas by comma.
The range is from 0-100
Background Ratio Allows you to set the ratio of each color in the gradient on a scale of 100. The total
ratios specified as this attribute should sum up to 100. For example, if you want to
plot a equidistant gradient for 2 colors, specify Background Ratio as "0,100".
Background Angle Allows you to set the angle of the gradient fill.
Table 16. Title and Axis
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 289
www.agreeya.com
Chart Canvas
Canvas refers to the area in which the chart is plotted.
Figure 3. Canvas
Data Plot
Plot refers to the column, lines in a column, line chart respectively.
Background Image or
SWF URL Allows you to specify an external image (GIF,JPEG, or PNG only) or a SWF file as the
background of the chart. Specify the URL (with relative path) of the background
image or SWF File. Make sure that the image and the chart SWF file are in the same
sub-domain.
If you specify an absolute URL, the background image will not be shown.
Background Image or
SWF Alpha Allows you to configure the alpha of the background (loaded) image using this
property.
Table 18. Canvas
Element Description
Canvas Border Color Allows you set the border color for the Canvas. Use hex color code. To use the
color picker, click on the color swatch square.
Canvas Border Thickness Allows you set thickness of canvas border (in pixels)
Canvas Border Alpha Allows you set alpha for canvas border.
Canvas Background Color Allows you set the background color for the Canvas. Use hex color code. To use a
gradient fill, specify all the colors of the gradient separated by commas.
Canvas Background Alpha Allows you to specify a respective alpha (transparency) for each color code that
you've specified in Canvas Background Color attribute. Separate the alphas by
comma.
Canvas Background Ratio Allows you to set the ratio of each color in the gradient on a scale of 100. The
total ratios specified as this attribute should sum up to 100. For example, if you
want to plot a equidistant gradient for 2 colors, specify canvasbgRatio as "0,100".
Canvas Background Angle Allows you to set the angle of the gradient fill (in degrees - 0-360).
Show Canvas Background Allows you to set the canvas background for a 3D chart (and canvas).
Show Canvas Base Allows you to set the canvas base for a 3D chart (and canvas).
Canvas Background Depth Allows you to set the depth of canvas background for a 3D chart (and canvas).
Canvas Base Depth Allows you to set the height of canvas base (in pixels) for a 3D chart (and
canvas).
Table 17. Border and Background
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 290
www.agreeya.com
For all the charts, you can specify custom color for each data plot using the color attribute of <set /> element.
The color must be in hex code format (RRGGBB) without #.
<chart ....>
<set label='Jan' value='420000' color='FF0000'/>
<set label='Feb' value='910000' color='00FF00'/>
<set label='Mar' value='720000' color='0000FF'/>
....
</chart>
Figure 4. Data Plot
By default, most charts have FFFFFF as the plot gradient color. If you wish to use solid fills for the column (or
area), use the Plot Gradient Color attribute without any color defined for it, that is, plotGradientColor=''
<chart plotGradientColor='' ....>
<set label='Jan' value='420000' color='FF0000'/>
<set label='Feb' value='910000' color='00FF00'/>
<set label='Mar' value='720000' color='0000FF'/>
....
</chart>
Figure 5. Data Plot with solid fills
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 291
www.agreeya.com
Data Labels
Data labels refer to the names for the data points that appear on the x-axis.
Figure 6. Data Labels
In the chart shown above, the dates are the data labels for the chart. By default, they get wrapped when there
is not enough space on the chart.
Table 19. Data Plot
Element Description
Plot Gradient Color Allows you to globally add a gradient color to the entire plot (column, area) of chart
by specifying a color as its attribute.
Plot Fill Angle Allows you set the fill angle for gradient if you've opted to fill the plot (column, area)
as gradient. The range is from 0 - 360.
Plot Fill Ratio Allows you set the ration for gradient if you've opted to fill the plot (column, area) as
gradient. The range is from 0 - 100.
Plot Fill Alpha Allows you set the fill alpha for gradient if you've opted to fill the plot (column, area)
as gradient.
Show Plot Border Allows you to show or hide the plot border. By default, each data plot (column, area,
pie) shows a border.
Plot Border Dashed Allows you to make the plot border dashed by setting this attribute to true.
Plot Border Dash
Length Allows you to set the length of each dash.
Plot Border Dash Gap Allows you to set the gap between each dash.
Use Round Edges Allows you to plot columns/bars with rounded edges and glass effect gradients in
charts that support 2D Columns or Bars (like column charts, bar charts, 2D
combination charts).
NOTE: In this mode, the following features do not work:
When you plot the columns with rounded edges, shadow is applied to them by
default and show Shadow attribute no longer works. If you want to remove
shadow from this mode, override the shadow with a new shadow style (applied
to DATAPLOT) with alpha as 0.
Plot fill properties like gradient color, angle. no longer work as the colors for
gradient are now calculated by the chart itself.
Plot border properties no longer work in this mode. Also, you cannot render
the border as dash in this mode.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 292
www.agreeya.com
Data Values
Data values refer to the plot values such as line, column, and bar displayed beside it.
Figure 7. Data Values
In the chart shown above, the dollar values appearing above the column are the data values.
External Logo
You can load external logos at run-time to be displayed over the chart. The logos can be GIF/JPEG/PNG or SWF
files that reside on the same sub-domain as the chart SWF.
Table 20. Data Labels
Element Description
Show Labels Allows you to show the data labels.
Label Display Allows you to display the data labels can be displayed on the charts in the following ways:
Wrap — By default, all the labels are shown in wrap mode, which enables you to wrap
your long x-axis labels in multiple lines.
Rotate — allows you to rotate or slant the x-axis labels.
Stagger — distributes labels into multiple lines (by default 2).
NOTE: Rotate mode does not work if you have non-English characters in your x-axis labels as
the charts use embedded fonts to render rotated labels.
Slant Labels Allows you to slant the labels at 45 degrees if you are using the Rotate mode for the Label
Display.
Stagger Lines Allows you to choose the number of lines to stagger the labels if you are using the Stagger
mode for the Label Display.
Label Step Allows you to show every n-th label instead of all labels if your X Axis labels represent a
continuous quantity like time and date.
Table 21. Data Values
Element Description
Show Values Allows you to show data values. By default, the data values are shown. To hide them, set
this attribute to false.
Rotate Values Allows you to rotate the values. By default, the chart will show the data values
horizontally.
Place Values
Inside Allows you to place the data values inside the columns.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 293
www.agreeya.com
Figure 8. External Logo
Font Properties
You can specify generic font properties for all the text on the chart using the attributes given below.
Table 22. External Logo
Element Description
Logo URL Allows you to specify the URL of the logo. You may use relative or absolute URL as long as
the image and the chart SWF file are in the same sub-domain.
Logo Position Allows you to set the position of the logo can be configured using this attribute.
Logo Alpha Allows you to set the opacity of the logo once it has loaded.
Logo Scale Allows you to set the scale of the logo, once it has loaded. The scale of 100 will display the
logo in its original size. The scale of less than 100 will shrink the logo. The scale of more
than 100 will enlarge the logo.
Logo Link Allows you to link the logo to an external URL. This link can open in same window, new
window, pop-up windows or frames. For information on how to format the link, see Trend
Lines on page 306.
Table 23. Font Properties
Element Description
Base Font Name Allows you set the font face (family) of all the text (data labels, values) on chart. If
you specify Outside Canvas Base Font Name attribute also, then this attribute
controls only the font face of text within the chart canvas bounds.
Base Font Size Allows you to set the base font size of the chart, that is, all the values and the names
in the chart that lie on the canvas are displayed using the font size provided here.
The range is from 0 - 72.
Base Font Color Allows you to set the base font color of the chart, that is, all the values and the
names in the chart that lie on the canvas are displayed using the font color provided
here. Use hex color code. To use the color picker, click on the color swatch square.
Outside Canvas Base
Font Name Allows you classify all the text in the chart into 2: the text inside the canvas which
consists of only the tool tip and the data values and all the text outside the canvas.
You can define a base font group for all the text outside the canvas as well.
This attribute sets the base font family of the chart font which lies outside the
canvas, that is, all the values and the names in the chart that lie outside the canvas
are displayed using the font name provided here.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 294
www.agreeya.com
Chart Palettes
qSIChartView offers 5 palettes. The palette theme configures colors of the following:
Background and border
Canvas border and background
Fonts
4Div lines
Toolti p
Anchors
Legend
The internal palette does not cover the color of the data items. To change the color of the data items, use the
Palette Colors attribute or Series Appearance property.
Y Axis
Chart limits are the minimum and maximum y-axis values. qSIChartView automatically calculates the best chart
limits when you do not specify them explicitly.
.
Outside Canvas Base
Font Size Allows you to set the base font size of the chart, that is, all the values and the names
in the chart that lie outside the canvas are displayed using the font size provided
here. The range is from 0 - 72
Outside Canvas Base
Font Color Allows you to set the base font color of the chart, that is, all the values and the
names in the chart that lie outside the canvas are displayed using the font color
provided here.
Table 24. Chart Palettes
Element Description
Palette Allows you to select the palette number.
Palette Colors Allows you to specify your own palette for data items by providing a list of hex
colors.
Table 25. Y Axix
Element Description
Y Axis Min Value Allows you to set the chart limits explicitly.
Y Axis Max Value Allows you to set the chart limits explicitly.
NOTE: The Y Axis Max Value must be bigger than any of the values in the data series.
Otherwise, the value will not be honored by the chart view.
Set Adaptive Y Min Allows you to set whether the y-axis lower limit would be 0 (in case of all positive
values on chart) or should the y-axis lower limit adapt itself to a different figure
based on values provided to the chart.
Primary Y Axis Min Value Allows you to explicitly set the lower limit of the primary y-axis. If you do not
specify this value, it is automatically calculated by qSIChartView based on the data
provided by you.
Primary Y Axis Max Value Allows you to explicitly set the upper limit of the primary y-axis. If you do not
specify this value, it is automatically calculated by qSIChartView based on the data
provided by you.
Secondary Y Axis Min
Value Allows you to explicitly set the lower limit of the secondary y-axis. If you do not
specify this value, it is automatically calculated by qSIChartView based on the data
provided by you.
Table 23. Font Properties
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 295
www.agreeya.com
Division Lines
Divisional lines are horizontal lines running through the canvas. They break up the y axis into smaller units
helping in better visual data interpretation.
Figure 9. Division Lines
Secondary Y Axis Max
Value Allows you to explicitly set the upper limit of the secondary y-axis. If you do not
specify this value, it is automatically calculated by qSIChartView based on the data
provided by you.
Primary Y Axis Name Allows you to set the primary y-axis title.
Secondary Y Axis Name Allows you to set the secondary y-axis title.
Set Adaptive Secondary
Y Min Allows you to set whether the secondary y-axis lower limit would be 0 (in case of all
positive values on chart) or should the y-axis lower limit adapt itself to a different
figure based on values provided to the chart.
Primary Y Axis Name
Width Allows you to set choose a maximum width (in pixels) that is applied to primary y-
axis name, if you do not rotate y-axis name.
Secondary Y Axis Name
Width If you opt to not rotate y-axis name, you can choose a maximum width (in pixels)
that is applied to secondary y-axis name.
Table 26. Division Lines
Element Description
Adjust Division Lines Allows you to explicitly specify the y-axis upper and lower limit values, and also
the number of divisional lines. In those cases, you need to automatic adjustment
of divisional lines by setting this attribute to false. Then you can specify the y-
axis upper and lower limits using the Y Axis Max Value and Y Axis Min Value
attributes respectively.
Number of Division Lines Allows you to set the number of divisional lines.
Div Line Effect Allows you to enable to apply an effect, for example, EMBOSS, or BEVEL to the
divisional lines. This attribute is applicable to MultiSeriesCombination3D chart
type only.
Show Y Axis Values Allows you to show all the y-axis values.
Y Axis Values Step Allows you to skip every nth Y Axis value.
Division Lines Allows you to set the color for divisional lines.
Division Lines Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of divisional lines. The range is from 1 - 5.
Table 25. Y Axix
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 296
www.agreeya.com
Zero Plane
Zero plane is a plane which separates the positive and negative numbers on a chart having both of them.
Figure 10. Zero Plane
Division Lines Alpha Allows you to set the alpha of divisional lines. The range is from 0 - 100.
Is Dashed Allows you to set the divisional line to be dashed.
Division Lines Dash Length Allows you to set the length of each dash.
Division Lines Dash Gap Allows you to set the gap between each dash.
Show Alternate H Grid
Color Allows you to set the horizontal grid bands alternately between the divisional
lines for all 2D charts. They can be hidden by setting this attribute to false.
Alternate H Grid Color Allows you to set the color of the horizontal grid bands.
Alternate H Grid Alpha Allows you to set the alpha of the horizontal grid bands. The range is from 0 -
100.
Vertical Div Lines Allows you to set the vertical divisional lines running through the canvas in a
line/area chart. They help in relating the data to its respective label, when there
is a large amount of data.
Number of Vertical Div
Lines Allows you to set the number of vertical div lines.
Vertical Div Lines Color Allows you to set the color of the vertical axis division lines.
Vertical Div Lines Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of the vertical axis division lines in pixels.
Vertical Div Lines Alpha Allows you to set the alpha of vertical axis division lines. The range is from 0 -
100.
Is Dashed Allows you to set the vertical axis division lines as dashed.
Vertical Div Lines Dash
Length Allows you to set the length of each dash.
Vertical Div Lines Dash Gap Allows you to set the gap between each dash.
Show Alternate V Grid
Color Allows you to set the vertical grid bands alternately between the vertical
divisional lines.
Alternate V Grid Color Allows you to set the color of the alternate vertical grid bands.
Alternate V Grid Alpha Allows you to set the alpha (transparency) of the alternate vertical grid bands.
Show V Line Label Border Allows you to set the borders for all labels for vLines in the chart. If you want to
show label border for just a particular vLine, you can override this value by
specifying border configuration for that specific vLine.
Table 26. Division Lines
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 297
www.agreeya.com
Anchors
Each data point in a line or area chart is represented by an anchor. The anchors help identify the data point
better in the chart. They also show a tool tip showing the data point details when the mouse is hovered over
them, and can be linked to other pages as well.
Figure 11. Anchors
Table 27. Zero Plane
element description
Show Zero Plane Allows you set the zero plane in the column, line, and the area chart. It can be
removed in the line chart but not in the column or the area chart because they use
this as their base to draw. It can be removed in the line chart by setting this
attribute to false.
Zero Plane Color Allows you set the color of the zero plane.
Zero Plane Alpha Allows you set the alpha (transparency) of the zero plane. The range is from 0 -
100.
Zero Plane Thickness Allows you set the thickness of the zero plane in pixels.
Zero Plane Show Border Allows you set the whether to show border of zero plane for a 3D chart.
Zero Plane Border Color Allows you set the border color of zero plane for a 3D chart.
Zero Plane Mesh Allows you set the whether to draw the zero plane as a wireframe mesh or as a
filled plane. If set to true, a mesh on the zero plane of the chart is drawn. This
attribute is applicable to MultiSeriesCombination3D chart type only.
Table 28. Anchors
Element Description
Draw Anchors Allows you show the anchors. The anchors are displayed by default. To hide them, set
this attribute to false. Once the anchors are hidden, the tool tips for the data points will
not be displayed and the links will not work.
Anchor Alpha Allows you set the alpha of entire anchors. The range is from 0 - 100. If you need to hide
the anchors but still have tool tip and link, set Anchor Alpha to ‘0’
Anchor Sides Allows you to set the number of sides the anchor will have. For example, an anchor with
3 sides would represent a triangle, with 4 it would be a square. The range is from 3 - 20.
Anchor Radius Allows you to set the radius (in pixels) of the anchor. The greater the radius, the bigger
the anchor size.
Anchor Border Color Allows you to set the border color of anchors.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 298
www.agreeya.com
Tool Tip
A tool tip is shown when the mouse is hovered over a particular data point. It shows the following information:
Single series chart (except pie & doughnut): Name & value
Pie & Doughnut: Name & value/percentage
Multi-series & combination chart: Series Name, Category Name, Data Value
Figure 12. Tool Tip
Paddings and Margins
qSIChartView lets you define various paddings and margins using pixels. These attributes are listed one-by-one
below.
By default, qSIChartView provides some padding between the chart border and the canvas. This is called the
chart margin and each margin can be set individually.
Anchor Border
Thickness Allows you to set the border thickness (in pixels) of the anchors.
Anchor Background
Color Allows you to set the background color of anchors.
Anchor Background
Alpha Allows you to set the alpha of anchor background. The range is from 0 - 100.
Table 29. Tool Tip
Element Description
Show Tool Tip Allows you to set the tool tip.
Show Tool Tip Shadow Allows you to show the tool tip shadow.
Tool Tip Border Color Allows you to customize the border color of the tool tip.
Tool Tip Background Color Allows you to customize the background color of the tool tip.
Tool Tip Separator Character Allows you to specify a character to separate the name and value displayed in
tool tip.
Series Name in Tool Tip Allows you to control whether series name will appear in the tool tip. For multi-
series and combination charts, qSIChartView shows the following information in
tool tip (unless tool text is explicitly defined): "Series Name, Category Name,
Data Value".
Show Percent In Tool Tip Allows you to show percentage values in Tool Tip for Pie or Doughnut chart. By
default, the Pie or Doughnut chart shows percentage values in Tool Tip.
Table 28. Anchors
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 299
www.agreeya.com
Figure 13. Paddings and Margins
Table 30. Paddings and Margins
Element Description
Left Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the left side of your chart. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Right Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the right side of your chart. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Top Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space ton the top of your chart. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Bottom Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the bottom of your chart. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Canvas Left Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the left side of the canvas. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Canvas Right Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the right side of the canvas. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Canvas Top Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space t on the top of the canvas. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Canvas Bottom
Margin Allows you to set the amount of empty space on the bottom of the canvas. Nothing is
rendered in this space.
Caption Padding Allows you to set the amount of space between the caption of the chart and the top of
the chart canvas. If you have a sub-caption defined in the chart, it controls the space
between the sub-caption and the top of the chart canvas.
X Label Gap Allows you to set the vertical space between the labels and canvas wall edge. If you
want more space between the canvas and the x-axis labels, you can use this attribute to
control it.
Y Label Gap Allows you set the horizontal space between the canvas wall edge and the y-axis values
or trend line values (on left/right side). This is particularly useful, when you want more
space between your canvas and y-axis values.
X Axis Name Padding Allows you to set the distance between the top of x-axis title and the bottom of data
labels (or canvas, if data labels are not shown).
Y Axis Name Padding Allows you to set the padding between the y-axis name and values.
Y Axis Values Padding Allows you to set the padding between the left end of the chart canvas and the y-axis
values.
Label Padding Allows you to set the vertical space between the canvas bottom edge and the data
labels.
Value Padding Allows you to control the space between your columns/anchors and the value
textboxes.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 300
www.agreeya.com
Smart Labels and Lines
Smart labels are the labels for the pie/doughnut chart. The smart labels prevent overlapping of labels even
when large number of labels are placed in close vicinity.
Figure 14. Smart Labels and Lines
Canvas Padding For a line/area chart, allows you to set the padding between the canvas border and the
position where the line/area chart begins to draw is called canvas padding.
Plot Space Percent On a column chart, allows you to set the spacing between two columns. By default, the
spacing is set to 20% of canvas width. For example, if you wanted all columns to stick to
each other without any space in between, you can set plotSpacePercent to 0. Similarly,
if you want very thin columns, you can set plotSpacePercent to its max value of 80.
Table 31. Smart Labels and Lines
Element Description
Enable Smart Labels Allows you to enable the smart labels (if required to save chart space or when there
are few pie segments). When the smart labels are switched off, the pie labels would
be displayed without the smart label lines. But if they number of labels increases and
smart labels are not being used, then the labels might overlap.
Smart Line Color Allows you to set the color of smart label connector lines.
Smart Line Thickness Allows you to set the thickness (in pixels) of smart label connector lines.
Smart Line Alpha Allows you to set the alpha (transparency) of smart label connector lines. The range is
0 - 100.
Is Smart Line Slanted Allows you to set the smart lines (smart label connector lines) in two ways: Slanted or
Straight.
Label Distance Allows you to set the distance of the label/value text boxes from the pie/doughnut
edge in pixels. You must set Enable Smart Labels to false for this attribute to take
effect.
Smart Label Clearance Allows you to set the clearance distance of a label (for sliced-in pies) from adjacent
sliced out pies in pixels.
Skip Overlap Labels Allows you to skip the overlapping labels if you have too many labels in your pie chart
(which is difficult to adjust even using smart labels). In that case, you have the option
to set this attribute to true. The labels of the least significant pies would be removed.
Show Percent Values Allows you to set the actual value of the pie segment to be displayed in the label or
the percentage value. By default, the actual values are displayed. When you want to
display their percentages, set this attribute to true.
Table 30. Paddings and Margins
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 301
www.agreeya.com
Legend
In multi-series/combination charts, the series name of each dataset shows up in the legend of the chart. This
helps you relate a data plot to its series name using its color. The legend does not appear for single-series charts
because there is only one series in the chart.
Figure 15. Legend
The legend below the chart helps identify the series name.
Table 32. Legend
Element Description
Show Legend Allows you to show the legend.
Interactive Legend Allows you to make the legend interactive. Interactive Legend only works for a
combination chart. In the combination chart, you can click the legend to show/hide
the values of the data items. If you set Interactive Legend to false, then legend will
not be interactive.
Legend Caption Allows you to add a caption for the entire legend by setting the same here.
Legend Marker Circle Allows you to use square legend keys or circular ones.
Reverse Legend Allows you to reverse the order of items in legend.
Legend Position Allows you to place the legend in 2 positions: RIGHT and BOTTOM. It gets placed
below the canvas by default. To place it to the right of the chart canvas, set Legend
Position = 'RIGHT'.
Allow Drag Allows you to make the legend dragable. End viewers of the chart can drag the
legend around on the chart.
Legend Background
Color Allows you to set the background color for the legend.
Legend Background
Alpha Allows you to set the background alpha (transparency) for the legend. The range is 0
- 100.
Legend Border Color Allows you to set the border color for the legend.
Legend Border
Thickness Allows you to set the border thickness, in pixels, for the legend.
Legend Border Alpha Allows you to set the border alpha for the legend. The range is 0 - 100.
Legend Shadow Allows you to set a shadow for legend.
Legend Scroll
Background Color Allows you to set the background color of the scroll bar. If you've too many items on
the legend, a scroll bar appears.
Legend Scroll Bar Color Allows you to set the bar color of the scroll bar. If you've too many items on the
legend, a scroll bar shows up on the same.
Legend Scroll Button
Color Allows you to set the color of buttons on the scroll bar. If you've too many items on
the legend, a scroll bar shows up on the same.If you've too many items on the
legend, a scroll bar shows up on the same.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 302
www.agreeya.com
Number Formatting
qSIChartView offers you a lot of options to format your numbers on the chart from number prefixes and suffixes
to controlling the decimal places to scaling your numbers based on a pre-defined scale.
.
3D Chart Attributes
The 3D Combination chart is a true 3D chart which offers features such as viewing from a specific camera angle,
definition of light source, use of dynamic lighting, and rotation.
The various elements of a 3D Combination chart are shown below:
Table 33. Number Formatting
Element Description
Format Number Allows you to determine whether the numbers displayed on the chart are formatted
using commas, for example, 40,000 if Format Number is true and 40000 if Format
Number is false.
Format Number Scale Allows you to determine whether to add K (thousands) and M (millions) to a number
after truncating and rounding it - for example, if Format Number Scale is set true,
1043 would become 1.04K (with decimals set to 2 places). Same with numbers in
millions - a M will added at the end.
Default Number Scale Allows you to set the default unit of the numbers that you are providing to the chart.
Number Scale Unit Allows you to set the unit of each block of the scale.
Number Scale Value Allows you to set the range of the various blocks that constitute the scale.
Number Prefix Allows you to add a prefix to all the numbers visible on the graph. For example, to
represent all dollars figure on the chart, you could specify this attribute to ' $' to
show like $40000, $50000.
Number Suffix Allows you to add a suffix to all the numbers visible on the graph. For example, to
represent all figure quantified as per annum on the chart, you could specify this
attribute to ' /a' to show like 40000/a, 50000/a.
Decimal Separator Allows you to specify the character to be used as the decimal separator in a number.
Thousand Separator Allows you to specify the character to be used as the thousands separator in a
number.
In Decimal Separator Allows you to input the decimal separator.
In Thousand Separator Allows you to input the thousand separator.
Decimals Allows you to set the number of decimal places to which all numbers on the chart
would be rounded. The range is from 0 - 10.
Force Decimals Allows you to add 0 padding at the end of decimal numbers. For example, if you set
decimals as 2 and a number is 23.4. If force Decimals is set to 1, qSIChartView will
convert the number to 23.40 (note the extra 0 at the end).
Y Axis Value Decimals Allows you to specify the div line values decimal precision. The range is from 0 - 10.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 303
www.agreeya.com
Figure 16. 3D Charts
Table 34. 3D Charts
Element Description
Is 2D Allows you to decide whether initially to draw a 2D view of the chart.
Chart Order Allows you to set the order by which different types of charts will appear. The value
can be any combination of 'column', 'line' or 'area', each separated by a comma. By
default, the order is: line, column, area. You can change to any order you like, for
example, 'column, area, line' or 'line, area'.
Chart On Top Allows you to decide whether or not the chart canvas is placed over the extra chart
elements (caption, subcaption, legend). This feature is visible when the chart canvas
is zoomed/scaled. +
Auto Scaling Allows you to decide whether or not the chart is allowed to best fit automatically
after a user interaction, for example, rotation.
Allow Scaling Allows you to set whether to allow zoom-in/zoom-out.
NOTE: Scaling or use of mouse is compatible only with Windows Operating System.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 304
www.agreeya.com
Animate 3D Allows you to show the initial plot animation. By default, the 3D chart is rendered with
a default animation.
To globally set off all animation set Animation to false. This would not only set off 3D
animations, but also disable all animations applied using <styles>. The additional use
of Animate 3D can override this value. Hence, a combination of Animation = false and
Animate 3D = true would disable all animations applied using <styles> but, enable
animation of the 3D canvas.
Exe Time Allows you to set the time that the chart takes to animate. This attribute also sets the
time taken by the chart canvas to animate when the chart is transformed to any view
(View3D, View 2D, Reset View).
Camera Angle
X/Camera Angle Y Allows you to define the camera angle.
Camera Angle X lets you specify the camera angle (for view around the chart
vertically) from which the chart is viewed initially in no animation mode (when
animate3D='0) . If not specified, the default value is 30. The range is from 0 to
360 and 0 to -360.
Camera Angle Y lets you specify the camera angle (for view around the chart
horizontally) from which the chart is viewed initially in no animation mode
(when animate3D='0). If not specified, the default value is -45. The range is
from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360.
Since this is a true 3D chart, it's rendered as a 3D model that is viewed from a specific
camera angle. The camera can simply be defined as the eye of a real viewer. When
you have set Animate 3D to 0, you can define the camera angle using two attributes -
Camera Angle X and Camera Angle Y.
When you use animation, you can also set up the starting camera view from which the
camera view starts animating, and the final camera view to which the chart would
finally be rotated. For this, you need to use Start Angle X, Start Angle Y, End Angle X
and End Angle Y attributes.
Start Angle X/End
Angle X Start Angle X — Allows you to specify the view angle (for view around the chart
vertically) at which rotation of the chart starts (when the chart is initialized). The
rotation stops at endAngX. If not specified, the default values for both the attributes
are 30. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360. This is for animated charts (when
animate3D='1').
End Angle X — Allows you to specify the view angle (for view around the chart
vertically) at which rotation of the chart ends (when the chart is initialized). The
rotation starts at startAngX. If not specified, the default values for both the attributes
are 30. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360. This is for animated charts (when
animate3D='1').
Start Angle Y/End
Angle Y Start Angle Y — Allows you to specify the view angle (for view around the chart
horizontally) from which rotation of the chart starts (when the chart is initialized).
The rotation stops at endAngY. If not specified, the default values for both the
attributes are -45. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360. This is for animated charts
(when animate3D='1').
End Angle Y — Allows you to specify the view angle (for view around the chart
horizontally) at which rotation of the chart ends (when the chart is initialized). The
rotation starts at startAngY. If not specified, the default values for both the attributes
are -45. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360. This is for animated charts (when
animate3D='1').
Light Angle X/Light
Angle Y Light Angle X — Allows you to specify the angular position of the light source (for X-
axis) w.r.t the chart world coordinate system. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360.
Light Angle Y — Allows you to specify the angular position of the light source (for Y-
axis) w.r.t the chart world coordinate system. The range is from 0 to 360 and 0 to -360.
Table 34. 3D Charts
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 305
www.agreeya.com
Custom About Menu Item
You can change the default "About QuickApps for SharePoint" context menu item to show your label and link it
to your own URL using the below attributes.
Intensity Allows you to control the intensity of the light that falls on the chart elements. The
range of this attribute lies between 0 to 10. 10 would provide light with maximum
intensity, and you will get the brightest view of the chart. If you set the value to 0,
light is provided with least intensity. However, the chart will never appear in full
darkness even you set intensity to 0. A faint light is always made available. By default,
the value is set to 2.5.
Dynamic Shading Allows you to set the chart in dynamic shading/non-world mode. If set to false, the
chart is in world mode.
For example, you can have a Combination 3D Chart that has two different lighting
systems to light up the chart elements. The light source may be fixed outside the
chart. This causes only those sides of the chart to get the light which face the light
source. Thus, when the chart is manually rotated, dynamic shades are created on the
chart surfaces. This system of lighting is called dynamic shading.
World lighting is where the light source is fixed with the chart. In this case, the light
source rotates with the rotation of the chart. Hence, the surface facing the light
source gets lightened and continues to be in the bright side despite any manual
rotation of the chart being made, whereas the surface not facing the light keeps
remaining in darkness with every chart rotation.
Bright 2D Allows you to set maximum brightness to the chart while being rendered in 2D mode.
This is applicable only when you've set Dynamic Shading to true. However, once you
set this attribute to true, you cannot use Light Angle X and Light Angle Y attributes.
Rather, it automatically sets up the light sources to give the brightest view of the
chart in 2D mode.
Allow Rotation Allows you to decide whether to stop any user interactive rotation of the chart or not.
If it is set to false, the interactive rotation is barred.
Constrain Vertical
Rotation Allows you to rotate up to 90 degrees (top or bottom) from 0 degree position. You can
also specify these limits using Minimum Vertical Rotation Angle and Maximum Vertical
Rotation Angle attributes. This is only applicable to user's mouse interactively with the
chart.
Minimum Vertical
Rotation Angle Allows you to set the minimum allowed angle up to which a user can rotate the chart
vertically. This is only applicable to user's mouse interactively with the chart.
Maximum Horizontal
Rotation Angle Allows you to set the maximum allowed angle up to which a user can rotate the chart
horizontally. This is only applicable to user's mouse interactively with the chart.
Z Depth Allows you to set the depth (3D thickness) of each DATAPLOT object using zDepth
attribute.
Z Gap Plot Allows you to specify a gap between all dataplots in a 3D combination chart, as more
than one DATAPLOT types can exist due to different datasets.
A Z Gap Plot set to 0 will show no gap between dataplots.
YZ Wall Depth Allows you to set the depth of the YZ wall of 3D chart.
ZX Wall Depth Allows you to set the depth of the ZX wall of 3D chart.
XY Wall Depth Allows you to set the depth of the XYwall of 3D chart.
Clustered Allows you to set a Combination 3D chart in clustered mode. In a Combination 3D
chart, you can plot multiple number of datasets which can be rendered as Column.
Table 34. 3D Charts
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 306
www.agreeya.com
Functional
These attributes let you control a variety of functional elements on the chart.
Trend Lines
Trend Lines allow you to specify the horizontal/vertical lines spanning the chart canvas which aid in
interpretation of data with respect to some pre-determined value.
Trend Lines contain the following:
Table 35. Custom About Menu
Element Description
Show About Menu
Item Allows you to set up a custom context menu in the chart, which can show your
text and can be linked to your URL. For example, you can set the context menu
of the chart to include "About your company name" and then link to your
company home page. By default, the chart shows "About QuickApps for
SharePoint" when right-clicked.
About Menu Item
Label Allows you to set a menu item label for the custom context menu item.
About Menu Item Link Allows you to provide a link for the custom context menu item. You can specify
the link in qSIChartView link format to be able to open the same in new window,
pop-ups, frames or as JavaScript links.
Table 36. Functional
Element Description
Animation Allows you to control animation in your charts. If you do not want to animate any part of the
chart, set this to false. This would also disable all animations applied using <styles>. Animate 3D
can override this value. By default, animation is set to true.
Click URL Allows you to set a URL as a hotspot for a chart. For more information, see Formatting Links.
Table 37. Trend Lines
Element Description
Start Value Allows you to set the start value for the trend line
End Value Allows you to set the ending y-axis value for the trend line
Display Value Allows you to display a string caption for the trend line by its side
Color Allows you to set the color of the trend line and its text
Is Trend Zone Allows you to set the trend as a zone rather than a line
Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of the trend line
Alpha Allows you to set the alpha transparency of the trend line
Dashed Allows you to set the trend line as a dashed line
Dash Length Allows you to set the length of each dash in pixels
Dash Gap Allows you to set the gap length between each dash
Value on Right Allows you to show if the trend line is on the right or left side of the chart
Tool Text Allows you to show tool text when hovered over a trend line
Parent Y Axis Allows to you set whether the trend line should be plotted against a primary or
secondary Y axis (If you use a dual Y Axis chart). If you do not use a dual Y axis chart,
the trend line is plotted against the primary Y axis.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 307
www.agreeya.com
Styles
Styles help you apply font, effects and animations to various objects of the chart. Styles lends a simple
mechanism using which you can easily control the visual layout of charts.
Styles allows you to:
Define your own style attributes using the Style Editor.
Associate them with defined Objects of the chart from within the Style Editor.
Have better control over chart look & feel.
Group together in one element in the XML document, thereby separating data from visual formatting.
Store the entire style definition in a central location in your application, so that all charts within
application can utilize it.
Re-use style definitions. Each style can be applied to multiple chart objects or vice versa.
Each object on the chart has been assigned a unique name, for direct association with style definitions. For
example, the background of the chart is termed as BACKGROUND. Similarly, the plot (columns, lines, areas) on
the chart is named as DATAPLOT. This enables you to associate each style to multiple chart objects or associate
multiple chart objects to a particular style.
You can find the list of objects for each chart in individual Chart XML Sheet.
Styles contains the following:
Table 38. Styles
Element Description
Advanced
Mode Turn on if you want to edit Styles in XML format.
styles>
<definition>
<style name='MyFirstFontStyle' type='font' face='Verdana' size='12' color='FF0000' bold='1'
bgColor='FFFFDD' />
<style name='MyFirstAnimationStyle' type='animation' param='_xScale' start='0'
duration='2' />
<style name='MyFirstShadow' type='Shadow' color='CCCCCC' />
</definition>
<application>
<apply toObject='Caption' styles='MyFirstFontStyle,MyFirstShadow' />
<apply toObject='Canvas' styles='MyFirstAnimationStyle' />
<apply toObject='DataPlot' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
</application>
</styles>
Name Allows you to assign your custom name for the style definition. Style name can only include
alphabets and numbers. Punctuation marks (including underscore) should not be used. Style
name must be unique, that is, two style definitions cannot have the same name.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 308
www.agreeya.com
Type Allows you to set the following types:
Font — allows you to control text properties for all the text on the chart. You can set:
Font — allows you to set the font type
Size — allows you to set the font size
Color — allows you to set the font color
Bold — allows you to set the font weigh
Underline — allows you to assign underline character
Background Color — allows you to set the background color
Border Color — allows you to set the border color
Is HTML — allows you to render the text as HTML
Left Margin — allows you to set the left margin of the text
Letter Spacing — allows you to set the space between the letters in the text
Animation — Allows you to define your custom animations for different elements of the
chart. By default, qSIChartView animates the data plot (columns, lines, area) only.
However, you can define your custom animations for other chart objects (like captions,
titles, values) in the XML. Each chart object can have multiple animation properties
(like x, y, xscale, yscale, alpha) and each sequence can have its own duration.
Param — Allows you to you specify the property of chart object which you want to
animate, such a _x (animate the x position), _y (animate the y position), _xScale
(animate the x-scale), _yScale (animate the y-scale), alpha (helps the alpha transition
animation effect), _rotation (animate pies and doughnuts in circles)
Start — allows you to set the start value of the animation
Duration — allows you to control the duration of animation in seconds
Easing — allows you to specify the pattern of animation easing.
Table 38. Styles
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 309
www.agreeya.com
Type Shadow — Allows you to apply shadow effect to any object on the chart.
Distance — allows you to set the offset distance of the shadow
Angle — allows you to set the angle of the shadow
Color — allows you to set the color of the shadow
Alpha — allows you to set the alpha transparency of the shadow
BlurX — allows you set the amount of horizontal blur on the shadow. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
BlurY — allows you to set the amount of vertical blur on the shadow. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
Strength — allows you to set the strength of the imprint or spread. The higher the
value, the more color is imprinted and the stronger the contrast between the shadow
and the background.
Quality — allows you to set the number of times to apply the shadow effect. Valid
values are 0 to 15. The default value is 1, which is equivalent to low quality. A value of
2 is medium quality, and a value of 3 is high quality. Shadow with lower values are
rendered quicker
Glow — lets you apply glow effects to objects on the chart.
Color — allows you to set the color of the glow
Alpha — allows you to set the alpha transparency of the glow
BlurX — allows you set the amount of horizontal blur on the glow. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
BlurY — allows you to set the amount of vertical blur on the glow. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
Strength — allows you to set the strength of the imprint or spread. The higher the
value, the more color is imprinted and the stronger the contrast between the shadow
and the background.
Quality — allows you to set the number of times to apply the glow effect. Valid values
are 0 to 15. The default value is 1, which is equivalent to low quality. A value of 2 is
medium quality, and a value of 3 is high quality. Shadow with lower values are rendered
quicker.
Table 38. Styles
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 310
www.agreeya.com
Custom defined styles to chart objects
To apply your defined styles to chart objects, make sure that you have the list of chart objects present in each
chart.
For example, the following chart objects are for 2D Single Series Column Chart:
Bevel — Allows you to apply bevel effect for any of the chart objects.
Angle — allows you to set the angle of the bevel
Distance — allows you to set the offset distance of the bevel
Shadow Color — allows you to set the shadow color of the bevel
Shadow Alpha — allows you to set the alpha transparency value of the shadow color
Highlight Color — allows you to set the highlight color of the bevel
Highlight Alpha — allows you to set the alpha transparency value of the highlight color
BlurX — allows you set the amount of horizontal blur on the bevel. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
BlurY — allows you to set the amount of vertical blur on the bevel. Values that are a
power of 2 (such as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other
values.
Strength — allows you to set the strength of the imprint or spread. The higher the
value, the more color is imprinted and the stronger the contrast between the shadow
and the background.
Quality — allows you to set the number of times to apply the bevel. Valid values are 0
to 15. The default value is 1, which is equivalent to low quality. A value of 2 is medium
quality, and a value of 3 is high quality. Shadow with lower values are rendered quicker.
Blur — Allows you to create a blur effect for any object on the chart.
BlurX — allows you set the amount of horizontal blur. Values that are a power of 2 (such
as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other values.
BlurY — allows you to set the amount of vertical blur. Values that are a power of 2 (such
as 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32) are optimized to render more quickly than other values.
Quality — allows you to set the number of times to apply the filter. Valid values are 0 to
15. The default value is 1, which is equivalent to low quality. A value of 2 is medium
quality, and a value of 3 is high quality. Shadow with lower values are rendered quicker.
Table 39. Chart Objects for 2D Series Column Chart
Object Name Description Features Supported Animation Parameters Supported
BACKGROUND entire background of the chart Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
_xScale
_yScale
CANVAS T the area in which the actual
chart is plotted. It is represented
by a bounded rectangle. In 3D
charts, it refers to the 3D base on
which the columns are built.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
_xScale
_yScale
Table 38. Styles
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 311
www.agreeya.com
CAPTION The heading of the chart Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
DATALABELS The x-axis labels of the data Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
DATAPLOT The actual plot of the chart. For
example, in Column 2D chart,
columns are referred to as
DATAPLOT.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
_xScale
_yScale
DATAVALUES The plot values that is, value of
each data (line, column, bar, pie),
which is displayed beside the data
plot.
Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
DIVLINES The horizontal or vertical lines
running through the canvas. Each
divisional line signifies a smaller
unit of the entire axis thus aiding
the users in interpreting the
chart.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_y
_yScale
HGRID Alternate color bands between
two successive horizontal
divisional lines
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_y
_xScale
_yScale
SUBCAPTION The sub-heading of the chart Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
TOOLTIP The tool tip shown when mouse is
hovered over the data plots Font (only
Font, Size
and Color
attributes are
supported)
Table 39. Chart Objects for 2D Series Column Chart
Object Name Description Features Supported Animation Parameters Supported
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 312
www.agreeya.com
The following XML does the work of applying styles to different chart objects:
<application>
<apply toObject='Caption' styles='MyFirstFontStyle,MyFirstShadow' />
<apply toObject='Canvas' styles='MyFirstAnimationStyle' />
<apply toObject='DataPlot' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
</application>
Each <apply> element helps to apply multiple styles to one chart object; for example, in our code, we first
apply the MyFirstFontStyle font style to Caption of the chart and then apply the shadow style MyFirstShadow to
the same object.
If you are using multiple styles, ensure:
TRENDLINES Hhorizontal/vertical lines
spanning the chart canvas which
aid in interpretation of data with
respect to some pre-determined
value.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_y
_xScale
_yScale
TRENDVALUES The display values of trend-lines
(if any) Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
VLINES Vertical separator lines that help
you separate blocks of data.
These lines run through the height
of the chart, thereby segregating
data into different blocks. In case
of bar charts, they are horizontal
and run through the width of
chart.
Animation
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_y
_xScale
_yScale
XAXISNAME The x-axis title of the chart Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
YAXISNAME The y-axis title of the chart Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
YAXISVALUES The limit values or divisional line
values, which are displayed along
the y-axis of the chart
Animation
Font
Shadow
Glow
Bevel
Blur
_alpha
_x
_y
_rotation
Table 39. Chart Objects for 2D Series Column Chart
Object Name Description Features Supported Animation Parameters Supported
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 313
www.agreeya.com
you separate the style names using comma
for example, <apply toObject='Caption' styles='MyFirstFontStyle,MyFirstShadow' />
when you apply a single style to multiple objects, define <apply> element for each object and then
assign the style for it.
for example,
<apply toObject='Caption' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
<apply toObject='DataPlot' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
You CANNOT separate the object list by comma and then assign a single style to it - the following is
INVALID:
<apply toObject='Caption,DataPlot' styles='MyFirstShadow' />
The style name specified during application has been defined earlier in style definition and the spelling
are correct, else, qSIChartView will ignore it and log the error in Debug Window.
Series Appearance
This property enables you to specify the appearance of the data series and data items in the series.
The Appearance element can contain one or more Series Appearance elements. Each Series Appearance
element controls the appearance of the data series in the chart. Therefore, the first Series Appearance element
controls the appearance of the first data series, the second one contains the second data series, and so on. See
the Configuration property on how to define multiple data series in the chart.
The Series Appearance contains the following:
Table 40. Series Appearance
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Series Appearance in XML format.
<Appearance>
<SeriesAppearance [optional attributes]>
<ItemAppearance [optional attributes] />
<ItemAppearance [optional attributes] />
</SeriesAppearances>
<SeriesAppearance [optional attributes]>
<ItemAppearance [optional attributes] />
<ItemAppearance [optional attributes]/>
</SeriesAppearances>
</Appearance>
Color Allows you to set the color using which columns, lines, area of that dataset would be drawn.
Alpha Allows you to set the alpha (transparency) of the entire dataset at the Series Appearance
level. The range is from 0 - 100.
Ratio Allows you to control the ratio of each color using a comma separated list of ratios, if you
are showing columns as gradients,
Dashed Allows you to set whether this dataset would appear as dashed.
Show Plot
Border Allows you to set whether to show the border of this dataset.
Plot Border
Color Allows you to set the color of the plot border.
Plot Border
Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of the plot border lines.
Plot Border
Alpha Allows you to set the alpha transparency of the plot border lines
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 314
www.agreeya.com
The Series Appearance element can contain zero or more Item Appearance elements. If you do specify any Item
Appearance element, every item in the series is displayed according to the settings in the Series Appearance
element. The Item Appearance is applied as follows:
If you specify the Item Value in the Item Appearance, the settings are applied based on the X axis value
of the item. For example, if the X axis shows the value of the Priority field in the Tasks list, you can make
all the High priority items displayed in red.
If you specify Y Axis Value Range in the Item Appearance, the settings are applied based on the Y axis
value of the item. For example, you can highlight any data items that falls within a certain range with a
certain color (low sales number with red, high sales number with blue).
If neither is specified, the settings are applied in the order they are listed. This means the first Item
Appearance controls the appearance of the first data item in the series, the second one controls the
second data item in the series, and so on. In this case, if the data series has more items to display than
the number of Item Appearance, the remaining items are displayed with the settings specified by the
Series Appearance. Having said this, it is better to define more Item Appearance elements when you
have a variable number of items to display in the chart.
Item Appearance contains the following:
Line Thickness Allows you to set the thickness of the lines for the particular dataset in pixels.
Line Dash
Length Allows you to define the length of the dash, if the lines are to be shown as dash for the
particular dataset.
Line Dash Gap Allows you to define the length of the gap between dashes, if the lines are to be shown as
dash for the particular dataset.
Draw Anchors Allows you set whether to draw anchors for the particular dataset. If the anchors are not
shown, then the tool tip and links will not work for the dataset.
Anchor Sides Allows you set the number of sides that the anchors of the particular dataset will have. For
example, an anchor with 3 sides would represent a triangle, with 4 it would be a square and
so on. The range is from 3 - 20.
Anchor Radius Allows you to set the radius (in pixels) of the anchors of the particular dataset. Greater the
radius, bigger would be the anchor size.
Anchor Border
Color Allows you set the border color of anchors of the particular dataset. Use hex code of colors.
To use the color picker, click on the color swatch square.
Anchor Border
Thickness Allows you set border thickness of anchors of the particular dataset in pixels.
Anchor
Background
Color
Allows you set the background color of anchors of the particular dataset. Use hex code of
colors. To use the color picker, click on the color swatch square.
Anchor Alpha Allows you set the alpha of entire anchors of the particular dataset. If you need to hide the
anchors for the dataset but still enable tool tips, set this as 0.
Anchor
Background
Alpha
Allows you set the alpha (transparency) of anchor background of the particular dataset. The
range is from 0 - 100.
Table 41. Item Appearance
Element Description
Item Value Allows you to specify the settings in the Item Appearance element that are applied to the
data items whose X axis value match with the specified value.
Y Axis Value
Range Allows you to apply the color is applied based on the Y axis value of the item, if you specify
Y Axis Value Range,
Table 40. Series Appearance
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 315
www.agreeya.com
To o l b a r
The Toolbar Appearance Tab contains the following:
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Color Allows you to define the color of data series at the Series Appearance level for multi-series
and combination charts. However, if you wish to highlight a particular data item, you can
specify its color at Item Appearance level.
Display Value Allows you to display a custom string value if instead of the numerical value of this data.
Tooltext Allows you to display more information for the data item as tool tip. By default,
qSIChartView shows the series Name, Category Name and value as tool tip text for that data
item.
Alpha Allows you to define the alpha of datasets at the Series Appearance level for multi-series and
combination charts, However, if you wish to highlight a particular data item, you can specify
its alpha at Item Appearance level using this attribute. The range is from 0 - 100.
Dashed Allows you to set whether the border of this data item should appear as dashed.
Anchor Sides Lets you specify item specific sides of the anchor in a line/area chart. The range is from 3 -
20.
Anchor Radius Lets you specify item specific radius (in pixels) of the anchor in a line/area chart.
Anchor Border
Color Lets you specify item specific border color of the anchor. Use hex code of colors. To use the
color picker, click on the color swatch square
Anchor Border
Thickness Lets you specify item specific border thickness in pixels) of the anchor in a line/area chart.
Anchor
Background
Color
Lets you specify item specific background color of the anchor in a line/area chart.
Anchor Alpha Lets you specify item specific alpha (transparency) of the anchor in a line/area chart. The
range is from 0 - 100.
Anchor
Background
Alpha
Lets you specify item specific alpha (transparency) of the anchor background in a line/area
chart. The range is from 0 - 100.
Table 42. Toolbar Appearance
Element Description
Toolbar Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the toolbar.
Show Return to Master Chart
Button If selected, displays the Return To Master Chart Button. This button will
appear only if the Source parameter exists in the URL of the current page.
When the user clicks this button, the user is returned back to the URL
specified in the Source HTTP parameter.
Show Export Button When selected, displays options that enable export of rendered chart in
various formats: JPG, PNG, SVG, PDF, and XLS (as an Excel spreadsheet).
Table 43. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Table 41. Item Appearance
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 316
www.agreeya.com
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 44. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the Web
Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 43. Layout
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 317
www.agreeya.com
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Table 45. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 46. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some settings,
such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current culture setting.
The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string values for different
cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can have
multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default culture,
leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes for
the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the string
in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve
the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not
found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 318
www.agreeya.com
qSIChartView Procedures
You can perform the following procedures using qSIChartView:
Configuring qSIChartView
Formatting Links
Setting Number Formatting
Setting Number Scaling
Configuring qSIChartView
To configure qSIChartview
1 Add qSIChartView to your page.
2Open ezEdit.
The Primary Content page opens by default.
3 Configure each element as needed and click OK.
4 If needed, configure the elements in the other tabs.
5 When done configuring each tab, click OK.
Formatting Links
You can perform the following procedures with links:
Defining Links for a Chart
Opening Links in a New Window
Linking to Frames
Opening Links in Pop-up Windows
Return to Master
Chart Button Text
Resource ID
By default, the text for the Return to Master Chart toolbar button is retrieved from the
resource file that is included in the product. If the resource file in the culture that you
want to use is not available, define the text for the Return to Master Chart toolbar button
in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource ID and the current cultural
setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default
text from the invariant resource file is used.
Filter Button Text
Resource ID By default, the text for the Filter toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that is
included in the product. If the resource file is not available, define the text for the Filter
toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID. This Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve
the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not
found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Table 46. Localization
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 319
www.agreeya.com
Defining Links for a Chart
To define a link for any data plot
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Functional.
3 In the Click URL field, define the link attribute as in the following example:
link='ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan'
With the above XML, the data plot (be it column, pie or line/area anchor), when clicked, will take to the
page ShowDetails.asp?Month=Jan, which might contain another chart to show detailed results for the
month of January.
The chart view expects all the links in URL Encoded format, if you have characters special characters
(such as ?,&) in your link. When the user clicks the link, the chart view decodes it and invokes
ShowDetails.asp?Month=Jan.
All the server-side scripting languages provide a generic function to URL Encode any string.
Opening Links in a New Window
You can open the link in a new window instead of the same window.
To open a link in a new window
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Functional.
3 In the Click URL field, add n- before any link, as in the following example:, link='n-
ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan'
The above link, when clicked, opens in a new window.
Opening Links in Pop-up Windows
The chart view also allows you to open your links in pop-up windows.
To open a link in pop-up window
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Functional.
3 In the Click URL field, define the link as in the following example:
link="P-detailsWin,width=400,height=300,toolbar=no,scrollbars=no, resizable=no-
ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan"
Where:
P- denotes that the link is to open in a new pop-up window.
detailsWin specifies a name for the new window. If you want all the links to open in the same
pop-up, use the same window name across all links. However, if you want each link to open in a
new pop-up, specify a different window name for each link.
height specifies the height of the window in pixels.
width specifies the width of the window in pixels.
resizable when enabled, allows the user to manually resize the window by dragging its edges or
corners.
scrollbars specify whether or not to display the horizontal and vertical scrollbars that normally
appear when the page content is larger tan the screen.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 320
www.agreeya.com
-ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan denotes the actual link to be invoked
Linking to Frames
The chart view allows you to open links in specified frames too. To do so, you just specify the name of the frame
in the link itself.
To open link in a specified frame
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Functional.
3 In the Click URL field, set the link as in the following example: link='F-FrameName-
ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan'
Where:
F denotes the link opens in a frame
-FrameName denotes the name of the frame to be opened
-ShowDetails.asp%3FMonth%3DJan denotes the actual link to be opened. The link needs to be URL
Encoded.
In this example, the main frameset is contained in FrameExample.html, which has two vertical frame pane- one
on top containing the chart (FramePages\FrameChart.html) and one on bottom to show the linked frame pages.
The bottom pane by default shows FramePages\LowerFrame.html which contains the message "Click on columns
above to view details ".
The setup looks as:
NOTE: You can include other attributes, such as:
menubar specifies whether or not to display a menu bar at the top of the window.
toolbar specifies whether or not to display the main toolbar (with the back,
forward, stop buttons).
location specifies whether or not to display the location bar (the Address Bar in
Internet Explorer) - where URLs are typed and displayed.
directories specifies whether or not to display any additional toolbar (for example,
the Links Bar in Internet Explorer).
status specifies whether or not to display the status bar at the foot of the window.
left specifies the distance in pixels of the new window from the left edge of the
screen. (This applies to Internet Explorer. For Netscape Navigator use screenX).
top specifies the distance in pixels of the new window from the top edge of the
screen. (This applies to Internet Explorer. For Netscape Navigator use screenY).
fullscreen when enabled causes the window to open in full-screen mode (Internet
Explorer only.)
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 321
www.agreeya.com
Figure 17. Linking to Frames
Setting Number Formatting
You can perform the following procedures:
Controlling Decimal Precision
Automatic Number Formatting
Setting Custom Thousand and Decimal Separator Character
Opening Links in Pop-up Windows
Adding Number Prefix and Suffix
Formatting Y-axis Values Decimal in Manual Div-Lines Mode
Controlling Decimal Precision
All the charts types in qSIChartView support the attribute decimals. This single attribute lets you control the
decimal precision of all the numbers on the chart. Using this attribute, you can globally set the number of
decimal places of ALL numbers of the chart.
To globally set the number of decimal places
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 Enter a value in the Decimal box.
4Click Save.
For example, if you have numbers on your chart as 12.432, 13.4 and 13 and you set Decimals='2' , the numbers
would be converted to 12.43, 13.4 and 13 respectively.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 322
www.agreeya.com
Figure 18. Decimal Precision
Similarly, if you had data as 0.12342, 0.134 and 0.13, and you set Decimals as 3, qSIChartView would output
0.124, 0.134 and 0.13 respectively.
Even though the Decimal is set to 3, qSIChartView does not add the 0 padding to 0.13 to form 0.130. However, if
you want your numbers on the chart to have trailing zeroes too, you can set Force Decimals=true and now the
numbers would show as 0.124, 0.134 and 0.130 respectively, as shown in the examples:
Figure 19. Force decimals
Automatic Number Formatting
qSIChartView automatically formats your numbers by adding K,M (Kilo, Million) and proper commas to the
numbers, as shown in the example:
Figure 20. Automatic Number Formatting
The data for chart is 12500, 13400 and 13300. qSIChartView automatically formats the number scaling to
convert to K (Thousands) & M (Millions).
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 323
www.agreeya.com
If you do not want to truncate numbers
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 From Format Number Scale, select False.
4Click Save.
When you now view the chart, you will see the following:
Figure 21. Not truncating numbers
In the example above, qSIChartView is showing full numbers on the chart. It has also added commas to the
numbers at the required places.
If you do not want to set commas
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 From Format Number, select False.
4 From Format Number Scale, select False.
5Click Save.
Figure 22. Not setting commas
The commas have been removed from numbers.
Setting Custom Thousand and Decimal Separator Character
By default, qSIChartView uses . (dot) as decimal separator and , (comma) as thousand separator character.
However, you can customize this character depending on your requirements. For example, you can swap the
separator characters.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 324
www.agreeya.com
To swap separator characters
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 In the In Decimal Separator, enter ,.
4 In the In Thousand Separator, enter ..
5Click Save.
Figure 23 shows the output.
Figure 23. Swap separator characters
Adding Number Prefix and Suffix
qSIChartView allows you to add a prefix or suffix to all numbers on the chart.
To add a number prefix or suffix
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 In the Number Prefix box, enter a character or value.
For example, to represent dollar figures, enter $.
4 In the Number Suffix box, enter a character or value.
For example, to represent figures quantified per annum, enter p.a.
5Click Save.
If you intend to use special characters for Number Prefix or Number Suffix, URL Encode them when using
dataXML method. For example, if you wish to have numberSuffix as % (for example, 30%):
numberSuffix='%25'
In dataURL method, you can directly specify the character.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 325
www.agreeya.com
Figure 24. Adding number prefixes and suffixes
Formatting Y-axis Values Decimal in Manual Div-Lines Mode
If you want to set the number of divisional lines on chart, you can control the decimals of y-axis values
separately. For example, consider the following attributes and chart:
Y Axis Min Value='115' Y Axis Max Value='140' Zero Plane=false Number of Division Lines='3' >
Figure 25. Formatting y-axis
In this chart, the chart lower limit, upper limit, and number of divisional lines have been manually set.
qSIChartView will not automatically adjust divisional lines. In the chart, qSIChartView has truncated decimals
from y-axis values, as it cannot find any other decimal values on the chart.
You can, however, show decimals on y-axis values in this case (when Zero Plane is false) using Y Axis Value
Decimals attribute, for example Y Axis Min Value='115' Y Axis Max Value='140' Zero Plane=false Number of
Division Lines='3' Y Axis Value Decimals='2' Decimals='0' >.
When you now see the chart, 2 decimal places on y-axis values appear. But, the other numbers on chart would
still have 0 decimal places.
Setting Number Scaling
Number scaling lets you define your own scales for numbers and then apply it to all numbers on the chart.
For example, if your numbers on the chart are greater than 1000, qSIChartView scales them to K (Thousands) or
M (Millions). For example, if you plot a chart with data as 12500, 13400 and 13300, you will see the following
chart:
NOTE: Force Decimals does not work in this mode.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 326
www.agreeya.com
Figure 26. Setting number scaling
qSIChartView has scaled the numbers down to K. By default, qSIChartView has the K,M (1000,1000) scaling
defined for each chart. You can, however, customize it.
You can perform the following procedures:
Adding Billions to Default Scaling
Putting Time in Scale
Adding Billions to Default Scaling
qSIChartView, by default, has 1000,1000 (K,M) scaling defined for all charts. It does not have the scaling for
billions defined. You can modify the number scaling to add billion so that the final scale looks like
1000,1000,1000 (K,M,B).
This scale would look something like:
1000 = 1 K
1000 K = 1 M
1000 M = 1 B
To convert this scale into qSIChartView format
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 In the Number Scale Value box, enter 1000,1000,1000.
4 In the Number Scale Unit box, enter K,M,B.
5Click Save.
Whatever numeric figure was present on the left hand side of the table is put in Number Scale Value and
whatever unit was present on the right side of the scale table has been put under Number Scale Unit - all
separated by commas.
If you want to set the chart formatting flags
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 From Format Number, select True.
4 From Format Number Scale, select True.
5 In the Number Prefix box, enter $.
6Click Save.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 327
www.agreeya.com
When you now view a chart containing data in billions, you will see the following chart. Note that the
chart now contains figure both in millions and billions.
Figure 27. Setting chart formatting
Putting Time in Scale
If you want to plot time-related figures on the chart, you can set the time in each process to range from a few
seconds to few days. You can build a scale indicating time and then specify it to the chart:
60 seconds = 1 minute
60 minute = 1 hr
24 hrs = 1 day
7 days = 1 week
To convert this scale in qSIChartView
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 In the Default Number Scale box, enter s.
The default number scale is now represented in seconds.
4 In the Number Scale Value box, enter 60,60,24,7.
5 In the Number Scale Unit box, enter min,hr,day,wk.
6Click Save.
Whatever numeric figure was present on the left hand side of the table is put in Number Scale Value and
whatever unit was present on the right side of the scale table has been put under Number Scale Unit - all
separated by commas.
If you want to set the chart formatting flags
1 From Chart Attributes, click Edit.
2Click Number Formatting.
3 From Format Number, select True.
4 From Format Number Scale, select True.
5Click Save.
When you now view the chart, you'll see that all the data has been automatically scaled to the best
value:
38 is converted to 38s
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 328
www.agreeya.com
150 is converted to 2.50min
11050 is converted to 3.07hr
334345 is converted to 3.87 day
1334345 is converted to 2.21wk
Figure 28. Time scaling
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
20
329
www.agreeya.com
qSIListForm
Overview
qSIListForm Pages
Overview
qSIListForm is a form that displays data from external systems, such as SQL Server, Web Services, K2, or
Salesforce. It allows you to associate a custom toolbar button with one or more actions, and enables you to
write complex validation logic.
This web part validates the following properties before setting them:
Form Component Behavior. If this succeeds, it will execute the custom action.
Fields that are marked as required. See Required on page 338.
Displayed Fields Type (if Number is selected as the type). See Type on page 338.
qSIListForm allows you to:
define a mask for the input. Enforcing the format increases the consistency and data correctness.
create a description for each field. The description can be plain text or HTML.
define a new title for the field. This is useful if the title is too long or if you want to display a different
title for the field.
assign a fixed value to a field.
assign a formatted value to a field based on values in other fields. The only requirement is that the
parent fields must precede the field to be assigned.
fill the value of a field from a value stored in the Session variable. This feature usually works in
conjunction with another web part, such as qSISelector or qSIListView.
auto-fill a certain field based on field in a consumed row.
implement the IWebPartRow interface to provide a row to another web part, such as qSIListView or
qSISelector.
hide a field. A hidden field is processed during postback, but it will not be displayed.
create a read -only field.
define a CAPTCHA field thereby enhancing the authenticity of entered data.
store the displayed, new, or updated items into the Session. This feature enables a List Form to
communicate with another web part, such as qSISelector in another page.
display, create, and edit data in your external systems. Out of the box, this Web Part supports the DAO
Provider for:
Web Services
SQL Server
Oracle
Domino Server using XML over HTTP
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 330
www.agreeya.com
Salesforce
K2Server (for SharePoint 2010 only)
Define a different title for different languages using the Resource List and the Title Resource ID
properties. You can also define different texts for the buttons in the list form toolbar for different
languages. The culture for the page can be defined by appending the Culture HTTP parameter to the
page URL; for example, http://hostname/sites/sitename/default.aspx?Culture=en-US
qSIListForm Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qSIListForm contains the
following tabs:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Optional Content
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
Catalog
This property defines the entity and the operations related to the entity.
TIP: To better understand SI web parts, read the System Integration Developer Guide.
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part, or accept the default. This field is
mandatory.
Catalog See Catalog on page 330.
Form Type Allows you to choose one of the following:
DisplayEntity — The form is used to display an entity (all fields are read-only).
NewEntity — The form is used to create a new entity.
EditEntity — The form is used to edit an entity.
Form Layout For more information, see Form Layout on page 333.
Display Fields For more information, see Display Fields on page 335.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 331
www.agreeya.com
Entities contain the following elements:
You can add operations to your entities by configuring the following elements:
Table 2. Catalog
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Catalog in XML format.
<Catalog>
<Entity Name="entityName" System="systemName" Service="serviceName"
Default="true/false">
<Properties>
<Property Name="propertyName" Type="typeName" Value="propertyValue" />
<Property Name="propertyName" Type="typeName" Value="propertyValue" />
</Properties>
<Operation Name="operationName" Method="methodName" Default="True/False" >
<Parameter Source="sourceType" SessionName="sessionName"
SourceName="sourceName" Type="parameterType" Name="parameterName"
Usage="usageType" Value="value" />
<Parameter Source="sourceType" SessionName="sessionName"
SourceName="sourceName" Type="parameterType" Name="parameterName"
Usage="usageType" Value="value" />
</Operation>
</Entity>
<Entity>
..</Entity>
</Catalog>
System Allows you to specify the system name that is defined in the System Integration
configuration file. If the system name does not exist in the System Integration
configuration file, you will get an error.
Service Allows you to specify the service name that is defined in the System Integration
configuration file. The service name that you specify here must belong to system that you
specify in the System attribute. If the service name does not exist in the System
Integration configuration file, you will get an error.
Name Allows you to specify the name of the entity which must be unique within this Catalog.
The name does not have to match with any name in your external system. However, it is
recommended that you use a descriptive name for your entity. This field is mandatory.
Set Session Name Allows you to enter name of the session variable where the edited or newly created item
is stored when it is saved, or the item that is being displayed or edited is stored when it is
loaded.
Reset Session
Names Allows you to reset (set to NULL) the value of the session variable whose name is specified
in this attribute. Specify multiple names by separating them with commas.
Default Allows you to define this entity as the default for the list form. If this element is not
specified, the first entity that is listed in the catalog becomes the default entity. The
default operation of the default entity is the operation that is used to retrieve the data
when the list form is loaded for the first time in edit or display mode.
Table 3. Operations
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the operation. This name does not have to match with any
name in your external system. This name is used to refer to this operation in the Action property.
This field is mandatory.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 332
www.agreeya.com
You can define parameters for the operation by configuring the following elements:
You can define one or more Property elements.
Method Allows you to specify the real name of the operation in your external system. For example, it
may refer to the name of a web service method. Or it may refer to the name of a stored
procedure in your SQL Server database.
Default Allows you to define this operation as the default. The default operation is the first operation
that is called to retrieve the entity to be displayed or edited. If this attribute is not specified,
the first operation listed in the entity becomes the default operation.
Table 4. Parameters
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the parameter.
Source Allows you to define the source of this parameter. The source can be one of the following:
DefaultValue — the value of the parameter that is the default
NullValue — the value of the parameter is blank
FixedValue — the value of the parameter that is defined in the Value attribute
HttpRequest — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the HTTP parameters in
the page URL. The name of the HTTP parameter is defined in the SourceName attribute.
As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName attribute is
ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter, which is Hardware, is used
as the value of the parameter.
Input — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from one of the input fields in the
form. You specify the name of the input field in the SourceName attribute. Additionally,
you can retrieve the current user information as the value of the parameter. You can
specify one of the following name in the SourceName attribute to retrieve the current
user information:
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row
that is consumed from another web part. You specify the name of the field that is
consumed in the SourceName attribute.
Session — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row that is stored in the
session. You specify the name of the session in the SessionName attribute. You specify
the name of the field that is consumed in the SourceName attribute.
ComplexType — the value of the parameter is an object based on the Type attribute and
Member definition inside the Parameter. Array and nested complex types are supported.
Array — the value of the parameter is an array of values
XML — the value of the parameter that is dynamically built when the condition is execute
at runtime
Usage Allows you to define the direction for this parameter. The options are In, Out, InOut, or
ReturnValue.
Table 5. Properties
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the property. Refer to the documentation for the DAO
Provider to your external system will tell you the name of the property that you must define.
Type Allows you to specify type of value that is specified in the Value attribute. Example:
System.String.
Value Allows you to specify the value of the property.
Table 3. Operations
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 333
www.agreeya.com
Form Layout
This property enables you to define the layout of the fields in the List Form. If this property is not defined, the
List Form will display the fields in two column format: the first column is the field title and the second column
is the control for the field.
This property is related to the Display Fields property. The Form Layout property defines the layout type and
the containers. In order to place a certain field in a specific container, you will use the Tab/Panel/Container ID
attribute of the Field element in the Display Fields property.
The Form Layout element can contain zero or more Container elements. You may not have to define any
container for a certain type of layout manager. Some custom layout manager may have a fixed set of containers
that do not need to be defined.
The Form Layout section contains the following:
Table 6. Form Layout
Form Layout
type Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Form Layout in XML format:
<FormLayout Type="TabLayout">
<Container Type="containerType" ID="containerID1" Label="tabText1"
ShowUserGroups="group1,group2" HideUserGroups="group3,group4">
<Container Type="containerType" ID="containerID2" Label="tabText2"
ShowUserGroups="group3,group4" HideUserGroups="group1,group2">
</FormLayout>
Tab Layout Groups the fields in multiple tabs. You can add tabs to this layout by setting values for the
following:
ID — the identifier for the tab. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Label — the label for the container. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will
use the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the container is shown if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the container is hidden if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will
take precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in the
HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
Panel Layout Groups the fields in multiple panels. You can add panels to this layout by setting values for
the following:
ID — the identifier for the panel. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Label — the label for the container. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will
use the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the container is shown if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the container is hidden if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will
take precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in the
HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 334
www.agreeya.com
Custom Layout Uses the custom layout manager class specified in the LayoutManagerClassName attribute to
layout the fields. Using the custom layout, you can write your own custom Layout Manager
where you can layout the fields in any way you want it or even create your own custom
controls in the form. For more detail on how to write your own custom Layout Manager
class, see Custom Layout on page 149.
You can add containers to this layout by setting values for the following:
ID — the identifier for the tab. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Type — the type of container.
Label — the label for the container. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will
use the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the container is shown if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the container is hidden if the current user is a member of at least
one of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group
names here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will
take precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in the
HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
MultiColumn
Layout Displays the data in multiple columns. You can select the number of columns, and select if
you want to render and control in a single row (displays the Label/Input control on the same
row. If not selected, the Label/Input control is on separate row. Being on the separate row
gives more screen real estate to render multiple columns. If this is selected, column span
and row span attributes are applied to grouped field.)
Table 6. Form Layout
Form Layout
type Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 335
www.agreeya.com
Display Fields
This property defines what fields should be displayed in the List Form and how the fields are populated.
Tab and
MultiColumn
Layout
Groups the fields in multiple tabs and in multiple columns in each tab.
You can add tabs to this layout by setting values for the following:
ID — the identifier for the tab. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Label — the label for the tab. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will use
the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the tab is shown if the current user is a member of at least one of
the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group names
here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the tab is hidden if the current user is a member of at least one of
the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group names
here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will take
precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in the
HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
Render and Control in a single row — the tab displays the Label/Input control on the
same row. If not selected, the Label/Input control is on separate row. Being on the
separate row gives more screen real estate to render multiple columns. If this is
selected, column span and row span attributes are applied to grouped field.
Panel and
MultiColumn
Layout
Groups the fields in multiple panels and in multiple columns in each panel.
You can add panels to this layout by setting values for the following:
ID — the identifier for the panel. This ID must be unique for each container that is
defined in the Form Layout. This identifier is referred to in the ContainerID attribute
of the Field element in the Display Fields Property.
Label — the label for the panel. Otherwise, if the container needs a label, it will use
the ID.
ShowUserGroups — the panel is shown if the current user is a member of at least one
of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group names
here by separating them with commas.
HideUserGroups — the panel is hidden if the current user is a member of at least one
of the specified SharePoint groups. You can define multiple SharePoint group names
here by separating them with commas. The HideUserGroups attribute will take
precedence if the current user is a member of one of the groups specified in the
HideUserGroups and ShowUserGroups.
Render and Control in a single row — the panel displays the Label/Input control on
the same row. If not selected, the Label/Input control is on separate row. Being on
the separate row gives more screen real estate to render multiple columns. If this is
selected, column span and row span attributes are applied to grouped field.
NOTE: You must configure Display Fields before configuring Form Component Behavior.
NOTE: In addition to the fields in the list, the listform recognizes the following special field.
CAPTCHA — This field contains the security image used for authenticating data that is input in the
form and works for the following form types: NewEntity and EditEntity. If the list contains an
existing field that has the name CAPTCHA then this field will take precedence.
Table 6. Form Layout
Form Layout
type Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 336
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Mode
Turn on if you want to edit Display Fields in XML format.
Data Index/Data Member
The Data Index allows you to define the index of the data table that contains the data to be displayed. This is
useful when the operation that retrieves the data from external system returns multiple data tables. If the data
table does not have any meaningful name, use the Data Index propertY.
The Data Member allows you to define the name of the data table that contains the data to be displayed. This is
useful when the operation that retrieves the data from external system returns multiple data tables and those
tables do not have any meaningful name. If the data table has meaningful name, you can refer to it by using the
Data Member property.
If neither the Data Member or the Data Index is specified, the first data table in the data set is used.
Fields
You can add fields by selecting them from a list automatically displayed or by manually adding them.
NOTE: This section is optional.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 337
www.agreeya.com
Loading Fields
If the default operation of the external system (selected in the Catalog section) contains data, click Load Fields
to display a list of fields. Select the fields you want to display in the web part.
Adding Fields
If the default operation does not contain data, select Add Fields.
You can add fields and enter values for the following:
Field Properties
Click Edit next to a field name to further define its properties by configuring the following:
NOTE: Loading Fields is supported in the qSIListForm Web Part only.
Table 7. Adding Fields
Values Description
Field Name Displays the field name.
Title Allows you to change the displayed title for the field. The value can be a plain string or
an encoded HTML string. Change the displayed title, for example, when the title is too
long or to make the title more descriptive.
Description Allows you to set the field description. It can be a plain string or an encoded HTML
string. The Description is added below the field value.
Table 8. Field Properties
Properties Description
Name Displays the field name.
Title Allows you to change the displayed title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an
encoded HTML string. You can change the displayed title, for example, when the title is too
long or to make the title more descriptive.
Title Resource ID If supporting a multi-lingual site, you may want to display a different Title for the field
depending on the current culture. This property defines the identifier in the Resource List
that is used as the title of the field. The TitleResourceID and the current cultural setting
(identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier is not found, the default Title is used.
Tooltip Allows you to set the text that is displayed in the tooltip when you hover your mouse over
the control for the field in the list form. If you do not specify this attribute, the display
name of the field is used as the tooltip text.
Tooltip Resource
ID If supporting a multi-lingual site, you may want to display a different tooltip for the field
depending on the current culture. This property defines the identifier in the Resource List
that is used as the title of the field. The Tooltip Resource ID and the current cultural
setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier is not found, the default tooltip is used.
Description Allows you to set the field description. It can be a plain string or an encoded HTML string.
The Description is added below the field value.
Description
Resource ID If supporting a multi-lingual site, you may want to display a different description for the
field depending on the current culture. This property defines the identifier in the Resource
List that is used as the title of the field. The Description Resource ID and the current
cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the
string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier is not found, the default
description is used.
Width (in pixels) Allows you to set the width of the control in pixels.
NOTE: Some controls, such as the Rich Text Editor, have minimum width and it will not
honor the specified width if it is smaller than its minimum width.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 338
www.agreeya.com
Column Span Allows you to set the span of the column.
Row Span Allows you to set the span of the row.
Type Allows you to define the type of field. The following types are supported:
SingleLineofText
MultipleLinesofText
RichText - disables resizing text
Choice - allows you to define the options for the Choice field or retrieves the options
for the names of the data table in a dataset.
Number - when selected, allows you enter a minimum and maximum value, and
select the number of decimal places and if you want these numbers as a percentage
Currency
DateTime - allows you to enter DateOnly or DateTime
Boolean
Required Select this check box if this field is required.
Hidden Allows you to hide the field.If the field is hidden, the List Form will not modify that field at
all. If you hide the field using the Hidden attribute, the field is processed according to the
way it is defined, but it will not be shown in the List Form.
Auto Post Back If selected, allows the control to refresh the form when its value changes. This attribute
should be set to true in the following scenarios:
When a choice field is used in the conditions of the Form Component Behavior
property.
When a choice field is passed as a parameter to another operation that is used to
populate another choice field.
Group Name Allows you to create dynamic behavior for a group of fields. The list form can be defined to
have dynamic behavior where certain fields or group of fields can be hidden, shown,
disabled, or enabled based on certain conditions. The value in the Group Name field is
referred to in the Form Component Behavior property.
Mask Allows you to define the format of the input. The mask can contain characters and input-
mask-flags such as:
# — digit or space, optional. If this position is blank in the mask, it is rendered as a prompt
character.
L — uppercase letter, optional. Restricts input to the ASCII letters A-Z.
l (lower case L) — lowercase letter, optional. Restricts input to the ASCII letters a-z.
a — accepts any character
<n..m> — restricts the user input to the declared numeric range, for example: <0..255>.
The numeric range mask part must occupy multiple characters of the mask.
<option1|option2|option3> — restricts user input to one of the set options, for example:
<Sun|Mon|Tue|Wed|Thu|Fri|Sat>.
\ — escapes a mask character, turning it into a literal. "\\" is the escape sequence for a
backslash.
All other character — all non mask elements will appear as themselves. Literals always
occupy a static position in the mask at run time, and cannot be moved or deleted by the
user.
Prompt
Character Allows you to define a placeholder to enter a character that is displayed and saved in place
of the empty characters when you specify a mask. If not specified, "_" (underscore) is used
as the default prompt character. Specify only a single character in this attribute.
Field Type Allows you to select a field type. More options are available depending on the field type
selected. For more information, see Field Types on page 339.
Table 8. Field Properties
Properties Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 339
www.agreeya.com
Field Types
Select one of the following field types.
Table 9. Field Types
Field types Description
Regular Field Allows you to assign a regular field. This is the default.
Fixed Value You can assign a fixed value to a field using the FixedValue attribute. For example,
to assign Accounting to the Department field:
<Field Name="Department" FixedValue="Accounting"/>
Additionally, you can use special variables for the FixedValue attribute.
<CurrentUserID/> — this value is replaced by the ID of the currently logged in
user. If you want to assign the current user to the People and Group field, use
this variable. If you are using Advanced Mode and you would like to assign a
task to the currently logged in user, you can specify the following Field
element: <Field Name="Assigned To" FixedValue="&lt;CurrentUserID/&gt;" />
<CurrentUserName/> — this value is replaced by the name of the currently
logged in user.
<CurrentUserEmail/> — this value is replaced by the email of the currently
logged in user.
<CurrentLoginName/> — this value is replaced by the login name of the
currently logged in user. The login name is usually in the form of
domain\username.
<Today/> — this value is replaced by today's date.
<Now/> — this value is replaced by the current date and time.
NOTE: If you are using SharePoint Form-Based Authentication, the above variables
will return the following, for example:
CurrentUserName=testuser
CurrentLoginName=i:0#.f|<site>|testuser
CurrentUserID=6
CurrentUserEmail=testuser@company.com
You can set the following:
Allow Edit - select this check box to edit the field value in the form;
otherwise, it is read-only.
Consume Value for an
HTTP Parameter The HTTP Parameter Consumer field gets its value from an HTTP parameter. This is
the attribute to create an HTTP Parameter Consumer field. You can set the
following:
Consume HTTP Parameter Name - allows you to enter the name of the HTTP
parameter whose value is to be consumed.
Allow Edit - select this check box to edit the field value in the form;
otherwise, it is read-only.
Calculated Format You can format a value of a field using values from other fields by using the
CalculatedFormat attribute. The value of the another field can be referred to using
the <%fieldName%> field replacement expression.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and
> characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in
the Display Fields editor in the List Form Editor, where the Editor will encode the
characters automatically for you.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 340
www.agreeya.com
Optional Content
You can configure the following optional content:
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Actions
Form
Views
Consume value from a
row provided by another
Web Part
The row consumer field gets its value from the row that is consumed by this List
Form. To create a row consumer field, you must connect the List Form with another
web part that implements the IRowProvider interface (such as the qSISelector).
You can set the following:
Consume Row Display Field Name - allows you to define the field name in the
row from where the value comes.
Consume Row Display Format - allows you to define the string format for the
values. This attribute takes precedence over the Consume Row Display Field
Name attribute. The format of the Consume Row Display Format is the same
as the format used in the Calculated Format attribute. If you select
NewEntity type as Form type, leave this field blank unless it is in simple text
format.
Allow Edit - select this check box to edit the field value in the form;
otherwise, it is read-only
Consume from another
session Session consumer field gets its value from a row that is stored in the session object.
If you require values from multiple providers, use the Session Consumer field type
instead of Row Consumer field type because the List Form can only be connected to
one row provider.
You can set the following:
Session Name - enter the name of the session
Consume Session Display Field Name - allows you to defines the field name in
the session from where the value comes.
Consume Session Display Format - allows you to define the string format for
the values. This attribute takes precedence over the Consume Session Display
Field Name attribute. The format of the Consume Session Display Format is
the same as the format used in the Calculated Format attribute.
Allow Edit - select this check box to edit the field value in the form;
otherwise, it is read-only
Table 10. Optional Content
Element Description
Display Required Field
Message Allows Required Fields Messages to be displayed on the form
Show Validation Summary Allows Validation Summary to be displayed on top of the form.
Table 9. Field Types
Field types Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 341
www.agreeya.com
Actions
The list form has some pre-defined actions, such as Save, Delete, Copy or Move. You can also write your own
custom action and hook it up with the list form.
The Actions page contain the following elements:
Custom Actions
This property enables you to define additional buttons in the toolbar or context menu item in the context menu.
You can program that button or context menu item to do a series of actions. The List Form supports some built-
in actions. However, you can write your own custom action using one of the .NET languages, compile it, and call
it by the List Form. See Custom Action Help on page 389 to see how to write your own custom actions.
Here are some ways that you can use this functionality:
Add a custom toolbar button called "Assign All to Me" that will assign all of the selected tasks in the List
Form to me.
Add a custom toolbar called "Approve" that will change the status of all of the selected expense items to
Approved.
Create a custom context menu item called "Publish" that will move the right-clicked document into
another document library.
Create a custom context menu item or toolbar item to start a workflow.
With the ability to write your own custom action, you can virtually do anything to the data when you
click the custom button that you define.
The Custom Actions element contains one Toolbar element and one Context Menu element. These elements can
contain one or more Action Item elements. You can associate the Action Item with one or more Action elements.
The Action element define a certain operation that is carried out by the action item when it is clicked. When
you add an action item, you can configure the following:
Table 11. Actions
Element Description
Custom Actions For more information, see Custom Actions on page 341.
Custom Action Error
Display Allows you to set where the error message is displayed if the custom action throws an
exception. The options are:
Inline — the error message is displayed in the list form above the displayed
fields.
Popup — the error message is displayed in a popup dialog box.
InlineAndPopup — the error message is displayed in a popup dialog box and
inline above the displayed fields.
Popup is the default.
This property will only affect the error message that is returned by the ICustomAction
implementation. It will not affect the error that is generated internally by the List
Form.
NOTE: The toolbar button affects all the items that are selected in the List Form. The context menu item
affects only the item that is being right-clicked regardless of how many items are selected in your List
Form.
NOTE: The custom action in the List Form does not support the Save action.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 342
www.agreeya.com
Table 12. Custom Actions
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Custom Actions in XML format.
<CustomActions>
<Toolbar>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID" Position="0"
PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID”
ImageUrl=”URL” AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session" SourceName="fieldName"
SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</Toolbar>
<ContextMenu>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID" Position="0"
PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID”
ImageUrl=”URL” AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session" SourceName="fieldName"
SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</ContextMenu>
</CustomActions>
IsSeparator Allows you to set the item as a separator.
ID Allows you to enter a unique ID that will identify the item. Use a descriptive
identifier to configure the action item with the editor.
Text Allows you to enter how the action item is displayed in the toolbar.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 343
www.agreeya.com
Text Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a a multi-lingual site. This attribute
defines the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the
Web Part. The Text Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the
Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the
string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the value in the Text
attribute is used.
Prompt Text Allows you to prompt the user to click the toolbar button or the context menu item.
Prompt Text Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a multi-lingual site. The property
defines the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the
Web Part. The Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the
Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the
string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the default is used.
Access Key (Toolbar
Only) Allows you to define one character from the Text attribute that becomes the access
key to this toolbar button or context menu item. For example, if you define a letter
T as the access key, you can press ALT+T and the browser will put the focus on this
button or context menu item. If there are multiple elements on the page with the
same access key, you can repeat ALT+T repeatedly until you get the focus on this
toolbar button or context menu item.
Position Allows you to set the position of the button in the toolbar. The index starts with 0.
Show User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the Web Part.
Separate groups with commas.
Hide User Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part.
Separate site group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide
User Groups, the user cannot
Table 12. Custom Actions
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 344
www.agreeya.com
When you add an action, you can configure the following:
Element Description
Name An optional element which allows you to identify a given action in order to access it from
another action. You can refer to this action from the GoToURL action and from
ICustomActionEx Interface.
Type Allows you to determine the type of the action. Here are the options:
Delete — deletes the item.
Move — allows you to move the item to a target. You must specify a Target Site URL,
Target List Name, and Target Folder. This action only works for document in a
document library.
Copy — allows you to copy the item to a target. You must specify a Target Site URL,
Target List Name, and Target Folder.
GoToURL — redirects the user to a specific URL. You must specify the URL and where
you want the URL to open. You must specify the following parameters:
- Input - the current user information as the value of the parameter
- Session - the name of the session variable where the value comes from when the
source is set to Session
- HttpRequest - the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the HTTP
parameters in the page URL. The name of the HTTP parameter is defined in the
SourceName attribute. As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName
attribute is ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter, which is
Hardware, is used as the value of the parameter.
- ListItem - the value of the parameter is a list item or row
- RowFromAnotherWebPart — the parameter for the GoToURL action can be
retrieved from the output of another action that comes first in the sequence of
actions defined in the ActionItem. There are two types of action that can produce
an output: an action with Type of ExecuteOperation, and an action with Type of
Custom that points to custom action implementation of ICustomActionEx Interface.
You do that by defining the SourceName attribute of the action. This is the syntax of
the SourceName attribute when you use ResultFormAction source:
<ActionName>.<ResultType>[.Name], where ActionName refers to the Name
attribute of the action that produces the output, ResultType can be OutParameter
(if the action result is returned through one of the out or inout parameter) or
RawData - (if the action result is returned as an object). Name is optional. It further
designates the object we want to use for the parameter. You do not have to specify
the Name when the ResultType is RawData. However, if the ResultType is
OutParameter, this name specifies the name of the out or input key value pair.
- ResultFromAction - the parameter for the GoToURL action can be retrieved from
the output of another action that comes first in the sequence of actions defined in
the ActionItem
You must define a source name (where in the source you want to get your
information from), name (the name of the parameter that is appended to the URL
you specified), and Session (the name of the session variable where the value comes
from when the source is set to Session)
GoToSource — redirects the user to the URL specified in the Source HTTP parameter.
The URL to the page must look like: http://...?Source=URL for this option to work.
StartWorkflow — starts the specified workflow in the Workflow Name drop-down
field. You must select a Workflow name.
ReturnToMasterChart — returns the user to the master chart page. You use this
action type if this web part is located in the drill down page.
Custom — implements your own custom action and call it with this action type.
Enter a Class name that implements the ICustomActionEx or ICustomAction
interface, or select a class from the drop-down list, if available.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 345
www.agreeya.com
Form
The Form page contains the following elements:
Form Component Behavior
This section is used to control the conditional behavior of the different components in the form, such as a field,
a group of fields or a tab. There are four different conditional behaviors that can be specified: Show When, Hide
When, Enabled When, and Disabled When. For fields, there are four additional conditional behaviors that can be
specified: Valid When, Invalid When, Required When, and Default When.
You can define one or more form component definitions.
Table 13. Form
Element Description
Form Initialization
Actions Allows the List Form to be automatically pre-populated when the Form Type
property is set to NewListItem, CreateDocument or UploadDocument. The List Form
will call the defined custom actions that are specified in this property.
The fields that cannot be automatically pre-populated are:
Auto-fill field (fixed value, consume value from an HTTP parameter,
calculated format, consume value from a session, consume row from a row
provided by another web part, auto fill with a lookup or cross-site lookup
field)
BDC Column
SI Column
Complex category field
Cross site lookup field
See the Custom Action Help on page 389 chapter on how to write a custom action to
initialize the list form.
Turn on Advanced Mode if you want to edit Form Initialization Actions in XML
format.
<FormInitialization>
<Action Name=”initial 1” Type="Custom"
Class="MyCompany.DevStudio.SampleFormInitializationAction,
MyCompany.DevStudio, Version=1.0.0.0, Culture=neutral,
PublicKeyToken=451cac61f7ec4225" / >
<Action Name=”initial 2” Type="Custom"
Class="MyCompany.DevStudio.SampleFormInitializationAction2,
MyCompany.DevStudio, Version=1.0.0.0, Culture=neutral,
PublicKeyToken=451cac61f7ec4225" / >
</FormInitialization>
Form initialization is a way to auto fill the form. It should not be used in
conjunction with another auto fill method. If you do this, the result is
unpredictable (that is sometimes the value from form initialization will take
precedence, but sometimes the value from the other auto fill method will take
precedence).
Form Component
Behavior For more information, see Form Component Behavior on page 345.
NOTE: You must configure Display Fields before configuring Form Component Behavior.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 346
www.agreeya.com
To see details for a form component, you can configure the following properties:
Table 14. Definition
Definition Description
Advanced
ModeTurn on if you want to edit Form Component Behavior in XML format.
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Field/Group/Container" ID="ComponentID">
<ShowWhen>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</ShowWhen>
<HideWhen>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</HideWhen>
<EnabledWhen>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</EnabledWhen>
<DisabledWhen>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</DisabledWhen>
<InvalidWhen Message=”Custom Message when condition is true”>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</InvalidWhen>
<ValidWhen Message=”Custom Message when condition is true”>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</ValidWhen>
<RequiredWhen Message=”Custom Message when condition is true”>
[Condition specified in CAML Filter format]
</RequiredWhen>
</Component>
<Componet ...>
<Component ...>
</FormComponentBehavior>
Type Defines the type of the component that is assigned the dynamic behavior. The choices are: Field,
Group, or Container (that is, tab/panel).
ID Defines the ID or name of the component whose behavior is defined to be dynamic. When the
Type is set to Field, this ID refers to the Name of a field that is defined in the Display Fields
property. When the Type is set to Group, this ID refers to the Group Name attribute of one or
more fields defined in the Display Fields property. When the Type is set to Container, this ID
refers to the ID of a container that is defined in the Form Layout property.
Table 15. Definition Properties
Property Description
Show When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be shown.
Hide When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be hidden. This
conditional behavior takes precedence over the Show When conditional behavior.
Therefore, if Hide When and Show When are defined and both evaluate to true, the
component is hidden.
Enabled When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be enabled.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 347
www.agreeya.com
For fields of type text, numeric or date/time, regular expression matching can be used for validation. Use the
“Matching” operator in the conditional behavior element.
The following are some examples of how to use this property:
1 Show the Resolved Date and Resolved By fields when the Status field is changed to "Resolved". By
specifying both fields’ GroupName attribute in the Display Fields property to “ResolvedFieldsGroup”, it
is defined that both fields belong to the same group.
<orFmComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Group" ID="ResolvedFieldsGroup">
<ShowWhen>
<Eq><FieldRef Name="Status"/><Value Type="Choice">Resolved</Value></Eq>
</ShowWhen>
</Component>Enable the "Amount Paid" field when the Invoice Status fie
</FormComponentBehavior>
2 ld is changed to "Paid".
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Field" ID="Amount Paid">
<EnabledWhen>
<Eq><FieldRef Name="Invoice Status"/><Value Type="Choice">Paid</Value></Eq>
</EnabledWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
3 Hide the Reason field when the Project Status field is not "Behind"
<FormComponentBehavior>
Disabled When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be disabled. This
conditional behavior takes precedence over the Enabled When conditional behavior.
Therefore, if Enabled When and Disabled When are defined and both evaluate to
true, the component is disabled.
Required When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be required. This
conditional behavior is for fields only. A custom message can be specified. It is
displayed when the Required When condition is satisfied. The message is displayed
by default in red after the input control on the form. However, you can specify any
text or HTML code as the Message attribute.
Valid When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be valid. This
conditional behavior is for fields only. A custom message can be specified. It is
displayed when the Valid When condition is satisfied. The message is displayed by
default in red after the input control on the form. However you can specify any text
or HTML code as the Message attribute.
Invalid When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be invalid. This
conditional behavior is for fields only. This conditional behavior takes precedence
over the Valid When conditional behavior. Therefore, if Valid When and Invalid
When are defined and both evaluate to true, the field is invalid. A custom message
can be specified. It is displayed when the Invalid When condition is satisfied. The
message is displayed by default in red after the input control on the form. However
you can specify any text or HTML code as the Message attribute.
Default When Defines the conditions of when the form component should be set as default.
Table 15. Definition Properties
Property Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 348
www.agreeya.com
<Component Type="Field" ID="Reason">
<HideWhen>
<Neq><FieldRef Name="Project Status"/><Value Type="Choice">Behind</Value></Neq>
</HideWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
4 Show error message if field, Assigned To, is blank when Status is “In Process”
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Field" ID="Assigned To">
<InvalidWhen Message="Assigned To Must be filled if Status is In Process">
<And>
<IsNull>
<FieldRef Name="AssignedTo" />
</IsNull>
<Eq>
<FieldRef Name="Status" />
<Value Type="Choice">In Progress</Value>
</Eq>
</And>
</InvalidWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
5 Field % Complete must be between 0 and 100
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Field" ID="% Complete">
<ValidWhen Message="% Complete must be between 0 and 100">
<And>
<Geq>
<FieldRef Name="PercentComplete" />
<Value Type="Number">0</Value>
</Geq>
<Leq>
<FieldRef Name="PercentComplete" />
<Value Type="Number">1</Value>
</Leq>
</And>
</ValidWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
6 Set the container to default when the Project Status field is "In-progress"
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 349
www.agreeya.com
<FormComponentBehavior>
<Component Type="Container" ID="Initiation">
<DefaultWhen>
<Neq><FieldRef Name="Project Status"/><Value Type="Choice">In-progress</Value></Neq>
</DefaultWhen>
</Component>
</FormComponentBehavior>
Views
The Views page contains the following:
Table 16. Views
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Toolbar
Control
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Element Description
Display Messages from
DAO Provider Allows you to display messages, such as informational messages or warnings at the top
of a web part. For more information on DAO providers, see System Integration
Developer Guide.
Custom Message
Display Allows you to specify a custom message based on certain conditions.
We currently do not support mapping for the messages that the Display Messages From
DAO Provider property enables.
Turn on Advanced Mode if you want to edit Custom Message Display in XML format.
CustomMessageDisplay contains the following properties:
Display When — allows you to set the conditions to display a custom error
message. When defining the Display When condition, the following operators
are supported: Eq (Equal) Neq (Not Equal) Null, Is Not Null, Begins With,
Contains and Matches (for regular expression).
Custom Message — The error message that you want displayed when the Display
When condition is set.
If a Display When condition is set during runtime but a custom message is not
specified, the original message is displayed. If you want to hide the original message,
use a blank string or any html code that renders no visible cues, such as
<div>&nbsp;</div>, for the CustomMessage attribute.
When multiple Custom Message elements are defined for this property, the first
Custom Message, whose Display When condition is set, is used.
If no conditions are met, an error message from the selected external system is
displayed.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 350
www.agreeya.com
To o l b a r
The Toolbar page allows you to configure the appearance of the toolbar. It contains the following:
Control
The Control page allows you to set the appearance of your user controls in a web part. It contains the following:
The Control page contains the following:
Table 17. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 18. Toolbar
Element Description
Toolbar Location Allows you to define where a toolbar for the list form should be displayed.
The choices are TopAndBottom, Top, Bottom or None. Select None if you
do not want to display the regular toolbar. Only the Ribbon buttons are
displayed in this case.
Toolbar Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the toolbar.
Table 19. Control
Element Description
Rich Text Editor Skin
Name Allows you to select the skin name for the rich text editor. The rich text editor
appears in the form when the Type attribute of the Field element in the Display
Fields property is set to RichText. If you have a custom skin, you can add it to the
following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft
Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Clear your browser cache frequently while working with custom skins. In IE, CSS
cache can be cleared by clicking the Clear Cache button in the CSS tab of
Developer Tools, located under the Tools menu of the browser.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 351
www.agreeya.com
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Drop-Down Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the drop-down menu control for the choice
field. If you have a custom skin, you can add it to the following folder for
SharePoint 2010:C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Tab/Panel Skin Name Allows you to specify the skin name for the Tab/Panel layout. If you have a custom
skin, you can add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program
Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Table 20. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 21. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections
to other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Table 19. Control
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 352
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a
Tooltip when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 22. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a
particular group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 21. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 353
www.agreeya.com
Table 23. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value
is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default
culture, leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the
attributes for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are
used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier
and culture is not found, the default is used.
Indicates Required Field
Button Text Resource ID Allows you to enter a text resource ID for the Indicates Required Field button.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
21
354
www.agreeya.com
qSIListView
Overview
qSIListView Pages
Overview
qSIListView displays data from your external system in a grid, and allows you to:
customize the look and feel by using Skin.
divide the data into multiple pages to limit their size and render pages faster. This feature is called
Paging. There are two Paging Modes available: Numeric Pager and Next Previous. If the number of rows in
a table is more than the specified Page Size, the data is divided into multiple pages and a Pager is
displayed at the bottom of the listview to enable the user to navigate to different pages
retrieve the data from your external system one page at a time using custom paging. In order to use this
feature, your external system must provide a method to retrieve one page of data by using the page size
and page index parameters. If your external system does not support custom paging, you can still page
your date as described in the previous point.
define a static filter using Complex Filter (For more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.). The
Complex Filter expression supports time functions (such as AddDays) and time expression (such as
[TODAY]) to filter out data based on a moving time window. This feature is called Data Aging.
define the initial static sort expression using the Sort Fields property. The listview can sort the data
based on multiple fields.
sort the data in the listview by clicking the grid headers. Clicking the header repeatedly will change the
sort direction for that field from ascending, descending and neutral (no filter). You can sort the data in
the listview using multiple fields.
create a relationship between parent and child entity.
define multiple levels of grouping on the data using the Grouped attribute in the Display Fields property.
You can also display the sum or item counts in the group header.
show or hide the listview based on the site group membership of the currently logged in user by using the
Show User Groups and Hide User Groups properties.
display the data in virtually any format that can be achieved with JavaScript and HTML. With this
feature, you can create many types of custom reports on the data. The JavaScript and HTML for a
custom display is defined in the Results Header, Results Body and the Results Footer properties.
consume a filter from another web part that implement IWebPartRow or IWebPartParameter interface.
consume a row from another web part that implement IWebPartRow interface. The row that the listview
consumed can be passed into the operation to retrieve the data as a parameter or can be used in the
custom action.
display, create, and edit data in your external systems. Out of the box, this Web Part supports the DAO
Provider for:
Web Services
SQL Server
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 355
www.agreeya.com
Oracle
Domino Server using XML over HTTP
Salesforce
K2Server (for SharePoint 2010 only)
qSIListView Pages
You can configure this web part through its tabs that are accessible through ezEdit. qSIListView contains the
following pages:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page contains the following:
Primary Content
Filtering
Search/Filter Panel
Sorting/Paging
Custom Display
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
TIP: To better understand SI web parts, read the System Integration Developer Guide.
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the Web Part, or accept the default. This field is
mandatory.
Catalog See Catalog on page 356.
Display Fields See Display Fields on page 350.
Entity Relationship See Entity Relationship on page 357
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 356
www.agreeya.com
Catalog
Entities contain the following elements:
You can add operations to your entities by configuring the following elements:
Table 2. Catalog
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Catalog in XML format.
System Allows you to specify the system name that is defined in the System Integration
configuration file. If the system name does not exist in the System Integration
configuration file, you will get an error.
Service Allows you to specify the service name that is defined in the System Integration
configuration file. The service name that you specify here must belong to system that
you specify in the System attribute. If the service name does not exist in the System
Integration configuration file, you will get an error.
Name Allows you to specify the name of the entity which must be unique within this Catalog.
The name does not have to match with any name in your external system. However, it is
recommended that you use a descriptive name for your entity. This field is mandatory.
Set Session Name Allows you to enter name of the session variable where the edited or newly created item
is stored when it is saved, or the item that is being displayed or edited is stored when it
is loaded.
Reset Session
Names Allows you to reset (set to NULL) the value of the session variable whose name is
specified in this attribute. Specify multiple names by separating them with commas.
Default Allows you to define this entity as the default for the list form. If this element is not
specified, the first entity that is listed in the catalog becomes the default entity. The
default operation of the default entity is the operation that is used to retrieve the data
when the list form is loaded for the first time in edit or display mode.
Table 3. Operations
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the operation. This name does not have to match with any
name in your external system. This name is used to refer to this operation in the Action property.
This field is mandatory.
Method Allows you to specify the real name of the operation in your external system. For example, it
may refer to the name of a web service method. Or it may refer to the name of a stored
procedure in your SQL Server database.
Default Allows you to define this operation as the default. The default operation is the first operation
that is called to retrieve the entity to be displayed or edited. If this attribute is not specified,
the first operation listed in the entity becomes the default operation.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 357
www.agreeya.com
You can define parameters for the operation by configuring the following elements:
You can define one or more Property elements.
Entity Relationship
Allows you to create a parent-child entity relationship. The default entity from the Catalog will be considered
as the Parent Entity. If no default entity is chosen in the Catalog, then the first entity in catalog is considered as
default entity. Anyone of the remaining entities can be used to select as a child entity. When you select the Edit
button, a dialog box opens with a list of parent and child key fields based on the list.
Entities contain the following elements:
Table 4. Parameters
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the parameter.
Source Allows you to define the source of this parameter. The source can be one of the following:
DefaultValue — the value of the parameter that is the default
NullValue — the value of the parameter is blank
FixedValue — the value of the parameter that is defined in the Value attribute
HttpRequest — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the HTTP parameters in
the page URL. The name of the HTTP parameter is defined in the SourceName attribute.
As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName attribute is
ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter, which is Hardware, is used
as the value of the parameter.
Input — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from one of the input fields in the
form. You specify the name of the input field in the SourceName attribute. Additionally,
you can retrieve the current user information as the value of the parameter. You can
specify one of the following name in the SourceName attribute to retrieve the current
user information:
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row
that is consumed from another web part. You specify the name of the field that is
consumed in the SourceName attribute.
Session — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row that is stored in the
session. You specify the name of the session in the SessionName attribute. You specify the
name of the field that is consumed in the SourceName attribute.
ComplexType — the value of the parameter is an object based on the Type attribute and
Member definition inside the Parameter. Array and nested complex types are supported.
Array — the value of the parameter is an array of values
XML — the value of the parameter that is dynamically built when the condition is execute
at runtime
Usage Allows you to define the direction for this parameter. The options are In, Out, InOut, or
ReturnValue.
Table 5. Properties
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the property. Refer to the documentation for the DAO Provider
to your external system will tell you the name of the property that you must define.
Type Allows you to specify type of value that is specified in the Value attribute. Example:
System.String.
Value Allows you to specify the value of the property.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 358
www.agreeya.com
Display Fields
This property defines what fields should be displayed in the ListView and how the fields are populated.
Advanced Mode
Turn on if you want to edit Display Fields in XML format.
Data Index/Data Member
The Data Index allows you to define the index of the data table that contains the data to be displayed. This is
useful when the operation that retrieves the data from external system returns multiple data tables. If the data
table does not have any meaningful name, use the Data Index propertY.
The Data Member allows you to define the name of the data table that contains the data to be displayed. This is
useful when the operation that retrieves the data from external system returns multiple data tables and those
tables do not have any meaningful name. If the data table has meaningful name, you can refer to it by using the
Data Member property.
If neither the Data Member or the Data Index is specified, the first data table in the data set is used.
Fields
Click Add Field to add fields to be displayed in the web part. You can add the following values for the fields to
be displayed.
Table 6. Entity Relationship
Element Description
Advanced
ModeTurn on if you want to edit Entity Relationship in XML format. XML will look like the following
<EntityRelations>
<EntityRelation ParentEntity="parentEntityName" ParentKeyFieldName=" parentKeyFieldName"
ChildEntity="childEntityName" ChildKeyFieldName="childKeyFieldName" Default="true" />
</EntityRelations>
Parent
Entity Key
Field
Name
Allows you to select parent entity key field name.
Child
Entity Allows you to select child entity.
Child
Entity Key
Field
Name
Allows you to select child entity key field name.
NOTE: This section is optional.
Table 7. Fields
Values Description
Name Displays the field name.
Title Allows you to change the displayed title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an
encoded HTML string. Change the displayed title, for example, when the title is too long or
to make the title more descriptive.
Width Allows you to set the width. It can be a plain string or an encoded HTML string. The
Description is added below the field value.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 359
www.agreeya.com
Field Properties
You can further define properties for the fields to be displayed by configuring the following:
Table 8. Field Properties
Property Description
Field Name Displays the field name.
Title Allows you to change the displayed title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an
encoded HTML string. Change the displayed title, for example, when the title is too long
or to make the title more descriptive.
Title Resource ID If supporting a multi-lingual site, you may want to display a different Title for the field
depending on the current culture. This property defines the identifier in the Resource List
that is used as the title of the field. The TitleResourceID and the current cultural setting
(identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the
Resource List. If the string with the given identifier is not found, the default Title is used.
Horizontal Align Allows you to set the horizontal alignment.
Vertical Align Allows you to set the vertical alignment.
Hidden Allows you to hide the field. If the field is hidden, the qSIListView will not modify that
field at all. If you hide the field using the Hidden attribute, the field is processed
according to the way it is defined, but it does not display.
Width Allows you to set the width of the control in pixels.
NOTE: Some controls, such as the Rich Text Editor, have minimum width and it will not
honor the specified width if it is smaller than its minimum width.
Item Style Allows you to define a distinct style for the item. You should define the style as you would
define the style in CSS file.
Item CSS Style Allows you to define a distinct style for the column and you already have defined the style
in an external CSS file.
This attribute takes precedence over the Item Style attribute.
Fixed Value Allows you to enter the text that is displayed as a value for this field. This is useful when
you want static text such as Edit displayed in a field. You can then make this text a
hyperlink using either the LinkTo or LinkToSource attributes.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you can configure Fixed Value as in the following
example:
<Field Name="EditColumn" FixedValue="Edit"
LinkTo="Lists/ListName/EditForm.aspx?ID=&lt;%ID%&gt;" />
To display an icon instead of a text, you can do the following (it assumes that you have
pencil.gif in the images folder in your site:
<Field Name="EditColumn" FixedValue="&lt;img src=&quot;images/edit.gif&quot;
border=0&gt;" LinkTo="Lists/ListName/EditForm.aspx?ID=&lt;%ID%&gt;" />
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 360
www.agreeya.com
Calculated Value Recognizes the field replacement expression <%Field%> to refer to a field. The listview
replaces the field replacement expression with the value of the field for each row of data.
When using this attribute, you must use the Name of a field that does not exist in the list.
It is because the listview constructs this field dynamically instead of using an existing field
in the list. If you use the name of an existing field, you will get an error that the field
already exists.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively, unless you type in the value in the
Display Fields editor in the List View Editor, where the Editor will encode the characters
automatically for you. This attribute helps you:
Display a full name by concatenating the first name and last name as follows:
<Field Name="CalculatedFullName" Title="Full Name" CalculatedValue="&lt;%First
Name%&gt; &lt;%Last Name%&gt;" />
Display the status of your project with different colors depending on its value. In
order to do this, you can write a JavaScript function and then call that JavaScript
function using this attribute.
<Field Name="CalculatedProjectStatus" Title="Status"
CalculatedValue="&lt;script&gt;FormatProjectStatus('&lt;%Status%&gt;');&lt;/script
&gt;" />
This assumes you have a JavaScript method called DisplayProjectStatus defined on
your page or in a JavaScript file that is included in your page. That JavaScript
method looks like:
<script language="javascript">
function FormatProjectStatus(status)
{
var displayedStatus = status;
if (status = 'Behind')
{
displayedStatus = '<font color="red">' + status + '</font>';
}
return displayedStatus;
}
</script>
You can format the value of the field in virtually any way you want. For example,
you can replace the text value with different images to give the user a pleasant
look in the presentation.
NOTE: You can only call one JavaScript function in the CalculatedValue attribute and the
JavaScript function must return a string.
Link To The listview turns the field into a hyperlinked column to the specified URL. The URL can
be an absolute or relative URL. The LinkTo can use the <%field name%> field replacement
expression.
NOTE: If you are using Advanced Mode, you must use the encoded form of the < and >
characters, which are &lt; and &gt;, respectively unless you type in the value in the
Display Fields editor in the List View Editor, where the Editor will encode the characters
automatically for you.
Every field that you refer to in the field replacement expression must be specified in the
Display Fields property. If you do not want to show that field to the user, you can use the
Hidden attribute to hide the field. If you use a relative URL, the URL is appended to the
URL of the current page.
Here is an example on how to make the Title field a hyperlink column to the edit form of
the Tasks list:
<Field Name="ProjectName" LinkTo="ProjectDetail.aspx?ID=&lt;%Projec
tID%&gt;&Source=default.aspx" />
Table 8. Field Properties
Property Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 361
www.agreeya.com
Filtering
The Filtering page allows you to use Complex Filters to define static filter for the data.
The Filtering page contains the following:
Link To Source The listview will make the field value a hyperlink to the URL specified in the Source HTTP
parameter of the current request. For this option to work, the current page URL must look
like: http://.....?Source=....
The LinkToSource is useful when you want to make the URL in the link dynamic. In that
case, you can pass in the URL for the link into the HTTP parameter of your page. For
example, say that we have a page where the user can select a particular contact from the
Contacts list. This page might be useful for several cases in your application and you
cannot hard code the URL because you may want the user to be redirected to different
URL depending where they are in the application. In that case, you can specify the URL for
the hyperlink in the URL of the page.
Open Link In Allows you to define how the Link To Field opens.
NOTE: If you select Dialog, you can configure the dialog width and height.
NOTE: For Internet Explorer 9, the "NewWindow" option requires the user to set the
following: Internet Options | General |Tabs | Settings > When a pop-up is encountered >
'Always open pop-ups in a new window'.
HTML Encode Allows the value in the field to be encoded first prior to being displayed. You need to set
this to true if this field contains values that are surrounded by < and >, such as <abc>.
Without the encoding, the value will not be displayed properly.
Display Format Specifies how the field value is formatted when displayed. For more detail about the
syntax of the DisplayFormat attribute, see Display Format on page 14.
The Field element can contain one or more Aggregate elements if its Grouped attribute is
set to true. The following are the attributes of the Aggregate element:
Text — The text that will precede the aggregated value when it is displayed.
Aggregate Function — These are the choices for the aggregate function: Sum, Min,
Max, Last, First, Count.
Field Name — The name of the field where the aggregation is performed.
Format String — This attribute defines how the aggregated value is displayed. See
the syntax of the format string in the DisplayFormat attribute.
Grouped Allows the data to be grouped by this field. You can set the Grouped attribute of multiple
fields to true if you want to have a subgroup.
Group Sort Direction — This attribute determines whether the values in the header
of the grouped field must be displayed in ascending or descending order. The
options are asc for ascending order or desc for descending order. The default value
is asc.
Group Expanded — If set to true, the group is initially expanded. Otherwise, it is
collapsed. If not specified, the default value is true.
When you select Grouped, you can add aggregate elements.
Text — allows you set the text that precedes the aggregated value when displayed
Aggregate Value — allows you to choose an aggregate function
Field Name — allows you to enter the name of the field where the aggregation will
happen
Format String — defines how the aggregated value is displayed
Table 8. Field Properties
Property Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 362
www.agreeya.com
Search/Filter Panel
The Search/Filter Panel allows you to define the panels for search, filter, and replace in the web part.
The Search/Filter Panel contains the following elements:
Table 9. Filtering
Element Description
Complex Filter Allows you to use the Complex Filter expression to define a static filter for the data.
The complex filter is applied to the data after the CAML Filter is applied.
NOTE: The Complex Filter is provided here only for backward compatibility reason. In
the past, Complex filter was used to support date functions.
For more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
Table 10. Search/Filter Panel
Element Description
Searched Fields See Searched Fields on page 363.
Expand Filter panel
on Load Allows you to automatically open the Filter panel by default so that the user can
perform a search quickly. When set to true, the Filter panel opens when the web part
is loaded for the first time.
Turn On List Searcher
ModeAllows the user to perform a search before the listview display any data.
Filter Criteria Usage Allow you to pass the filter criteria to the DAO provider layer. There are three options
in this property:
PassToDAOProvider — The filter criteria is passed to the DAO Provider. When
you select this, the filter criteria will not be used to filter the data that is
returned by the external system (because the SI List View assumes that the
data has been filtered by the external system).
FilterData — The filter criteria is used to filter the data that is returned by the
external system.
PassToDAOProviderAndFilterData — The filter criteria is passed to the DAO
Provider and is used to filter the data that is being returned by the external
system.
When you select PassToDAOProvider or PassToDAOProviderAndFilterData, you can use
the filter criteria as parameter values in the operations in the Catalog property. In
order to do so, you specify the parameter source as Input and the source name as:
FieldName.Value — allows you to retrieve the value that is entered by the user
in the Filter panel for a specific field.
FieldName.MaxValue — allows you to retrieve the maximum value that is
entered by the user in the Filter panel for the field that has Between operator,
such as DateTime field.
FieldName.Operator - allows you to retrieve the operator that is specified by
the user for a specific field.
There is a possibility that your back-end only handles "Equals" operator. In that case,
you can use the FixedOperator="Equals" attribute in the Searched Fields property so
that the user can only use the Equals operator.
Panel Button Location Determines the location of the Go, Reset and Close buttons in the Filter panel. This
property also determines the location of the Go and Close buttons in the Replace
panel.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 363
www.agreeya.com
Searched Fields
This property defines which fields are displayed in the Filter panel. If defined, the web part will display Filter
button in the toolbar. To disable the search feature, you can leave this property blank. If defined, the web part
will display Filter or Search menu items under the Actions button in the toolbar. To disable the search feature,
you can leave this property blank.
You will be able to perform a search by pressing Enter.
You can further edit fields using the following elements:
NOTE: Pressing Enter will not allow you to perform a search on such fields as external data, people picker,
managed metadata, and a drop-down list. Instead, the default behavior will occur.
Table 11. Searched Fields
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Searched Fields in XML format.
This property is an XML string in the following format:
<Fields>
<Field Name="fieldName" [optional attributes]/>
<!-- To search a cross site lookup field, use one of the following two formats -->
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFieldName="fieldName" SortField="fieldName" [optional
attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
<Field Name="fieldName" DisplayFormat="fieldName" SortField="fieldName" [optional
attributes]>
<List SiteUrl="siteUrl" SiteName="siteName" ListName="listName"/>
</Field>
</Fields>
Name Indicates the element you are editing.
Type Allows you to select a type of field.
Title Displays title for the field. The value can be a plain string or an encoded HTML string.
Default Value Defines the default value for the field.
You can define a text, a number or a date. A date value must be specified in ISO 8601 format:
YYYY-MM-DDThh:mm:ssZ, for example: midnight of February 14, 2002 is 2002-02-
14T00:00:00Z.
Default
Operator Defines the default operator for the field.
Fixed Operator Defines the operator for the field. If specified, the drop-down menu to select the operator
for this field is turned off.
Column Count Defines the number of columns for the options in a multi-choice field or in a choice-and-
lookup field if the Enable Multi Choice attribute is set to True. This is useful in case your
choice or lookup fields have too many choices and you want to break the choices into several
columns to minimize the vertical scrolling in your form.
Date Time
Format Available if you select DateTime as a type.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 364
www.agreeya.com
Sorting/Paging
The Sorting/Paging page allows you to define the sorting criteria and paging type and size in the web part.
The Sorting/Paging page contains the following elements:
Enable Multi
Choice Available if you select Choice as a type. Allows you to select multiple options for the choice-
and-lookup field. Therefore, the user can specify a condition like "A or B". This attribute is
ignored by other field types.
To search a cross-site lookup field, you must specify one or more List elements inside the
Field element. The cross-site lookup field is displayed as two drop downs.
Choice
Population
Type
Allows you to define how you want to define the options in your Choice field. It is a drop-
down list with the following options: Manually or Using Operation in the Catalog. For more
information, see the below paragraphs.
If you select Choice as the field type, you can define the options in your choice field.
You can hardcode the options directly under the Field element. Select the
ChoicePopulationType of ‘Manually’ to do this. Here is an example:
<Field Name="EmployeeStatus" Type="Choice">
<Option Text="Active" Value="1" />
<Option Text="Retired" Value="2" />
</Field>
If the Value attribute is not specified, the Text is used as the value.
You can specify an action that will retrieve the options from your external system. Select the
ChoicePopulationType of ‘Using Operation in the Catalog’ to do this. The syntax is:
<Field Name="fieldName" Type="Choice">
<Lookup Operation="EntityName.OperationName" DataMember="tableName"
DataTextField="textFieldName" DataValueField="valueFieldName" />
</Field>
-OR-
<Field Name="fieldName" Type="Choice">
<Lookup Operation="EntityName.OperationName" DataIndex="index"
DataTextField="textFieldName" DataValueField="valueFieldName" />
</Field>
The Operation defines the operation that is used to retrieve the options from the
external system. The syntax for the operation is EntityName.OperationName. Both the
entity and the operation must already be defined in the Catalog property.
The DataMember defines the data table name that contains the options in case the
operation returns multiple tables. If external system returns multiple data tables
without name, you can use the DataIndex attribute to refer to the table. The index is
a number and it starts with 0 (not 1).
The DataTextField defines the column in the data table whose value is displayed in the
drop-down menu.
The DataValueField defines the column in the data table that contains the real value
that should be saved back to the external system.
Table 11. Searched Fields
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 365
www.agreeya.com
Custom Display
The custom display properties lets the page designer customize the display of the data using HTML and
JavaScript. The custom display appears after the default display (if the Display Fields property is defined).
Three properties define the custom display. The example in each property illustrates how to display the
FullName field of the search results in an HTML table.
Table 12. Sorting/Paging
Element Description
Sort Fields Allows you to define the initial sorting criterion for the data. This is the syntax for this
property:
FieldName1 [SortDirection], FieldName1 [SortDirection]
SortDirection is either ASC (ascending order) or DESC (descending order). The
FieldName and the SortDirection are case sensitive. If the SortDirection is not
specified, ascending order is assumed. For example:
First Name ASC, Last Name DESC, Company
NOTE: You cannot define criteria to sort custom fields. To sort custom fields, click the
column in qListView. You can sort custom fields under the following circumstances
only:
the custom field search data total count is less than MaxQueryRowCount's value
(by default, this value is 2000)
the custom field is only a calculated value
the custom field’s calculated value is not written in JavaScript code
Allow Custom Paging Defines whether or not your default operation supports custom paging. Custom paging
feature enables your operation to retrieve the data from your external system one
page at a time. If you set this property to true, your operation should take the
PageSize, PageIndex and SortFields parameters. Click here to see the example in the
Catalog property for an operation that supports custom paging feature.
If your default operation does not support custom paging, you should set this property
to false. In the absence of custom paging, the SI List View will automatically page the
data for you if the number of rows in your data table is larger than the number in the
Page Size property.
If you deal with a large number of data in the external system, we recommend that
you use custom paging to improve the response time of the list view.
Paging Mode Allows you to select the type of pager that is displayed at the bottom of the listview if
the items must be divided into multiple pages.
Page Size Allows you to set the maximum number of rows that is displayed in one page. If the
number of rows is larger than the Page Size, the data is divided into several pages. You
can navigate the pages using the Pager displayed at the bottom of the listview.
Table 13. Custom Display
Element Description
Results Header Allows you to set the value of this property that is rendered once before the Results
Body. This property is a good place to include any JavaScript file, defining any
JavaScript function, or define any HTML elements for the header.
Example: These are the customers that match your search
criteria.<br><table><tr><th>Full Name</th></tr>
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 366
www.agreeya.com
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Actions
Views
Actions
This property enables you to define additional buttons in the toolbar or context menu item in the context menu.
You can program that button or context menu item to do a series of actions. The listview supports some built-in
actions. However, you can write your own custom action using one of the .NET languages, compile it, and call it
by the listview. See Custom Action Help on page 389 to see how to write your own custom actions.
Here are some ways that you can use this functionality:
Add a custom toolbar button called "Assign All to Me" that will assign all of the selected tasks in the
listview to me.
Add a custom toolbar called "Approve" that will change the status of all of the selected expense items to
Approved.
Create a custom context menu item called "Publish" that will move the right-clicked document into
another document library.
Create a custom context menu item or toolbar item to start a workflow.
With the ability to write your own custom action, you can virtually do anything to the data when you
click the custom button that you define.
The Actions page contain the following elements:
Custom Actions
The Custom Actions element contains one Toolbar element and one Context Menu element. These elements can
contain one or more Action Item elements. You can associate the Action Item with one or more Action elements.
Results Body Allows you to set the value of this property that is repeated once for every row in the
search results. You can use the <%field name%> field replacement expression to refer
to the value of a certain field.
Example: <tr><td><%FullName%></td>
Results Footer Allows you to set the value of this property that is rendered once after the Results
Body.
Example: </table>
NOTE: The toolbar button affects all the items that are selected in the listview. The context menu item
affects only the item that is being right-clicked regardless of how many items are selected in your
listview.
Table 14. Actions
Element Description
Custom Actions For more information, see Custom Actions on page 366.
NOTE: The custom action in the listview does not support the Save action.
Table 13. Custom Display
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 367
www.agreeya.com
The Action element define a certain operation that is carried out by the action item when it is clicked.When you
add an action item, you can configure the following:
Table 15. Custom Actions
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Custom Actions in XML format.
<CustomActions>
<Toolbar>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID" Position="0"
PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prom
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session" SourceName="fieldName"
SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem" SourceName="httpParameterName"
/>
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</Toolbar>
<ContextMenu>
<ActionItem ID="UniqueID" Text="text" TextResourceID="textResourceID" Position="0"
PromptText="promptText" PrompTextResourceID=”prompTextResourceID” ImageUrl=”URL”
AccessKey=”AccessKeyCharacter”>
<Action Type="Delete" />
<Action Type="Move" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="Copy" TargetFolder="targetFolder" TargetSiteURL="targetSiteUrl"
TargetListName="targetListName" />
<Action Type="GoToURL" URL="TargetURL">
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="Session" SourceName="fieldName"
SessionName=”sessionName” />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="RowFromAnotherWebPart"
SourceName="fieldName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="HttpRequest"
SourceName="httpParameterName" />
<Parameter Name="parameterName" Source="ListItem" SourceName="httpParameterName"
/>
</Action>
<Action Type="GoToSource"/>
<Action Type="Custom" Class="IUIActionImpl" />
</ActionItem>
</ContextMenu>
</CustomActions>
IsSeparator Allows you to set the item as a separator.
ID Allows you to enter a unique ID that will identify the item. Use a descriptive identifier to
configure the action item with the editor.
Text Allows you to enter how the action item is displayed in the toolbar.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 368
www.agreeya.com
When you add an action, you can configure the following:
Text Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a a multi-lingual site. This attribute defines
the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the Web Part. The
Text Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP
parameter) are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given
identifier and culture is not found, the value in the Text attribute is used.
Prompt Text Allows you to prompt the user to click the toolbar button or the context menu item.
Prompt Text
Resource ID Allows you to define this property if you support a multi-lingual site. The property defines
the identifier of the string in the Resource List that is used as the title of the Web Part. The
Resource ID and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter)
are used to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and
culture is not found, the default is used.
Access Key
(Toolbar Only) Allows you to define one character from the Text attribute that becomes the access key to
this toolbar button or context menu item. For example, if you define a letter T as the access
key, you can press ALT+T and the browser will put the focus on this button or context menu
item. If there are multiple elements on the page with the same access key, you can repeat
ALT+T repeatedly until you get the focus on this toolbar button or context menu item.
Position Allows you to set the position of the button in the toolbar. The index starts with 0.
Show User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the Web Part. Separate groups
with commas.
Hide User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part. Separate site
group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide User
Groups, the user cannot
Table 15. Custom Actions
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 369
www.agreeya.com
Table 16. Action
Element Description
Name An optional element which allows you to identify a given action in order to access it from another
action. You can refer to this action from the GoToURL action and from ICustomActionEx
Interface.
Type Allows you to determine the type of the action. Here are the options:
GoToURL — redirects the user to a specific URL. You must specify the URL and where you
want the URL to open. If you select to open the URL in a dialog, you can configure the
dialog width and height.
You must specify the following parameters:
Input - the current user information as the value of the parameter
Session - the name of the session variable where the value comes from when the
source is set to Session
HttpRequest - the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the HTTP
parameters in the page URL. The name of the HTTP parameter is defined in the
SourceName attribute. As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName
attribute is ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter, which is
Hardware, is used as the value of the parameter.
ListItem - the value of the parameter is a list item or row
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the parameter for the GoToURL action can be retrieved
from the output of another action that comes first in the sequence of actions
defined in the ActionItem. There are two types of action that can produce an
output: an action with Type of ExecuteOperation, and an action with Type of
Custom that points to custom action implementation of ICustomActionEx Interface.
You do that by defining the SourceName attribute of the action. This is the syntax
of the SourceName attribute when you use ResultFormAction source:
<ActionName>.<ResultType>[.Name], where ActionName refers to the Name
attribute of the action that produces the output, ResultType can be OutParameter
(if the action result is returned through one of the out or inout parameter) or
RawData - (if the action result is returned as an object). Name is optional. It
further designates the object we want to use for the parameter. You do not have to
specify the Name when the ResultType is RawData. However, if the ResultType is
OutParameter, this name specifies the name of the out or input key value pair.
ResultFromAction - the parameter for the GoToURL action can be retrieved from
the output of another action that comes first in the sequence of actions defined in
the ActionItem
You must define a source name (where in the source you want to get your
information from), name (the name of the parameter that is appended to the URL
you specified), and Session (the name of the session variable where the value
comes from when the source is set to Session)
GoToSource — redirects the user to the URL specified in the Source HTTP parameter. The
URL to the page must look like: http://...?Source=URL for this option to work.
StartWorkflow — starts the specified workflow in the Workflow Name drop-down field. You
must select a Workflow name.
ReturnToMasterChart — returns the user to the master chart page. You use this action type
if this web part is located in the drill down page.
Custom — implements your own custom action and call it with this action type. Enter a
Class name that implements the ICustomActionEx or ICustomAction interface, or select a
class from the drop-down list, if available.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 370
www.agreeya.com
Views
The Views page allows you to set views so the user to view the data in Excel or a chart.
The Views page contains the following elements:
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Grid
Toolbar
Context Menu
Layout
Other
Table 17. Views
Element Description
Search Session Name The listview will store the search criteria, last selected folder, sort criteria, and
other listview dynamic settings in the session variable with this name.
The listview also use the Search Session Name to communicate those settings to
qExcelViewer and qChartView located in the page whose URL specified in the Excel
Viewer URL or Chart Viewer URL property, respectively. Therefore, the Search
Session Name in those web parts must be set to the same value as the session name
in this SIListView.
Display Message from
DAO Provider The external data that comes from the backend system sometimes contains
messages, such as informational messages or warnings. The SI List Form displays
these messages at the top of the webpart. The Display Messages From DAO Provider
property determines whether or not these messages should be displayed. There are
times when you want to suppress these messages especially when the messages are
not useful to the end user.
Custom Message Display Allows you to specify a custom message based on certain conditions.
We currently do not support mapping for the messages that the Display Messages
From DAO Provider property enables.
Turn on Advanced Mode if you want to edit Custom Message Display in XML format.
CustomMessageDisplay contains the following properties:
Display When — allows you to set the conditions to display a custom error
message. When defining the Display When condition, the following operators
are supported: Eq (Equal) Neq (Not Equal) Null, Is Not Null, Begins With,
Contains and Matches (for regular expression).
Custom Message — The error message that you want displayed when the
Display When condition is set.
If a Display When condition is set during runtime but a custom message is not
specified, the original message is displayed. If you want to hide the original
message, use a blank string or any html code that renders no visible cues, such as
<div>&nbsp;</div>, for the CustomMessage attribute.
When multiple Custom Message elements are defined for this property, the first
Custom Message, whose Display When condition is set, is used.
If no conditions are met, an error message from the selected external system is
displayed.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 371
www.agreeya.com
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
0
Grid
The Grid page allows you set the appearance of the grid in the web part.
The Grid contains the following:
Table 18. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 19. Grid
Element Description
Selection Column
Type Allows you to set a column type:
None: Use None if you want to click the row to select it or press Ctrl or Shift
and click the row to select multiple rows.
MultiRowSelector: Use this option if want the listview to display a check box as
the first column. To select a row, select the check box for that row. To select
multiple rows, select the check box for each row to be selected.
SingleRowSelector: Use this option if want the listview to display a check box
as the first column. To select a row, select the check box for that row.
Hide Expand\Collapse
Image When No Child
Item
Allows you to hide the +/- sign next to a list item if the item contains 0 child items.
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the grid in the listview. If you have a custom
skin, you can add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program
Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Header Style Allows you to enter the style for the header. You can define the style as you would in a
CSS class.
Example: font-family: verdana; color: black; background-color: #FFCC99; height:
20px;
Header CSS Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the grid's header. If this property is
specified, it will override the style defined in the Header Style property. You must
define the class specified here in an external CSS file.
Pager Style Allows you to enter the style for the pager. You can define the style as you would in a
CSS class; for example, font-family: verdana; color: black; background-color:
#FFCC99; height: 20px;
Pager CSS Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the pager. If this property is specified, it
will override the style defined in the Pager Style property. You must define the class
specified here in an external CSS file.
Item Style Allows you to enter the style for the item. You can define the style as you would in a
CSS class; for example, color: red; font-weight: bold
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 372
www.agreeya.com
Item CSS Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the item in the odd-numbered row (1, 3, 5,
and so on.). If this property is specified, it will override the style defined in the Item
Style property. You must define the class specified here in an external CSS file.
Alternating Item Style Allows you to enter the style for the item in the even-numbered row (2, 4, 6, and so
on). You can define the style as you would in a CSS class; for example, font-family:
verdana; color: yellow; font-weight: bold;
Alternating Item CSS
Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the item. If this property is specified, it
will override the style defined in the Alternating Item Style property. You must define
the class specified here in an external CSS file.
Selected Item Style Allows you to enter the style for the selected item in the grid. You can define the style
as you would in a CSS class; for example, backgroundcolor: orange !important; color:
blue !important;
You can add "!important" after the color name so that this color will override the
selected item style provided by the skin.
Selected Item CSS
Class Allows you to enter the CSS class name for the selected item in grid. If this property is
specified, it overrides the style defined in the Selected Item Style property. You must
define the class specified here in an external CSS file.
Table 19. Grid
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 373
www.agreeya.com
To o l b a r
The Toolbar page allows you to configure the appearance of the toolbar. It contains the following:
Main View Appearance
Field Name Allows you to define the name of the field whose values determine the color of the
row in the main view. The value of this field is compared against the FieldValue and
FieldValueRange in the Color Appearance property.
Color Appearance Allows you to define the color of the rows in the main view, child view, and group
header.
Turn on Advanced Mode if you want to edit Color Appearance in XML format.
<Appearance>
<MainViewAppearance>
<RowAppearance FieldValue="value1" BackgroundColor="color1"
FontColor="color2" />
<RowAppearance FieldValueRange="number - number"
BackgroundColor="color3" FontColor="color4" />
</MainViewAppearance>
<GroupeHeaderAppearance>
<RowAppearance FieldValue="value1" BackgroundColor="color1"
FontColor="color2" />
<RowAppearance FieldValueRange="number - number"
BackgroundColor="color3" FontColor="color4" />
</GroupHeaderAppearance>
</Appearance>
To add color for the group header, you must enable grouping for displayed fields
before specifying field value, background color and font color.
Select the Edit button, then click Add Row Appearance to enter values in the
following:
Field Value — value for the field
Field Value Range — a range of values for the field, including negative values
Background Color — the background color of the row for the specified value in
the Field Value attribute. The color can be specified as a well-known color
such as white, black, cyan, lightGray, as a RGB value such as 255, 255,255, or
you can specify it as #FFFFFF, #CCDDEE.
Font Color — the font color of the row for the specified value in the Field Value
attribute. The color can be specified as a well-known color such as white,
black, cyan, light gray, as a RGB value such as 255, 255,255, or you can specify
it as #FFFFFF, #CCDDEE. The Font Color attribute is ignored if you specify a URL
in the LinkTo attribute or set the LinkToSource or LinkToTargetURL attributes to
true.
Table 20. Toolbar
Element Description
Toolbar Skin Name Allows you to enter the skin name for the toolbar.
Show Export Button Allows you to display the Export button.
Show Print Button Allows you to display the Print button.
Table 19. Grid
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 374
www.agreeya.com
Context Menu
The Context Menu page allows you to set the look and feel of the context menu. It contains the following:
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 21. Context Menu Appearance
Element Description
Show Context Menu
Method Allows you to define how the context menu is shown if the Enable Context
Menu property is set to True. There are three options in this property:
RightClick — The user can open the context menu by right clicking the
row in the listview. This is the default option.
ShowContextMenuColumn — The listview will show the context menu
column. The context menu column shows a drop-down arrow image
which will open the context menu when clicked.
RightClickAndShowContextMenuColumn — The user can open the
context menu either by right clicking the row or by using the context
menu column.
Table 22. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web
part. If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language,
either from Left to Right or Right to Left
Table 23. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different
zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in
connections to other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal
view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web
part
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 375
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Ajax
Security
Resources
Ajax
The AJAX page allows you to configure AJAX in your web part.It contains the following:
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web
part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a
Tooltip when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information
about the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web
part, either in a separate window which you must close before returning
to the Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to
close before returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current
browser window (Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be
used as the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be
16 by 16 pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be
used in the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem
importing the web part
Table 24. AJAX
Element Description
Enable AJAX Allows you to enable AJAX for the listview. AJAX enables the listview to carry out some
operations within the grid without refreshing the whole page. For example, when you
sort a column by clicking its column header or change the page by clicking the pager, the
listview only refreshes the data in the grid without causing the whole page to post back.
However, there are times when AJAX causes some issues. In this case, you must disable
the AJAX capability of the listview.
The following are some known situations where you need to disable AJAX:
In Internet Explorer 6, the data grid will fail to carry out the AJAX operation. If
your user base reports this issue, you can disable the AJAX to fix it.
If you use javascript's document.write() method in the Results Body property of
the Custom Display, the text that is generated using document.write() will not be
rendered after the AJAX operation. This is true even if you do not call the
document.write() directly within the Results Body but rather through another
javascript function that calls document.write().
Table 23. Other
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 376
www.agreeya.com
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization elements in the web part using resource lists.
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
Table 25. Security
Element Description
Show User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members can view the web part. Separate
groups with commas.
Hide User
Groups Allows you to list SharePoint groups whose members cannot view the Web Part. Separate
site group names with commas (for example, Administrators, Readers).
If a user is a member of a group that is defined in both Show User Groups and Hide User
Groups, the user cannot view the Web Part.
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a
particular group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 26. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some
settings, such as the Web Part , whose value can change depending on the current
culture setting. The Resource List property defines the list that contains the string
values for different cultures. The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can
have multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value is
different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default culture,
leave the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes
for the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be
absolute (http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is
mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the
string in the Resource List that is used as the text of the Web Part. The Resource ID and
the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and
culture is not found, the default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 377
www.agreeya.com
Action Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Action toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the
culture that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Action
toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used
to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and
culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Filter Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Filter toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that
is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture
that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Filter toolbar
button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and
culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Export Button
Text Resource ID By default, the text for the Export toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file
that is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the
culture that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Export
toolbar button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID
and the current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used
to retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and
culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Print Button Text
Resource ID By default, the text for the Print toolbar button is retrieved from the resource file that
is included in the product. However, we may not have the resource file in the culture
that you want to use. In this case, you can simply define the text for the Print toolbar
button in the Resource List and specify its Resource ID here. This Resource ID and the
current cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to
retrieve the string in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and
culture is not found, the default text from the invariant resource file is used.
Table 26. Localization
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
22
378
www.agreeya.com
qSISelector
Overview
qSISelector Pages
Overview
qSISelector displays data from a SharePoint list in a drop-down control. This web part remembers the last item
selected, even after you leave the page.
Using qSISelector, you can:
manage multiple projects in one workspace. You can place a selector that displays the project
information on every page in your application and use that selector to filter the data in the qListView or
any other view on the page. Because the selector remembers the last item selected even as you move
from page to page, you only see the data for the same project until you switch to another project.
place a selector above a qListForm to select a certain item and then feed that item to the list form
because the qSISelector is a row provider.
display, create, and edit data in your external systems. Out of the box, this Web Part supports the DAO
Provider for:
Web Services
SQL Server
Oracle
Domino Server using XML over HTTP
Salesforce
K2Server (for SharePoint 2010 only)
qSISelector supports multiple languages. You can define a different Title for different languages using the
Resource List and the Title Resource ID properties. The culture for the page can be defined by appending the
Culture HTTP parameter to the page URL. For example:
http://hostname/sites/sitename/default.aspx?Culture=en-US
qSISelector implements the following web part connection interfaces:
IWebPartRow interface, which provides a row to another web part, such as qSIListView.
IWebPartRow interface, which enables the selector to consume a row from another web part that
implements IWebPartRow interface. The value from the consumed row can be used in the operator for a
certain operation in the Actions property.
TIP: To better understand SI web parts, read the System Integration Developer Guide.
NOTE: The IWebPartRow implementation is labeled with Send Row To in the web part
Connection menu. This interface cannot be connected with the obsolete IRowConsumer or
IFilterConsumer implementation. Do not connect this new interface with the old interface
that is marked obsolete.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 379
www.agreeya.com
qSISelector Pages
You can configure this web part through its pages that are accessible through ezEdit. qSISelector contains the
following pages:
Content Page
Behavior Page
Appearance Page
Advanced Page
Content Page
The Content page allows you to enter the content for your web part. It contains the following:
Primary Content
Filtering
Sorting
Selection
Primary Content
The Primary Content page is default category. You need to configure one or more elements in this page to get
started using this web part.
Primary Content contains the following:
NOTE: The IWebPartRow consumer implementation is labeled with Get Row From in the
web part Connection menu. This interface cannot be connected with the obsolete
IFilterProvider or IRowProvider implementation. Do not connect this new interface with the
old interface that is marked obsolete.
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
Title Allows you to enter a title for the web part.
Catalog See Catalog on page 380.
Data Member Allows you to define the name of the data table that contains the data to be displayed.
This is useful when the operation that retrieves the data from external system returns
multiple data tables. If the data table does not have any meaningful name, use the
Data Index property.
Data Index Allows you to define the index of the data table that contains the data to be displayed.
This is useful when the operation that retrieves the data from external system returns
multiple data tables and those tables do not have any meaningful name. If the data
table has meaningful name, you can refer to it by using the Data Member property.
If neither the Data Member or the Data Index property is specified, the first data table
in the data set is used.
Primary Key Field
Name Allows you to define the field name in the returned data table that is used as the
primary key. The primary key field must have a unique value for every row in the data
table. The qSISelector will use the value in the primary key field to differentiate one
row in the data table from another.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 380
www.agreeya.com
Catalog
This property defines the entity and the operations related to the entity. This property is an XML string in this
format:
The Catalog section contains one or more entities. An entity identifies which system and service you have
defined in the Configuration Editor. An entity contains one or more operations that can be executed on the
entity, and consists of the following attributes:
Display Field Name Allows to enter the name of the field that you want to display in the selector.If you
want to display information from multiple fields, use the Display Format properties.
The Display Field Name property is ignored if the Display Format property is defined.
Display Format Allows you to define the format of the items that are displayed in the selector. You can
use field replacement expression (<%field name %>) to refer to a field name.
Display Fields Allows you to define the fields that are displayed in the drop-down menu of the web
part. If defined, the choices in the drop-down menu are displayed in a grid.
This property is an XML string in this format:
<Fields>
<Field Name="fieldName" Width="width" />
<Field Name="fieldName" Width="width" />
</Fields>
The <Fields> element may contain one or more <Field> elements.
Name - The name of the field. The field name is case-sensitive.
Width - The display width of the field. The value can be in pixel (for example:
200px) or percent (for example: 30%).
Eliminate Duplicate
Values Allows you to define whether or not you want to eliminate duplicate values in the drop-
down menu. This is useful in case you want to use the selector as a filter to another
Web Part.
NOTE: If you are using a Salesforce system, the parameters that are available depend on
the method selected. See the System Integration Developer Guide for the methods and
parameters.
Table 1. Primary Con t e n t
Element Description
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 381
www.agreeya.com
Operations
An operation contains the following properties.
Table 2. Catalog
Element Description
Advanced Mode Turn on if you want to edit Catalog in XML format.
<Catalog>
<Entity Name="entityName" System="systemName" Service="serviceName"
Default="true/false" SetSessionName="sessionName"
ResetSessionNames="sessionName">
<Properties>
<Property Name="propertyName" Type="typeName" Value="propertyValue" />
<Property Name="propertyName" Type="typeName" Value="propertyValue" />
</Properties>
<Operation Name="operationName" Method="methodName" Default="True/False" >
<Parameter Source="sourceType" SessionName="sessionName"
SourceName="sourceName" Type="parameterType" Name="parameterName"
Usage="usageType" Value="value" />
<Parameter Source="sourceType" SessionName="sessionName"
SourceName="sourceName" Type="parameterType" Name="parameterName"
Usage="usageType" Value="value" />
</Operation>
</Entity>
<Entity>...</Entity>
</Catalog>
System Allows you to specify the system name that is defined in the System Integration
configuration file. If the system name does not exist in the System Integration
configuration file, you will get an error.
Service Allows you to specify the service name that is defined in the System Integration
configuration file. The service name that you specify here must belong to system that
you specify in the System attribute. If the service name does not exist in the System
Integration configuration file, you will get an error.
Name Allows you to specify the name of the entity which must be unique within this Catalog.
The name does not have to match with any name in your external system. However, it
is recommended that you use a descriptive name for your entity. This field is
mandatory.
Set Session Name Allows you to enter name of the session variable where the edited or newly created
item is stored when it is saved, or the item that is being displayed or edited is stored
when it is loaded.
Reset Session Names Allows you to reset (set to NULL) the value of the session variable whose name is
specified in this attribute. Specify multiple names by separating them with commas.
Default Allows you to define this entity as the default for the list form. If this element is not
specified, the first entity that is listed in the catalog becomes the default entity. The
default operation of the default entity is the operation that is used to retrieve the data
when the list form is loaded for the first time in edit or display mode.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 382
www.agreeya.com
Operation Parameters
You can click Edit to add parameters to your operation. You can define the following:
Table 3. Operations
Element Description
Name Allows you to define the name of the operation. This name does not have to match with any
name in your external system. This field is mandatory.
Method There are three supported types:
TableDirect — select this type to return all the data in a table. Specify the schema and
table name in the Method field below.
Stored Procedure — select this type to use a stored procedure to update or return data.
Specify the schema and stored procedure in the Method field below. Once a stored
procedure is selected, the Editor updates with the parameters that are defined for the
stored procedure. It is recommended that you do not add or remove these parameters
or change the “Name”, “Source”, or “Usage” fields.
Text — select this type to use free form PL/SQL string to query or update the database.
If your SQL string requires parameters, you will need to add them manually by clicking
the Add Parameter button.
NOTE: This attribute is only applicable for Oracle systems.
Method Allows you to set the real name of the operation in your external system. For example, it may
refer to the name of a web service method. Or it may refer to the name of a stored procedure
in your SQL Server database.
Default Allows you to select this operation as the default for the entity. The default operation is the
first operation that is called to retrieve the entity to be displayed. If this attribute is not
specified, the first operation listed in the entity becomes the default operation.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 383
www.agreeya.com
Properties
The Catalog section contains the following properties:
Table 4. Operation Parameters
Parameter Description
Name Allows you to set the parameter name that is used when calling the operation in your external
system.
Source Allows you to define the source of this parameter, which can be one of the following:
Default Value — the default value of the parameter type or default instance of the
parameter type. You must specify a type and usage (the direction for the parameter).
For example, if the parameter type is Boolean, the Default Value for the parameter is
false; if the parameter type is String, the default value is null. If a simple class or
structure is involved, an instance of the object is created and used as the parameter
value.
NullValue — the value of the parameter is null. You must specify a type and usage.
FixedValue — the value of the parameter. You must specify a value, type, and usage.
HttpRequest — the value of the parameter is retrieved from the HTTP parameters in
the page URL. You must specify a Source Name (the source name where the value is
retrieved) and usage. As an example, say the current page URL is
http://mysite.com/default.aspx?ProductType=Hardware. If the SourceName attribute
is ProductType, the value of the ProductType HTTP parameter, which is Hardware, is
used as the value of the parameter.
Input — you can link a field on the form to an operation parameter. You must specify a
Source Name, type, and usage.
You can also use this source type to retrieve the current user information as the value
of the parameter. You can retrieve the following information:
CurrentUserName - display name of the current user
CurrentLoginName - login name of the current user
CurrentUserID - ID of the current user
CurreUserEmail - email address of the current user
RowFromAnotherWebPart — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row
that is consumed from another web part. You must specify a Source Name and type.
Session — the value of the parameter that is retrieved from the row that is stored in
the session. You specify Session Name (define the name of the session where the row
of information is retrieved), Source Name, type, and usage.
ComplexType — the value of the parameter is an object based on the Type attribute
and Member definition inside the Parameter. Array and nested complex types are
supported. You must specify type and usage.
Array — the value of the parameter is an array of values. You must specify type and
usage.
XML — the value of the parameter that is dynamically built when the condition is
execute at runtime. You must specify type and usage.
NOTE: For sources related to Salesforce, see the System Integration Developer Guide.
Element Description
Name Allows you to specify the name of the property. Refer to the documentation for the DAO
Provider to your external system will tell you the name of the property that you must define.
Type Allows you to specify type of value that is specified in the Value attribute. Example:
System.String.
Value Allows you to specify the value of the property.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 384
www.agreeya.com
Filtering
The Filtering page allows you to use Complex Filters to define static filter for the data.
The Filtering page contains the following:
Sorting
The Sorting page allows you to define the sorting criteria.
The Sorting page contains the following elements:
Selection
The Selection page allows you to configure what do with empty selections. This page contains the following:
Table 5. Filtering
Element Description
Complex Filter Allows you to use the Complex Filter expression to define a static filter for the data. The
complex filter is applied to the data after the CAML Filter is applied.
NOTE: The Complex Filter is provided here only for backward compatibility reason. In the
past, Complex filter was used to support date functions.
For more information, see Complex Filters on page 21.
Table 6. Sorting/Paging
Element Description
Sort Fields Allows you to enter a value that is used to sort the entries. This property accepts a
single field name.
Sort in Ascending
Order Allows you to sort the entries in the ascending order. Deselect this check box if you
want the entries in descending order. This field is ignored if the Sort Field property is
not defined.
Table 7. Selection
Element Description
Show Empty Selection Allows you to display the value of Empty Selection Item Name property as the
first item.
You should check this property if you want the user to be able to select
nothing. Selecting nothing returns the entire unfiltered list. Another case is
when the qSelector acts as a filter to another web part and you want the
ability to pass an empty filter. This means the other web part will display all
its data unfiltered.allow customer to select the behavior of the empty
selection. And this option is only valid for the "Get Filter From" connection
type.
Turn Off Filtering When Empty
Selection is Chosen Allows you to turn filtering on or off if Show Empty Selection is selected. This
option is only valid for the "Get Filter From" connection type.
Empty Selection Item Name Allows you to display a specified value as the first item in the Selector when
the Show Empty Selection is checked. The default is - Select One -.
Empty Drop-Down Item Name Allows you to display specified text that is displayed in the drop-down menu
when it contains no list items. The default is <Empty>.
Refresh Page When Selection
Changed Allows you to determine whether the page should be refreshed when you
select another item in the selector. By default, the value is false, which
means that the page is only posted back.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 385
www.agreeya.com
Behavior Page
The Behavior page allows you to configure behaviors, such as adding buttons or menus, so the user can perform
operations when using the web part.
The Behavior page contains the following:
Views
Views
The Views page contains the following:
Table 8. Views
Appearance Page
The Appearance page allows you to set the overall look and feel of the web part. This page contains the
following:
Ribbon
Persistent Selector
Layout
Other
Ribbon
The Ribbon page allows you to set the display name of the Ribbon.
Element Description
Display Messages from
DAO Provider Allows you to display messages, such as informational messages or warnings at the top
of a web part. For more information on DAO providers, see System Integration
Developer Guide.
Custom Message
Display Allows you to specify a custom message based on certain conditions.
We currently do not support mapping for the messages that the Display Messages From
DAO Provider property enables.
Turn on Advanced Mode if you want to edit Custom Message Display in XML format.
CustomMessageDisplay contains the following properties:
Display When — allows you to set the conditions to display a custom error
message. When defining the Display When condition, the following operators
are supported: Eq (Equal) Neq (Not Equal) Null, Is Not Null, Begins With,
Contains and Matches (for regular expression).
Custom Message — The error message that you want displayed when the Display
When condition is set.
If a Display When condition is set during runtime but a custom message is not
specified, the original message is displayed. If you want to hide the original message,
use a blank string or any html code that renders no visible cues, such as
<div>&nbsp;</div>, for the CustomMessage attribute.
When multiple Custom Message elements are defined for this property, the first
Custom Message, whose Display When condition is set, is used.
If no conditions are met, an error message from the selected external system is
displayed.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 386
www.agreeya.com
Persistent Selector
The Selector page allows you to configure the appearance of the selector. It contains the following:
Layout
The Layout page allows you to set the overall layout of the web part. It contains the following:
Other
The Other page allows you to set the appearance of other elements in the web part. It contains the following:
Table 9. Ribbon
Element Description
SharePoint Ribbon Tab
Name Allows you to edit the display name of the Ribbon tab.
Table 10. Toolbar
Element Description
Skin Name Allows you to select the skin name for the grid in the listview. If you have a custom
skin, you can add it to the following folder for SharePoint 2010:C:\Program
Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\14\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins, for
SharePoint 2013: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\15\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins or for
SharePoint 2016: C:\Program Files\Common Files\Microsoft Shared\Web Server
Extensions\16\TEMPLATE\LAYOUTS\QuestSoftware\Telerik\Q32013SP1\Skins.
When creating a custom skin, you can refer to the Sample Skin folder in the install
directory.
Persistent Selector Width Allows you to specify the width of the input part for the selector.
Drop Down Width Allows you to specify the width of the drop-down menu for the selector in pixels. If
you specify the width for each field in the Display Fields property in pixels, the
value of this property is usually the total width of all fields.
Drop Down Height Allows you to specify the height of the drop-down menu for the selector.
Table 11. Layout
Element Description
Width Allows you to set the web part to a fixed width
Height Allows you to set the web part to a fixed height
Chrome State Allows you to select if the web part can be minimized or not when you open the web part.
If Minimized is selected, then only the Title Bar displays.
Chrome Type Allows you to select the kind of border to display around the web part.
Hidden Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Direction Allows you to set how the text in the web part displays depending on the language, either
from Left to Right or Right to Left
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 387
www.agreeya.com
Advanced Page
The Advanced page allows you to set advanced features of the web part, such as the following:
Security
Resources
Security
The Security page allows you to set which users are allowed to view the web part. It contains the following:
Resources
The Resources page allows you to enable Localization in the web part using resource lists.
Table 12. Other
Element Description
Allow Minimize Select this check box if you want the web part minimized
Allow Close Select this check box if you want the web part removed from the page
Allow Hide Select this check box if you want the web part hidden
Allow Zone Change Select this check box if you want the web part moved to a different zone
Allow Connections Select this check box if you want the web part to participate in connections to
other web parts
Allow Editing in Personal View Select this check box if you want the web part modified in a personal view
Export Mode Allows you to select the level of data that can be exported for this web part
Title URL Allows you to add the title of a URL as extra information about the web part
Description Allows you to enter a description of the web part that is displayed as a Tooltip
when you hover your mouse over the web part title or icon.
Help URL Allows you to enter the location of a file containing Help information about
the web part.
Help Mode Allows you to specify how a browser displays Help content for the web part,
either in a separate window which you must close before returning to the
Web Page (Mode), in a separate window that you do not need to close before
returning to the Web Page (Modeless), or in the current browser window
(Navigate)
Catalog Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used as
the web part icon in the Web Part List. The image size must be 16 by 16
pixels.
Title Icon Image URL Allows you to specify the location of a file containing an image to be used in
the web part title bar. The image size must be 16 by 16 pixels.
Import Error Message Allows you to specify a message that appears if there is a problem importing
the web part
Table 13. Security
Element Description
Target
Audiences Allows you to have the Web Part to appear only to people who are members of a particular
group or audience.
An audience can be identified by using a SharePoint group, a distribution list, a security
group, or a global audience.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 388
www.agreeya.com
Localization
Localization contains the following elements.
-
NOTE: While this feature is still available to use, we recommend using ezLocalizer. For more information,
see ezLocalizer on page 400.
Table 14. Localization
Element Description
Resource List Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. In a multi-lingual site, there are some settings,
such as the web part, whose value can change depending on the current culture setting. The
Resource List property defines the list that contains the string values for different cultures.
The resource list must contain 3 columns:
Resource ID — This field contains the identifier to refer to the string. You can have
multiple strings with the same Resource ID as long as their Culture value is different.
Culture — This field contains the culture for the string. For the default culture, leave
the Culture field blank.
Value — This field contains the value for the string.
The Lists element can contain only one List element. The following are the attributes for
the List element:
SiteUrl — The URL to the site that contains the resource list. The URL can be absolute
(http://...) or relative to the current page URL. This attribute is mandatory.
ListName — The name of the resource List. The list name is case sensitive.
Title Resource ID Allows you to support a multi-lingual site. The property defines the identifier of the string in
the Resource List that is used as the text of the web part. The Resource ID and the current
cultural setting (identified with the Culture HTTP parameter) are used to retrieve the string
in the Resource List. If the string with the given identifier and culture is not found, the
default is used.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
A
389
www.agreeya.com
Custom Action Help
Overview
Custom Action
Overview
The Custom Action capability enables you to write a custom code that can be called from qListView, qListForm,
qSIListView or qSIListForm. In your custom code, you can:
write a complex custom validation and abort the action if the data is invalid.
copy the item to another list or library before the item is saved in a qListForm.
initialize one or more fields in the qListForm when the list form is initialized. Refer to the Form
Initialization Actions property of the qListForm and qSIListForm on how to call this kind of custom action.
Custom Action
To write your own custom action, ensure:
A Class Library project is created using Microsoft Visual Studio
Microsoft SharePoint Server is installed and running properly
QuickApps for SharePoint is installed and running properly in your SharePoint environment
You have a strong name key file to sign your assembly
Your custom action classes must implement either the WA.Core.ICustomAction interface or the
WA.Core.ICustomActionEx interface.
ICustomActionEx Interface
The ICustomActionEx interface is located in WA.Core.DLL that is installed in the Global Assembly Cache (GAC)
when you install the QuickApps for SharePoint.
The following is the signature of the WA.Core.ICustomActionEx interface:
public interface ICustomActionEx
{
ActionResult Perform(CustomActionContext context, CustomActionCancelEventArgs evt);
}
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 390
www.agreeya.com
Parameters
The following table lists the parameters of the Perform method.
Example
The following is a simple implementation that demonstrates how to retrieve SPListItem object(s) from the
passed in parameter, process the parameters, and how to notify the web parts about the outcome of the custom
action.
Below is an example of a custom action class. This class verifies that if this item has high priority, it must be
assigned to somebody. Otherwise, it will cancel the operation.
using System;
TIP: Any exception thrown within the Perform method is caught by the web part. Afterwards, the web
part will set the event's Cancel property to true and set its error message with the exception's Message
property.
Table 1. Perform method parameters
Parameter Description
CustomActionContext Allows you to:
Access the HTTPContext object using HTTPContext property. The HTTPContext
object allows you to access the Request and Response objects to do various
things.
Access the collection of items where this action is to be performed. This
collection contains Microsoft.SharePoint.PListItem objects (for qListView and
qListForm) or System.Data.DataRow objects (for qSIListView, qSIListForm and
qSIChartView). The following statements are true for the second parameters:
This parameter is never null and it will contain zero or more SPListItem or
DataRow objects.
When your custom code is called from the qListForm's toolbar button or
qListView's context menu item, the collection will contain one SPListItem
object, which is the item that is being right-clicked in the listview or displayed
in the list form.
When your custom code is called from the qListView's toolbar button, it may
contain zero or more SPListItem objects, which are the items that are selected
in the listview.
When your custom code is called from the qSIListForm's toolbar button or
qSIListView's context menu item, the collection will contain one DataRow
object, which is the row that is being right-clicked in the listview or displayed
in the list form.
When your custom code is called from the qSIListView's toolbar button, it may
contain zero or more DataRow objects, which are the rows that are selected in
the listview.
When your custom code is called from the qSIChartView's toolbar button, it
contains all the rows that are being used in the chart view
CustomActionCancel
EventArgs Is used to tell the web part about the outcome of the action. The Perform method may
return an object of ActionResult class. This ActionResult is stored by the framework
and can be accessed by another action that is executed after this action. If your action
does not need to return anything, you can return null.
It allows you to:
Cancel the operation by setting the Cancel property to true.
Set a custom error message by setting the Message property.
Access the web part that invokes this action by using the Source property. You
may analyze the property of the web part to do different things in your code.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 391
www.agreeya.com
using System.Web;
using System.Collections;
using System.Collections.Generic;
using System.Text;
using System.ComponentModel;
using Microsoft.SharePoint;
using WA.Core;
namespace MyCompany.DevStudio
{
/// <summary>
/// A sample custom action that you can use to validate a Task in the Tasks list.
///
/// In this case, the sample custom action ensures that a high priority task must be assigned to
somebody.
/// If not, the sample custom action will cancel the action and generates an error message.
/// </summary>
public class SampleCustomActionEx : ICustomActionEx
{
/// <summary>
/// The Perform method is called by the webpart when the action item (such
/// as toolbar button or context menu item) is clicked.
/// </summary>
/// <param name="context">The CustomActionContext object that contains the HTTP Request and
HTTP Context.
/// If the custom action is invoked from an SI Web Part, it will also contain a collection of DataRows
/// where the action is performed. If the custom action is invoked from a non-SI Web Part, it will
contain
/// a collection of SPListItem object.</param>
/// <param name="evt">The event argument that can be used to cancel the action and
/// to carry the error message back to the Web Part.</param>
/// <returns></returns>
public ActionResult Perform(CustomActionContext context, CustomActionCancelEventArgs evt)
{
ActionResult actionResult = new ActionResult();
if (context.Items == null || context.Items.Count == 0)
{
evt.Cancel = true;
// you may construct a simple message for popup message or html text if message is shown as
inline
evt.Message = "There is no item to validate.";
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 392
www.agreeya.com
return actionResult;
}
// This sample custom action is meant to be used by a qListView or qListForm
// that points to a Task list. Therefore, the items contains SPListItem objects.
SPListItem item = null;
IEnumerator enumerator = context.Items.GetEnumerator();
while (enumerator.MoveNext())
{
item = enumerator.Current as SPListItem;
if (item != null)
{
if (item["Priority"] != null)
{
string priority = item["Priority"].ToString();
if ("(1) High".Equals(priority))
{
if (item["Assigned To"] == null ||
string.IsNullOrEmpty(item["Assigned To"].ToString()))
{
evt.Cancel = true;
evt.Message = "A high priority task must be assigned to a user";
}
}
}
}
}
/* The following code shows you how you can store the result from this action to be used by
another action
* in the chain of actions of the ActionItem. The lines are commented out because they are not
really used
* in this action. It is for illustration purposes only.
*
* You have two ways to store the data. First, you can store the data as RawData in the
actionResult. Here is an example:
actionResult.RawData = someData;
* You can also store the data as key-value pairs in the OutParameters of the actionResult. Here
is an example:
*
actionResult.OutParameters["Name"] = someData;
*/
/* The following code shows you how you can use the result from another action. The lines are
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 393
www.agreeya.com
* commented out because they are not really used in this action. It is for illustration purpose
only.
*
* You can access the RawData that comes from another action the following name.
* ActionName - this is the name of the action that stores the result.
* RawData - use this specifier to get the RawData
*
object rawData = context.GetActionResult("ActionName.RawData");
* You can also access the key-value pairs in the OutParameters by using the following specifier:
* ActionName - this is the name of the action that stores the result.
* OutParameter - use this specifier to get to the OutParameters key-value pairs
* Name - the key for the value in the OutParameters key-value pairs
object val = context.GetActionResult("ActionName.OutParameter.Name");
*/
return actionResult;
}
}
}
Here is another example of a custom action class. This custom action class can be used to initialize a qListForm.
using System;
using System.Web;
using System.Collections;
using System.Collections.Generic;
using System.Text;
using System.ComponentModel;
using Microsoft.SharePoint;
using Microsoft.SharePoint.WebControls;
using Microsoft.SharePoint.Utilities;
using Microsoft.SharePoint.Administration;
using Microsoft.SharePoint.WebPartPages;
using System.IO;
using System.Net.Mail;
using System.Security.Principal;
using System.Runtime.InteropServices;
using System.Threading;
using WA.Core;
namespace MyCompany.DevStudio
{
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 394
www.agreeya.com
/// <summary>
/// A sample custom action that you can use to validate a Task in the Tasks list.
///
/// In this case, the sample custom action ensures that a high priority task must be assigned to
somebody.
/// If not, the sample custom action will cancel the action and generates an error message.
/// </summary>
public class InitializeFormAction : ICustomActionEx
{
/// <summary>
/// The Perform method is called by the webpart when the fields in the list form are initialized.
/// </summary>
/// <param name="context">The CustomActionContext object that contains the HTTP Request and
HTTP Context.
/// If the custom action is invoked from an qSIListForm, it will also contain a collection of
Hashtable
/// where the action is performed. If the custom action is invoked from a qListForm, it will contain
/// a collection of SPListItem object.</param>
/// <param name="evt">The event argument that can be used to cancel the action and
/// to carry the error message back to the Web Part.</param>
/// <returns></returns>
public ActionResult Perform(CustomActionContext context, CustomActionCancelEventArgs evt)
{
ActionResult actionResult = new ActionResult();
if (context.Items == null || context.Items.Count == 0)
{
return actionResult;
}
// This sample custom action is meant to be used by a qListForm
// that points to a Task list. Therefore, the items contains SPListItem objects.
SPListItem item = null;
IEnumerator enumerator = context.Items.GetEnumerator();
while (enumerator.MoveNext())
{
item = enumerator.Current as SPListItem;
if (item != null)
{
// Initialize the title with a value
item["Title"] = "New Task";
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 395
www.agreeya.com
}
}
return actionResult;
}
}
ICustomAction Interface (Deprecated)
This interface is deprecated starting from version 5.0. Use the ICustomActionEx Interface on page 389 instead.
The ICustomAction interface is located in WA.Core.DLL that is installed in the Global Assembly Cache (GAC)
when you install QuickApps for SharePoint.
The following is the signature of the WA.Core.ICustomAction interface:
public interface ICustomAction
{
void Perform(HttpContext context,
ICollection listItems,
CustomActionCancelEventArgs evt);
}
Parameters
The following table lists the parameters of the Perform method.
NOTE: Microsoft Visual Studio.Net 2010/2012 project must contain references to the following two DLLs:
C:\Windows\Microsoft.NET\assembly\GAC_MSIL\Microsoft.SharePoint\v4.0_15.0.0.0__71e9bce111e94
29c\Microsoft.SharePoint.dll
C:\Windows\Microsoft.NET\assembly\GAC_MSIL\WA.Core\v4.0_4.0.0.0__2b4b09f1c57c8f0b\WA.Core.
dll
TIP: Any exception thrown from the custom action classes is caught by the web part. Afterwards, the web
part will set the event's Cancel property to true and set its error message with the exception’s Message
property.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 396
www.agreeya.com
Example
The following is a simple implementation that demonstrates how to retrieve SPListItem object(s) from the
passed in parameter, process the parameters, and how to notify the web parts about the outcome of the custom
action.
Below is an example of a custom action class. This class verifies that if this item has high priority, it must be
assigned to somebody. Otherwise, it will cancel the operation.
using System;
using System.Web;
using System.Collections;
using System.Collections.Generic;
using System.Text;
using System.ComponentModel;
using Microsoft.SharePoint;
using WA.Core;
namespace CustomActionSample
{
public class MyCustomAction : ICustomAction
Table 2. Perform method parameters
Parameter Description
HttpContext Allows you to access the Request and Response object
a collection of
Microsoft.SharePoint.PListItem
objects (for qListView and
qListForm) or a collection of
System.Data.DataRow objects (for
qSIListView, qSIListForm and
qSIChartView)
Allows the following:
This parameter is never null and it will contain zero or more
SPListItem or DataRow objects.
When your custom code is called from the qListForm's toolbar
button or qListView's context menu item, the collection will contain
one SPListItem object, which is the item that is being right-clicked
in the listview or displayed in the list form.
When your custom code is called from the qListView's toolbar
button, it may contain zero or more SPListItem objects, which are
the items that are selected in the listview.
When your custom code is called from the qSIListForm's toolbar
button or qSIListView's context menu item, the collection will
contain one DataRow object, which is the row that is being right-
clicked in the listview or displayed in the list form.
When your custom code is called from the qSIListView's toolbar
button, it may contain zero or more DataRow objects, which are the
rows that are selected in the listview.
When your custom code is called from the qSIChartView’s toolbar
button, it contains all the rows that are being used in the chart
view.
CustomActionCancelEventArgs Is used to tell the web part about the outcome of the action. This allows
you to:
Cancel the operation
Set a custom error message
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 397
www.agreeya.com
{
public void Perform(HttpContext context, ICollection listItems, CustomActionCancelEventArgs evt)
{
if (listItems.Count == 0)
{
evt.Cancel = true;
evt.Message = "There is no item to validate";
return;
}
SPListItem item = null;
IEnumerator enumerator = listItems.GetEnumerator();
while (enumerator.MoveNext())
{
item = enumerator.Current as SPListItem;
if (item != null)
{
if (item["Priority"] != null)
{
string priority = item["Priority"].ToString();
if ("(1) High".Equals(priority))
{
if (item["Assigned To"] == null ||
string.IsNullOrEmpty(item["Assigned To"].ToString()))
}
evt.Cancel = true;
evt.Message = "A high priority task must be assigned to a user";
}
}
}
}
}
}
}
}
NOTE: Microsoft Visual Studio.Net 2010/2012 project must contain references to the following two dlls:
C:\Windows\Microsoft.NET\assembly\GAC_MSIL\Microsoft.SharePoint\v4.0_15.0.0.0__71e9bce111e94
29c\Microsoft.SharePoint.dll
C:\Windows\Microsoft.NET\assembly\GAC_MSIL\WA.Core\v4.0_4.0.0.0__2b4b09f1c57c8f0b\WA.Core.
dll
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 398
www.agreeya.com
Debugging
In order to debug the code, generate the debug version of the DLL and copy the DLL and PDB file into the bin
folder under the root folder of your SharePoint application. If you cannot find the bin folder, you can create
one. Sign your assembly with a strong name key file.
Physical Path
To find the physical path of the root folder of your SharePoint application
1Select Start | Control Panel | Administrative Tools | Internet Information Services (IIS) Manager.
2 Expand the node with your computer name.
3 Expand the Web Sites folder.
4 Find the node that represents your site. The SharePoint site should contain _layouts, _vti_bin and
_wpresources underneath it.
5 Right-click the node and select Properties.
6Select Home Directory tab.
The value in the Local path tells you the physical path of your root folder.
Trust Level
Once you generate the debug version, you should change the trust level for your web application to Full while
debugging the custom action. The trust level is specified in the web.config. Find the trust element in your
web.config and change the level to Full.
<trust level="Full" originUrl="" />
Debugging the Code
To debug your code
1 Open the SharePoint page that contains the listview or list form web parts that contains the custom
action.
2 Open your project's solution using Visual Studio.
3Select Debug | Attach to Process.
4 Select w3wp.exe in the process list. If w3wp.exe is not listed, make sure that you check Show processes
in all sessions. You may see more than one w3wp.exe listed. If you do, select the one with your user
name.
5Click Attach.
6 Set some breakpoints in your custom action code.
7 Invoke your custom action by clicking the custom toolbar button or the custom context menu that you
configure in the listview or the list form web part.
NOTE: You can set the output folder of your project to the bin folder of your SharePoint application.
Therefore, the DLL and PDB files are automatically updated every time you compile your application.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 399
www.agreeya.com
Using the Custom Action Class
When you specify the class name in the action item with type Custom, you must use a fully qualified class name.
The Custom Action Editor will automatically show you all the custom action classes that are located in the bin
folder of your SharePoint application.
Figure 1. Custom Action Editor
Deploying Custom Action Class
When it is ready to deploy the solution, build your custom action project in release mode. Sign the assembly
with a strong name key file. This ensures the assembly created can be deployed into Global Assembly Cache
(GAC).You can deploy your assembly into the GAC by using the gacutil.exe that comes with the .NET Framework
SDK. Here is the command: gacutil /i <DLLName>.
Once the assembly is dropped into the GAC, your class is ready to use.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
B
400
www.agreeya.com
ezLocalizer
ezLocalizer allows you to translate your Web Parts to various languages.
You can perform the following functions:
Creating a New Project
Opening an Existing Project
Finding Values in a Project
Creating a New Project
To create a new project
1Select Start | All Programs | AgreeYa | QuickApps for SharePoint ezLocalizer | ezLocalizer.
2Select File | New.
3 Select where you want to store your project and what version of Web Parts you are translating. Click OK.
The selected version of Web Parts resource file opens.
4Click the Select Languages button.
5 Select one or more languages from the Available Languages column, move them to the Selected
Languages column, and click OK.
The selected languages will be the target languages to which your resource files are translated.
6 Enter the translated invariant value in the Value in <Language> column.
7Click Save to save your resource project.
The project will be saved in the folder you have chosen in step 3.
8Click Compile to generate the .dll files for the selected language.
If one or more values are not translated, an error message appears asking if you want to continue. If you
click Yes, you can keep the values blank or overwrite the blank values with existing invariant values. You
can choose not to create satellite assemblies if you are not finished translating the resource files or
overwriting existing assemblies you have previously compiled.
For more information on satellite assemblies, see http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-
us/library/sb6a8618(v=vs.90).aspx.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 401
www.agreeya.com
9 If you are using:
10 Restart IIS.
Opening an Existing Project
To open an existing project
1Select Start | All Programs | AgreeYa | QuickApps for SharePoint ezLocalizer | ezLocalizer.
2Select File | Open, and select an existing project.
3 Make any necessary changes.
4Click Save to save your resource project.
5Click Compile to generate the .dll files for the selected language.
Finding Values in a Project
You can find a name, invariant value, or translated value in a single category or the entire project.
Sharepoint 2010 Sharepoint 2013 Sharepoint 2016
Copy the assemblies to
the GAC of your Web
Front-end servers
where you have
QuickApps for
SharePoint 2010
installed and activated.
NOTE: To copy your assemblies
to GAC, drag your DLLs into the
C:\Windows\Assembly folder.
To uninstall the assemblies,
right-click an assembly, and
select Uninstall.
1 Install GACUTIL.
Download it from
http://www.microsoft.
com/en-
us/download/details.as
px?id=8279.
2 From the command
prompt, run:
GACUTIL /i <FULL
PATH>WA.Resources.
resources.dll
GACUTIL /i <FULL
PATH>/Quest.Resour
ces.resources.dll
NOTE: If the DLLs are installed
correctly, they are located at
%Windows%\Microsoft.Net\asse
mbly\GAC_MSIL.
3 Copy gacutil.exe and
gacutil.exe.config and
run the commands to
every Web Front-end
server that has
QuickApps for
SharePoint 2013
installed and activated.
1 Install GACUTIL.
Download it from
http://www.microsoft.
com/en-
us/download/details.as
px?id=8279.
2 From the command
prompt, run:
GACUTIL /i <FULL
PATH>WA.Resources.
resources.dll
GACUTIL /i <FULL
PATH>/Quest.Resour
ces.resources.dll
NOTE: If the DLLs are installed
correctly, they are located at
%Windows%\Microsoft.Net\asse
mbly\GAC_MSIL.
3 Copy gacutil.exe and
gacutil.exe.config and
run the commands to
every Web Front-end
server that has
QuickApps for
SharePoint 2016
installed and activated.
NOTE: You must restart IIS to see the translated values.
NOTE: For more information, see Creating a New Project on page 400.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 402
www.agreeya.com
To find a name, invariant value, or translated value
1Select Actions | Find.
The Find tab opens.
2 Select a category.
3 Enter a name, invariant value, or translated value to find.
4Click Find to find the name or value in a single category.
OR
Click Find All to find the name or value in the entire project.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
C
403
www.agreeya.com
My First App
Overview
Using My First App
Overview
My First App allows you to create a basic SharePoint application. You can add, edit, and view items in a
SharePoint list, and then, if desired, plot the data from the list in a chart.
Before you begin, ensure that the SharePoint site contains the list you want to use. If a list does not already
exist, create one.
Using My First App
To use My First App
1 Ensure the My First App feature is activated on your site collection.
2 From any site in your site collection where you want to build your first app, click Site Settings.
3Click My First App.
4Click Start.
5 Pick a SharePoint list, and click Next.
6 Select a chart type, enter a chart name, and select fields for X-axis and Y-axis, and a function to compile
the Y-axis data.
7Click Next.
8 Select a target location and enter a page name for your app.
9Click Build.
When the app is completed, you can either go to your app right away or build another app.
If you want to configure the list and chart, select ezEdit from the Ribbon tabs.
For information on qChartView, see qChartView on page 48. For information on qListView, see qListView
on page 192.
NOTE: You need to be a site owner in order to use My First App.
NOTE: If you do not want to build a chart, keep the default "No Chart".
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
D
404
www.agreeya.com
Application Templates
Installing the Application Templates
Adding the CRM template
Adding the Help Desk Template
Adding the Project Dashboard Template
Adding the Project Workspace
Installing the Application Templates
QuickApps for SharePoint comes with several application templates. You can use these application templates as
a turn-key solution, extend it to your own need, or as an example for your own application.
Figure 1. Structure of the application templates:
The Single Project and Multi Projects sites must be added underneath the Project Dashboard site. Otherwise,
you will see an error in the Panel Menu citing that the list for the menu cannot be found. This is because the
lists for the Single Project's and Multi Project's panel menu are located in the Project Dashboard site.
The Application Site Templates in SharePoint are delivered as SharePoint solution packages: AgreeYa CRM
Site.wsp, AgreeYa Help Desk Site.wsp, AgreeYa Multi Project Site.wsp, AgreeYa Project Dashboard Site.wsp, and
AgreeYa Single Project Site.wsp.
To install the application templates
1 Copy the solution packages (.wsp files) to a local folder.
2 Click the Application Templates link on the QuickApps for SharePoint autorun screen of the installer.
3 Open the Solutions Gallery in SharePoint.
4 On the SharePoint Ribbon Solutions tab, click Upload Solution. Browse and upload the Site Application
Temp late.
5Click Activate to activate it if you want the Site Template to appear in the New Site dialog box later.
Adding the CRM template
The CRM can be a top-level site or a subsite of another site.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 405
www.agreeya.com
The CRM application template can be used to manage customer data such as companies, contacts, tasks,
conversation records, and sales funnel (sales opportunities).
To add the CRM template
1 Open Sites and workspaces in SharePoint.
2Click Create.
3 Complete the site information and select the CRM Site template under the Custom tab.
4Click Create.
Next, you must configure the administrator group. The member of this group will see the Administration
Pages panel in the panel menu.
To configure the administrator group
1 Open People and groups in SharePoint.
2Click New to create Administrators group and assign members to this group.
If you want to create announcements that are displayed in the Home page, login as a member of the
Administrators group and select Administration Pages | Application Setup in the panel menu.
Click the New button in the Companies listview in the Home page to create company records. When you
click Save and View Details, the company record is saved and you will redirected to the Company Detail
page where you can enter the Contacts, Tasks, Conversation Records and Sales Funnel (Sales
Opportunities) for that company.
Adding the Help Desk Template
The Help Desk can be a top-level site or a subsite of another site.
The Help Desk application template can be used to manage Help Desk tickets and to look for help desk related
information such as links, FAQs, and Knowledge Base Articles.
To add the Help Desk template
1 Open Sites and workspaces in SharePoint.
2Click Create on the toolbar.
3 Complete the site information and select the Help Desk Site template under the Custom tab.
4Click Create.
Next, you must configure the group for the help desk users.
To configure the group for help desk users
1 Open People and groups in SharePoint.
2 Create 4 new groups (3 new groups if you have already created an Administrators group) and assign
members to these groups.
Administrators The members of this group can see the Administration Pages panel in the panel
menu.
Help Desk Users This is the group for a regular user. Regular users can create a ticket and track
their existing tickets. They can also lookup the resources in the site.
Help Desk Technicians Help Desk Technician can do everything that the Help Desk User can do.
Also, they can assign a ticket to themselves or other technician and working on the ticket.
Help Desk Supervisors Help Desk Supervisor can do everything that the Help Desk Technician can
do. Also, they can administer the list of help desk technician and add FAQ, and Knowledge Base
articles.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 406
www.agreeya.com
If you do not log in as a member of Help Desk Supervisors, open another window and log in as a
supervisor.
Select Supervisor | Administrative Page in the menu. At a minimum, you must fill in the Help Desk
Technician information and the Supported Products. You can also create other information such as
Announcements, Help Desk Links, FAQs, and Knowledge Base Articles in this page.
After the setup is done, anybody can start using the site. The first thing that the user can do is to create
a new ticket by clicking the New button in the My New or Unassigned Tickets view in the home page.
After a ticket is created, the owner of the ticket can keep track the life cycle of the ticket by clicking
the Active Tickets, Resolved Tickets and Closed Tickets links in the panel menu.
Help Desk Technicians can login to the site and look for newly created tickets using the New or
Unassigned Tickets page. The link to navigate to this page is available in the panel menu. Somebody
must be a member of the Help Desk Technicians member to be able to see this menu. Help Desk
Technicians can also see any tickets that are assigned to him/her, resolved by him/her or closed tickets
that are resolved by him/her by clicking the appropriate links in the panel menu.
Any user can look for information such as FAQs, discussion board, Knowledge Base Articles, by clicking
the links in the panel menu. Only a member of Help Desk Supervisors group can create FAQs, Knowledge
Base Articles, by using the administrative page.
Adding the Project Dashboard Template
The Project Dashboard can be a top-level site or a subsite of another site.
The Project Dashboard, Single Project, and Multi Projects application templates can be used to manage
different aspect of a project, such as Tasks, Issues, and documents.
To add the Project Dashboard template
1 Open Sites and workspaces in SharePoint.
2Click Create.
3 Complete the site information and select the Project Dashboard Site template under the Custom tab.
4Click Create.
Next, you must configure the administrator group if you have not done so. The member of this group will
see the Administration Pages panel in the panel menu.
To configure the administrator group
1 Open People and groups in SharePoint.
2 Create an Administrators group and assign members to this group.
The Project Dashboard site itself does not contain any data. You must create one or more Single Project
sites or Multi Project sites as subsites of the Project Dashboard site.
Adding the Project Workspace
The Project Workspace must be created under the Project Dashboard.
To add the project workspace
1 Open Sites and workspaces in SharePoint.
2Click Create on the toolbar.
3 Complete the site information and select either the template Single Project Site or Multi Project Site
under the Custom tab.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 407
www.agreeya.com
4Click Create.
Login as a member of the Administrators group and select Administration Pages | Application Setup in
the panel menu. Setup your projects, phases for your projects, and other information pertaining to the
projects. For the Single Project site, you must create only one Project. You can create more than one
projects in the Multi Project site.
After the project is setup, any user can login to the project site and start managing the Tasks, Issues and
documents related to the project. In the Multi Project site, the user can switch between one project and
another by selecting it in the selector that is located above the listview in each page. The selected
project is memorized when the user navigates between pages enabling them to see the data only for the
selected project.
The user can also go to the Project Dashboard site to see the aggregated information from all the
subsites. For example, a manager can easily monitor the health of all the projects in the home page of
the Project Dashboard site.
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide
E
408
www.agreeya.com
Sample Charts
Single Series
Multi-Series
Scroll
Stacked
Table 1. Sample cha r t s
Chart Group Chart Type Example
Single Series Area2D
Bar2D
Column2D
Column3D
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 409
www.agreeya.com
Doughnut2D
Doughnut3D
Line
Pie2D
Pie3D
Table 1. Sample cha r t s
Chart Group Chart Type Example
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 410
www.agreeya.com
Multi-Series MultiSeriesArea
MultiSeriesBar2D
MultiSeriesBar3D
Table 1. Sample cha r t s
Chart Group Chart Type Example
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 411
www.agreeya.com
MultoSeriesColumn2D
MultiSeriesColumn3D
MultiSeriesColumn3DAnd
LineDualYAxis
MultiSeriesColumnAndLine3D
MultiSeriesCombination2D
Table 1. Sample cha r t s
Chart Group Chart Type Example
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 412
www.agreeya.com
MultiSeriesCombination3D
MultiSeriesCombination2DDual
YAxis
MultiSeriesLine
Table 1. Sample cha r t s
Chart Group Chart Type Example
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 413
www.agreeya.com
Scroll ScrollArea2D
ScrollColumn2D
ScrollCombination2D
ScrollCombination2DDualYAxis
ScrollLine2D
ScrollStackedColumn2D
Table 1. Sample cha r t s
Chart Group Chart Type Example
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 414
www.agreeya.com
Stacked StackedArea2D
StackedBar2D
StackedBar3D
StackedColumn2D
StackedColumn3DDualLineYAx
is
Table 1. Sample cha r t s
Chart Group Chart Type Example
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 415
A
about QuickApps, 8
adding a web part later in qDynamicLayout, 123
adding billions to default, 96, 326
adding items to a list in SharePoint using qListForm,
187
adding more web parts to the same tab in
qDynamicLayout, 123
adding number prefix and suffix, 94, 324
Advanced Mode, 19
AJAX, 156, 184, 232, 237, 244, 375
Application Templates, 404
CRM Template, 404
Dashboard Template, 406
Help Desk Template, 405
installing, 404
Project Workspace, 406
automatic number formatting, 92, 322
C
CAML Filters, 19, 53, 106, 161, 203, 247, 268
using dynamic variables, 21
variables, 20
charts
multi-series, 410
scroll, 413
single series, 408
stacked, 414
Complex Filters, 21, 53, 203, 247, 268, 279, 362
Configuration Wizard
configuring advanced settings
qListView, 226
configuring basic settings
qCalendarView, 34
qChartView, 88
qListForm, 187
qListView, 226
qCalendarView, 10
qChartView, 48
qListForm, 143
qListView, 193
configuring a web part within qDynamicLayout, 123
configuring qCascadingMenu, 46
configuring qDynamicLayout, 123
configuring qManagement, 233
configuring qPanelMenu, 263
controlling decimal precision, 91, 321
creating and editing collapsible sections in qListForm,
188
CRM Template, 404
Custom Action, 389
customactionex interface, 389
debugging, 398
deploying the custom action class, 399
icustomaction interface (deprecated), 395
using the custom action class, 399
Custom Action class, 399
deploying, 399
custom actions, 23, 168, 209, 282, 341, 366
Custom Layout, 149
custom layout manager class, 150
debugging, 153
deploying custom layout manager class, 155
Layout Manager, 149
using custom layout manager class, 154
Custom Layout Manager class, 150
deploying, 155
using, 154
customactionex interface, 389
D
debugging, 153, 398
defining links in qChartView, 89
defining links in qSIChartView, 319
deploying the custom action class, 399
dynamic variables in CAML Filter, 21
E
exploring Web Parts in qManagement, 234
ezLocalizer, 400
F
features of QuickApps, 8
form initialization actions, 172, 345
formatting links in qChartView, 89
formatting links in qSIChartView, 318
Index
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 416
formatting y-axis values decimal in manual-div line
mode, 95, 325
H
Help Desk Template, 405
I
icustomaction interface (deprecated), 395
installing Application Templates, 404
L
Layout Manager, 149
linking to frames in qChartView, 90
linking to frames in qSIChartView, 320
Localization, 400
M
multi-series charts, 410
My First App, 403
using, 403
N
number formatting in qChartView, 91
adding number prefix and suffix, 94
automatic number formatting, 92
controlling decimal precision, 91
formatting y-axis values decimal in manual-div
lines mode, 95
setting custom thousand and decimal separator
character, 94
number formatting in qSIChartView, 321
adding number prefix and suffix, 324
automatic number formatting, 322
controlling decimal precision, 321
formatting y-axis values decimal in manual-div
lines mode, 325
setting custom thousand and decimal separator
character, 323
number scaling in qChartView, 96
adding billions to default, 96
putting time in scale, 97
number scaling in qSIChartView, 325
adding billions to default, 326
putting time in scale, 327
O
opening links in a new window in qChartView, 89
opening links in a new window in qSIChartView, 319
opening links in a pop-up window in qChartView, 89
opening links in a pop-up window in qSIChartView, 319
P
Project Dashboard Template, 406
Project Workspace, 406
putting time in scale, 97, 327
Q
qCalendarView, 10
Configuration Wizard, 10
configuring basic settings, 34
Pages, 11
Advanced Page, 32
Appearance Page, 28
Behavior Page, 22
Content Page, 11
qCaptionDisplay, 35
Pages, 36
Advanced Page, 38
Appearance Page, 36
Content Page, 36
qCascadingMenu, 40
configuring, 46
Pages, 41
Appearance Page, 43
Behavior Page, 42
Content Page, 41
qCascadingMenu Pages
Advanced Page, 44
qChartView, 48
adding billions to default, 96
Configuration Wizard, 48
configuring basic settings, 88
defining links, 89
formatting links, 89
linking to frames, 90
number formatting, 91
adding number prefix and suffix, 94
automatic number formatting, 92
controlling decimal precision, 91
formatting y-axis values decimal in manual-
div line mode, 95
setting custom thousand and decimal
separator character, 94
number scaling, 96
adding billions to default, 96
putting time in scale, 97
opening links in a new window, 89
opening links in a pop-up window, 89
Pages, 48
Advanced Page, 86
Appearance Page, 56
Behavior Page, 56
Content Page, 49
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 417
qDiscussionView, 99
Pages, 99
Appearance Page, 109
Behavior Page, 109
Content Page, 99
qDiscussionView Pages
Advanced Page, 112
qDynamicLayout, 119
adding a web part later, 123
adding more web parts to the same tab, 123
configuring, 123
configuring a web part within qDynamicLayout,
123
Pages, 119
Advanced Page, 122
Appearance Page, 121
Content Page, 119
qExcelViewer, 124
qExcelViewer Pages, 124
Advanced Page, 127
Appearance Page, 126
Content Page, 124
qHelpLink, 130
qHelpLink Pages, 130
Advanced Page, 133
Behavior Page, 132
Content Page, 131
qItemDisplay, 135
qItemDisplay Pages, 135
Advanced Page, 139
Appearance Page, 137
Behavior Page, 137
Content Page, 135
qListForm, 141
adding items to a list in SharePoint, 187
Configuration Wizard, 143
configuring basic settings, 187
creating and editing collapsible sections, 188
User Permissions, 143
qListForm Pages, 144
Advanced Page, 184
Appearance Page, 180
Behavior Page, 167
Content Page, 144
qListView, 192
Configuration Wizard, 193
configuring advanced settings, 226
configuring basic settings, 226
qListView Pages, 193
Advanced Page, 220
Appearance Page, 214
Behavior Page, 208
Content Page, 194
qManagement, 228
configuring, 233
exploring Web Parts, 234
searching web parts, 234
setting new property values, 234
qManagement Pages, 228
Advanced Page, 232
Appearance Page, 229
Content Page, 228
qMediaView, 236
qMediaView Pages, 236
Advanced Page, 244
Appearance Page, 240
Content Page, 237
qMultiSelector, 245
qMultiSelector Pages, 245
Advanced Page, 250
Appearance Page, 248
Content Page, 245
qPageRedirector, 252
qPageRedirector Pages, 253
Advanced Page, 255
Appearance Page, 253
Content Page, 253
qPanelMenu, 257
configuring, 263
qPanelMenu Pages, 258
Advanced Page, 262
Appearance Page, 260
Behavior Page, 260
Content Page, 258
qSelector, 265
qSelector Pages, 266
Advanced Page, 270
Appearance Page, 269
Content Page, 266
qSIChartView, 272
adding billions to default, 326
defining links, 319
formatting links, 318
linking to frames, 320
number formatting, 321
adding number prefix and suffix, 324
automatic number formatting, 322
controlling decimal precision, 321
formatting y-axis values decimal in manual-
div line mode, 325
setting custom thousand and decimal
separator character, 323
number scaling, 325
putting time in scale, 327
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 418
opening links in a new window, 319
opening links in a pop-up window, 319
qSIChartView Pages, 272
Advanced Page, 316
Appearance Page, 287
Behavior Page, 282
Content Page, 273
qSIListForm, 329
qSIListForm Pages, 330
Advanced Page, 352
Appearance Page, 349
Behavior Page, 340
Content Page, 330
qSIListView, 354
qSIListView Pages, 355
Advanced Page, 375
Appearance Page, 370
Behavior Page, 366
Content Page, 355
qSISelector, 378
qSISelector Pages, 379
Advanced Page, 387
Appearance Page, 385
Content Page, 379
QuickApps
about, 8
features, 8
R
ribbon groups, 9
S
sample charts, 408
scroll charts, 413
searching web parts in qManagement, 234
setting custom thousand and decimal separator
character, 94, 323
setting new property values in qManagement, 234
single series charts, 408
stacked charts, 414
U
User Permissions
qListForm, 143
using My First App, 403
using the custom action class, 399
V
variables, 20
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 419
www.agreeya.com
About AgreeYa
AgreeYa Solutions is a global provider of software, solutions, and services focused on deploying business-driven,
technology-enabled solutions that create next-generation competitive advantages for customers.
Headquartered in Folsom, California, AgreeYa is a growing and dynamic organization with 15 offices in 8
countries employing more than 1,300 professionals. Over the last 15 years, AgreeYa has worked with 200+
companies ranging from Fortune 100 firms to small and large businesses, delivering solutions for variety of
industries including telecommunications, BFSI, healthcare, high-tech, manufacturing, utility and government.
AgreeYa’s software portfolio includes SocialXtend (intranet and enterprise social collaboration), VDIXtend
(Desktop-on-Cloud), Onvelop (enterprise mobility productivity suite), Edvelop (single window collaboration and
communication solution for 21st century learning) and Cogent (comprehensive end-to-end case management
solution for collections agencies and law firms). As part of its solutions and services offerings, AgreeYa provides
intranet and enterprise collaboration on SharePoint, cloud and infrastructure, enterprise mobility, product
engineering, application development and management, independent software testing, and staffing (IT and
risk/compliance) solutions. For more information visit www.agreeya.com
Contacting AgreeYa
Technical sup port:
Online support
Product questions and sales:
1-800-AGREEYA
Email:
quickapps@agreeya.com
Technical support resources
Technical support is available to customers who have purchased AgreeYa software with a valid maintenance
contract and to customers who have trial versions. To access the Support Portal, go to
www.quickapps.agreeya.com/support.
The Support Portal provides self-help tools you can use to solve problems quickly and independently, 24 hours a
day, 365 days a year. In addition, the portal provides direct access to product support engineers through an
online Service Requests system.
The site enables you to:
Create, update, and manage Service Requests (cases)
View Knowledge Base articles
Obtain product notifications
Download software. For trial software, go to Trial Downloads.
View how-to videos
Engage in community discussions
Chat with a support engineer
QuickApps for SharePoint® 6.9
User Guide 420
www.agreeya.com
Third-party contributions
This product contains the third-party components listed below. For third-party license information, go to
http://quickapps.agreeya.com/support.
Table 1. List of third-party contributions
Component License or acknowledgement
async.js n/a Copyright 2010 Caolan McMahon
DevArt dotConnect for
Oracle 7.6 DevArt dotConnect for Oracle 7.6
Exclusively licensed for QuickApps for SharePoint, this component may not be used
for any other purpose.
JQuery 1.8.2 MIT
spin.js 1.3.2 MIT

Navigation menu